Index: ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Core/Inc/FreeRTOSConfig.h
===================================================================
--- ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Core/Inc/FreeRTOSConfig.h	(revision 73)
+++ ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Core/Inc/FreeRTOSConfig.h	(revision 73)
@@ -0,0 +1,193 @@
+/* USER CODE BEGIN Header */
+/*
+ * FreeRTOS Kernel V10.3.1
+ * Portion Copyright (C) 2017 Amazon.com, Inc. or its affiliates.  All Rights Reserved.
+ * Portion Copyright (C) 2019 StMicroelectronics, Inc.  All Rights Reserved.
+ *
+ * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of
+ * this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in
+ * the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to
+ * use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of
+ * the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so,
+ * subject to the following conditions:
+ *
+ * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all
+ * copies or substantial portions of the Software.
+ *
+ * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
+ * IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS
+ * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR
+ * COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
+ * IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
+ * CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
+ *
+ * http://www.FreeRTOS.org
+ * http://aws.amazon.com/freertos
+ *
+ * 1 tab == 4 spaces!
+ */
+/* USER CODE END Header */
+
+#ifndef FREERTOS_CONFIG_H
+#define FREERTOS_CONFIG_H
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------
+ * Application specific definitions.
+ *
+ * These definitions should be adjusted for your particular hardware and
+ * application requirements.
+ *
+ * These parameters and more are described within the 'configuration' section of the
+ * FreeRTOS API documentation available on the FreeRTOS.org web site.
+ *
+ * See http://www.freertos.org/a00110.html
+ *----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* USER CODE BEGIN Includes */
+/* Section where include file can be added */
+/* USER CODE END Includes */
+
+/* Ensure definitions are only used by the compiler, and not by the assembler. */
+#if defined(__ICCARM__) || defined(__CC_ARM) || defined(__GNUC__)
+  #include <stdint.h>
+  extern uint32_t SystemCoreClock;
+#endif
+#ifndef CMSIS_device_header
+#define CMSIS_device_header "stm32h7xx.h"
+#endif /* CMSIS_device_header */
+
+#define configENABLE_FPU                         1
+#define configENABLE_MPU                         0
+
+#define configUSE_PREEMPTION                     1
+#define configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION          1
+#define configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION         1
+#define configUSE_IDLE_HOOK                      0
+#define configUSE_TICK_HOOK                      0
+#define configCPU_CLOCK_HZ                       ( SystemCoreClock )
+#define configTICK_RATE_HZ                       ((TickType_t)1000)
+#define configMAX_PRIORITIES                     ( 56 )
+#define configMINIMAL_STACK_SIZE                 ((uint16_t)128)
+#define configTOTAL_HEAP_SIZE                    ((size_t)15360)
+#define configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN                  ( 16 )
+#define configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY                 1
+#define configUSE_16_BIT_TICKS                   0
+#define configUSE_MUTEXES                        1
+#define configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE                8
+#define configCHECK_FOR_STACK_OVERFLOW           2
+#define configUSE_RECURSIVE_MUTEXES              1
+#define configUSE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORES            1
+#define configENABLE_BACKWARD_COMPATIBILITY      0
+#define configUSE_PORT_OPTIMISED_TASK_SELECTION  0
+#define configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE                  1
+#define configRECORD_STACK_HIGH_ADDRESS          1
+/* USER CODE BEGIN MESSAGE_BUFFER_LENGTH_TYPE */
+/* Defaults to size_t for backward compatibility, but can be changed
+   if lengths will always be less than the number of bytes in a size_t. */
+#define configMESSAGE_BUFFER_LENGTH_TYPE         size_t
+/* USER CODE END MESSAGE_BUFFER_LENGTH_TYPE */
+
+/* Co-routine definitions. */
+#define configUSE_CO_ROUTINES                    0
+#define configMAX_CO_ROUTINE_PRIORITIES          ( 2 )
+
+/* Software timer definitions. */
+#define configUSE_TIMERS                         1
+#define configTIMER_TASK_PRIORITY                ( 2 )
+#define configTIMER_QUEUE_LENGTH                 10
+#define configTIMER_TASK_STACK_DEPTH             256
+
+/* CMSIS-RTOS V2 flags */
+#define configUSE_OS2_THREAD_SUSPEND_RESUME  1
+#define configUSE_OS2_THREAD_ENUMERATE       1
+#define configUSE_OS2_EVENTFLAGS_FROM_ISR    1
+#define configUSE_OS2_THREAD_FLAGS           1
+#define configUSE_OS2_TIMER                  1
+#define configUSE_OS2_MUTEX                  1
+
+/* Set the following definitions to 1 to include the API function, or zero
+to exclude the API function. */
+#define INCLUDE_vTaskPrioritySet             1
+#define INCLUDE_uxTaskPriorityGet            1
+#define INCLUDE_vTaskDelete                  1
+#define INCLUDE_vTaskCleanUpResources        0
+#define INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend                 1
+#define INCLUDE_vTaskDelayUntil              1
+#define INCLUDE_vTaskDelay                   1
+#define INCLUDE_xTaskGetSchedulerState       1
+#define INCLUDE_xTimerPendFunctionCall       1
+#define INCLUDE_xQueueGetMutexHolder         1
+#define INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark  1
+#define INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark2 1
+#define INCLUDE_xTaskGetCurrentTaskHandle    1
+#define INCLUDE_eTaskGetState                1
+#define INCLUDE_xTaskGetHandle               1
+
+/*
+ * The CMSIS-RTOS V2 FreeRTOS wrapper is dependent on the heap implementation used
+ * by the application thus the correct define need to be enabled below
+ */
+#define USE_FreeRTOS_HEAP_4
+
+/* Cortex-M specific definitions. */
+#ifdef __NVIC_PRIO_BITS
+ /* __BVIC_PRIO_BITS will be specified when CMSIS is being used. */
+ #define configPRIO_BITS         __NVIC_PRIO_BITS
+#else
+ #define configPRIO_BITS         4
+#endif
+
+/* The lowest interrupt priority that can be used in a call to a "set priority"
+function. */
+#define configLIBRARY_LOWEST_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY   15
+
+/* The highest interrupt priority that can be used by any interrupt service
+routine that makes calls to interrupt safe FreeRTOS API functions.  DO NOT CALL
+INTERRUPT SAFE FREERTOS API FUNCTIONS FROM ANY INTERRUPT THAT HAS A HIGHER
+PRIORITY THAN THIS! (higher priorities are lower numeric values. */
+#define configLIBRARY_MAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY 5
+
+/* Interrupt priorities used by the kernel port layer itself.  These are generic
+to all Cortex-M ports, and do not rely on any particular library functions. */
+#define configKERNEL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY 		( configLIBRARY_LOWEST_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY << (8 - configPRIO_BITS) )
+/* !!!! configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY must not be set to zero !!!!
+See http://www.FreeRTOS.org/RTOS-Cortex-M3-M4.html. */
+#define configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY 	( configLIBRARY_MAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY << (8 - configPRIO_BITS) )
+
+/* Normal assert() semantics without relying on the provision of an assert.h
+header file. */
+/* USER CODE BEGIN 1 */
+#define configASSERT( x ) if ((x) == 0) {taskDISABLE_INTERRUPTS(); for( ;; );}
+/* USER CODE END 1 */
+
+/* Definitions that map the FreeRTOS port interrupt handlers to their CMSIS
+standard names. */
+#define vPortSVCHandler    SVC_Handler
+#define xPortPendSVHandler PendSV_Handler
+
+/* IMPORTANT: After 10.3.1 update, Systick_Handler comes from NVIC (if SYS timebase = systick), otherwise from cmsis_os2.c */
+
+#define USE_CUSTOM_SYSTICK_HANDLER_IMPLEMENTATION 0
+
+/* USER CODE BEGIN Defines */
+/* Section where parameter definitions can be added (for instance, to override default ones in FreeRTOS.h) */
+/* USER CODE END Defines */
+
+#if defined(__ICCARM__) || defined(__CC_ARM) || defined(__GNUC__)
+void PreSleepProcessing(uint32_t ulExpectedIdleTime);
+void PostSleepProcessing(uint32_t ulExpectedIdleTime);
+#endif /* defined(__ICCARM__) || defined(__CC_ARM) || defined(__GNUC__) */
+
+/* The configPRE_SLEEP_PROCESSING() and configPOST_SLEEP_PROCESSING() macros
+allow the application writer to add additional code before and after the MCU is
+placed into the low power state respectively. */
+#if configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE == 1
+#define configPRE_SLEEP_PROCESSING(__x__)                           \
+                                       do {                         \
+                                         __x__ = 0;                 \
+                                         PreSleepProcessing(__x__); \
+                                      }while(0)
+#define configPOST_SLEEP_PROCESSING                       PostSleepProcessing
+#endif /* configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE == 1 */
+
+#endif /* FREERTOS_CONFIG_H */
Index: ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Core/Src/freertos.c
===================================================================
--- ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Core/Src/freertos.c	(revision 73)
+++ ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Core/Src/freertos.c	(revision 73)
@@ -0,0 +1,166 @@
+/* USER CODE BEGIN Header */
+/**
+  ******************************************************************************
+  * File Name          : freertos.c
+  * Description        : Code for freertos applications
+  ******************************************************************************
+  * @attention
+  *
+  * Copyright (c) 2025 STMicroelectronics.
+  * All rights reserved.
+  *
+  * This software is licensed under terms that can be found in the LICENSE file
+  * in the root directory of this software component.
+  * If no LICENSE file comes with this software, it is provided AS-IS.
+  *
+  ******************************************************************************
+  */
+/* USER CODE END Header */
+
+/* Includes ------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+#include "FreeRTOS.h"
+#include "task.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "cmsis_os.h"
+
+/* Private includes ----------------------------------------------------------*/
+/* USER CODE BEGIN Includes */
+
+#include "keys_task.h"
+
+/* USER CODE END Includes */
+
+/* Private typedef -----------------------------------------------------------*/
+typedef StaticTask_t osStaticThreadDef_t;
+/* USER CODE BEGIN PTD */
+
+/* USER CODE END PTD */
+
+/* Private define ------------------------------------------------------------*/
+/* USER CODE BEGIN PD */
+
+/* USER CODE END PD */
+
+/* Private macro -------------------------------------------------------------*/
+/* USER CODE BEGIN PM */
+
+/* USER CODE END PM */
+
+/* Private variables ---------------------------------------------------------*/
+/* USER CODE BEGIN Variables */
+
+const uint16_t KEYS_TASK_STACK_DEPTH_WORDS = 128U;
+
+/* USER CODE END Variables */
+/* Definitions for mainTask */
+osThreadId_t mainTaskHandle;
+uint32_t mainTaskBuffer[ 128 ];
+osStaticThreadDef_t mainTaskControlBlock;
+const osThreadAttr_t mainTask_attributes = {
+  .name = "mainTask",
+  .cb_mem = &mainTaskControlBlock,
+  .cb_size = sizeof(mainTaskControlBlock),
+  .stack_mem = &mainTaskBuffer[0],
+  .stack_size = sizeof(mainTaskBuffer),
+  .priority = (osPriority_t) osPriorityNormal,
+};
+
+/* Private function prototypes -----------------------------------------------*/
+/* USER CODE BEGIN FunctionPrototypes */
+
+/* USER CODE END FunctionPrototypes */
+
+void mainTaskStart(void *argument);
+
+//void MX_FREERTOS_Init(void); /* (MISRA C 2004 rule 8.1) */
+
+/* Hook prototypes */
+void vApplicationStackOverflowHook(TaskHandle_t xTask, signed char *pcTaskName);
+
+/* USER CODE BEGIN 4 */
+void vApplicationStackOverflowHook(TaskHandle_t xTask, signed char *pcTaskName)
+{
+   /* Run time stack overflow checking is performed if
+   configCHECK_FOR_STACK_OVERFLOW is defined to 1 or 2. This hook function is
+   called if a stack overflow is detected. */
+}
+/* USER CODE END 4 */
+
+/* USER CODE BEGIN PREPOSTSLEEP */
+__weak void PreSleepProcessing(uint32_t ulExpectedIdleTime)
+{
+/* place for user code */
+}
+
+__weak void PostSleepProcessing(uint32_t ulExpectedIdleTime)
+{
+/* place for user code */
+}
+/* USER CODE END PREPOSTSLEEP */
+
+/**
+  * @brief  FreeRTOS initialization
+  * @param  None
+  * @retval None
+  */
+void MX_FREERTOS_Init(void) {
+  /* USER CODE BEGIN Init */
+
+  /* USER CODE END Init */
+
+  /* USER CODE BEGIN RTOS_MUTEX */
+  /* add mutexes, ... */
+  /* USER CODE END RTOS_MUTEX */
+
+  /* USER CODE BEGIN RTOS_SEMAPHORES */
+  /* add semaphores, ... */
+  /* USER CODE END RTOS_SEMAPHORES */
+
+  /* USER CODE BEGIN RTOS_TIMERS */
+  /* start timers, add new ones, ... */
+  /* USER CODE END RTOS_TIMERS */
+
+  /* USER CODE BEGIN RTOS_QUEUES */
+  /* add queues, ... */
+  /* USER CODE END RTOS_QUEUES */
+
+  /* Create the thread(s) */
+  /* creation of mainTask */
+  mainTaskHandle = osThreadNew(mainTaskStart, NULL, &mainTask_attributes);
+
+  /* USER CODE BEGIN RTOS_THREADS */
+  /* add threads, ... */
+
+  BaseType_t r = xTaskCreate(keysTaskStart, "ScanKeysTask", KEYS_TASK_STACK_DEPTH_WORDS, NULL, 0, NULL);
+
+  /* USER CODE END RTOS_THREADS */
+
+  /* USER CODE BEGIN RTOS_EVENTS */
+  /* add events, ... */
+  /* USER CODE END RTOS_EVENTS */
+
+}
+
+/* USER CODE BEGIN Header_mainTaskStart */
+/**
+  * @brief  Function implementing the mainTask thread.
+  * @param  argument: Not used
+  * @retval None
+  */
+/* USER CODE END Header_mainTaskStart */
+__weak void mainTaskStart(void *argument)
+{
+  /* USER CODE BEGIN mainTaskStart */
+  /* Infinite loop */
+  for(;;)
+  {
+    osDelay(1);
+  }
+  /* USER CODE END mainTaskStart */
+}
+
+/* Private application code --------------------------------------------------*/
+/* USER CODE BEGIN Application */
+
+/* USER CODE END Application */
+
Index: ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Core/Src/main.c
===================================================================
--- ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Core/Src/main.c	(revision 72)
+++ ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Core/Src/main.c	(revision 73)
@@ -65,5 +65,4 @@
 void SPI_WriteComm(uint8_t);
 void SPI_WriteData(uint8_t);
-void DoNothing(void) {};
 
 
@@ -112,5 +111,5 @@
 
   /* USER CODE BEGIN SysInit */
-#define MX_SDMMC1_SD_Init DoNothing
+
   /* USER CODE END SysInit */
 
@@ -125,5 +124,5 @@
   MX_TIM8_Init();
   /* USER CODE BEGIN 2 */
-#undef MX_SDMMC1_SD_Init
+
   /* USER CODE END 2 */
 
Index: ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/CMSIS_RTOS_V2/cmsis_os.h
===================================================================
--- ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/CMSIS_RTOS_V2/cmsis_os.h	(revision 73)
+++ ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/CMSIS_RTOS_V2/cmsis_os.h	(revision 73)
@@ -0,0 +1,846 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 2013-2019 ARM Limited. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
+ *
+ * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the License); you may
+ * not use this file except in compliance with the License.
+ * You may obtain a copy of the License at
+ *
+ * www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0
+ *
+ * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software
+ * distributed under the License is distributed on an AS IS BASIS, WITHOUT
+ * WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied.
+ * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and
+ * limitations under the License.
+ *
+ * ----------------------------------------------------------------------
+ *
+ * $Date:        10. January 2017
+ * $Revision:    V2.1.0
+ *
+ * Project:      CMSIS-RTOS API
+ * Title:        cmsis_os.h FreeRTOS header file
+ *
+ * Version 0.02
+ *    Initial Proposal Phase
+ * Version 0.03
+ *    osKernelStart added, optional feature: main started as thread
+ *    osSemaphores have standard behavior
+ *    osTimerCreate does not start the timer, added osTimerStart
+ *    osThreadPass is renamed to osThreadYield
+ * Version 1.01
+ *    Support for C++ interface
+ *     - const attribute removed from the osXxxxDef_t typedefs
+ *     - const attribute added to the osXxxxDef macros
+ *    Added: osTimerDelete, osMutexDelete, osSemaphoreDelete
+ *    Added: osKernelInitialize
+ * Version 1.02
+ *    Control functions for short timeouts in microsecond resolution:
+ *    Added: osKernelSysTick, osKernelSysTickFrequency, osKernelSysTickMicroSec
+ *    Removed: osSignalGet 
+ * Version 2.0.0
+ *    OS objects creation without macros (dynamic creation and resource allocation):
+ *     - added: osXxxxNew functions which replace osXxxxCreate
+ *     - added: osXxxxAttr_t structures
+ *     - deprecated: osXxxxCreate functions, osXxxxDef_t structures
+ *     - deprecated: osXxxxDef and osXxxx macros
+ *    osStatus codes simplified and renamed to osStatus_t
+ *    osEvent return structure deprecated
+ *    Kernel:
+ *     - added: osKernelInfo_t and osKernelGetInfo
+ *     - added: osKernelState_t and osKernelGetState (replaces osKernelRunning)
+ *     - added: osKernelLock, osKernelUnlock
+ *     - added: osKernelSuspend, osKernelResume
+ *     - added: osKernelGetTickCount, osKernelGetTickFreq
+ *     - renamed osKernelSysTick to osKernelGetSysTimerCount
+ *     - replaced osKernelSysTickFrequency with osKernelGetSysTimerFreq
+ *     - deprecated osKernelSysTickMicroSec
+ *    Thread:
+ *     - extended number of thread priorities
+ *     - renamed osPrioriry to osPrioriry_t
+ *     - replaced osThreadCreate with osThreadNew
+ *     - added: osThreadGetName
+ *     - added: osThreadState_t and osThreadGetState
+ *     - added: osThreadGetStackSize, osThreadGetStackSpace
+ *     - added: osThreadSuspend, osThreadResume
+ *     - added: osThreadJoin, osThreadDetach, osThreadExit
+ *     - added: osThreadGetCount, osThreadEnumerate
+ *     - added: Thread Flags (moved from Signals) 
+ *    Signals:
+ *     - renamed osSignals to osThreadFlags (moved to Thread Flags)
+ *     - changed return value of Set/Clear/Wait functions
+ *     - Clear function limited to current running thread
+ *     - extended Wait function (options)
+ *     - added: osThreadFlagsGet
+ *    Event Flags:
+ *     - added new independent object for handling Event Flags
+ *    Delay and Wait functions:
+ *     - added: osDelayUntil
+ *     - deprecated: osWait
+ *    Timer:
+ *     - replaced osTimerCreate with osTimerNew
+ *     - added: osTimerGetName, osTimerIsRunning
+ *    Mutex:
+ *     - extended: attributes (Recursive, Priority Inherit, Robust)
+ *     - replaced osMutexCreate with osMutexNew
+ *     - renamed osMutexWait to osMutexAcquire
+ *     - added: osMutexGetName, osMutexGetOwner
+ *    Semaphore:
+ *     - extended: maximum and initial token count
+ *     - replaced osSemaphoreCreate with osSemaphoreNew
+ *     - renamed osSemaphoreWait to osSemaphoreAcquire (changed return value)
+ *     - added: osSemaphoreGetName, osSemaphoreGetCount
+ *    Memory Pool:
+ *     - using osMemoryPool prefix instead of osPool
+ *     - replaced osPoolCreate with osMemoryPoolNew
+ *     - extended osMemoryPoolAlloc (timeout)
+ *     - added: osMemoryPoolGetName
+ *     - added: osMemoryPoolGetCapacity, osMemoryPoolGetBlockSize
+ *     - added: osMemoryPoolGetCount, osMemoryPoolGetSpace
+ *     - added: osMemoryPoolDelete
+ *     - deprecated: osPoolCAlloc
+ *    Message Queue:
+ *     - extended: fixed size message instead of a single 32-bit value
+ *     - using osMessageQueue prefix instead of osMessage
+ *     - replaced osMessageCreate with osMessageQueueNew
+ *     - updated: osMessageQueuePut, osMessageQueueGet
+ *     - added: osMessageQueueGetName
+ *     - added: osMessageQueueGetCapacity, osMessageQueueGetMsgSize
+ *     - added: osMessageQueueGetCount, osMessageQueueGetSpace
+ *     - added: osMessageQueueReset, osMessageQueueDelete
+ *    Mail Queue: 
+ *     - deprecated (superseded by extended Message Queue functionality)
+ * Version 2.1.0
+ *    Support for critical and uncritical sections (nesting safe):
+ *    - updated: osKernelLock, osKernelUnlock
+ *    - added: osKernelRestoreLock
+ *    Updated Thread and Event Flags:
+ *    - changed flags parameter and return type from int32_t to uint32_t
+ *---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+ 
+#ifndef CMSIS_OS_H_
+#define CMSIS_OS_H_
+
+#include "FreeRTOS.h"
+#include "task.h"
+
+#define RTOS_ID_n             ((tskKERNEL_VERSION_MAJOR << 16) | (tskKERNEL_VERSION_MINOR))
+#define RTOS_ID_s             ("FreeRTOS " tskKERNEL_VERSION_NUMBER)
+
+#define osCMSIS               0x20001U  ///< API version (main[31:16].sub[15:0])
+
+#define osCMSIS_FreeRTOS      RTOS_ID_n ///< RTOS identification and version (main[31:16].sub[15:0])
+ 
+#define osKernelSystemId      RTOS_ID_s ///< RTOS identification string
+ 
+#define osFeature_MainThread  0         ///< main thread      1=main can be thread, 0=not available
+#define osFeature_Signals     24U       ///< maximum number of Signal Flags available per thread
+#define osFeature_Semaphore   65535U    ///< maximum count for \ref osSemaphoreCreate function
+#define osFeature_Wait        0         ///< osWait function: 1=available, 0=not available
+#define osFeature_SysTick     1         ///< osKernelSysTick functions: 1=available, 0=not available
+#define osFeature_Pool        0         ///< Memory Pools:    1=available, 0=not available
+#define osFeature_MessageQ    1         ///< Message Queues:  1=available, 0=not available
+#define osFeature_MailQ       0         ///< Mail Queues:     1=available, 0=not available
+ 
+#if   defined(__CC_ARM)
+#define os_InRegs __value_in_regs
+#elif defined(__ARMCC_VERSION) && (__ARMCC_VERSION >= 6010050)
+#define os_InRegs __attribute__((value_in_regs))
+#else
+#define os_InRegs
+#endif
+ 
+#include "cmsis_os2.h"
+ 
+#ifdef  __cplusplus
+extern "C"
+{
+#endif
+ 
+ 
+// ==== Enumerations, structures, defines ====
+ 
+/// Priority values.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+typedef enum {
+  osPriorityIdle          = -3,         ///< Priority: idle (lowest)
+  osPriorityLow           = -2,         ///< Priority: low
+  osPriorityBelowNormal   = -1,         ///< Priority: below normal
+  osPriorityNormal        =  0,         ///< Priority: normal (default)
+  osPriorityAboveNormal   = +1,         ///< Priority: above normal
+  osPriorityHigh          = +2,         ///< Priority: high
+  osPriorityRealtime      = +3,         ///< Priority: realtime (highest)
+  osPriorityError         = 0x84,       ///< System cannot determine priority or illegal priority.
+  osPriorityReserved      = 0x7FFFFFFF  ///< Prevents enum down-size compiler optimization.
+} osPriority;
+#else
+#define osPriority osPriority_t
+#endif
+
+/// Entry point of a thread.
+typedef void (*os_pthread) (void const *argument);
+ 
+/// Entry point of a timer call back function.
+typedef void (*os_ptimer) (void const *argument);
+ 
+/// Timer type.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+typedef enum {
+  osTimerOnce             = 0,          ///< One-shot timer.
+  osTimerPeriodic         = 1           ///< Repeating timer.
+} os_timer_type;
+#else
+#define os_timer_type osTimerType_t
+#endif
+ 
+/// Timeout value.
+#define osWaitForever       0xFFFFFFFFU ///< Wait forever timeout value.
+ 
+/// Status code values returned by CMSIS-RTOS functions.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+typedef enum {
+  osOK                    =    0,       ///< Function completed; no error or event occurred.
+  osEventSignal           = 0x08,       ///< Function completed; signal event occurred.
+  osEventMessage          = 0x10,       ///< Function completed; message event occurred.
+  osEventMail             = 0x20,       ///< Function completed; mail event occurred.
+  osEventTimeout          = 0x40,       ///< Function completed; timeout occurred.
+  osErrorParameter        = 0x80,       ///< Parameter error: a mandatory parameter was missing or specified an incorrect object.
+  osErrorResource         = 0x81,       ///< Resource not available: a specified resource was not available.
+  osErrorTimeoutResource  = 0xC1,       ///< Resource not available within given time: a specified resource was not available within the timeout period.
+  osErrorISR              = 0x82,       ///< Not allowed in ISR context: the function cannot be called from interrupt service routines.
+  osErrorISRRecursive     = 0x83,       ///< Function called multiple times from ISR with same object.
+  osErrorPriority         = 0x84,       ///< System cannot determine priority or thread has illegal priority.
+  osErrorNoMemory         = 0x85,       ///< System is out of memory: it was impossible to allocate or reserve memory for the operation.
+  osErrorValue            = 0x86,       ///< Value of a parameter is out of range.
+  osErrorOS               = 0xFF,       ///< Unspecified RTOS error: run-time error but no other error message fits.
+  osStatusReserved        = 0x7FFFFFFF  ///< Prevents enum down-size compiler optimization.
+} osStatus;
+#else
+typedef int32_t                  osStatus;
+#define osEventSignal           (0x08)
+#define osEventMessage          (0x10)
+#define osEventMail             (0x20)
+#define osEventTimeout          (0x40)
+#define osErrorOS               osError
+#define osErrorTimeoutResource  osErrorTimeout
+#define osErrorISRRecursive     (-126)
+#define osErrorValue            (-127)
+#define osErrorPriority         (-128)
+#endif
+ 
+ 
+// >>> the following data type definitions may be adapted towards a specific RTOS
+ 
+/// Thread ID identifies the thread.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+typedef void *osThreadId;
+#else
+#define osThreadId osThreadId_t
+#endif
+ 
+/// Timer ID identifies the timer.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+typedef void *osTimerId;
+#else
+#define osTimerId osTimerId_t
+#endif
+ 
+/// Mutex ID identifies the mutex.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+typedef void *osMutexId;
+#else
+#define osMutexId osMutexId_t
+#endif
+ 
+/// Semaphore ID identifies the semaphore.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+typedef void *osSemaphoreId;
+#else
+#define osSemaphoreId osSemaphoreId_t
+#endif
+ 
+/// Pool ID identifies the memory pool.
+typedef void *osPoolId;
+ 
+/// Message ID identifies the message queue.
+typedef void *osMessageQId;
+ 
+/// Mail ID identifies the mail queue.
+typedef void *osMailQId;
+ 
+ 
+/// Thread Definition structure contains startup information of a thread.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+typedef struct os_thread_def {
+  os_pthread                 pthread;   ///< start address of thread function
+  osPriority               tpriority;   ///< initial thread priority
+  uint32_t                 instances;   ///< maximum number of instances of that thread function
+  uint32_t                 stacksize;   ///< stack size requirements in bytes; 0 is default stack size
+} osThreadDef_t;
+#else
+typedef struct os_thread_def {
+  os_pthread                 pthread;   ///< start address of thread function
+  osThreadAttr_t                attr;   ///< thread attributes
+} osThreadDef_t;
+#endif
+ 
+/// Timer Definition structure contains timer parameters.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+typedef struct os_timer_def {
+  os_ptimer                   ptimer;   ///< start address of a timer function
+} osTimerDef_t;
+#else
+typedef struct os_timer_def {
+  os_ptimer                   ptimer;   ///< start address of a timer function
+  osTimerAttr_t                 attr;   ///< timer attributes
+} osTimerDef_t;
+#endif
+ 
+/// Mutex Definition structure contains setup information for a mutex.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+typedef struct os_mutex_def {
+  uint32_t                     dummy;   ///< dummy value
+} osMutexDef_t;
+#else
+#define osMutexDef_t osMutexAttr_t
+#endif
+ 
+/// Semaphore Definition structure contains setup information for a semaphore.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+typedef struct os_semaphore_def {
+  uint32_t                     dummy;   ///< dummy value
+} osSemaphoreDef_t;
+#else
+#define osSemaphoreDef_t osSemaphoreAttr_t
+#endif
+ 
+/// Definition structure for memory block allocation.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+typedef struct os_pool_def {
+  uint32_t                   pool_sz;   ///< number of items (elements) in the pool
+  uint32_t                   item_sz;   ///< size of an item
+  void                         *pool;   ///< pointer to memory for pool
+} osPoolDef_t;
+#else
+typedef struct os_pool_def {
+  uint32_t                   pool_sz;   ///< number of items (elements) in the pool
+  uint32_t                   item_sz;   ///< size of an item
+  osMemoryPoolAttr_t            attr;   ///< memory pool attributes
+} osPoolDef_t;
+#endif
+ 
+/// Definition structure for message queue.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+typedef struct os_messageQ_def {
+  uint32_t                  queue_sz;   ///< number of elements in the queue
+  void                         *pool;   ///< memory array for messages
+} osMessageQDef_t;
+#else
+typedef struct os_messageQ_def {
+  uint32_t                  queue_sz;   ///< number of elements in the queue
+  osMessageQueueAttr_t          attr;   ///< message queue attributes
+} osMessageQDef_t;
+#endif
+ 
+/// Definition structure for mail queue.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+typedef struct os_mailQ_def {
+  uint32_t                  queue_sz;   ///< number of elements in the queue
+  uint32_t                   item_sz;   ///< size of an item
+  void                         *pool;   ///< memory array for mail
+} osMailQDef_t;
+#else
+typedef struct os_mailQ_def {
+  uint32_t                  queue_sz;   ///< number of elements in the queue
+  uint32_t                   item_sz;   ///< size of an item
+  void                         *mail;   ///< pointer to mail
+  osMemoryPoolAttr_t         mp_attr;   ///< memory pool attributes
+  osMessageQueueAttr_t       mq_attr;   ///< message queue attributes
+} osMailQDef_t;
+#endif
+ 
+ 
+/// Event structure contains detailed information about an event.
+typedef struct {
+  osStatus                    status;   ///< status code: event or error information
+  union {
+    uint32_t                       v;   ///< message as 32-bit value
+    void                          *p;   ///< message or mail as void pointer
+    int32_t                  signals;   ///< signal flags
+  } value;                              ///< event value
+  union {
+    osMailQId                mail_id;   ///< mail id obtained by \ref osMailCreate
+    osMessageQId          message_id;   ///< message id obtained by \ref osMessageCreate
+  } def;                                ///< event definition
+} osEvent;
+ 
+ 
+//  ==== Kernel Management Functions ====
+ 
+/// Initialize the RTOS Kernel for creating objects.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osStatus osKernelInitialize (void);
+#endif
+ 
+/// Start the RTOS Kernel scheduler.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osStatus osKernelStart (void);
+#endif
+ 
+/// Check if the RTOS kernel is already started.
+/// \return 0 RTOS is not started, 1 RTOS is started.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+int32_t osKernelRunning(void);
+#endif
+ 
+#if (defined(osFeature_SysTick) && (osFeature_SysTick != 0))  // System Timer available
+ 
+/// Get the RTOS kernel system timer counter.
+/// \return RTOS kernel system timer as 32-bit value 
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+uint32_t osKernelSysTick (void);
+#else
+#define  osKernelSysTick osKernelGetSysTimerCount
+#endif
+ 
+/// The RTOS kernel system timer frequency in Hz.
+/// \note Reflects the system timer setting and is typically defined in a configuration file.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+#define osKernelSysTickFrequency 100000000
+#endif
+ 
+/// Convert a microseconds value to a RTOS kernel system timer value.
+/// \param         microsec     time value in microseconds.
+/// \return time value normalized to the \ref osKernelSysTickFrequency
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+#define osKernelSysTickMicroSec(microsec) (((uint64_t)microsec * (osKernelSysTickFrequency)) / 1000000)
+#else
+#define osKernelSysTickMicroSec(microsec) (((uint64_t)microsec *  osKernelGetSysTimerFreq()) / 1000000)
+#endif
+ 
+#endif  // System Timer available
+ 
+ 
+//  ==== Thread Management Functions ====
+ 
+/// Create a Thread Definition with function, priority, and stack requirements.
+/// \param         name          name of the thread function.
+/// \param         priority      initial priority of the thread function.
+/// \param         instances     number of possible thread instances.
+/// \param         stacksz       stack size (in bytes) requirements for the thread function.
+#if defined (osObjectsExternal)  // object is external
+#define osThreadDef(name, priority, instances, stacksz) \
+extern const osThreadDef_t os_thread_def_##name
+#else                            // define the object
+#define osThreadDef(name, priority, instances, stacksz) \
+static uint64_t os_thread_stack##name[(stacksz)?(((stacksz+7)/8)):1]; \
+static StaticTask_t os_thread_cb_##name; \
+const osThreadDef_t os_thread_def_##name = \
+{ (name), \
+  { NULL, osThreadDetached, \
+    (instances == 1) ? (&os_thread_cb_##name) : NULL,\
+    (instances == 1) ? sizeof(StaticTask_t) : 0U, \
+    ((stacksz) && (instances == 1)) ? (&os_thread_stack##name) : NULL, \
+    8*((stacksz+7)/8), \
+    (priority), 0U, 0U } }
+#endif
+ 
+/// Access a Thread definition.
+/// \param         name          name of the thread definition object.
+#define osThread(name) \
+&os_thread_def_##name
+ 
+/// Create a thread and add it to Active Threads and set it to state READY.
+/// \param[in]     thread_def    thread definition referenced with \ref osThread.
+/// \param[in]     argument      pointer that is passed to the thread function as start argument.
+/// \return thread ID for reference by other functions or NULL in case of error.
+osThreadId osThreadCreate (const osThreadDef_t *thread_def, void *argument);
+ 
+/// Return the thread ID of the current running thread.
+/// \return thread ID for reference by other functions or NULL in case of error.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osThreadId osThreadGetId (void);
+#endif
+ 
+/// Change priority of a thread.
+/// \param[in]     thread_id     thread ID obtained by \ref osThreadCreate or \ref osThreadGetId.
+/// \param[in]     priority      new priority value for the thread function.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osStatus osThreadSetPriority (osThreadId thread_id, osPriority priority);
+#endif
+ 
+/// Get current priority of a thread.
+/// \param[in]     thread_id     thread ID obtained by \ref osThreadCreate or \ref osThreadGetId.
+/// \return current priority value of the specified thread.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osPriority osThreadGetPriority (osThreadId thread_id);
+#endif
+ 
+/// Pass control to next thread that is in state \b READY.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osStatus osThreadYield (void);
+#endif
+ 
+/// Terminate execution of a thread.
+/// \param[in]     thread_id     thread ID obtained by \ref osThreadCreate or \ref osThreadGetId.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osStatus osThreadTerminate (osThreadId thread_id);
+#endif
+ 
+ 
+//  ==== Signal Management ====
+ 
+/// Set the specified Signal Flags of an active thread.
+/// \param[in]     thread_id     thread ID obtained by \ref osThreadCreate or \ref osThreadGetId.
+/// \param[in]     signals       specifies the signal flags of the thread that should be set.
+/// \return previous signal flags of the specified thread or 0x80000000 in case of incorrect parameters.
+int32_t osSignalSet (osThreadId thread_id, int32_t signals);
+ 
+/// Clear the specified Signal Flags of an active thread.
+/// \param[in]     thread_id     thread ID obtained by \ref osThreadCreate or \ref osThreadGetId.
+/// \param[in]     signals       specifies the signal flags of the thread that shall be cleared.
+/// \return previous signal flags of the specified thread or 0x80000000 in case of incorrect parameters or call from ISR.
+int32_t osSignalClear (osThreadId thread_id, int32_t signals);
+ 
+/// Wait for one or more Signal Flags to become signaled for the current \b RUNNING thread.
+/// \param[in]     signals       wait until all specified signal flags set or 0 for any single signal flag.
+/// \param[in]     millisec      \ref CMSIS_RTOS_TimeOutValue or 0 in case of no time-out.
+/// \return event flag information or error code.
+os_InRegs osEvent osSignalWait (int32_t signals, uint32_t millisec);
+ 
+ 
+//  ==== Generic Wait Functions ====
+ 
+/// Wait for Timeout (Time Delay).
+/// \param[in]     millisec      \ref CMSIS_RTOS_TimeOutValue "time delay" value
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osStatus osDelay (uint32_t millisec);
+#endif
+ 
+#if (defined (osFeature_Wait) && (osFeature_Wait != 0))  // Generic Wait available
+ 
+/// Wait for Signal, Message, Mail, or Timeout.
+/// \param[in] millisec          \ref CMSIS_RTOS_TimeOutValue or 0 in case of no time-out
+/// \return event that contains signal, message, or mail information or error code.
+os_InRegs osEvent osWait (uint32_t millisec);
+ 
+#endif  // Generic Wait available
+ 
+ 
+//  ==== Timer Management Functions ====
+ 
+/// Define a Timer object.
+/// \param         name          name of the timer object.
+/// \param         function      name of the timer call back function.
+#if defined (osObjectsExternal)  // object is external
+#define osTimerDef(name, function) \
+extern const osTimerDef_t os_timer_def_##name
+#else                            // define the object
+#define osTimerDef(name, function) \
+static StaticTimer_t os_timer_cb_##name; \
+const osTimerDef_t os_timer_def_##name = \
+{ (function), { NULL, 0U, (&os_timer_cb_##name), sizeof(StaticTimer_t) } }
+#endif
+ 
+/// Access a Timer definition.
+/// \param         name          name of the timer object.
+#define osTimer(name) \
+&os_timer_def_##name
+ 
+/// Create and Initialize a timer.
+/// \param[in]     timer_def     timer object referenced with \ref osTimer.
+/// \param[in]     type          osTimerOnce for one-shot or osTimerPeriodic for periodic behavior.
+/// \param[in]     argument      argument to the timer call back function.
+/// \return timer ID for reference by other functions or NULL in case of error.
+osTimerId osTimerCreate (const osTimerDef_t *timer_def, os_timer_type type, void *argument);
+ 
+/// Start or restart a timer.
+/// \param[in]     timer_id      timer ID obtained by \ref osTimerCreate.
+/// \param[in]     millisec      \ref CMSIS_RTOS_TimeOutValue "time delay" value of the timer.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osStatus osTimerStart (osTimerId timer_id, uint32_t millisec);
+#endif
+ 
+/// Stop a timer.
+/// \param[in]     timer_id      timer ID obtained by \ref osTimerCreate.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osStatus osTimerStop (osTimerId timer_id);
+#endif
+ 
+/// Delete a timer.
+/// \param[in]     timer_id      timer ID obtained by \ref osTimerCreate.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osStatus osTimerDelete (osTimerId timer_id);
+#endif
+ 
+ 
+//  ==== Mutex Management Functions ====
+ 
+/// Define a Mutex.
+/// \param         name          name of the mutex object.
+#if defined (osObjectsExternal)  // object is external
+#define osMutexDef(name) \
+extern const osMutexDef_t os_mutex_def_##name
+#else                            // define the object
+#define osMutexDef(name) \
+static StaticSemaphore_t os_mutex_cb_##name; \
+const osMutexDef_t os_mutex_def_##name = \
+{ NULL, osMutexRecursive | osMutexPrioInherit, (&os_mutex_cb_##name), sizeof(StaticSemaphore_t) }
+#endif
+ 
+/// Access a Mutex definition.
+/// \param         name          name of the mutex object.
+#define osMutex(name) \
+&os_mutex_def_##name
+ 
+/// Create and Initialize a Mutex object.
+/// \param[in]     mutex_def     mutex definition referenced with \ref osMutex.
+/// \return mutex ID for reference by other functions or NULL in case of error.
+osMutexId osMutexCreate (const osMutexDef_t *mutex_def);
+ 
+/// Wait until a Mutex becomes available.
+/// \param[in]     mutex_id      mutex ID obtained by \ref osMutexCreate.
+/// \param[in]     millisec      \ref CMSIS_RTOS_TimeOutValue or 0 in case of no time-out.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osStatus osMutexWait (osMutexId mutex_id, uint32_t millisec);
+#else
+#define  osMutexWait osMutexAcquire
+#endif
+ 
+/// Release a Mutex that was obtained by \ref osMutexWait.
+/// \param[in]     mutex_id      mutex ID obtained by \ref osMutexCreate.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osStatus osMutexRelease (osMutexId mutex_id);
+#endif
+ 
+/// Delete a Mutex object.
+/// \param[in]     mutex_id      mutex ID obtained by \ref osMutexCreate.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osStatus osMutexDelete (osMutexId mutex_id);
+#endif
+ 
+ 
+//  ==== Semaphore Management Functions ====
+ 
+#if (defined (osFeature_Semaphore) && (osFeature_Semaphore != 0U))  // Semaphore available
+ 
+/// Define a Semaphore object.
+/// \param         name          name of the semaphore object.
+#if defined (osObjectsExternal)  // object is external
+#define osSemaphoreDef(name) \
+extern const osSemaphoreDef_t os_semaphore_def_##name
+#else                            // define the object
+#define osSemaphoreDef(name) \
+static StaticSemaphore_t os_semaphore_cb_##name; \
+const osSemaphoreDef_t os_semaphore_def_##name = \
+{ NULL, 0U, (&os_semaphore_cb_##name), sizeof(StaticSemaphore_t) }
+#endif
+ 
+/// Access a Semaphore definition.
+/// \param         name          name of the semaphore object.
+#define osSemaphore(name) \
+&os_semaphore_def_##name
+ 
+/// Create and Initialize a Semaphore object.
+/// \param[in]     semaphore_def semaphore definition referenced with \ref osSemaphore.
+/// \param[in]     count         maximum and initial number of available tokens.
+/// \return semaphore ID for reference by other functions or NULL in case of error.
+osSemaphoreId osSemaphoreCreate (const osSemaphoreDef_t *semaphore_def, int32_t count);
+ 
+/// Wait until a Semaphore token becomes available.
+/// \param[in]     semaphore_id  semaphore object referenced with \ref osSemaphoreCreate.
+/// \param[in]     millisec      \ref CMSIS_RTOS_TimeOutValue or 0 in case of no time-out.
+/// \return number of available tokens, or -1 in case of incorrect parameters.
+int32_t osSemaphoreWait (osSemaphoreId semaphore_id, uint32_t millisec);
+ 
+/// Release a Semaphore token.
+/// \param[in]     semaphore_id  semaphore object referenced with \ref osSemaphoreCreate.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osStatus osSemaphoreRelease (osSemaphoreId semaphore_id);
+#endif
+ 
+/// Delete a Semaphore object.
+/// \param[in]     semaphore_id  semaphore object referenced with \ref osSemaphoreCreate.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+#if (osCMSIS < 0x20000U)
+osStatus osSemaphoreDelete (osSemaphoreId semaphore_id);
+#endif
+ 
+#endif  // Semaphore available
+ 
+ 
+//  ==== Memory Pool Management Functions ====
+
+#if (defined(osFeature_Pool) && (osFeature_Pool != 0))  // Memory Pool available
+ 
+/// \brief Define a Memory Pool.
+/// \param         name          name of the memory pool.
+/// \param         no            maximum number of blocks (objects) in the memory pool.
+/// \param         type          data type of a single block (object).
+#if defined (osObjectsExternal)  // object is external
+#define osPoolDef(name, no, type) \
+extern const osPoolDef_t os_pool_def_##name
+#else                            // define the object
+#define osPoolDef(name, no, type) \
+const osPoolDef_t os_pool_def_##name = \
+{ (no), sizeof(type), {NULL} }
+#endif
+ 
+/// \brief Access a Memory Pool definition.
+/// \param         name          name of the memory pool
+#define osPool(name) \
+&os_pool_def_##name
+ 
+/// Create and Initialize a Memory Pool object.
+/// \param[in]     pool_def      memory pool definition referenced with \ref osPool.
+/// \return memory pool ID for reference by other functions or NULL in case of error.
+osPoolId osPoolCreate (const osPoolDef_t *pool_def);
+ 
+/// Allocate a memory block from a Memory Pool.
+/// \param[in]     pool_id       memory pool ID obtain referenced with \ref osPoolCreate.
+/// \return address of the allocated memory block or NULL in case of no memory available.
+void *osPoolAlloc (osPoolId pool_id);
+ 
+/// Allocate a memory block from a Memory Pool and set memory block to zero.
+/// \param[in]     pool_id       memory pool ID obtain referenced with \ref osPoolCreate.
+/// \return address of the allocated memory block or NULL in case of no memory available.
+void *osPoolCAlloc (osPoolId pool_id);
+ 
+/// Return an allocated memory block back to a Memory Pool.
+/// \param[in]     pool_id       memory pool ID obtain referenced with \ref osPoolCreate.
+/// \param[in]     block         address of the allocated memory block to be returned to the memory pool.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+osStatus osPoolFree (osPoolId pool_id, void *block);
+ 
+#endif  // Memory Pool available
+ 
+ 
+//  ==== Message Queue Management Functions ====
+ 
+#if (defined(osFeature_MessageQ) && (osFeature_MessageQ != 0))  // Message Queue available
+  
+/// \brief Create a Message Queue Definition.
+/// \param         name          name of the queue.
+/// \param         queue_sz      maximum number of messages in the queue.
+/// \param         type          data type of a single message element (for debugger).
+#if defined (osObjectsExternal)  // object is external
+#define osMessageQDef(name, queue_sz, type) \
+extern const osMessageQDef_t os_messageQ_def_##name
+#else                            // define the object
+#define osMessageQDef(name, queue_sz, type) \
+static StaticQueue_t os_mq_cb_##name; \
+static uint32_t os_mq_data_##name[(queue_sz) * sizeof(type)]; \
+const osMessageQDef_t os_messageQ_def_##name = \
+{ (queue_sz), \
+  { NULL, 0U, (&os_mq_cb_##name), sizeof(StaticQueue_t), \
+              (&os_mq_data_##name), sizeof(os_mq_data_##name) } }
+#endif
+ 
+/// \brief Access a Message Queue Definition.
+/// \param         name          name of the queue
+#define osMessageQ(name) \
+&os_messageQ_def_##name
+ 
+/// Create and Initialize a Message Queue object.
+/// \param[in]     queue_def     message queue definition referenced with \ref osMessageQ.
+/// \param[in]     thread_id     thread ID (obtained by \ref osThreadCreate or \ref osThreadGetId) or NULL.
+/// \return message queue ID for reference by other functions or NULL in case of error.
+osMessageQId osMessageCreate (const osMessageQDef_t *queue_def, osThreadId thread_id);
+ 
+/// Put a Message to a Queue.
+/// \param[in]     queue_id      message queue ID obtained with \ref osMessageCreate.
+/// \param[in]     info          message information.
+/// \param[in]     millisec      \ref CMSIS_RTOS_TimeOutValue or 0 in case of no time-out.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+osStatus osMessagePut (osMessageQId queue_id, uint32_t info, uint32_t millisec);
+ 
+/// Get a Message from a Queue or timeout if Queue is empty.
+/// \param[in]     queue_id      message queue ID obtained with \ref osMessageCreate.
+/// \param[in]     millisec      \ref CMSIS_RTOS_TimeOutValue or 0 in case of no time-out.
+/// \return event information that includes status code.
+os_InRegs osEvent osMessageGet (osMessageQId queue_id, uint32_t millisec);
+ 
+#endif  // Message Queue available
+ 
+ 
+//  ==== Mail Queue Management Functions ====
+ 
+#if (defined(osFeature_MailQ) && (osFeature_MailQ != 0))  // Mail Queue available
+ 
+/// \brief Create a Mail Queue Definition.
+/// \param         name          name of the queue.
+/// \param         queue_sz      maximum number of mails in the queue.
+/// \param         type          data type of a single mail element.
+#if defined (osObjectsExternal)  // object is external
+#define osMailQDef(name, queue_sz, type) \
+extern const osMailQDef_t os_mailQ_def_##name
+#else                            // define the object
+#define osMailQDef(name, queue_sz, type) \
+const osMailQDef_t os_mailQ_def_##name = \
+{ (queue_sz), sizeof(type), NULL }
+#endif
+ 
+/// \brief Access a Mail Queue Definition.
+/// \param         name          name of the queue
+#define osMailQ(name) \
+&os_mailQ_def_##name
+ 
+/// Create and Initialize a Mail Queue object.
+/// \param[in]     queue_def     mail queue definition referenced with \ref osMailQ.
+/// \param[in]     thread_id     thread ID (obtained by \ref osThreadCreate or \ref osThreadGetId) or NULL.
+/// \return mail queue ID for reference by other functions or NULL in case of error.
+osMailQId osMailCreate (const osMailQDef_t *queue_def, osThreadId thread_id);
+ 
+/// Allocate a memory block for mail from a mail memory pool.
+/// \param[in]     queue_id      mail queue ID obtained with \ref osMailCreate.
+/// \param[in]     millisec      \ref CMSIS_RTOS_TimeOutValue or 0 in case of no time-out
+/// \return pointer to memory block that can be filled with mail or NULL in case of error.
+void *osMailAlloc (osMailQId queue_id, uint32_t millisec);
+ 
+/// Allocate a memory block for mail from a mail memory pool and set memory block to zero.
+/// \param[in]     queue_id      mail queue ID obtained with \ref osMailCreate.
+/// \param[in]     millisec      \ref CMSIS_RTOS_TimeOutValue or 0 in case of no time-out
+/// \return pointer to memory block that can be filled with mail or NULL in case of error.
+void *osMailCAlloc (osMailQId queue_id, uint32_t millisec);
+ 
+/// Put a Mail into a Queue.
+/// \param[in]     queue_id      mail queue ID obtained with \ref osMailCreate.
+/// \param[in]     mail          pointer to memory with mail to put into a queue.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+osStatus osMailPut (osMailQId queue_id, const void *mail);
+ 
+/// Get a Mail from a Queue or timeout if Queue is empty.
+/// \param[in]     queue_id      mail queue ID obtained with \ref osMailCreate.
+/// \param[in]     millisec      \ref CMSIS_RTOS_TimeOutValue or 0 in case of no time-out.
+/// \return event information that includes status code.
+os_InRegs osEvent osMailGet (osMailQId queue_id, uint32_t millisec);
+ 
+/// Free a memory block by returning it to a mail memory pool.
+/// \param[in]     queue_id      mail queue ID obtained with \ref osMailCreate.
+/// \param[in]     mail          pointer to memory block that was obtained with \ref osMailGet.
+/// \return status code that indicates the execution status of the function.
+osStatus osMailFree (osMailQId queue_id, void *mail);
+ 
+#endif  // Mail Queue available
+ 
+ 
+#ifdef  __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+ 
+#endif  // CMSIS_OS_H_
Index: ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/CMSIS_RTOS_V2/cmsis_os2.c
===================================================================
--- ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/CMSIS_RTOS_V2/cmsis_os2.c	(revision 73)
+++ ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/CMSIS_RTOS_V2/cmsis_os2.c	(revision 73)
@@ -0,0 +1,2482 @@
+/* --------------------------------------------------------------------------
+ * Copyright (c) 2013-2020 Arm Limited. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
+ *
+ * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the License); you may
+ * not use this file except in compliance with the License.
+ * You may obtain a copy of the License at
+ *
+ * www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0
+ *
+ * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software
+ * distributed under the License is distributed on an AS IS BASIS, WITHOUT
+ * WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied.
+ * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and
+ * limitations under the License.
+ *
+ *      Name:    cmsis_os2.c
+ *      Purpose: CMSIS RTOS2 wrapper for FreeRTOS
+ *
+ *---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "cmsis_os2.h"                  // ::CMSIS:RTOS2
+#include "cmsis_compiler.h"             // Compiler agnostic definitions
+
+#include "FreeRTOS.h"                   // ARM.FreeRTOS::RTOS:Core
+#include "task.h"                       // ARM.FreeRTOS::RTOS:Core
+#include "event_groups.h"               // ARM.FreeRTOS::RTOS:Event Groups
+#include "semphr.h"                     // ARM.FreeRTOS::RTOS:Core
+
+#include "freertos_mpool.h"             // osMemoryPool definitions
+#include "freertos_os2.h"               // Configuration check and setup
+
+/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+#ifndef __ARM_ARCH_6M__
+  #define __ARM_ARCH_6M__         0
+#endif
+#ifndef __ARM_ARCH_7M__
+  #define __ARM_ARCH_7M__         0
+#endif
+#ifndef __ARM_ARCH_7EM__
+  #define __ARM_ARCH_7EM__        0
+#endif
+#ifndef __ARM_ARCH_8M_MAIN__
+  #define __ARM_ARCH_8M_MAIN__    0
+#endif
+#ifndef __ARM_ARCH_7A__
+  #define __ARM_ARCH_7A__         0
+#endif
+
+#if   ((__ARM_ARCH_7M__      == 1U) || \
+       (__ARM_ARCH_7EM__     == 1U) || \
+       (__ARM_ARCH_8M_MAIN__ == 1U))
+#define IS_IRQ_MASKED()           ((__get_PRIMASK() != 0U) || (__get_BASEPRI() != 0U))
+#elif  (__ARM_ARCH_6M__      == 1U)
+#define IS_IRQ_MASKED()           (__get_PRIMASK() != 0U)
+#elif (__ARM_ARCH_7A__       == 1U)
+/* CPSR mask bits */
+#define CPSR_MASKBIT_I            0x80U
+
+#define IS_IRQ_MASKED()           ((__get_CPSR() & CPSR_MASKBIT_I) != 0U)
+#else
+#define IS_IRQ_MASKED()           (__get_PRIMASK() != 0U)
+#endif
+
+#if    (__ARM_ARCH_7A__      == 1U)
+/* CPSR mode bitmasks */
+#define CPSR_MODE_USER            0x10U
+#define CPSR_MODE_SYSTEM          0x1FU
+
+#define IS_IRQ_MODE()             ((__get_mode() != CPSR_MODE_USER) && (__get_mode() != CPSR_MODE_SYSTEM))
+#else
+#define IS_IRQ_MODE()             (__get_IPSR() != 0U)
+#endif
+
+#define IS_IRQ()                  IS_IRQ_MODE()
+
+#define SVCall_IRQ_NBR            (IRQn_Type) -5	/* SVCall_IRQ_NBR added as SV_Call handler name is not the same for CM0 and for all other CMx */
+
+/* Limits */
+#define MAX_BITS_TASK_NOTIFY      31U
+#define MAX_BITS_EVENT_GROUPS     24U
+
+#define THREAD_FLAGS_INVALID_BITS (~((1UL << MAX_BITS_TASK_NOTIFY)  - 1U))
+#define EVENT_FLAGS_INVALID_BITS  (~((1UL << MAX_BITS_EVENT_GROUPS) - 1U))
+
+/* Kernel version and identification string definition (major.minor.rev: mmnnnrrrr dec) */
+#define KERNEL_VERSION            (((uint32_t)tskKERNEL_VERSION_MAJOR * 10000000UL) | \
+                                   ((uint32_t)tskKERNEL_VERSION_MINOR *    10000UL) | \
+                                   ((uint32_t)tskKERNEL_VERSION_BUILD *        1UL))
+
+#define KERNEL_ID                 ("FreeRTOS " tskKERNEL_VERSION_NUMBER)
+
+/* Timer callback information structure definition */
+typedef struct {
+  osTimerFunc_t func;
+  void         *arg;
+} TimerCallback_t;
+
+/* Kernel initialization state */
+static osKernelState_t KernelState = osKernelInactive;
+
+/*
+  Heap region definition used by heap_5 variant
+
+  Define configAPPLICATION_ALLOCATED_HEAP as nonzero value in FreeRTOSConfig.h if
+  heap regions are already defined and vPortDefineHeapRegions is called in application.
+
+  Otherwise vPortDefineHeapRegions will be called by osKernelInitialize using
+  definition configHEAP_5_REGIONS as parameter. Overriding configHEAP_5_REGIONS
+  is possible by defining it globally or in FreeRTOSConfig.h.
+*/
+#if defined(USE_FreeRTOS_HEAP_5)
+#if (configAPPLICATION_ALLOCATED_HEAP == 0)
+  /*
+    FreeRTOS heap is not defined by the application.
+    Single region of size configTOTAL_HEAP_SIZE (defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h)
+    is provided by default. Define configHEAP_5_REGIONS to provide custom
+    HeapRegion_t array.
+  */
+  #define HEAP_5_REGION_SETUP   1
+  
+  #ifndef configHEAP_5_REGIONS
+    #define configHEAP_5_REGIONS xHeapRegions
+
+    static uint8_t ucHeap[configTOTAL_HEAP_SIZE];
+
+    static HeapRegion_t xHeapRegions[] = {
+      { ucHeap, configTOTAL_HEAP_SIZE },
+      { NULL,   0                     }
+    };
+  #else
+    /* Global definition is provided to override default heap array */
+    extern HeapRegion_t configHEAP_5_REGIONS[];
+  #endif
+#else
+  /*
+    The application already defined the array used for the FreeRTOS heap and
+    called vPortDefineHeapRegions to initialize heap.
+  */
+  #define HEAP_5_REGION_SETUP   0
+#endif /* configAPPLICATION_ALLOCATED_HEAP */
+#endif /* USE_FreeRTOS_HEAP_5 */
+
+#if defined(SysTick)
+#undef SysTick_Handler
+
+/* CMSIS SysTick interrupt handler prototype */
+extern void SysTick_Handler     (void);
+/* FreeRTOS tick timer interrupt handler prototype */
+extern void xPortSysTickHandler (void);
+
+/*
+  SysTick handler implementation that also clears overflow flag.
+*/
+#if (USE_CUSTOM_SYSTICK_HANDLER_IMPLEMENTATION == 0)
+void SysTick_Handler (void) {
+  /* Clear overflow flag */
+  SysTick->CTRL;
+
+  if (xTaskGetSchedulerState() != taskSCHEDULER_NOT_STARTED) {
+    /* Call tick handler */
+    xPortSysTickHandler();
+  }
+}
+#endif
+#endif /* SysTick */
+
+/*
+  Setup SVC to reset value.
+*/
+__STATIC_INLINE void SVC_Setup (void) {
+#if (__ARM_ARCH_7A__ == 0U)
+  /* Service Call interrupt might be configured before kernel start     */
+  /* and when its priority is lower or equal to BASEPRI, svc intruction */
+  /* causes a Hard Fault.                                               */
+  NVIC_SetPriority (SVCall_IRQ_NBR, 0U);
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+  Function macro used to retrieve semaphore count from ISR
+*/
+#ifndef uxSemaphoreGetCountFromISR
+#define uxSemaphoreGetCountFromISR( xSemaphore ) uxQueueMessagesWaitingFromISR( ( QueueHandle_t ) ( xSemaphore ) )
+#endif
+
+/* Get OS Tick count value */
+static uint32_t OS_Tick_GetCount (void);
+/* Get OS Tick overflow status */
+static uint32_t OS_Tick_GetOverflow (void);
+/* Get OS Tick interval */
+static uint32_t OS_Tick_GetInterval (void);
+/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+osStatus_t osKernelInitialize (void) {
+  osStatus_t stat;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else {
+    if (KernelState == osKernelInactive) {
+      #if defined(USE_TRACE_EVENT_RECORDER)
+        EvrFreeRTOSSetup(0U);
+      #endif
+      #if defined(USE_FreeRTOS_HEAP_5) && (HEAP_5_REGION_SETUP == 1)
+        vPortDefineHeapRegions (configHEAP_5_REGIONS);
+      #endif
+      KernelState = osKernelReady;
+      stat = osOK;
+    } else {
+      stat = osError;
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osKernelGetInfo (osVersion_t *version, char *id_buf, uint32_t id_size) {
+
+  if (version != NULL) {
+    /* Version encoding is major.minor.rev: mmnnnrrrr dec */
+    version->api    = KERNEL_VERSION;
+    version->kernel = KERNEL_VERSION;
+  }
+
+  if ((id_buf != NULL) && (id_size != 0U)) {
+    if (id_size > sizeof(KERNEL_ID)) {
+      id_size = sizeof(KERNEL_ID);
+    }
+    memcpy(id_buf, KERNEL_ID, id_size);
+  }
+
+  return (osOK);
+}
+
+osKernelState_t osKernelGetState (void) {
+  osKernelState_t state;
+
+  switch (xTaskGetSchedulerState()) {
+    case taskSCHEDULER_RUNNING:
+      state = osKernelRunning;
+      break;
+
+    case taskSCHEDULER_SUSPENDED:
+      state = osKernelLocked;
+      break;
+
+    case taskSCHEDULER_NOT_STARTED:
+    default:
+      if (KernelState == osKernelReady) {
+        state = osKernelReady;
+      } else {
+        state = osKernelInactive;
+      }
+      break;
+  }
+
+  return (state);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osKernelStart (void) {
+  osStatus_t stat;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else {
+    if (KernelState == osKernelReady) {
+      /* Ensure SVC priority is at the reset value */
+      SVC_Setup();
+      /* Change state to enable IRQ masking check */
+      KernelState = osKernelRunning;
+      /* Start the kernel scheduler */
+      vTaskStartScheduler();
+      stat = osOK;
+    } else {
+      stat = osError;
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+int32_t osKernelLock (void) {
+  int32_t lock;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    lock = (int32_t)osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else {
+    switch (xTaskGetSchedulerState()) {
+      case taskSCHEDULER_SUSPENDED:
+        lock = 1;
+        break;
+
+      case taskSCHEDULER_RUNNING:
+        vTaskSuspendAll();
+        lock = 0;
+        break;
+
+      case taskSCHEDULER_NOT_STARTED:
+      default:
+        lock = (int32_t)osError;
+        break;
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (lock);
+}
+
+int32_t osKernelUnlock (void) {
+  int32_t lock;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    lock = (int32_t)osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else {
+    switch (xTaskGetSchedulerState()) {
+      case taskSCHEDULER_SUSPENDED:
+        lock = 1;
+
+        if (xTaskResumeAll() != pdTRUE) {
+          if (xTaskGetSchedulerState() == taskSCHEDULER_SUSPENDED) {
+            lock = (int32_t)osError;
+          }
+        }
+        break;
+
+      case taskSCHEDULER_RUNNING:
+        lock = 0;
+        break;
+
+      case taskSCHEDULER_NOT_STARTED:
+      default:
+        lock = (int32_t)osError;
+        break;
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (lock);
+}
+
+int32_t osKernelRestoreLock (int32_t lock) {
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    lock = (int32_t)osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else {
+    switch (xTaskGetSchedulerState()) {
+      case taskSCHEDULER_SUSPENDED:
+      case taskSCHEDULER_RUNNING:
+        if (lock == 1) {
+          vTaskSuspendAll();
+        }
+        else {
+          if (lock != 0) {
+            lock = (int32_t)osError;
+          }
+          else {
+            if (xTaskResumeAll() != pdTRUE) {
+              if (xTaskGetSchedulerState() != taskSCHEDULER_RUNNING) {
+                lock = (int32_t)osError;
+              }
+            }
+          }
+        }
+        break;
+
+      case taskSCHEDULER_NOT_STARTED:
+      default:
+        lock = (int32_t)osError;
+        break;
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (lock);
+}
+
+uint32_t osKernelGetTickCount (void) {
+  TickType_t ticks;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    ticks = xTaskGetTickCountFromISR();
+  } else {
+    ticks = xTaskGetTickCount();
+  }
+
+  return (ticks);
+}
+
+uint32_t osKernelGetTickFreq (void) {
+  return (configTICK_RATE_HZ);
+}
+
+/* Get OS Tick count value */
+static uint32_t OS_Tick_GetCount (void) {
+  uint32_t load = SysTick->LOAD;
+  return  (load - SysTick->VAL);
+}
+
+/* Get OS Tick overflow status */
+static uint32_t OS_Tick_GetOverflow (void) {
+  return ((SysTick->CTRL >> 16) & 1U);
+}
+
+/* Get OS Tick interval */
+static uint32_t OS_Tick_GetInterval (void) {
+  return (SysTick->LOAD + 1U);
+}
+
+uint32_t osKernelGetSysTimerCount (void) {
+  uint32_t irqmask = IS_IRQ_MASKED();
+  TickType_t ticks;
+  uint32_t val;
+
+  __disable_irq();
+
+  ticks = xTaskGetTickCount();
+  val   = OS_Tick_GetCount();
+
+  if (OS_Tick_GetOverflow() != 0U) {
+    val = OS_Tick_GetCount();
+    ticks++;
+  }
+  val += ticks * OS_Tick_GetInterval();
+
+  if (irqmask == 0U) {
+    __enable_irq();
+  }
+
+  return (val);
+}
+
+uint32_t osKernelGetSysTimerFreq (void) {
+  return (configCPU_CLOCK_HZ);
+}
+
+/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+osThreadId_t osThreadNew (osThreadFunc_t func, void *argument, const osThreadAttr_t *attr) {
+  const char *name;
+  uint32_t stack;
+  TaskHandle_t hTask;
+  UBaseType_t prio;
+  int32_t mem;
+
+  hTask = NULL;
+
+  if (!IS_IRQ() && (func != NULL)) {
+    stack = configMINIMAL_STACK_SIZE;
+    prio  = (UBaseType_t)osPriorityNormal;
+
+    name = NULL;
+    mem  = -1;
+
+    if (attr != NULL) {
+      if (attr->name != NULL) {
+        name = attr->name;
+      }
+      if (attr->priority != osPriorityNone) {
+        prio = (UBaseType_t)attr->priority;
+      }
+
+      if ((prio < osPriorityIdle) || (prio > osPriorityISR) || ((attr->attr_bits & osThreadJoinable) == osThreadJoinable)) {
+        return (NULL);
+      }
+
+      if (attr->stack_size > 0U) {
+        /* In FreeRTOS stack is not in bytes, but in sizeof(StackType_t) which is 4 on ARM ports.       */
+        /* Stack size should be therefore 4 byte aligned in order to avoid division caused side effects */
+        stack = attr->stack_size / sizeof(StackType_t);
+      }
+
+      if ((attr->cb_mem    != NULL) && (attr->cb_size    >= sizeof(StaticTask_t)) &&
+          (attr->stack_mem != NULL) && (attr->stack_size >  0U)) {
+        mem = 1;
+      }
+      else {
+        if ((attr->cb_mem == NULL) && (attr->cb_size == 0U) && (attr->stack_mem == NULL)) {
+          mem = 0;
+        }
+      }
+    }
+    else {
+      mem = 0;
+    }
+
+    if (mem == 1) {
+      #if (configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+        hTask = xTaskCreateStatic ((TaskFunction_t)func, name, stack, argument, prio, (StackType_t  *)attr->stack_mem,
+                                                                                      (StaticTask_t *)attr->cb_mem);
+      #endif
+    }
+    else {
+      if (mem == 0) {
+        #if (configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+          if (xTaskCreate ((TaskFunction_t)func, name, (uint16_t)stack, argument, prio, &hTask) != pdPASS) {
+            hTask = NULL;
+          }
+        #endif
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  return ((osThreadId_t)hTask);
+}
+
+const char *osThreadGetName (osThreadId_t thread_id) {
+  TaskHandle_t hTask = (TaskHandle_t)thread_id;
+  const char *name;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ() || (hTask == NULL)) {
+    name = NULL;
+  } else {
+    name = pcTaskGetName (hTask);
+  }
+
+  return (name);
+}
+
+osThreadId_t osThreadGetId (void) {
+  osThreadId_t id;
+
+  id = (osThreadId_t)xTaskGetCurrentTaskHandle();
+
+  return (id);
+}
+
+osThreadState_t osThreadGetState (osThreadId_t thread_id) {
+  TaskHandle_t hTask = (TaskHandle_t)thread_id;
+  osThreadState_t state;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ() || (hTask == NULL)) {
+    state = osThreadError;
+  }
+  else {
+    switch (eTaskGetState (hTask)) {
+      case eRunning:   state = osThreadRunning;    break;
+      case eReady:     state = osThreadReady;      break;
+      case eBlocked:
+      case eSuspended: state = osThreadBlocked;    break;
+      case eDeleted:   state = osThreadTerminated; break;
+      case eInvalid:
+      default:         state = osThreadError;      break;
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (state);
+}
+
+uint32_t osThreadGetStackSpace (osThreadId_t thread_id) {
+  TaskHandle_t hTask = (TaskHandle_t)thread_id;
+  uint32_t sz;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ() || (hTask == NULL)) {
+    sz = 0U;
+  } else {
+    sz = (uint32_t)(uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark(hTask) * sizeof(StackType_t));
+  }
+
+  return (sz);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osThreadSetPriority (osThreadId_t thread_id, osPriority_t priority) {
+  TaskHandle_t hTask = (TaskHandle_t)thread_id;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if ((hTask == NULL) || (priority < osPriorityIdle) || (priority > osPriorityISR)) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    stat = osOK;
+    vTaskPrioritySet (hTask, (UBaseType_t)priority);
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+osPriority_t osThreadGetPriority (osThreadId_t thread_id) {
+  TaskHandle_t hTask = (TaskHandle_t)thread_id;
+  osPriority_t prio;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ() || (hTask == NULL)) {
+    prio = osPriorityError;
+  } else {
+    prio = (osPriority_t)((int32_t)uxTaskPriorityGet (hTask));
+  }
+
+  return (prio);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osThreadYield (void) {
+  osStatus_t stat;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  } else {
+    stat = osOK;
+    taskYIELD();
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+#if (configUSE_OS2_THREAD_SUSPEND_RESUME == 1)
+osStatus_t osThreadSuspend (osThreadId_t thread_id) {
+  TaskHandle_t hTask = (TaskHandle_t)thread_id;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if (hTask == NULL) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    stat = osOK;
+    vTaskSuspend (hTask);
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osThreadResume (osThreadId_t thread_id) {
+  TaskHandle_t hTask = (TaskHandle_t)thread_id;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if (hTask == NULL) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    stat = osOK;
+    vTaskResume (hTask);
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+#endif /* (configUSE_OS2_THREAD_SUSPEND_RESUME == 1) */
+
+__NO_RETURN void osThreadExit (void) {
+#ifndef USE_FreeRTOS_HEAP_1
+  vTaskDelete (NULL);
+#endif
+  for (;;);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osThreadTerminate (osThreadId_t thread_id) {
+  TaskHandle_t hTask = (TaskHandle_t)thread_id;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+#ifndef USE_FreeRTOS_HEAP_1
+  eTaskState tstate;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if (hTask == NULL) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    tstate = eTaskGetState (hTask);
+
+    if (tstate != eDeleted) {
+      stat = osOK;
+      vTaskDelete (hTask);
+    } else {
+      stat = osErrorResource;
+    }
+  }
+#else
+  stat = osError;
+#endif
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+uint32_t osThreadGetCount (void) {
+  uint32_t count;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    count = 0U;
+  } else {
+    count = uxTaskGetNumberOfTasks();
+  }
+
+  return (count);
+}
+
+#if (configUSE_OS2_THREAD_ENUMERATE == 1)
+uint32_t osThreadEnumerate (osThreadId_t *thread_array, uint32_t array_items) {
+  uint32_t i, count;
+  TaskStatus_t *task;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ() || (thread_array == NULL) || (array_items == 0U)) {
+    count = 0U;
+  } else {
+    vTaskSuspendAll();
+
+    count = uxTaskGetNumberOfTasks();
+    task  = pvPortMalloc (count * sizeof(TaskStatus_t));
+
+    if (task != NULL) {
+      count = uxTaskGetSystemState (task, count, NULL);
+
+      for (i = 0U; (i < count) && (i < array_items); i++) {
+        thread_array[i] = (osThreadId_t)task[i].xHandle;
+      }
+      count = i;
+    }
+    (void)xTaskResumeAll();
+
+    vPortFree (task);
+  }
+
+  return (count);
+}
+#endif /* (configUSE_OS2_THREAD_ENUMERATE == 1) */
+
+#if (configUSE_OS2_THREAD_FLAGS == 1)
+uint32_t osThreadFlagsSet (osThreadId_t thread_id, uint32_t flags) {
+  TaskHandle_t hTask = (TaskHandle_t)thread_id;
+  uint32_t rflags;
+  BaseType_t yield;
+
+  if ((hTask == NULL) || ((flags & THREAD_FLAGS_INVALID_BITS) != 0U)) {
+    rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    rflags = (uint32_t)osError;
+
+    if (IS_IRQ()) {
+      yield = pdFALSE;
+
+      (void)xTaskNotifyFromISR (hTask, flags, eSetBits, &yield);
+      (void)xTaskNotifyAndQueryFromISR (hTask, 0, eNoAction, &rflags, NULL);
+
+      portYIELD_FROM_ISR (yield);
+    }
+    else {
+      (void)xTaskNotify (hTask, flags, eSetBits);
+      (void)xTaskNotifyAndQuery (hTask, 0, eNoAction, &rflags);
+    }
+  }
+  /* Return flags after setting */
+  return (rflags);
+}
+
+uint32_t osThreadFlagsClear (uint32_t flags) {
+  TaskHandle_t hTask;
+  uint32_t rflags, cflags;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if ((flags & THREAD_FLAGS_INVALID_BITS) != 0U) {
+    rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    hTask = xTaskGetCurrentTaskHandle();
+
+    if (xTaskNotifyAndQuery (hTask, 0, eNoAction, &cflags) == pdPASS) {
+      rflags = cflags;
+      cflags &= ~flags;
+
+      if (xTaskNotify (hTask, cflags, eSetValueWithOverwrite) != pdPASS) {
+        rflags = (uint32_t)osError;
+      }
+    }
+    else {
+      rflags = (uint32_t)osError;
+    }
+  }
+
+  /* Return flags before clearing */
+  return (rflags);
+}
+
+uint32_t osThreadFlagsGet (void) {
+  TaskHandle_t hTask;
+  uint32_t rflags;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else {
+    hTask = xTaskGetCurrentTaskHandle();
+
+    if (xTaskNotifyAndQuery (hTask, 0, eNoAction, &rflags) != pdPASS) {
+      rflags = (uint32_t)osError;
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (rflags);
+}
+
+uint32_t osThreadFlagsWait (uint32_t flags, uint32_t options, uint32_t timeout) {
+  uint32_t rflags, nval;
+  uint32_t clear;
+  TickType_t t0, td, tout;
+  BaseType_t rval;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if ((flags & THREAD_FLAGS_INVALID_BITS) != 0U) {
+    rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    if ((options & osFlagsNoClear) == osFlagsNoClear) {
+      clear = 0U;
+    } else {
+      clear = flags;
+    }
+
+    rflags = 0U;
+    tout   = timeout;
+
+    t0 = xTaskGetTickCount();
+    do {
+      rval = xTaskNotifyWait (0, clear, &nval, tout);
+
+      if (rval == pdPASS) {
+        rflags &= flags;
+        rflags |= nval;
+
+        if ((options & osFlagsWaitAll) == osFlagsWaitAll) {
+          if ((flags & rflags) == flags) {
+            break;
+          } else {
+            if (timeout == 0U) {
+              rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorResource;
+              break;
+            }
+          }
+        }
+        else {
+          if ((flags & rflags) != 0) {
+            break;
+          } else {
+            if (timeout == 0U) {
+              rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorResource;
+              break;
+            }
+          }
+        }
+
+        /* Update timeout */
+        td = xTaskGetTickCount() - t0;
+
+        if (td > tout) {
+          tout  = 0;
+        } else {
+          tout -= td;
+        }
+      }
+      else {
+        if (timeout == 0) {
+          rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorResource;
+        } else {
+          rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorTimeout;
+        }
+      }
+    }
+    while (rval != pdFAIL);
+  }
+
+  /* Return flags before clearing */
+  return (rflags);
+}
+#endif /* (configUSE_OS2_THREAD_FLAGS == 1) */
+
+osStatus_t osDelay (uint32_t ticks) {
+  osStatus_t stat;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else {
+    stat = osOK;
+
+    if (ticks != 0U) {
+      vTaskDelay(ticks);
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osDelayUntil (uint32_t ticks) {
+  TickType_t tcnt, delay;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else {
+    stat = osOK;
+    tcnt = xTaskGetTickCount();
+
+    /* Determine remaining number of ticks to delay */
+    delay = (TickType_t)ticks - tcnt;
+
+    /* Check if target tick has not expired */
+    if((delay != 0U) && (0 == (delay >> (8 * sizeof(TickType_t) - 1)))) {
+      vTaskDelayUntil (&tcnt, delay);
+    }
+    else
+    {
+      /* No delay or already expired */
+      stat = osErrorParameter;
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+#if (configUSE_OS2_TIMER == 1)
+
+static void TimerCallback (TimerHandle_t hTimer) {
+  TimerCallback_t *callb;
+
+  callb = (TimerCallback_t *)pvTimerGetTimerID (hTimer);
+
+  if (callb != NULL) {
+    callb->func (callb->arg);
+  }
+}
+
+osTimerId_t osTimerNew (osTimerFunc_t func, osTimerType_t type, void *argument, const osTimerAttr_t *attr) {
+  const char *name;
+  TimerHandle_t hTimer;
+  TimerCallback_t *callb;
+  UBaseType_t reload;
+  int32_t mem;
+
+  hTimer = NULL;
+
+  if (!IS_IRQ() && (func != NULL)) {
+    /* Allocate memory to store callback function and argument */
+    callb = pvPortMalloc (sizeof(TimerCallback_t));
+
+    if (callb != NULL) {
+      callb->func = func;
+      callb->arg  = argument;
+
+      if (type == osTimerOnce) {
+        reload = pdFALSE;
+      } else {
+        reload = pdTRUE;
+      }
+
+      mem  = -1;
+      name = NULL;
+
+      if (attr != NULL) {
+        if (attr->name != NULL) {
+          name = attr->name;
+        }
+
+        if ((attr->cb_mem != NULL) && (attr->cb_size >= sizeof(StaticTimer_t))) {
+          mem = 1;
+        }
+        else {
+          if ((attr->cb_mem == NULL) && (attr->cb_size == 0U)) {
+            mem = 0;
+          }
+        }
+      }
+      else {
+        mem = 0;
+      }
+
+      if (mem == 1) {
+        #if (configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+          hTimer = xTimerCreateStatic (name, 1, reload, callb, TimerCallback, (StaticTimer_t *)attr->cb_mem);
+        #endif
+      }
+      else {
+        if (mem == 0) {
+          #if (configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+            hTimer = xTimerCreate (name, 1, reload, callb, TimerCallback);
+          #endif
+        }
+      }
+
+      if ((hTimer == NULL) && (callb != NULL)) {
+        vPortFree (callb);
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  return ((osTimerId_t)hTimer);
+}
+
+const char *osTimerGetName (osTimerId_t timer_id) {
+  TimerHandle_t hTimer = (TimerHandle_t)timer_id;
+  const char *p;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ() || (hTimer == NULL)) {
+    p = NULL;
+  } else {
+    p = pcTimerGetName (hTimer);
+  }
+
+  return (p);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osTimerStart (osTimerId_t timer_id, uint32_t ticks) {
+  TimerHandle_t hTimer = (TimerHandle_t)timer_id;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if (hTimer == NULL) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    if (xTimerChangePeriod (hTimer, ticks, 0) == pdPASS) {
+      stat = osOK;
+    } else {
+      stat = osErrorResource;
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osTimerStop (osTimerId_t timer_id) {
+  TimerHandle_t hTimer = (TimerHandle_t)timer_id;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if (hTimer == NULL) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    if (xTimerIsTimerActive (hTimer) == pdFALSE) {
+      stat = osErrorResource;
+    }
+    else {
+      if (xTimerStop (hTimer, 0) == pdPASS) {
+        stat = osOK;
+      } else {
+        stat = osError;
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+uint32_t osTimerIsRunning (osTimerId_t timer_id) {
+  TimerHandle_t hTimer = (TimerHandle_t)timer_id;
+  uint32_t running;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ() || (hTimer == NULL)) {
+    running = 0U;
+  } else {
+    running = (uint32_t)xTimerIsTimerActive (hTimer);
+  }
+
+  return (running);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osTimerDelete (osTimerId_t timer_id) {
+  TimerHandle_t hTimer = (TimerHandle_t)timer_id;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+#ifndef USE_FreeRTOS_HEAP_1
+  TimerCallback_t *callb;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if (hTimer == NULL) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    callb = (TimerCallback_t *)pvTimerGetTimerID (hTimer);
+
+    if (xTimerDelete (hTimer, 0) == pdPASS) {
+      vPortFree (callb);
+      stat = osOK;
+    } else {
+      stat = osErrorResource;
+    }
+  }
+#else
+  stat = osError;
+#endif
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+#endif /* (configUSE_OS2_TIMER == 1) */
+
+/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+osEventFlagsId_t osEventFlagsNew (const osEventFlagsAttr_t *attr) {
+  EventGroupHandle_t hEventGroup;
+  int32_t mem;
+
+  hEventGroup = NULL;
+
+  if (!IS_IRQ()) {
+    mem = -1;
+
+    if (attr != NULL) {
+      if ((attr->cb_mem != NULL) && (attr->cb_size >= sizeof(StaticEventGroup_t))) {
+        mem = 1;
+      }
+      else {
+        if ((attr->cb_mem == NULL) && (attr->cb_size == 0U)) {
+          mem = 0;
+        }
+      }
+    }
+    else {
+      mem = 0;
+    }
+
+    if (mem == 1) {
+      #if (configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+      hEventGroup = xEventGroupCreateStatic (attr->cb_mem);
+      #endif
+    }
+    else {
+      if (mem == 0) {
+        #if (configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+          hEventGroup = xEventGroupCreate();
+        #endif
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  return ((osEventFlagsId_t)hEventGroup);
+}
+
+uint32_t osEventFlagsSet (osEventFlagsId_t ef_id, uint32_t flags) {
+  EventGroupHandle_t hEventGroup = (EventGroupHandle_t)ef_id;
+  uint32_t rflags;
+  BaseType_t yield;
+
+  if ((hEventGroup == NULL) || ((flags & EVENT_FLAGS_INVALID_BITS) != 0U)) {
+    rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else if (IS_IRQ()) {
+  #if (configUSE_OS2_EVENTFLAGS_FROM_ISR == 0)
+    (void)yield;
+    /* Enable timers and xTimerPendFunctionCall function to support osEventFlagsSet from ISR */
+    rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorResource;
+  #else
+    yield = pdFALSE;
+
+    if (xEventGroupSetBitsFromISR (hEventGroup, (EventBits_t)flags, &yield) == pdFAIL) {
+      rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorResource;
+    } else {
+      rflags = flags;
+      portYIELD_FROM_ISR (yield);
+    }
+  #endif
+  }
+  else {
+    rflags = xEventGroupSetBits (hEventGroup, (EventBits_t)flags);
+  }
+
+  return (rflags);
+}
+
+uint32_t osEventFlagsClear (osEventFlagsId_t ef_id, uint32_t flags) {
+  EventGroupHandle_t hEventGroup = (EventGroupHandle_t)ef_id;
+  uint32_t rflags;
+
+  if ((hEventGroup == NULL) || ((flags & EVENT_FLAGS_INVALID_BITS) != 0U)) {
+    rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else if (IS_IRQ()) {
+  #if (configUSE_OS2_EVENTFLAGS_FROM_ISR == 0)
+    /* Enable timers and xTimerPendFunctionCall function to support osEventFlagsSet from ISR */
+    rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorResource;
+  #else
+    rflags = xEventGroupGetBitsFromISR (hEventGroup);
+
+    if (xEventGroupClearBitsFromISR (hEventGroup, (EventBits_t)flags) == pdFAIL) {
+      rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorResource;
+    }
+  #endif
+  }
+  else {
+    rflags = xEventGroupClearBits (hEventGroup, (EventBits_t)flags);
+  }
+
+  return (rflags);
+}
+
+uint32_t osEventFlagsGet (osEventFlagsId_t ef_id) {
+  EventGroupHandle_t hEventGroup = (EventGroupHandle_t)ef_id;
+  uint32_t rflags;
+
+  if (ef_id == NULL) {
+    rflags = 0U;
+  }
+  else if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    rflags = xEventGroupGetBitsFromISR (hEventGroup);
+  }
+  else {
+    rflags = xEventGroupGetBits (hEventGroup);
+  }
+
+  return (rflags);
+}
+
+uint32_t osEventFlagsWait (osEventFlagsId_t ef_id, uint32_t flags, uint32_t options, uint32_t timeout) {
+  EventGroupHandle_t hEventGroup = (EventGroupHandle_t)ef_id;
+  BaseType_t wait_all;
+  BaseType_t exit_clr;
+  uint32_t rflags;
+
+  if ((hEventGroup == NULL) || ((flags & EVENT_FLAGS_INVALID_BITS) != 0U)) {
+    rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else {
+    if (options & osFlagsWaitAll) {
+      wait_all = pdTRUE;
+    } else {
+      wait_all = pdFAIL;
+    }
+
+    if (options & osFlagsNoClear) {
+      exit_clr = pdFAIL;
+    } else {
+      exit_clr = pdTRUE;
+    }
+
+    rflags = xEventGroupWaitBits (hEventGroup, (EventBits_t)flags, exit_clr, wait_all, (TickType_t)timeout);
+
+    if (options & osFlagsWaitAll) {
+      if ((flags & rflags) != flags) {
+        if (timeout > 0U) {
+          rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorTimeout;
+        } else {
+          rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorResource;
+        }
+      }
+    }
+    else {
+      if ((flags & rflags) == 0U) {
+        if (timeout > 0U) {
+          rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorTimeout;
+        } else {
+          rflags = (uint32_t)osErrorResource;
+        }
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (rflags);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osEventFlagsDelete (osEventFlagsId_t ef_id) {
+  EventGroupHandle_t hEventGroup = (EventGroupHandle_t)ef_id;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+
+#ifndef USE_FreeRTOS_HEAP_1
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if (hEventGroup == NULL) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    stat = osOK;
+    vEventGroupDelete (hEventGroup);
+  }
+#else
+  stat = osError;
+#endif
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+#if (configUSE_OS2_MUTEX == 1)
+
+osMutexId_t osMutexNew (const osMutexAttr_t *attr) {
+  SemaphoreHandle_t hMutex;
+  uint32_t type;
+  uint32_t rmtx;
+  int32_t  mem;
+  #if (configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE > 0)
+  const char *name;
+  #endif
+
+  hMutex = NULL;
+
+  if (!IS_IRQ()) {
+    if (attr != NULL) {
+      type = attr->attr_bits;
+    } else {
+      type = 0U;
+    }
+
+    if ((type & osMutexRecursive) == osMutexRecursive) {
+      rmtx = 1U;
+    } else {
+      rmtx = 0U;
+    }
+
+    if ((type & osMutexRobust) != osMutexRobust) {
+      mem = -1;
+
+      if (attr != NULL) {
+        if ((attr->cb_mem != NULL) && (attr->cb_size >= sizeof(StaticSemaphore_t))) {
+          mem = 1;
+        }
+        else {
+          if ((attr->cb_mem == NULL) && (attr->cb_size == 0U)) {
+            mem = 0;
+          }
+        }
+      }
+      else {
+        mem = 0;
+      }
+
+      if (mem == 1) {
+        #if (configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+          if (rmtx != 0U) {
+            #if (configUSE_RECURSIVE_MUTEXES == 1)
+            hMutex = xSemaphoreCreateRecursiveMutexStatic (attr->cb_mem);
+            #endif
+          }
+          else {
+            hMutex = xSemaphoreCreateMutexStatic (attr->cb_mem);
+          }
+        #endif
+      }
+      else {
+        if (mem == 0) {
+          #if (configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+            if (rmtx != 0U) {
+              #if (configUSE_RECURSIVE_MUTEXES == 1)
+              hMutex = xSemaphoreCreateRecursiveMutex ();
+              #endif
+            } else {
+              hMutex = xSemaphoreCreateMutex ();
+            }
+          #endif
+        }
+      }
+
+      #if (configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE > 0)
+      if (hMutex != NULL) {
+        if (attr != NULL) {
+          name = attr->name;
+        } else {
+          name = NULL;
+        }
+        vQueueAddToRegistry (hMutex, name);
+      }
+      #endif
+
+      if ((hMutex != NULL) && (rmtx != 0U)) {
+        hMutex = (SemaphoreHandle_t)((uint32_t)hMutex | 1U);
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  return ((osMutexId_t)hMutex);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osMutexAcquire (osMutexId_t mutex_id, uint32_t timeout) {
+  SemaphoreHandle_t hMutex;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+  uint32_t rmtx;
+
+  hMutex = (SemaphoreHandle_t)((uint32_t)mutex_id & ~1U);
+
+  rmtx = (uint32_t)mutex_id & 1U;
+
+  stat = osOK;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if (hMutex == NULL) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    if (rmtx != 0U) {
+      #if (configUSE_RECURSIVE_MUTEXES == 1)
+      if (xSemaphoreTakeRecursive (hMutex, timeout) != pdPASS) {
+        if (timeout != 0U) {
+          stat = osErrorTimeout;
+        } else {
+          stat = osErrorResource;
+        }
+      }
+      #endif
+    }
+    else {
+      if (xSemaphoreTake (hMutex, timeout) != pdPASS) {
+        if (timeout != 0U) {
+          stat = osErrorTimeout;
+        } else {
+          stat = osErrorResource;
+        }
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osMutexRelease (osMutexId_t mutex_id) {
+  SemaphoreHandle_t hMutex;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+  uint32_t rmtx;
+
+  hMutex = (SemaphoreHandle_t)((uint32_t)mutex_id & ~1U);
+
+  rmtx = (uint32_t)mutex_id & 1U;
+
+  stat = osOK;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if (hMutex == NULL) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    if (rmtx != 0U) {
+      #if (configUSE_RECURSIVE_MUTEXES == 1)
+      if (xSemaphoreGiveRecursive (hMutex) != pdPASS) {
+        stat = osErrorResource;
+      }
+      #endif
+    }
+    else {
+      if (xSemaphoreGive (hMutex) != pdPASS) {
+        stat = osErrorResource;
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+osThreadId_t osMutexGetOwner (osMutexId_t mutex_id) {
+  SemaphoreHandle_t hMutex;
+  osThreadId_t owner;
+
+  hMutex = (SemaphoreHandle_t)((uint32_t)mutex_id & ~1U);
+
+  if (IS_IRQ() || (hMutex == NULL)) {
+    owner = NULL;
+  } else {
+    owner = (osThreadId_t)xSemaphoreGetMutexHolder (hMutex);
+  }
+
+  return (owner);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osMutexDelete (osMutexId_t mutex_id) {
+  osStatus_t stat;
+#ifndef USE_FreeRTOS_HEAP_1
+  SemaphoreHandle_t hMutex;
+
+  hMutex = (SemaphoreHandle_t)((uint32_t)mutex_id & ~1U);
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if (hMutex == NULL) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    #if (configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE > 0)
+    vQueueUnregisterQueue (hMutex);
+    #endif
+    stat = osOK;
+    vSemaphoreDelete (hMutex);
+  }
+#else
+  stat = osError;
+#endif
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+#endif /* (configUSE_OS2_MUTEX == 1) */
+
+/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+osSemaphoreId_t osSemaphoreNew (uint32_t max_count, uint32_t initial_count, const osSemaphoreAttr_t *attr) {
+  SemaphoreHandle_t hSemaphore;
+  int32_t mem;
+  #if (configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE > 0)
+  const char *name;
+  #endif
+
+  hSemaphore = NULL;
+
+  if (!IS_IRQ() && (max_count > 0U) && (initial_count <= max_count)) {
+    mem = -1;
+
+    if (attr != NULL) {
+      if ((attr->cb_mem != NULL) && (attr->cb_size >= sizeof(StaticSemaphore_t))) {
+        mem = 1;
+      }
+      else {
+        if ((attr->cb_mem == NULL) && (attr->cb_size == 0U)) {
+          mem = 0;
+        }
+      }
+    }
+    else {
+      mem = 0;
+    }
+
+    if (mem != -1) {
+      if (max_count == 1U) {
+        if (mem == 1) {
+          #if (configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+            hSemaphore = xSemaphoreCreateBinaryStatic ((StaticSemaphore_t *)attr->cb_mem);
+          #endif
+        }
+        else {
+          #if (configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+            hSemaphore = xSemaphoreCreateBinary();
+          #endif
+        }
+
+        if ((hSemaphore != NULL) && (initial_count != 0U)) {
+          if (xSemaphoreGive (hSemaphore) != pdPASS) {
+            vSemaphoreDelete (hSemaphore);
+            hSemaphore = NULL;
+          }
+        }
+      }
+      else {
+        if (mem == 1) {
+          #if (configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+            hSemaphore = xSemaphoreCreateCountingStatic (max_count, initial_count, (StaticSemaphore_t *)attr->cb_mem);
+          #endif
+        }
+        else {
+          #if (configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+            hSemaphore = xSemaphoreCreateCounting (max_count, initial_count);
+          #endif
+        }
+      }
+      
+      #if (configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE > 0)
+      if (hSemaphore != NULL) {
+        if (attr != NULL) {
+          name = attr->name;
+        } else {
+          name = NULL;
+        }
+        vQueueAddToRegistry (hSemaphore, name);
+      }
+      #endif
+    }
+  }
+
+  return ((osSemaphoreId_t)hSemaphore);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osSemaphoreAcquire (osSemaphoreId_t semaphore_id, uint32_t timeout) {
+  SemaphoreHandle_t hSemaphore = (SemaphoreHandle_t)semaphore_id;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+  BaseType_t yield;
+
+  stat = osOK;
+
+  if (hSemaphore == NULL) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    if (timeout != 0U) {
+      stat = osErrorParameter;
+    }
+    else {
+      yield = pdFALSE;
+
+      if (xSemaphoreTakeFromISR (hSemaphore, &yield) != pdPASS) {
+        stat = osErrorResource;
+      } else {
+        portYIELD_FROM_ISR (yield);
+      }
+    }
+  }
+  else {
+    if (xSemaphoreTake (hSemaphore, (TickType_t)timeout) != pdPASS) {
+      if (timeout != 0U) {
+        stat = osErrorTimeout;
+      } else {
+        stat = osErrorResource;
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osSemaphoreRelease (osSemaphoreId_t semaphore_id) {
+  SemaphoreHandle_t hSemaphore = (SemaphoreHandle_t)semaphore_id;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+  BaseType_t yield;
+
+  stat = osOK;
+
+  if (hSemaphore == NULL) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    yield = pdFALSE;
+
+    if (xSemaphoreGiveFromISR (hSemaphore, &yield) != pdTRUE) {
+      stat = osErrorResource;
+    } else {
+      portYIELD_FROM_ISR (yield);
+    }
+  }
+  else {
+    if (xSemaphoreGive (hSemaphore) != pdPASS) {
+      stat = osErrorResource;
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+uint32_t osSemaphoreGetCount (osSemaphoreId_t semaphore_id) {
+  SemaphoreHandle_t hSemaphore = (SemaphoreHandle_t)semaphore_id;
+  uint32_t count;
+
+  if (hSemaphore == NULL) {
+    count = 0U;
+  }
+  else if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    count = uxQueueMessagesWaitingFromISR (hSemaphore);
+  } else {
+    count = (uint32_t)uxSemaphoreGetCount (hSemaphore);
+  }
+
+  return (count);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osSemaphoreDelete (osSemaphoreId_t semaphore_id) {
+  SemaphoreHandle_t hSemaphore = (SemaphoreHandle_t)semaphore_id;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+
+#ifndef USE_FreeRTOS_HEAP_1
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if (hSemaphore == NULL) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    #if (configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE > 0)
+    vQueueUnregisterQueue (hSemaphore);
+    #endif
+
+    stat = osOK;
+    vSemaphoreDelete (hSemaphore);
+  }
+#else
+  stat = osError;
+#endif
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+osMessageQueueId_t osMessageQueueNew (uint32_t msg_count, uint32_t msg_size, const osMessageQueueAttr_t *attr) {
+  QueueHandle_t hQueue;
+  int32_t mem;
+  #if (configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE > 0)
+  const char *name;
+  #endif
+
+  hQueue = NULL;
+
+  if (!IS_IRQ() && (msg_count > 0U) && (msg_size > 0U)) {
+    mem = -1;
+
+    if (attr != NULL) {
+      if ((attr->cb_mem != NULL) && (attr->cb_size >= sizeof(StaticQueue_t)) &&
+          (attr->mq_mem != NULL) && (attr->mq_size >= (msg_count * msg_size))) {
+        mem = 1;
+      }
+      else {
+        if ((attr->cb_mem == NULL) && (attr->cb_size == 0U) &&
+            (attr->mq_mem == NULL) && (attr->mq_size == 0U)) {
+          mem = 0;
+        }
+      }
+    }
+    else {
+      mem = 0;
+    }
+
+    if (mem == 1) {
+      #if (configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+        hQueue = xQueueCreateStatic (msg_count, msg_size, attr->mq_mem, attr->cb_mem);
+      #endif
+    }
+    else {
+      if (mem == 0) {
+        #if (configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+          hQueue = xQueueCreate (msg_count, msg_size);
+        #endif
+      }
+    }
+
+    #if (configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE > 0)
+    if (hQueue != NULL) {
+      if (attr != NULL) {
+        name = attr->name;
+      } else {
+        name = NULL;
+      }
+      vQueueAddToRegistry (hQueue, name);
+    }
+    #endif
+
+  }
+
+  return ((osMessageQueueId_t)hQueue);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osMessageQueuePut (osMessageQueueId_t mq_id, const void *msg_ptr, uint8_t msg_prio, uint32_t timeout) {
+  QueueHandle_t hQueue = (QueueHandle_t)mq_id;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+  BaseType_t yield;
+
+  (void)msg_prio; /* Message priority is ignored */
+
+  stat = osOK;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    if ((hQueue == NULL) || (msg_ptr == NULL) || (timeout != 0U)) {
+      stat = osErrorParameter;
+    }
+    else {
+      yield = pdFALSE;
+
+      if (xQueueSendToBackFromISR (hQueue, msg_ptr, &yield) != pdTRUE) {
+        stat = osErrorResource;
+      } else {
+        portYIELD_FROM_ISR (yield);
+      }
+    }
+  }
+  else {
+    if ((hQueue == NULL) || (msg_ptr == NULL)) {
+      stat = osErrorParameter;
+    }
+    else {
+      if (xQueueSendToBack (hQueue, msg_ptr, (TickType_t)timeout) != pdPASS) {
+        if (timeout != 0U) {
+          stat = osErrorTimeout;
+        } else {
+          stat = osErrorResource;
+        }
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osMessageQueueGet (osMessageQueueId_t mq_id, void *msg_ptr, uint8_t *msg_prio, uint32_t timeout) {
+  QueueHandle_t hQueue = (QueueHandle_t)mq_id;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+  BaseType_t yield;
+
+  (void)msg_prio; /* Message priority is ignored */
+
+  stat = osOK;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    if ((hQueue == NULL) || (msg_ptr == NULL) || (timeout != 0U)) {
+      stat = osErrorParameter;
+    }
+    else {
+      yield = pdFALSE;
+
+      if (xQueueReceiveFromISR (hQueue, msg_ptr, &yield) != pdPASS) {
+        stat = osErrorResource;
+      } else {
+        portYIELD_FROM_ISR (yield);
+      }
+    }
+  }
+  else {
+    if ((hQueue == NULL) || (msg_ptr == NULL)) {
+      stat = osErrorParameter;
+    }
+    else {
+      if (xQueueReceive (hQueue, msg_ptr, (TickType_t)timeout) != pdPASS) {
+        if (timeout != 0U) {
+          stat = osErrorTimeout;
+        } else {
+          stat = osErrorResource;
+        }
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+uint32_t osMessageQueueGetCapacity (osMessageQueueId_t mq_id) {
+  StaticQueue_t *mq = (StaticQueue_t *)mq_id;
+  uint32_t capacity;
+
+  if (mq == NULL) {
+    capacity = 0U;
+  } else {
+    /* capacity = pxQueue->uxLength */
+    capacity = mq->uxDummy4[1];
+  }
+
+  return (capacity);
+}
+
+uint32_t osMessageQueueGetMsgSize (osMessageQueueId_t mq_id) {
+  StaticQueue_t *mq = (StaticQueue_t *)mq_id;
+  uint32_t size;
+
+  if (mq == NULL) {
+    size = 0U;
+  } else {
+    /* size = pxQueue->uxItemSize */
+    size = mq->uxDummy4[2];
+  }
+
+  return (size);
+}
+
+uint32_t osMessageQueueGetCount (osMessageQueueId_t mq_id) {
+  QueueHandle_t hQueue = (QueueHandle_t)mq_id;
+  UBaseType_t count;
+
+  if (hQueue == NULL) {
+    count = 0U;
+  }
+  else if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    count = uxQueueMessagesWaitingFromISR (hQueue);
+  }
+  else {
+    count = uxQueueMessagesWaiting (hQueue);
+  }
+
+  return ((uint32_t)count);
+}
+
+uint32_t osMessageQueueGetSpace (osMessageQueueId_t mq_id) {
+  StaticQueue_t *mq = (StaticQueue_t *)mq_id;
+  uint32_t space;
+  uint32_t isrm;
+
+  if (mq == NULL) {
+    space = 0U;
+  }
+  else if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    isrm = taskENTER_CRITICAL_FROM_ISR();
+
+    /* space = pxQueue->uxLength - pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting; */
+    space = mq->uxDummy4[1] - mq->uxDummy4[0];
+
+    taskEXIT_CRITICAL_FROM_ISR(isrm);
+  }
+  else {
+    space = (uint32_t)uxQueueSpacesAvailable ((QueueHandle_t)mq);
+  }
+
+  return (space);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osMessageQueueReset (osMessageQueueId_t mq_id) {
+  QueueHandle_t hQueue = (QueueHandle_t)mq_id;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if (hQueue == NULL) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    stat = osOK;
+    (void)xQueueReset (hQueue);
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osMessageQueueDelete (osMessageQueueId_t mq_id) {
+  QueueHandle_t hQueue = (QueueHandle_t)mq_id;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+
+#ifndef USE_FreeRTOS_HEAP_1
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else if (hQueue == NULL) {
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    #if (configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE > 0)
+    vQueueUnregisterQueue (hQueue);
+    #endif
+
+    stat = osOK;
+    vQueueDelete (hQueue);
+  }
+#else
+  stat = osError;
+#endif
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+#ifdef FREERTOS_MPOOL_H_
+
+/* Static memory pool functions */
+static void  FreeBlock   (MemPool_t *mp, void *block);
+static void *AllocBlock  (MemPool_t *mp);
+static void *CreateBlock (MemPool_t *mp);
+
+osMemoryPoolId_t osMemoryPoolNew (uint32_t block_count, uint32_t block_size, const osMemoryPoolAttr_t *attr) {
+  MemPool_t *mp;
+  const char *name;
+  int32_t mem_cb, mem_mp;
+  uint32_t sz;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    mp = NULL;
+  }
+  else if ((block_count == 0U) || (block_size == 0U)) {
+    mp = NULL;
+  }
+  else {
+    mp = NULL;
+    sz = MEMPOOL_ARR_SIZE (block_count, block_size);
+
+    name = NULL;
+    mem_cb = -1;
+    mem_mp = -1;
+
+    if (attr != NULL) {
+      if (attr->name != NULL) {
+        name = attr->name;
+      }
+
+      if ((attr->cb_mem != NULL) && (attr->cb_size >= sizeof(MemPool_t))) {
+        /* Static control block is provided */
+        mem_cb = 1;
+      }
+      else if ((attr->cb_mem == NULL) && (attr->cb_size == 0U)) {
+        /* Allocate control block memory on heap */
+        mem_cb = 0;
+      }
+
+      if ((attr->mp_mem == NULL) && (attr->mp_size == 0U)) {
+        /* Allocate memory array on heap */
+          mem_mp = 0;
+      }
+      else {
+        if (attr->mp_mem != NULL) {
+          /* Check if array is 4-byte aligned */
+          if (((uint32_t)attr->mp_mem & 3U) == 0U) {
+            /* Check if array big enough */
+            if (attr->mp_size >= sz) {
+              /* Static memory pool array is provided */
+              mem_mp = 1;
+            }
+          }
+        }
+      }
+    }
+    else {
+      /* Attributes not provided, allocate memory on heap */
+      mem_cb = 0;
+      mem_mp = 0;
+    }
+
+    if (mem_cb == 0) {
+      mp = pvPortMalloc (sizeof(MemPool_t));
+    } else {
+      mp = attr->cb_mem;
+    }
+
+    if (mp != NULL) {
+      /* Create a semaphore (max count == initial count == block_count) */
+      #if (configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+        mp->sem = xSemaphoreCreateCountingStatic (block_count, block_count, &mp->mem_sem);
+      #elif (configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+        mp->sem = xSemaphoreCreateCounting (block_count, block_count);
+      #else
+        mp->sem == NULL;
+      #endif
+
+      if (mp->sem != NULL) {
+        /* Setup memory array */
+        if (mem_mp == 0) {
+          mp->mem_arr = pvPortMalloc (sz);
+        } else {
+          mp->mem_arr = attr->mp_mem;
+        }
+      }
+    }
+
+    if ((mp != NULL) && (mp->mem_arr != NULL)) {
+      /* Memory pool can be created */
+      mp->head    = NULL;
+      mp->mem_sz  = sz;
+      mp->name    = name;
+      mp->bl_sz   = block_size;
+      mp->bl_cnt  = block_count;
+      mp->n       = 0U;
+
+      /* Set heap allocated memory flags */
+      mp->status = MPOOL_STATUS;
+
+      if (mem_cb == 0) {
+        /* Control block on heap */
+        mp->status |= 1U;
+      }
+      if (mem_mp == 0) {
+        /* Memory array on heap */
+        mp->status |= 2U;
+      }
+    }
+    else {
+      /* Memory pool cannot be created, release allocated resources */
+      if ((mem_cb == 0) && (mp != NULL)) {
+        /* Free control block memory */
+        vPortFree (mp);
+      }
+      mp = NULL;
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (mp);
+}
+
+const char *osMemoryPoolGetName (osMemoryPoolId_t mp_id) {
+  MemPool_t *mp = (osMemoryPoolId_t)mp_id;
+  const char *p;
+
+  if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    p = NULL;
+  }
+  else if (mp_id == NULL) {
+    p = NULL;
+  }
+  else {
+    p = mp->name;
+  }
+
+  return (p);
+}
+
+void *osMemoryPoolAlloc (osMemoryPoolId_t mp_id, uint32_t timeout) {
+  MemPool_t *mp;
+  void *block;
+  uint32_t isrm;
+
+  if (mp_id == NULL) {
+    /* Invalid input parameters */
+    block = NULL;
+  }
+  else {
+    block = NULL;
+
+    mp = (MemPool_t *)mp_id;
+
+    if ((mp->status & MPOOL_STATUS) == MPOOL_STATUS) {
+      if (IS_IRQ()) {
+        if (timeout == 0U) {
+          if (xSemaphoreTakeFromISR (mp->sem, NULL) == pdTRUE) {
+            if ((mp->status & MPOOL_STATUS) == MPOOL_STATUS) {
+              isrm  = taskENTER_CRITICAL_FROM_ISR();
+
+              /* Get a block from the free-list */
+              block = AllocBlock(mp);
+
+              if (block == NULL) {
+                /* List of free blocks is empty, 'create' new block */
+                block = CreateBlock(mp);
+              }
+
+              taskEXIT_CRITICAL_FROM_ISR(isrm);
+            }
+          }
+        }
+      }
+      else {
+        if (xSemaphoreTake (mp->sem, (TickType_t)timeout) == pdTRUE) {
+          if ((mp->status & MPOOL_STATUS) == MPOOL_STATUS) {
+            taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+
+            /* Get a block from the free-list */
+            block = AllocBlock(mp);
+
+            if (block == NULL) {
+              /* List of free blocks is empty, 'create' new block */
+              block = CreateBlock(mp);
+            }
+
+            taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+          }
+        }
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (block);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osMemoryPoolFree (osMemoryPoolId_t mp_id, void *block) {
+  MemPool_t *mp;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+  uint32_t isrm;
+  BaseType_t yield;
+
+  if ((mp_id == NULL) || (block == NULL)) {
+    /* Invalid input parameters */
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else {
+    mp = (MemPool_t *)mp_id;
+
+    if ((mp->status & MPOOL_STATUS) != MPOOL_STATUS) {
+      /* Invalid object status */
+      stat = osErrorResource;
+    }
+    else if ((block < (void *)&mp->mem_arr[0]) || (block > (void*)&mp->mem_arr[mp->mem_sz-1])) {
+      /* Block pointer outside of memory array area */
+      stat = osErrorParameter;
+    }
+    else {
+      stat = osOK;
+
+      if (IS_IRQ()) {
+        if (uxSemaphoreGetCountFromISR (mp->sem) == mp->bl_cnt) {
+          stat = osErrorResource;
+        }
+        else {
+          isrm = taskENTER_CRITICAL_FROM_ISR();
+
+          /* Add block to the list of free blocks */
+          FreeBlock(mp, block);
+
+          taskEXIT_CRITICAL_FROM_ISR(isrm);
+
+          yield = pdFALSE;
+          xSemaphoreGiveFromISR (mp->sem, &yield);
+          portYIELD_FROM_ISR (yield);
+        }
+      }
+      else {
+        if (uxSemaphoreGetCount (mp->sem) == mp->bl_cnt) {
+          stat = osErrorResource;
+        }
+        else {
+          taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+
+          /* Add block to the list of free blocks */
+          FreeBlock(mp, block);
+
+          taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+          xSemaphoreGive (mp->sem);
+        }
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+uint32_t osMemoryPoolGetCapacity (osMemoryPoolId_t mp_id) {
+  MemPool_t *mp;
+  uint32_t  n;
+
+  if (mp_id == NULL) {
+    /* Invalid input parameters */
+    n = 0U;
+  }
+  else {
+    mp = (MemPool_t *)mp_id;
+
+    if ((mp->status & MPOOL_STATUS) != MPOOL_STATUS) {
+      /* Invalid object status */
+      n = 0U;
+    }
+    else {
+      n = mp->bl_cnt;
+    }
+  }
+
+  /* Return maximum number of memory blocks */
+  return (n);
+}
+
+uint32_t osMemoryPoolGetBlockSize (osMemoryPoolId_t mp_id) {
+  MemPool_t *mp;
+  uint32_t  sz;
+
+  if (mp_id == NULL) {
+    /* Invalid input parameters */
+    sz = 0U;
+  }
+  else {
+    mp = (MemPool_t *)mp_id;
+
+    if ((mp->status & MPOOL_STATUS) != MPOOL_STATUS) {
+      /* Invalid object status */
+      sz = 0U;
+    }
+    else {
+      sz = mp->bl_sz;
+    }
+  }
+
+  /* Return memory block size in bytes */
+  return (sz);
+}
+
+uint32_t osMemoryPoolGetCount (osMemoryPoolId_t mp_id) {
+  MemPool_t *mp;
+  uint32_t  n;
+
+  if (mp_id == NULL) {
+    /* Invalid input parameters */
+    n = 0U;
+  }
+  else {
+    mp = (MemPool_t *)mp_id;
+
+    if ((mp->status & MPOOL_STATUS) != MPOOL_STATUS) {
+      /* Invalid object status */
+      n = 0U;
+    }
+    else {
+      if (IS_IRQ()) {
+        n = uxSemaphoreGetCountFromISR (mp->sem);
+      } else {
+        n = uxSemaphoreGetCount        (mp->sem);
+      }
+
+      n = mp->bl_cnt - n;
+    }
+  }
+
+  /* Return number of memory blocks used */
+  return (n);
+}
+
+uint32_t osMemoryPoolGetSpace (osMemoryPoolId_t mp_id) {
+  MemPool_t *mp;
+  uint32_t  n;
+
+  if (mp_id == NULL) {
+    /* Invalid input parameters */
+    n = 0U;
+  }
+  else {
+    mp = (MemPool_t *)mp_id;
+
+    if ((mp->status & MPOOL_STATUS) != MPOOL_STATUS) {
+      /* Invalid object status */
+      n = 0U;
+    }
+    else {
+      if (IS_IRQ()) {
+        n = uxSemaphoreGetCountFromISR (mp->sem);
+      } else {
+        n = uxSemaphoreGetCount        (mp->sem);
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  /* Return number of memory blocks available */
+  return (n);
+}
+
+osStatus_t osMemoryPoolDelete (osMemoryPoolId_t mp_id) {
+  MemPool_t *mp;
+  osStatus_t stat;
+
+  if (mp_id == NULL) {
+    /* Invalid input parameters */
+    stat = osErrorParameter;
+  }
+  else if (IS_IRQ()) {
+    stat = osErrorISR;
+  }
+  else {
+    mp = (MemPool_t *)mp_id;
+
+    taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+
+    /* Invalidate control block status */
+    mp->status  = mp->status & 3U;
+
+    /* Wake-up tasks waiting for pool semaphore */
+    while (xSemaphoreGive (mp->sem) == pdTRUE);
+
+    mp->head    = NULL;
+    mp->bl_sz   = 0U;
+    mp->bl_cnt  = 0U;
+
+    if ((mp->status & 2U) != 0U) {
+      /* Memory pool array allocated on heap */
+      vPortFree (mp->mem_arr);
+    }
+    if ((mp->status & 1U) != 0U) {
+      /* Memory pool control block allocated on heap */
+      vPortFree (mp);
+    }
+
+    taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+    stat = osOK;
+  }
+
+  return (stat);
+}
+
+/*
+  Create new block given according to the current block index.
+*/
+static void *CreateBlock (MemPool_t *mp) {
+  MemPoolBlock_t *p = NULL;
+
+  if (mp->n < mp->bl_cnt) {
+    /* Unallocated blocks exist, set pointer to new block */
+    p = (void *)(mp->mem_arr + (mp->bl_sz * mp->n));
+
+    /* Increment block index */
+    mp->n += 1U;
+  }
+
+  return (p);
+}
+
+/*
+  Allocate a block by reading the list of free blocks.
+*/
+static void *AllocBlock (MemPool_t *mp) {
+  MemPoolBlock_t *p = NULL;
+
+  if (mp->head != NULL) {
+    /* List of free block exists, get head block */
+    p = mp->head;
+
+    /* Head block is now next on the list */
+    mp->head = p->next;
+  }
+
+  return (p);
+}
+
+/*
+  Free block by putting it to the list of free blocks.
+*/
+static void FreeBlock (MemPool_t *mp, void *block) {
+  MemPoolBlock_t *p = block;
+
+  /* Store current head into block memory space */
+  p->next = mp->head;
+
+  /* Store current block as new head */
+  mp->head = p;
+}
+#endif /* FREERTOS_MPOOL_H_ */
+/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* Callback function prototypes */
+extern void vApplicationIdleHook (void);
+extern void vApplicationTickHook (void);
+extern void vApplicationMallocFailedHook (void);
+extern void vApplicationDaemonTaskStartupHook (void);
+extern void vApplicationStackOverflowHook (TaskHandle_t xTask, signed char *pcTaskName);
+
+/**
+  Dummy implementation of the callback function vApplicationIdleHook().
+*/
+#if (configUSE_IDLE_HOOK == 1)
+__WEAK void vApplicationIdleHook (void){}
+#endif
+
+/**
+  Dummy implementation of the callback function vApplicationTickHook().
+*/
+#if (configUSE_TICK_HOOK == 1)
+ __WEAK void vApplicationTickHook (void){}
+#endif
+
+/**
+  Dummy implementation of the callback function vApplicationMallocFailedHook().
+*/
+#if (configUSE_MALLOC_FAILED_HOOK == 1)
+__WEAK void vApplicationMallocFailedHook (void){}
+#endif
+
+/**
+  Dummy implementation of the callback function vApplicationDaemonTaskStartupHook().
+*/
+#if (configUSE_DAEMON_TASK_STARTUP_HOOK == 1)
+__WEAK void vApplicationDaemonTaskStartupHook (void){}
+#endif
+
+/**
+  Dummy implementation of the callback function vApplicationStackOverflowHook().
+*/
+#if (configCHECK_FOR_STACK_OVERFLOW > 0)
+__WEAK void vApplicationStackOverflowHook (TaskHandle_t xTask, signed char *pcTaskName) {
+  (void)xTask;
+  (void)pcTaskName;
+  configASSERT(0);
+}
+#endif
+
+/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+#if (configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1)
+/* External Idle and Timer task static memory allocation functions */
+extern void vApplicationGetIdleTaskMemory  (StaticTask_t **ppxIdleTaskTCBBuffer,  StackType_t **ppxIdleTaskStackBuffer,  uint32_t *pulIdleTaskStackSize);
+extern void vApplicationGetTimerTaskMemory (StaticTask_t **ppxTimerTaskTCBBuffer, StackType_t **ppxTimerTaskStackBuffer, uint32_t *pulTimerTaskStackSize);
+
+/*
+  vApplicationGetIdleTaskMemory gets called when configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION
+  equals to 1 and is required for static memory allocation support.
+*/
+__WEAK void vApplicationGetIdleTaskMemory (StaticTask_t **ppxIdleTaskTCBBuffer, StackType_t **ppxIdleTaskStackBuffer, uint32_t *pulIdleTaskStackSize) {
+  /* Idle task control block and stack */
+  static StaticTask_t Idle_TCB;
+  static StackType_t  Idle_Stack[configMINIMAL_STACK_SIZE];
+
+  *ppxIdleTaskTCBBuffer   = &Idle_TCB;
+  *ppxIdleTaskStackBuffer = &Idle_Stack[0];
+  *pulIdleTaskStackSize   = (uint32_t)configMINIMAL_STACK_SIZE;
+}
+
+/*
+  vApplicationGetTimerTaskMemory gets called when configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION
+  equals to 1 and is required for static memory allocation support.
+*/
+__WEAK void vApplicationGetTimerTaskMemory (StaticTask_t **ppxTimerTaskTCBBuffer, StackType_t **ppxTimerTaskStackBuffer, uint32_t *pulTimerTaskStackSize) {
+  /* Timer task control block and stack */
+  static StaticTask_t Timer_TCB;
+  static StackType_t  Timer_Stack[configTIMER_TASK_STACK_DEPTH];
+
+  *ppxTimerTaskTCBBuffer   = &Timer_TCB;
+  *ppxTimerTaskStackBuffer = &Timer_Stack[0];
+  *pulTimerTaskStackSize   = (uint32_t)configTIMER_TASK_STACK_DEPTH;
+}
+#endif
Index: ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/include/FreeRTOS.h
===================================================================
--- ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/include/FreeRTOS.h	(revision 73)
+++ ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/include/FreeRTOS.h	(revision 73)
@@ -0,0 +1,1295 @@
+/*
+ * FreeRTOS Kernel V10.3.1
+ * Copyright (C) 2020 Amazon.com, Inc. or its affiliates.  All Rights Reserved.
+ *
+ * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of
+ * this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in
+ * the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to
+ * use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of
+ * the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so,
+ * subject to the following conditions:
+ *
+ * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all
+ * copies or substantial portions of the Software.
+ *
+ * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
+ * IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS
+ * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR
+ * COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
+ * IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
+ * CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
+ *
+ * http://www.FreeRTOS.org
+ * http://aws.amazon.com/freertos
+ *
+ * 1 tab == 4 spaces!
+ */
+
+#ifndef INC_FREERTOS_H
+#define INC_FREERTOS_H
+
+/*
+ * Include the generic headers required for the FreeRTOS port being used.
+ */
+#include <stddef.h>
+
+/*
+ * If stdint.h cannot be located then:
+ *   + If using GCC ensure the -nostdint options is *not* being used.
+ *   + Ensure the project's include path includes the directory in which your
+ *     compiler stores stdint.h.
+ *   + Set any compiler options necessary for it to support C99, as technically
+ *     stdint.h is only mandatory with C99 (FreeRTOS does not require C99 in any
+ *     other way).
+ *   + The FreeRTOS download includes a simple stdint.h definition that can be
+ *     used in cases where none is provided by the compiler.  The files only
+ *     contains the typedefs required to build FreeRTOS.  Read the instructions
+ *     in FreeRTOS/source/stdint.readme for more information.
+ */
+#include <stdint.h> /* READ COMMENT ABOVE. */
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+/* Application specific configuration options. */
+#include "FreeRTOSConfig.h"
+
+/* Basic FreeRTOS definitions. */
+#include "projdefs.h"
+
+/* Definitions specific to the port being used. */
+#include "portable.h"
+
+/* Must be defaulted before configUSE_NEWLIB_REENTRANT is used below. */
+#ifndef configUSE_NEWLIB_REENTRANT
+	#define configUSE_NEWLIB_REENTRANT 0
+#endif
+
+/* Required if struct _reent is used. */
+#if ( configUSE_NEWLIB_REENTRANT == 1 )
+	#include <reent.h>
+#endif
+/*
+ * Check all the required application specific macros have been defined.
+ * These macros are application specific and (as downloaded) are defined
+ * within FreeRTOSConfig.h.
+ */
+
+#ifndef configMINIMAL_STACK_SIZE
+	#error Missing definition:  configMINIMAL_STACK_SIZE must be defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h.  configMINIMAL_STACK_SIZE defines the size (in words) of the stack allocated to the idle task.  Refer to the demo project provided for your port for a suitable value.
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configMAX_PRIORITIES
+	#error Missing definition:  configMAX_PRIORITIES must be defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h.  See the Configuration section of the FreeRTOS API documentation for details.
+#endif
+
+#if configMAX_PRIORITIES < 1
+	#error configMAX_PRIORITIES must be defined to be greater than or equal to 1.
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_PREEMPTION
+	#error Missing definition:  configUSE_PREEMPTION must be defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h as either 1 or 0.  See the Configuration section of the FreeRTOS API documentation for details.
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_IDLE_HOOK
+	#error Missing definition:  configUSE_IDLE_HOOK must be defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h as either 1 or 0.  See the Configuration section of the FreeRTOS API documentation for details.
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_TICK_HOOK
+	#error Missing definition:  configUSE_TICK_HOOK must be defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h as either 1 or 0.  See the Configuration section of the FreeRTOS API documentation for details.
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_16_BIT_TICKS
+	#error Missing definition:  configUSE_16_BIT_TICKS must be defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h as either 1 or 0.  See the Configuration section of the FreeRTOS API documentation for details.
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_CO_ROUTINES
+	#define configUSE_CO_ROUTINES 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_vTaskPrioritySet
+	#define INCLUDE_vTaskPrioritySet 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_uxTaskPriorityGet
+	#define INCLUDE_uxTaskPriorityGet 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_vTaskDelete
+	#define INCLUDE_vTaskDelete 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend
+	#define INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_vTaskDelayUntil
+	#define INCLUDE_vTaskDelayUntil 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_vTaskDelay
+	#define INCLUDE_vTaskDelay 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_xTaskGetIdleTaskHandle
+	#define INCLUDE_xTaskGetIdleTaskHandle 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_xTaskAbortDelay
+	#define INCLUDE_xTaskAbortDelay 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_xQueueGetMutexHolder
+	#define INCLUDE_xQueueGetMutexHolder 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_xSemaphoreGetMutexHolder
+	#define INCLUDE_xSemaphoreGetMutexHolder INCLUDE_xQueueGetMutexHolder
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_xTaskGetHandle
+	#define INCLUDE_xTaskGetHandle 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark
+	#define INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark2
+	#define INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark2 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_eTaskGetState
+	#define INCLUDE_eTaskGetState 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_xTaskResumeFromISR
+	#define INCLUDE_xTaskResumeFromISR 1
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_xTimerPendFunctionCall
+	#define INCLUDE_xTimerPendFunctionCall 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_xTaskGetSchedulerState
+	#define INCLUDE_xTaskGetSchedulerState 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INCLUDE_xTaskGetCurrentTaskHandle
+	#define INCLUDE_xTaskGetCurrentTaskHandle 0
+#endif
+
+#if configUSE_CO_ROUTINES != 0
+	#ifndef configMAX_CO_ROUTINE_PRIORITIES
+		#error configMAX_CO_ROUTINE_PRIORITIES must be greater than or equal to 1.
+	#endif
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_DAEMON_TASK_STARTUP_HOOK
+	#define configUSE_DAEMON_TASK_STARTUP_HOOK 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_APPLICATION_TASK_TAG
+	#define configUSE_APPLICATION_TASK_TAG 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configNUM_THREAD_LOCAL_STORAGE_POINTERS
+	#define configNUM_THREAD_LOCAL_STORAGE_POINTERS 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_RECURSIVE_MUTEXES
+	#define configUSE_RECURSIVE_MUTEXES 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_MUTEXES
+	#define configUSE_MUTEXES 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_TIMERS
+	#define configUSE_TIMERS 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORES
+	#define configUSE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORES 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_ALTERNATIVE_API
+	#define configUSE_ALTERNATIVE_API 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portCRITICAL_NESTING_IN_TCB
+	#define portCRITICAL_NESTING_IN_TCB 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN
+	#define configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN 16
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configIDLE_SHOULD_YIELD
+	#define configIDLE_SHOULD_YIELD		1
+#endif
+
+#if configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN < 1
+	#error configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN must be set to a minimum of 1 in FreeRTOSConfig.h
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configASSERT
+	#define configASSERT( x )
+	#define configASSERT_DEFINED 0
+#else
+	#define configASSERT_DEFINED 1
+#endif
+
+/* configPRECONDITION should be defined as configASSERT.
+The CBMC proofs need a way to track assumptions and assertions.
+A configPRECONDITION statement should express an implicit invariant or
+assumption made.  A configASSERT statement should express an invariant that must
+hold explicit before calling the code. */
+#ifndef configPRECONDITION
+	#define configPRECONDITION( X ) configASSERT(X)
+	#define configPRECONDITION_DEFINED 0
+#else
+	#define configPRECONDITION_DEFINED 1
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portMEMORY_BARRIER
+	#define portMEMORY_BARRIER()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portSOFTWARE_BARRIER
+	#define portSOFTWARE_BARRIER()
+#endif
+
+/* The timers module relies on xTaskGetSchedulerState(). */
+#if configUSE_TIMERS == 1
+
+	#ifndef configTIMER_TASK_PRIORITY
+		#error If configUSE_TIMERS is set to 1 then configTIMER_TASK_PRIORITY must also be defined.
+	#endif /* configTIMER_TASK_PRIORITY */
+
+	#ifndef configTIMER_QUEUE_LENGTH
+		#error If configUSE_TIMERS is set to 1 then configTIMER_QUEUE_LENGTH must also be defined.
+	#endif /* configTIMER_QUEUE_LENGTH */
+
+	#ifndef configTIMER_TASK_STACK_DEPTH
+		#error If configUSE_TIMERS is set to 1 then configTIMER_TASK_STACK_DEPTH must also be defined.
+	#endif /* configTIMER_TASK_STACK_DEPTH */
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TIMERS */
+
+#ifndef portSET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR
+	#define portSET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR() 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portCLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR
+	#define portCLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR( uxSavedStatusValue ) ( void ) uxSavedStatusValue
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portCLEAN_UP_TCB
+	#define portCLEAN_UP_TCB( pxTCB ) ( void ) pxTCB
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portPRE_TASK_DELETE_HOOK
+	#define portPRE_TASK_DELETE_HOOK( pvTaskToDelete, pxYieldPending )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portSETUP_TCB
+	#define portSETUP_TCB( pxTCB ) ( void ) pxTCB
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE
+	#define configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE 0U
+#endif
+
+#if ( configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE < 1 )
+	#define vQueueAddToRegistry( xQueue, pcName )
+	#define vQueueUnregisterQueue( xQueue )
+	#define pcQueueGetName( xQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portPOINTER_SIZE_TYPE
+	#define portPOINTER_SIZE_TYPE uint32_t
+#endif
+
+/* Remove any unused trace macros. */
+#ifndef traceSTART
+	/* Used to perform any necessary initialisation - for example, open a file
+	into which trace is to be written. */
+	#define traceSTART()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceEND
+	/* Use to close a trace, for example close a file into which trace has been
+	written. */
+	#define traceEND()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_SWITCHED_IN
+	/* Called after a task has been selected to run.  pxCurrentTCB holds a pointer
+	to the task control block of the selected task. */
+	#define traceTASK_SWITCHED_IN()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceINCREASE_TICK_COUNT
+	/* Called before stepping the tick count after waking from tickless idle
+	sleep. */
+	#define traceINCREASE_TICK_COUNT( x )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceLOW_POWER_IDLE_BEGIN
+	/* Called immediately before entering tickless idle. */
+	#define traceLOW_POWER_IDLE_BEGIN()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef	traceLOW_POWER_IDLE_END
+	/* Called when returning to the Idle task after a tickless idle. */
+	#define traceLOW_POWER_IDLE_END()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_SWITCHED_OUT
+	/* Called before a task has been selected to run.  pxCurrentTCB holds a pointer
+	to the task control block of the task being switched out. */
+	#define traceTASK_SWITCHED_OUT()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_PRIORITY_INHERIT
+	/* Called when a task attempts to take a mutex that is already held by a
+	lower priority task.  pxTCBOfMutexHolder is a pointer to the TCB of the task
+	that holds the mutex.  uxInheritedPriority is the priority the mutex holder
+	will inherit (the priority of the task that is attempting to obtain the
+	muted. */
+	#define traceTASK_PRIORITY_INHERIT( pxTCBOfMutexHolder, uxInheritedPriority )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_PRIORITY_DISINHERIT
+	/* Called when a task releases a mutex, the holding of which had resulted in
+	the task inheriting the priority of a higher priority task.
+	pxTCBOfMutexHolder is a pointer to the TCB of the task that is releasing the
+	mutex.  uxOriginalPriority is the task's configured (base) priority. */
+	#define traceTASK_PRIORITY_DISINHERIT( pxTCBOfMutexHolder, uxOriginalPriority )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceBLOCKING_ON_QUEUE_RECEIVE
+	/* Task is about to block because it cannot read from a
+	queue/mutex/semaphore.  pxQueue is a pointer to the queue/mutex/semaphore
+	upon which the read was attempted.  pxCurrentTCB points to the TCB of the
+	task that attempted the read. */
+	#define traceBLOCKING_ON_QUEUE_RECEIVE( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceBLOCKING_ON_QUEUE_PEEK
+	/* Task is about to block because it cannot read from a
+	queue/mutex/semaphore.  pxQueue is a pointer to the queue/mutex/semaphore
+	upon which the read was attempted.  pxCurrentTCB points to the TCB of the
+	task that attempted the read. */
+	#define traceBLOCKING_ON_QUEUE_PEEK( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceBLOCKING_ON_QUEUE_SEND
+	/* Task is about to block because it cannot write to a
+	queue/mutex/semaphore.  pxQueue is a pointer to the queue/mutex/semaphore
+	upon which the write was attempted.  pxCurrentTCB points to the TCB of the
+	task that attempted the write. */
+	#define traceBLOCKING_ON_QUEUE_SEND( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configCHECK_FOR_STACK_OVERFLOW
+	#define configCHECK_FOR_STACK_OVERFLOW 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configRECORD_STACK_HIGH_ADDRESS
+	#define configRECORD_STACK_HIGH_ADDRESS 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configINCLUDE_FREERTOS_TASK_C_ADDITIONS_H
+	#define configINCLUDE_FREERTOS_TASK_C_ADDITIONS_H 0
+#endif
+
+/* The following event macros are embedded in the kernel API calls. */
+
+#ifndef traceMOVED_TASK_TO_READY_STATE
+	#define traceMOVED_TASK_TO_READY_STATE( pxTCB )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef tracePOST_MOVED_TASK_TO_READY_STATE
+	#define tracePOST_MOVED_TASK_TO_READY_STATE( pxTCB )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_CREATE
+	#define traceQUEUE_CREATE( pxNewQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_CREATE_FAILED
+	#define traceQUEUE_CREATE_FAILED( ucQueueType )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceCREATE_MUTEX
+	#define traceCREATE_MUTEX( pxNewQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceCREATE_MUTEX_FAILED
+	#define traceCREATE_MUTEX_FAILED()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceGIVE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE
+	#define traceGIVE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE( pxMutex )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceGIVE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE_FAILED
+	#define traceGIVE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE_FAILED( pxMutex )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTAKE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE
+	#define traceTAKE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE( pxMutex )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTAKE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE_FAILED
+	#define traceTAKE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE_FAILED( pxMutex )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceCREATE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORE
+	#define traceCREATE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORE()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceCREATE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORE_FAILED
+	#define traceCREATE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORE_FAILED()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_SEND
+	#define traceQUEUE_SEND( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_SEND_FAILED
+	#define traceQUEUE_SEND_FAILED( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_RECEIVE
+	#define traceQUEUE_RECEIVE( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_PEEK
+	#define traceQUEUE_PEEK( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_PEEK_FAILED
+	#define traceQUEUE_PEEK_FAILED( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_PEEK_FROM_ISR
+	#define traceQUEUE_PEEK_FROM_ISR( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_RECEIVE_FAILED
+	#define traceQUEUE_RECEIVE_FAILED( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_SEND_FROM_ISR
+	#define traceQUEUE_SEND_FROM_ISR( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_SEND_FROM_ISR_FAILED
+	#define traceQUEUE_SEND_FROM_ISR_FAILED( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_RECEIVE_FROM_ISR
+	#define traceQUEUE_RECEIVE_FROM_ISR( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_RECEIVE_FROM_ISR_FAILED
+	#define traceQUEUE_RECEIVE_FROM_ISR_FAILED( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_PEEK_FROM_ISR_FAILED
+	#define traceQUEUE_PEEK_FROM_ISR_FAILED( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_DELETE
+	#define traceQUEUE_DELETE( pxQueue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_CREATE
+	#define traceTASK_CREATE( pxNewTCB )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_CREATE_FAILED
+	#define traceTASK_CREATE_FAILED()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_DELETE
+	#define traceTASK_DELETE( pxTaskToDelete )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_DELAY_UNTIL
+	#define traceTASK_DELAY_UNTIL( x )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_DELAY
+	#define traceTASK_DELAY()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_PRIORITY_SET
+	#define traceTASK_PRIORITY_SET( pxTask, uxNewPriority )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_SUSPEND
+	#define traceTASK_SUSPEND( pxTaskToSuspend )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_RESUME
+	#define traceTASK_RESUME( pxTaskToResume )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_RESUME_FROM_ISR
+	#define traceTASK_RESUME_FROM_ISR( pxTaskToResume )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_INCREMENT_TICK
+	#define traceTASK_INCREMENT_TICK( xTickCount )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTIMER_CREATE
+	#define traceTIMER_CREATE( pxNewTimer )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTIMER_CREATE_FAILED
+	#define traceTIMER_CREATE_FAILED()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTIMER_COMMAND_SEND
+	#define traceTIMER_COMMAND_SEND( xTimer, xMessageID, xMessageValueValue, xReturn )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTIMER_EXPIRED
+	#define traceTIMER_EXPIRED( pxTimer )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTIMER_COMMAND_RECEIVED
+	#define traceTIMER_COMMAND_RECEIVED( pxTimer, xMessageID, xMessageValue )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceMALLOC
+    #define traceMALLOC( pvAddress, uiSize )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceFREE
+    #define traceFREE( pvAddress, uiSize )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceEVENT_GROUP_CREATE
+	#define traceEVENT_GROUP_CREATE( xEventGroup )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceEVENT_GROUP_CREATE_FAILED
+	#define traceEVENT_GROUP_CREATE_FAILED()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceEVENT_GROUP_SYNC_BLOCK
+	#define traceEVENT_GROUP_SYNC_BLOCK( xEventGroup, uxBitsToSet, uxBitsToWaitFor )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceEVENT_GROUP_SYNC_END
+	#define traceEVENT_GROUP_SYNC_END( xEventGroup, uxBitsToSet, uxBitsToWaitFor, xTimeoutOccurred ) ( void ) xTimeoutOccurred
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceEVENT_GROUP_WAIT_BITS_BLOCK
+	#define traceEVENT_GROUP_WAIT_BITS_BLOCK( xEventGroup, uxBitsToWaitFor )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceEVENT_GROUP_WAIT_BITS_END
+	#define traceEVENT_GROUP_WAIT_BITS_END( xEventGroup, uxBitsToWaitFor, xTimeoutOccurred ) ( void ) xTimeoutOccurred
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceEVENT_GROUP_CLEAR_BITS
+	#define traceEVENT_GROUP_CLEAR_BITS( xEventGroup, uxBitsToClear )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceEVENT_GROUP_CLEAR_BITS_FROM_ISR
+	#define traceEVENT_GROUP_CLEAR_BITS_FROM_ISR( xEventGroup, uxBitsToClear )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceEVENT_GROUP_SET_BITS
+	#define traceEVENT_GROUP_SET_BITS( xEventGroup, uxBitsToSet )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceEVENT_GROUP_SET_BITS_FROM_ISR
+	#define traceEVENT_GROUP_SET_BITS_FROM_ISR( xEventGroup, uxBitsToSet )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceEVENT_GROUP_DELETE
+	#define traceEVENT_GROUP_DELETE( xEventGroup )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef tracePEND_FUNC_CALL
+	#define tracePEND_FUNC_CALL(xFunctionToPend, pvParameter1, ulParameter2, ret)
+#endif
+
+#ifndef tracePEND_FUNC_CALL_FROM_ISR
+	#define tracePEND_FUNC_CALL_FROM_ISR(xFunctionToPend, pvParameter1, ulParameter2, ret)
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceQUEUE_REGISTRY_ADD
+	#define traceQUEUE_REGISTRY_ADD(xQueue, pcQueueName)
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_NOTIFY_TAKE_BLOCK
+	#define traceTASK_NOTIFY_TAKE_BLOCK()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_NOTIFY_TAKE
+	#define traceTASK_NOTIFY_TAKE()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_NOTIFY_WAIT_BLOCK
+	#define traceTASK_NOTIFY_WAIT_BLOCK()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_NOTIFY_WAIT
+	#define traceTASK_NOTIFY_WAIT()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_NOTIFY
+	#define traceTASK_NOTIFY()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_NOTIFY_FROM_ISR
+	#define traceTASK_NOTIFY_FROM_ISR()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceTASK_NOTIFY_GIVE_FROM_ISR
+	#define traceTASK_NOTIFY_GIVE_FROM_ISR()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceSTREAM_BUFFER_CREATE_FAILED
+	#define traceSTREAM_BUFFER_CREATE_FAILED( xIsMessageBuffer )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceSTREAM_BUFFER_CREATE_STATIC_FAILED
+	#define traceSTREAM_BUFFER_CREATE_STATIC_FAILED( xReturn, xIsMessageBuffer )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceSTREAM_BUFFER_CREATE
+	#define traceSTREAM_BUFFER_CREATE( pxStreamBuffer, xIsMessageBuffer )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceSTREAM_BUFFER_DELETE
+	#define traceSTREAM_BUFFER_DELETE( xStreamBuffer )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceSTREAM_BUFFER_RESET
+	#define traceSTREAM_BUFFER_RESET( xStreamBuffer )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceBLOCKING_ON_STREAM_BUFFER_SEND
+	#define traceBLOCKING_ON_STREAM_BUFFER_SEND( xStreamBuffer )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceSTREAM_BUFFER_SEND
+	#define traceSTREAM_BUFFER_SEND( xStreamBuffer, xBytesSent )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceSTREAM_BUFFER_SEND_FAILED
+	#define traceSTREAM_BUFFER_SEND_FAILED( xStreamBuffer )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceSTREAM_BUFFER_SEND_FROM_ISR
+	#define traceSTREAM_BUFFER_SEND_FROM_ISR( xStreamBuffer, xBytesSent )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceBLOCKING_ON_STREAM_BUFFER_RECEIVE
+	#define traceBLOCKING_ON_STREAM_BUFFER_RECEIVE( xStreamBuffer )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceSTREAM_BUFFER_RECEIVE
+	#define traceSTREAM_BUFFER_RECEIVE( xStreamBuffer, xReceivedLength )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceSTREAM_BUFFER_RECEIVE_FAILED
+	#define traceSTREAM_BUFFER_RECEIVE_FAILED( xStreamBuffer )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef traceSTREAM_BUFFER_RECEIVE_FROM_ISR
+	#define traceSTREAM_BUFFER_RECEIVE_FROM_ISR( xStreamBuffer, xReceivedLength )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS
+	#define configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS 0
+#endif
+
+#if ( configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS == 1 )
+
+	#ifndef portCONFIGURE_TIMER_FOR_RUN_TIME_STATS
+		#error If configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS is defined then portCONFIGURE_TIMER_FOR_RUN_TIME_STATS must also be defined.  portCONFIGURE_TIMER_FOR_RUN_TIME_STATS should call a port layer function to setup a peripheral timer/counter that can then be used as the run time counter time base.
+	#endif /* portCONFIGURE_TIMER_FOR_RUN_TIME_STATS */
+
+	#ifndef portGET_RUN_TIME_COUNTER_VALUE
+		#ifndef portALT_GET_RUN_TIME_COUNTER_VALUE
+			#error If configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS is defined then either portGET_RUN_TIME_COUNTER_VALUE or portALT_GET_RUN_TIME_COUNTER_VALUE must also be defined.  See the examples provided and the FreeRTOS web site for more information.
+		#endif /* portALT_GET_RUN_TIME_COUNTER_VALUE */
+	#endif /* portGET_RUN_TIME_COUNTER_VALUE */
+
+#endif /* configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS */
+
+#ifndef portCONFIGURE_TIMER_FOR_RUN_TIME_STATS
+	#define portCONFIGURE_TIMER_FOR_RUN_TIME_STATS()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_MALLOC_FAILED_HOOK
+	#define configUSE_MALLOC_FAILED_HOOK 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portPRIVILEGE_BIT
+	#define portPRIVILEGE_BIT ( ( UBaseType_t ) 0x00 )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portYIELD_WITHIN_API
+	#define portYIELD_WITHIN_API portYIELD
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portSUPPRESS_TICKS_AND_SLEEP
+	#define portSUPPRESS_TICKS_AND_SLEEP( xExpectedIdleTime )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configEXPECTED_IDLE_TIME_BEFORE_SLEEP
+	#define configEXPECTED_IDLE_TIME_BEFORE_SLEEP 2
+#endif
+
+#if configEXPECTED_IDLE_TIME_BEFORE_SLEEP < 2
+	#error configEXPECTED_IDLE_TIME_BEFORE_SLEEP must not be less than 2
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE
+	#define configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configPRE_SUPPRESS_TICKS_AND_SLEEP_PROCESSING
+	#define configPRE_SUPPRESS_TICKS_AND_SLEEP_PROCESSING( x )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configPRE_SLEEP_PROCESSING
+	#define configPRE_SLEEP_PROCESSING( x )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configPOST_SLEEP_PROCESSING
+	#define configPOST_SLEEP_PROCESSING( x )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_QUEUE_SETS
+	#define configUSE_QUEUE_SETS 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portTASK_USES_FLOATING_POINT
+	#define portTASK_USES_FLOATING_POINT()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portALLOCATE_SECURE_CONTEXT
+	#define portALLOCATE_SECURE_CONTEXT( ulSecureStackSize )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portDONT_DISCARD
+	#define portDONT_DISCARD
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_TIME_SLICING
+	#define configUSE_TIME_SLICING 1
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configINCLUDE_APPLICATION_DEFINED_PRIVILEGED_FUNCTIONS
+	#define configINCLUDE_APPLICATION_DEFINED_PRIVILEGED_FUNCTIONS 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_STATS_FORMATTING_FUNCTIONS
+	#define configUSE_STATS_FORMATTING_FUNCTIONS 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID
+	#define portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY
+	#define configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER
+	#define mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef mtCOVERAGE_TEST_DELAY
+	#define mtCOVERAGE_TEST_DELAY()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portASSERT_IF_IN_ISR
+	#define portASSERT_IF_IN_ISR()
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_PORT_OPTIMISED_TASK_SELECTION
+	#define configUSE_PORT_OPTIMISED_TASK_SELECTION 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configAPPLICATION_ALLOCATED_HEAP
+	#define configAPPLICATION_ALLOCATED_HEAP 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS
+	#define configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS 1
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configUSE_POSIX_ERRNO
+	#define configUSE_POSIX_ERRNO 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef portTICK_TYPE_IS_ATOMIC
+	#define portTICK_TYPE_IS_ATOMIC 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION
+	/* Defaults to 0 for backward compatibility. */
+	#define configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION
+	/* Defaults to 1 for backward compatibility. */
+	#define configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION 1
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configSTACK_DEPTH_TYPE
+	/* Defaults to uint16_t for backward compatibility, but can be overridden
+	in FreeRTOSConfig.h if uint16_t is too restrictive. */
+	#define configSTACK_DEPTH_TYPE uint16_t
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configMESSAGE_BUFFER_LENGTH_TYPE
+	/* Defaults to size_t for backward compatibility, but can be overridden
+	in FreeRTOSConfig.h if lengths will always be less than the number of bytes
+	in a size_t. */
+	#define configMESSAGE_BUFFER_LENGTH_TYPE size_t
+#endif
+
+/* Sanity check the configuration. */
+#if( configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE != 0 )
+	#if( INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend != 1 )
+		#error INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend must be set to 1 if configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE is not set to 0
+	#endif /* INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend */
+#endif /* configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE */
+
+#if( ( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 0 ) && ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 0 ) )
+	#error configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION and configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION cannot both be 0, but can both be 1.
+#endif
+
+#if( ( configUSE_RECURSIVE_MUTEXES == 1 ) && ( configUSE_MUTEXES != 1 ) )
+	#error configUSE_MUTEXES must be set to 1 to use recursive mutexes
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configINITIAL_TICK_COUNT
+	#define configINITIAL_TICK_COUNT 0
+#endif
+
+#if( portTICK_TYPE_IS_ATOMIC == 0 )
+	/* Either variables of tick type cannot be read atomically, or
+	portTICK_TYPE_IS_ATOMIC was not set - map the critical sections used when
+	the tick count is returned to the standard critical section macros. */
+	#define portTICK_TYPE_ENTER_CRITICAL() portENTER_CRITICAL()
+	#define portTICK_TYPE_EXIT_CRITICAL() portEXIT_CRITICAL()
+	#define portTICK_TYPE_SET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR() portSET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR()
+	#define portTICK_TYPE_CLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR( x ) portCLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR( ( x ) )
+#else
+	/* The tick type can be read atomically, so critical sections used when the
+	tick count is returned can be defined away. */
+	#define portTICK_TYPE_ENTER_CRITICAL()
+	#define portTICK_TYPE_EXIT_CRITICAL()
+	#define portTICK_TYPE_SET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR() 0
+	#define portTICK_TYPE_CLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR( x ) ( void ) x
+#endif
+
+/* Definitions to allow backward compatibility with FreeRTOS versions prior to
+V8 if desired. */
+#ifndef configENABLE_BACKWARD_COMPATIBILITY
+	#define configENABLE_BACKWARD_COMPATIBILITY 1
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configPRINTF
+	/* configPRINTF() was not defined, so define it away to nothing.  To use
+	configPRINTF() then define it as follows (where MyPrintFunction() is
+	provided by the application writer):
+
+	void MyPrintFunction(const char *pcFormat, ... );
+	#define configPRINTF( X )   MyPrintFunction X
+
+	Then call like a standard printf() function, but placing brackets around
+	all parameters so they are passed as a single parameter.  For example:
+	configPRINTF( ("Value = %d", MyVariable) ); */
+	#define configPRINTF( X )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configMAX
+	/* The application writer has not provided their own MAX macro, so define
+	the following generic implementation. */
+	#define configMAX( a, b ) ( ( ( a ) > ( b ) ) ? ( a ) : ( b ) )
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configMIN
+	/* The application writer has not provided their own MAX macro, so define
+	the following generic implementation. */
+	#define configMIN( a, b ) ( ( ( a ) < ( b ) ) ? ( a ) : ( b ) )
+#endif
+
+#if configENABLE_BACKWARD_COMPATIBILITY == 1
+	#define eTaskStateGet eTaskGetState
+	#define portTickType TickType_t
+	#define xTaskHandle TaskHandle_t
+	#define xQueueHandle QueueHandle_t
+	#define xSemaphoreHandle SemaphoreHandle_t
+	#define xQueueSetHandle QueueSetHandle_t
+	#define xQueueSetMemberHandle QueueSetMemberHandle_t
+	#define xTimeOutType TimeOut_t
+	#define xMemoryRegion MemoryRegion_t
+	#define xTaskParameters TaskParameters_t
+	#define xTaskStatusType	TaskStatus_t
+	#define xTimerHandle TimerHandle_t
+	#define xCoRoutineHandle CoRoutineHandle_t
+	#define pdTASK_HOOK_CODE TaskHookFunction_t
+	#define portTICK_RATE_MS portTICK_PERIOD_MS
+	#define pcTaskGetTaskName pcTaskGetName
+	#define pcTimerGetTimerName pcTimerGetName
+	#define pcQueueGetQueueName pcQueueGetName
+	#define vTaskGetTaskInfo vTaskGetInfo
+	#define xTaskGetIdleRunTimeCounter ulTaskGetIdleRunTimeCounter
+
+	/* Backward compatibility within the scheduler code only - these definitions
+	are not really required but are included for completeness. */
+	#define tmrTIMER_CALLBACK TimerCallbackFunction_t
+	#define pdTASK_CODE TaskFunction_t
+	#define xListItem ListItem_t
+	#define xList List_t
+
+	/* For libraries that break the list data hiding, and access list structure
+	members directly (which is not supposed to be done). */
+	#define pxContainer pvContainer
+#endif /* configENABLE_BACKWARD_COMPATIBILITY */
+
+#if( configUSE_ALTERNATIVE_API != 0 )
+	#error The alternative API was deprecated some time ago, and was removed in FreeRTOS V9.0 0
+#endif
+
+/* Set configUSE_TASK_FPU_SUPPORT to 0 to omit floating point support even
+if floating point hardware is otherwise supported by the FreeRTOS port in use.
+This constant is not supported by all FreeRTOS ports that include floating
+point support. */
+#ifndef configUSE_TASK_FPU_SUPPORT
+	#define configUSE_TASK_FPU_SUPPORT 1
+#endif
+
+/* Set configENABLE_MPU to 1 to enable MPU support and 0 to disable it. This is
+currently used in ARMv8M ports. */
+#ifndef configENABLE_MPU
+	#define configENABLE_MPU 0
+#endif
+
+/* Set configENABLE_FPU to 1 to enable FPU support and 0 to disable it. This is
+currently used in ARMv8M ports. */
+#ifndef configENABLE_FPU
+	#define configENABLE_FPU 1
+#endif
+
+/* Set configENABLE_TRUSTZONE to 1 enable TrustZone support and 0 to disable it.
+This is currently used in ARMv8M ports. */
+#ifndef configENABLE_TRUSTZONE
+	#define configENABLE_TRUSTZONE 1
+#endif
+
+/* Set configRUN_FREERTOS_SECURE_ONLY to 1 to run the FreeRTOS ARMv8M port on
+the Secure Side only. */
+#ifndef configRUN_FREERTOS_SECURE_ONLY
+	#define configRUN_FREERTOS_SECURE_ONLY 0
+#endif
+
+/* Sometimes the FreeRTOSConfig.h settings only allow a task to be created using
+ * dynamically allocated RAM, in which case when any task is deleted it is known
+ * that both the task's stack and TCB need to be freed.  Sometimes the
+ * FreeRTOSConfig.h settings only allow a task to be created using statically
+ * allocated RAM, in which case when any task is deleted it is known that neither
+ * the task's stack or TCB should be freed.  Sometimes the FreeRTOSConfig.h
+ * settings allow a task to be created using either statically or dynamically
+ * allocated RAM, in which case a member of the TCB is used to record whether the
+ * stack and/or TCB were allocated statically or dynamically, so when a task is
+ * deleted the RAM that was allocated dynamically is freed again and no attempt is
+ * made to free the RAM that was allocated statically.
+ * tskSTATIC_AND_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION_POSSIBLE is only true if it is possible for a
+ * task to be created using either statically or dynamically allocated RAM.  Note
+ * that if portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS is 1 then a protected task can be created with
+ * a statically allocated stack and a dynamically allocated TCB.
+ *
+ * The following table lists various combinations of portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS,
+ * configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION and configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION and
+ * when it is possible to have both static and dynamic allocation:
+ *  +-----+---------+--------+-----------------------------+-----------------------------------+------------------+-----------+
+ * | MPU | Dynamic | Static |     Available Functions     |       Possible Allocations        | Both Dynamic and | Need Free |
+ * |     |         |        |                             |                                   | Static Possible  |           |
+ * +-----+---------+--------+-----------------------------+-----------------------------------+------------------+-----------+
+ * | 0   | 0       | 1      | xTaskCreateStatic           | TCB - Static, Stack - Static      | No               | No        |
+ * +-----|---------|--------|-----------------------------|-----------------------------------|------------------|-----------|
+ * | 0   | 1       | 0      | xTaskCreate                 | TCB - Dynamic, Stack - Dynamic    | No               | Yes       |
+ * +-----|---------|--------|-----------------------------|-----------------------------------|------------------|-----------|
+ * | 0   | 1       | 1      | xTaskCreate,                | 1. TCB - Dynamic, Stack - Dynamic | Yes              | Yes       |
+ * |     |         |        | xTaskCreateStatic           | 2. TCB - Static, Stack - Static   |                  |           |
+ * +-----|---------|--------|-----------------------------|-----------------------------------|------------------|-----------|
+ * | 1   | 0       | 1      | xTaskCreateStatic,          | TCB - Static, Stack - Static      | No               | No        |
+ * |     |         |        | xTaskCreateRestrictedStatic |                                   |                  |           |
+ * +-----|---------|--------|-----------------------------|-----------------------------------|------------------|-----------|
+ * | 1   | 1       | 0      | xTaskCreate,                | 1. TCB - Dynamic, Stack - Dynamic | Yes              | Yes       |
+ * |     |         |        | xTaskCreateRestricted       | 2. TCB - Dynamic, Stack - Static  |                  |           |
+ * +-----|---------|--------|-----------------------------|-----------------------------------|------------------|-----------|
+ * | 1   | 1       | 1      | xTaskCreate,                | 1. TCB - Dynamic, Stack - Dynamic | Yes              | Yes       |
+ * |     |         |        | xTaskCreateStatic,          | 2. TCB - Dynamic, Stack - Static  |                  |           |
+ * |     |         |        | xTaskCreateRestricted,      | 3. TCB - Static, Stack - Static   |                  |           |
+ * |     |         |        | xTaskCreateRestrictedStatic |                                   |                  |           |
+ * +-----+---------+--------+-----------------------------+-----------------------------------+------------------+-----------+
+ */
+#define tskSTATIC_AND_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION_POSSIBLE	( ( ( portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS == 0 ) && ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) ) || \
+													  ( ( portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) ) )
+
+/*
+ * In line with software engineering best practice, FreeRTOS implements a strict
+ * data hiding policy, so the real structures used by FreeRTOS to maintain the
+ * state of tasks, queues, semaphores, etc. are not accessible to the application
+ * code.  However, if the application writer wants to statically allocate such
+ * an object then the size of the object needs to be know.  Dummy structures
+ * that are guaranteed to have the same size and alignment requirements of the
+ * real objects are used for this purpose.  The dummy list and list item
+ * structures below are used for inclusion in such a dummy structure.
+ */
+struct xSTATIC_LIST_ITEM
+{
+	#if( configUSE_LIST_DATA_INTEGRITY_CHECK_BYTES == 1 )
+		TickType_t xDummy1;
+	#endif
+	TickType_t xDummy2;
+	void *pvDummy3[ 4 ];
+	#if( configUSE_LIST_DATA_INTEGRITY_CHECK_BYTES == 1 )
+		TickType_t xDummy4;
+	#endif
+};
+typedef struct xSTATIC_LIST_ITEM StaticListItem_t;
+
+/* See the comments above the struct xSTATIC_LIST_ITEM definition. */
+struct xSTATIC_MINI_LIST_ITEM
+{
+	#if( configUSE_LIST_DATA_INTEGRITY_CHECK_BYTES == 1 )
+		TickType_t xDummy1;
+	#endif
+	TickType_t xDummy2;
+	void *pvDummy3[ 2 ];
+};
+typedef struct xSTATIC_MINI_LIST_ITEM StaticMiniListItem_t;
+
+/* See the comments above the struct xSTATIC_LIST_ITEM definition. */
+typedef struct xSTATIC_LIST
+{
+	#if( configUSE_LIST_DATA_INTEGRITY_CHECK_BYTES == 1 )
+		TickType_t xDummy1;
+	#endif
+	UBaseType_t uxDummy2;
+	void *pvDummy3;
+	StaticMiniListItem_t xDummy4;
+	#if( configUSE_LIST_DATA_INTEGRITY_CHECK_BYTES == 1 )
+		TickType_t xDummy5;
+	#endif
+} StaticList_t;
+
+/*
+ * In line with software engineering best practice, especially when supplying a
+ * library that is likely to change in future versions, FreeRTOS implements a
+ * strict data hiding policy.  This means the Task structure used internally by
+ * FreeRTOS is not accessible to application code.  However, if the application
+ * writer wants to statically allocate the memory required to create a task then
+ * the size of the task object needs to be know.  The StaticTask_t structure
+ * below is provided for this purpose.  Its sizes and alignment requirements are
+ * guaranteed to match those of the genuine structure, no matter which
+ * architecture is being used, and no matter how the values in FreeRTOSConfig.h
+ * are set.  Its contents are somewhat obfuscated in the hope users will
+ * recognise that it would be unwise to make direct use of the structure members.
+ */
+typedef struct xSTATIC_TCB
+{
+	void				*pxDummy1;
+	#if ( portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS == 1 )
+		xMPU_SETTINGS	xDummy2;
+	#endif
+	StaticListItem_t	xDummy3[ 2 ];
+	UBaseType_t			uxDummy5;
+	void				*pxDummy6;
+	uint8_t				ucDummy7[ configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN ];
+	#if ( ( portSTACK_GROWTH > 0 ) || ( configRECORD_STACK_HIGH_ADDRESS == 1 ) )
+		void			*pxDummy8;
+	#endif
+	#if ( portCRITICAL_NESTING_IN_TCB == 1 )
+		UBaseType_t		uxDummy9;
+	#endif
+	#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+		UBaseType_t		uxDummy10[ 2 ];
+	#endif
+	#if ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+		UBaseType_t		uxDummy12[ 2 ];
+	#endif
+	#if ( configUSE_APPLICATION_TASK_TAG == 1 )
+		void			*pxDummy14;
+	#endif
+	#if( configNUM_THREAD_LOCAL_STORAGE_POINTERS > 0 )
+		void			*pvDummy15[ configNUM_THREAD_LOCAL_STORAGE_POINTERS ];
+	#endif
+	#if ( configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS == 1 )
+		uint32_t		ulDummy16;
+	#endif
+	#if ( configUSE_NEWLIB_REENTRANT == 1 )
+		struct	_reent	xDummy17;
+	#endif
+	#if ( configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS == 1 )
+		uint32_t 		ulDummy18;
+		uint8_t 		ucDummy19;
+	#endif
+	#if ( tskSTATIC_AND_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION_POSSIBLE != 0 )
+		uint8_t			uxDummy20;
+	#endif
+
+	#if( INCLUDE_xTaskAbortDelay == 1 )
+		uint8_t ucDummy21;
+	#endif
+	#if ( configUSE_POSIX_ERRNO == 1 )
+		int				iDummy22;
+	#endif
+} StaticTask_t;
+
+/*
+ * In line with software engineering best practice, especially when supplying a
+ * library that is likely to change in future versions, FreeRTOS implements a
+ * strict data hiding policy.  This means the Queue structure used internally by
+ * FreeRTOS is not accessible to application code.  However, if the application
+ * writer wants to statically allocate the memory required to create a queue
+ * then the size of the queue object needs to be know.  The StaticQueue_t
+ * structure below is provided for this purpose.  Its sizes and alignment
+ * requirements are guaranteed to match those of the genuine structure, no
+ * matter which architecture is being used, and no matter how the values in
+ * FreeRTOSConfig.h are set.  Its contents are somewhat obfuscated in the hope
+ * users will recognise that it would be unwise to make direct use of the
+ * structure members.
+ */
+typedef struct xSTATIC_QUEUE
+{
+	void *pvDummy1[ 3 ];
+
+	union
+	{
+		void *pvDummy2;
+		UBaseType_t uxDummy2;
+	} u;
+
+	StaticList_t xDummy3[ 2 ];
+	UBaseType_t uxDummy4[ 3 ];
+	uint8_t ucDummy5[ 2 ];
+
+	#if( ( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) )
+		uint8_t ucDummy6;
+	#endif
+
+	#if ( configUSE_QUEUE_SETS == 1 )
+		void *pvDummy7;
+	#endif
+
+	#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+		UBaseType_t uxDummy8;
+		uint8_t ucDummy9;
+	#endif
+
+} StaticQueue_t;
+typedef StaticQueue_t StaticSemaphore_t;
+
+/*
+ * In line with software engineering best practice, especially when supplying a
+ * library that is likely to change in future versions, FreeRTOS implements a
+ * strict data hiding policy.  This means the event group structure used
+ * internally by FreeRTOS is not accessible to application code.  However, if
+ * the application writer wants to statically allocate the memory required to
+ * create an event group then the size of the event group object needs to be
+ * know.  The StaticEventGroup_t structure below is provided for this purpose.
+ * Its sizes and alignment requirements are guaranteed to match those of the
+ * genuine structure, no matter which architecture is being used, and no matter
+ * how the values in FreeRTOSConfig.h are set.  Its contents are somewhat
+ * obfuscated in the hope users will recognise that it would be unwise to make
+ * direct use of the structure members.
+ */
+typedef struct xSTATIC_EVENT_GROUP
+{
+	TickType_t xDummy1;
+	StaticList_t xDummy2;
+
+	#if( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+		UBaseType_t uxDummy3;
+	#endif
+
+	#if( ( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) )
+			uint8_t ucDummy4;
+	#endif
+
+} StaticEventGroup_t;
+
+/*
+ * In line with software engineering best practice, especially when supplying a
+ * library that is likely to change in future versions, FreeRTOS implements a
+ * strict data hiding policy.  This means the software timer structure used
+ * internally by FreeRTOS is not accessible to application code.  However, if
+ * the application writer wants to statically allocate the memory required to
+ * create a software timer then the size of the queue object needs to be know.
+ * The StaticTimer_t structure below is provided for this purpose.  Its sizes
+ * and alignment requirements are guaranteed to match those of the genuine
+ * structure, no matter which architecture is being used, and no matter how the
+ * values in FreeRTOSConfig.h are set.  Its contents are somewhat obfuscated in
+ * the hope users will recognise that it would be unwise to make direct use of
+ * the structure members.
+ */
+typedef struct xSTATIC_TIMER
+{
+	void				*pvDummy1;
+	StaticListItem_t	xDummy2;
+	TickType_t			xDummy3;
+	void 				*pvDummy5;
+	TaskFunction_t		pvDummy6;
+	#if( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+		UBaseType_t		uxDummy7;
+	#endif
+	uint8_t 			ucDummy8;
+
+} StaticTimer_t;
+
+/*
+* In line with software engineering best practice, especially when supplying a
+* library that is likely to change in future versions, FreeRTOS implements a
+* strict data hiding policy.  This means the stream buffer structure used
+* internally by FreeRTOS is not accessible to application code.  However, if
+* the application writer wants to statically allocate the memory required to
+* create a stream buffer then the size of the stream buffer object needs to be
+* know.  The StaticStreamBuffer_t structure below is provided for this purpose.
+* Its size and alignment requirements are guaranteed to match those of the
+* genuine structure, no matter which architecture is being used, and no matter
+* how the values in FreeRTOSConfig.h are set.  Its contents are somewhat
+* obfuscated in the hope users will recognise that it would be unwise to make
+* direct use of the structure members.
+*/
+typedef struct xSTATIC_STREAM_BUFFER
+{
+	size_t uxDummy1[ 4 ];
+	void * pvDummy2[ 3 ];
+	uint8_t ucDummy3;
+	#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+		UBaseType_t uxDummy4;
+	#endif
+} StaticStreamBuffer_t;
+
+/* Message buffers are built on stream buffers. */
+typedef StaticStreamBuffer_t StaticMessageBuffer_t;
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif /* INC_FREERTOS_H */
+
Index: ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/list.c
===================================================================
--- ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/list.c	(revision 73)
+++ ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/list.c	(revision 73)
@@ -0,0 +1,198 @@
+/*
+ * FreeRTOS Kernel V10.3.1
+ * Copyright (C) 2020 Amazon.com, Inc. or its affiliates.  All Rights Reserved.
+ *
+ * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of
+ * this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in
+ * the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to
+ * use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of
+ * the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so,
+ * subject to the following conditions:
+ *
+ * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all
+ * copies or substantial portions of the Software.
+ *
+ * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
+ * IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS
+ * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR
+ * COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
+ * IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
+ * CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
+ *
+ * http://www.FreeRTOS.org
+ * http://aws.amazon.com/freertos
+ *
+ * 1 tab == 4 spaces!
+ */
+
+
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include "FreeRTOS.h"
+#include "list.h"
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------
+ * PUBLIC LIST API documented in list.h
+ *----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vListInitialise( List_t * const pxList )
+{
+	/* The list structure contains a list item which is used to mark the
+	end of the list.  To initialise the list the list end is inserted
+	as the only list entry. */
+	pxList->pxIndex = ( ListItem_t * ) &( pxList->xListEnd );			/*lint !e826 !e740 !e9087 The mini list structure is used as the list end to save RAM.  This is checked and valid. */
+
+	/* The list end value is the highest possible value in the list to
+	ensure it remains at the end of the list. */
+	pxList->xListEnd.xItemValue = portMAX_DELAY;
+
+	/* The list end next and previous pointers point to itself so we know
+	when the list is empty. */
+	pxList->xListEnd.pxNext = ( ListItem_t * ) &( pxList->xListEnd );	/*lint !e826 !e740 !e9087 The mini list structure is used as the list end to save RAM.  This is checked and valid. */
+	pxList->xListEnd.pxPrevious = ( ListItem_t * ) &( pxList->xListEnd );/*lint !e826 !e740 !e9087 The mini list structure is used as the list end to save RAM.  This is checked and valid. */
+
+	pxList->uxNumberOfItems = ( UBaseType_t ) 0U;
+
+	/* Write known values into the list if
+	configUSE_LIST_DATA_INTEGRITY_CHECK_BYTES is set to 1. */
+	listSET_LIST_INTEGRITY_CHECK_1_VALUE( pxList );
+	listSET_LIST_INTEGRITY_CHECK_2_VALUE( pxList );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vListInitialiseItem( ListItem_t * const pxItem )
+{
+	/* Make sure the list item is not recorded as being on a list. */
+	pxItem->pxContainer = NULL;
+
+	/* Write known values into the list item if
+	configUSE_LIST_DATA_INTEGRITY_CHECK_BYTES is set to 1. */
+	listSET_FIRST_LIST_ITEM_INTEGRITY_CHECK_VALUE( pxItem );
+	listSET_SECOND_LIST_ITEM_INTEGRITY_CHECK_VALUE( pxItem );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vListInsertEnd( List_t * const pxList, ListItem_t * const pxNewListItem )
+{
+ListItem_t * const pxIndex = pxList->pxIndex;
+
+	/* Only effective when configASSERT() is also defined, these tests may catch
+	the list data structures being overwritten in memory.  They will not catch
+	data errors caused by incorrect configuration or use of FreeRTOS. */
+	listTEST_LIST_INTEGRITY( pxList );
+	listTEST_LIST_ITEM_INTEGRITY( pxNewListItem );
+
+	/* Insert a new list item into pxList, but rather than sort the list,
+	makes the new list item the last item to be removed by a call to
+	listGET_OWNER_OF_NEXT_ENTRY(). */
+	pxNewListItem->pxNext = pxIndex;
+	pxNewListItem->pxPrevious = pxIndex->pxPrevious;
+
+	/* Only used during decision coverage testing. */
+	mtCOVERAGE_TEST_DELAY();
+
+	pxIndex->pxPrevious->pxNext = pxNewListItem;
+	pxIndex->pxPrevious = pxNewListItem;
+
+	/* Remember which list the item is in. */
+	pxNewListItem->pxContainer = pxList;
+
+	( pxList->uxNumberOfItems )++;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vListInsert( List_t * const pxList, ListItem_t * const pxNewListItem )
+{
+ListItem_t *pxIterator;
+const TickType_t xValueOfInsertion = pxNewListItem->xItemValue;
+
+	/* Only effective when configASSERT() is also defined, these tests may catch
+	the list data structures being overwritten in memory.  They will not catch
+	data errors caused by incorrect configuration or use of FreeRTOS. */
+	listTEST_LIST_INTEGRITY( pxList );
+	listTEST_LIST_ITEM_INTEGRITY( pxNewListItem );
+
+	/* Insert the new list item into the list, sorted in xItemValue order.
+
+	If the list already contains a list item with the same item value then the
+	new list item should be placed after it.  This ensures that TCBs which are
+	stored in ready lists (all of which have the same xItemValue value) get a
+	share of the CPU.  However, if the xItemValue is the same as the back marker
+	the iteration loop below will not end.  Therefore the value is checked
+	first, and the algorithm slightly modified if necessary. */
+	if( xValueOfInsertion == portMAX_DELAY )
+	{
+		pxIterator = pxList->xListEnd.pxPrevious;
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		/* *** NOTE ***********************************************************
+		If you find your application is crashing here then likely causes are
+		listed below.  In addition see https://www.freertos.org/FAQHelp.html for
+		more tips, and ensure configASSERT() is defined!
+		https://www.freertos.org/a00110.html#configASSERT
+
+			1) Stack overflow -
+			   see https://www.freertos.org/Stacks-and-stack-overflow-checking.html
+			2) Incorrect interrupt priority assignment, especially on Cortex-M
+			   parts where numerically high priority values denote low actual
+			   interrupt priorities, which can seem counter intuitive.  See
+			   https://www.freertos.org/RTOS-Cortex-M3-M4.html and the definition
+			   of configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY on
+			   https://www.freertos.org/a00110.html
+			3) Calling an API function from within a critical section or when
+			   the scheduler is suspended, or calling an API function that does
+			   not end in "FromISR" from an interrupt.
+			4) Using a queue or semaphore before it has been initialised or
+			   before the scheduler has been started (are interrupts firing
+			   before vTaskStartScheduler() has been called?).
+		**********************************************************************/
+
+		for( pxIterator = ( ListItem_t * ) &( pxList->xListEnd ); pxIterator->pxNext->xItemValue <= xValueOfInsertion; pxIterator = pxIterator->pxNext ) /*lint !e826 !e740 !e9087 The mini list structure is used as the list end to save RAM.  This is checked and valid. *//*lint !e440 The iterator moves to a different value, not xValueOfInsertion. */
+		{
+			/* There is nothing to do here, just iterating to the wanted
+			insertion position. */
+		}
+	}
+
+	pxNewListItem->pxNext = pxIterator->pxNext;
+	pxNewListItem->pxNext->pxPrevious = pxNewListItem;
+	pxNewListItem->pxPrevious = pxIterator;
+	pxIterator->pxNext = pxNewListItem;
+
+	/* Remember which list the item is in.  This allows fast removal of the
+	item later. */
+	pxNewListItem->pxContainer = pxList;
+
+	( pxList->uxNumberOfItems )++;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+UBaseType_t uxListRemove( ListItem_t * const pxItemToRemove )
+{
+/* The list item knows which list it is in.  Obtain the list from the list
+item. */
+List_t * const pxList = pxItemToRemove->pxContainer;
+
+	pxItemToRemove->pxNext->pxPrevious = pxItemToRemove->pxPrevious;
+	pxItemToRemove->pxPrevious->pxNext = pxItemToRemove->pxNext;
+
+	/* Only used during decision coverage testing. */
+	mtCOVERAGE_TEST_DELAY();
+
+	/* Make sure the index is left pointing to a valid item. */
+	if( pxList->pxIndex == pxItemToRemove )
+	{
+		pxList->pxIndex = pxItemToRemove->pxPrevious;
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+	}
+
+	pxItemToRemove->pxContainer = NULL;
+	( pxList->uxNumberOfItems )--;
+
+	return pxList->uxNumberOfItems;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
Index: ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/portable/GCC/ARM_CM4F/port.c
===================================================================
--- ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/portable/GCC/ARM_CM4F/port.c	(revision 73)
+++ ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/portable/GCC/ARM_CM4F/port.c	(revision 73)
@@ -0,0 +1,775 @@
+/*
+ * FreeRTOS Kernel V10.3.1
+ * Copyright (C) 2020 Amazon.com, Inc. or its affiliates.  All Rights Reserved.
+ *
+ * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of
+ * this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in
+ * the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to
+ * use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of
+ * the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so,
+ * subject to the following conditions:
+ *
+ * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all
+ * copies or substantial portions of the Software.
+ *
+ * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
+ * IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS
+ * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR
+ * COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
+ * IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
+ * CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
+ *
+ * http://www.FreeRTOS.org
+ * http://aws.amazon.com/freertos
+ *
+ * 1 tab == 4 spaces!
+ */
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------
+ * Implementation of functions defined in portable.h for the ARM CM4F port.
+ *----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* Scheduler includes. */
+#include "FreeRTOS.h"
+#include "task.h"
+
+#ifndef __VFP_FP__
+	#error This port can only be used when the project options are configured to enable hardware floating point support.
+#endif
+
+#ifndef configSYSTICK_CLOCK_HZ
+	#define configSYSTICK_CLOCK_HZ configCPU_CLOCK_HZ
+	/* Ensure the SysTick is clocked at the same frequency as the core. */
+	#define portNVIC_SYSTICK_CLK_BIT	( 1UL << 2UL )
+#else
+	/* The way the SysTick is clocked is not modified in case it is not the same
+	as the core. */
+	#define portNVIC_SYSTICK_CLK_BIT	( 0 )
+#endif
+
+/* Constants required to manipulate the core.  Registers first... */
+#define portNVIC_SYSTICK_CTRL_REG			( * ( ( volatile uint32_t * ) 0xe000e010 ) )
+#define portNVIC_SYSTICK_LOAD_REG			( * ( ( volatile uint32_t * ) 0xe000e014 ) )
+#define portNVIC_SYSTICK_CURRENT_VALUE_REG	( * ( ( volatile uint32_t * ) 0xe000e018 ) )
+#define portNVIC_SYSPRI2_REG				( * ( ( volatile uint32_t * ) 0xe000ed20 ) )
+/* ...then bits in the registers. */
+#define portNVIC_SYSTICK_INT_BIT			( 1UL << 1UL )
+#define portNVIC_SYSTICK_ENABLE_BIT			( 1UL << 0UL )
+#define portNVIC_SYSTICK_COUNT_FLAG_BIT		( 1UL << 16UL )
+#define portNVIC_PENDSVCLEAR_BIT 			( 1UL << 27UL )
+#define portNVIC_PEND_SYSTICK_CLEAR_BIT		( 1UL << 25UL )
+
+/* Constants used to detect a Cortex-M7 r0p1 core, which should use the ARM_CM7
+r0p1 port. */
+#define portCPUID							( * ( ( volatile uint32_t * ) 0xE000ed00 ) )
+#define portCORTEX_M7_r0p1_ID				( 0x410FC271UL )
+#define portCORTEX_M7_r0p0_ID				( 0x410FC270UL )
+
+#define portNVIC_PENDSV_PRI					( ( ( uint32_t ) configKERNEL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY ) << 16UL )
+#define portNVIC_SYSTICK_PRI				( ( ( uint32_t ) configKERNEL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY ) << 24UL )
+
+/* Constants required to check the validity of an interrupt priority. */
+#define portFIRST_USER_INTERRUPT_NUMBER		( 16 )
+#define portNVIC_IP_REGISTERS_OFFSET_16 	( 0xE000E3F0 )
+#define portAIRCR_REG						( * ( ( volatile uint32_t * ) 0xE000ED0C ) )
+#define portMAX_8_BIT_VALUE					( ( uint8_t ) 0xff )
+#define portTOP_BIT_OF_BYTE					( ( uint8_t ) 0x80 )
+#define portMAX_PRIGROUP_BITS				( ( uint8_t ) 7 )
+#define portPRIORITY_GROUP_MASK				( 0x07UL << 8UL )
+#define portPRIGROUP_SHIFT					( 8UL )
+
+/* Masks off all bits but the VECTACTIVE bits in the ICSR register. */
+#define portVECTACTIVE_MASK					( 0xFFUL )
+
+/* Constants required to manipulate the VFP. */
+#define portFPCCR							( ( volatile uint32_t * ) 0xe000ef34 ) /* Floating point context control register. */
+#define portASPEN_AND_LSPEN_BITS			( 0x3UL << 30UL )
+
+/* Constants required to set up the initial stack. */
+#define portINITIAL_XPSR					( 0x01000000 )
+#define portINITIAL_EXC_RETURN				( 0xfffffffd )
+
+/* The systick is a 24-bit counter. */
+#define portMAX_24_BIT_NUMBER				( 0xffffffUL )
+
+/* For strict compliance with the Cortex-M spec the task start address should
+have bit-0 clear, as it is loaded into the PC on exit from an ISR. */
+#define portSTART_ADDRESS_MASK		( ( StackType_t ) 0xfffffffeUL )
+
+/* A fiddle factor to estimate the number of SysTick counts that would have
+occurred while the SysTick counter is stopped during tickless idle
+calculations. */
+#define portMISSED_COUNTS_FACTOR			( 45UL )
+
+/* Let the user override the pre-loading of the initial LR with the address of
+prvTaskExitError() in case it messes up unwinding of the stack in the
+debugger. */
+#ifdef configTASK_RETURN_ADDRESS
+	#define portTASK_RETURN_ADDRESS	configTASK_RETURN_ADDRESS
+#else
+	#define portTASK_RETURN_ADDRESS	prvTaskExitError
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Setup the timer to generate the tick interrupts.  The implementation in this
+ * file is weak to allow application writers to change the timer used to
+ * generate the tick interrupt.
+ */
+void vPortSetupTimerInterrupt( void );
+
+/*
+ * Exception handlers.
+ */
+void xPortPendSVHandler( void ) __attribute__ (( naked ));
+void xPortSysTickHandler( void );
+void vPortSVCHandler( void ) __attribute__ (( naked ));
+
+/*
+ * Start first task is a separate function so it can be tested in isolation.
+ */
+static void prvPortStartFirstTask( void ) __attribute__ (( naked ));
+
+/*
+ * Function to enable the VFP.
+ */
+static void vPortEnableVFP( void ) __attribute__ (( naked ));
+
+/*
+ * Used to catch tasks that attempt to return from their implementing function.
+ */
+static void prvTaskExitError( void );
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* Each task maintains its own interrupt status in the critical nesting
+variable. */
+static UBaseType_t uxCriticalNesting = 0xaaaaaaaa;
+
+/*
+ * The number of SysTick increments that make up one tick period.
+ */
+#if( configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE == 1 )
+	static uint32_t ulTimerCountsForOneTick = 0;
+#endif /* configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE */
+
+/*
+ * The maximum number of tick periods that can be suppressed is limited by the
+ * 24 bit resolution of the SysTick timer.
+ */
+#if( configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE == 1 )
+	static uint32_t xMaximumPossibleSuppressedTicks = 0;
+#endif /* configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE */
+
+/*
+ * Compensate for the CPU cycles that pass while the SysTick is stopped (low
+ * power functionality only.
+ */
+#if( configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE == 1 )
+	static uint32_t ulStoppedTimerCompensation = 0;
+#endif /* configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE */
+
+/*
+ * Used by the portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID() macro to ensure
+ * FreeRTOS API functions are not called from interrupts that have been assigned
+ * a priority above configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY.
+ */
+#if( configASSERT_DEFINED == 1 )
+	 static uint8_t ucMaxSysCallPriority = 0;
+	 static uint32_t ulMaxPRIGROUPValue = 0;
+	 static const volatile uint8_t * const pcInterruptPriorityRegisters = ( const volatile uint8_t * const ) portNVIC_IP_REGISTERS_OFFSET_16;
+#endif /* configASSERT_DEFINED */
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/*
+ * See header file for description.
+ */
+StackType_t *pxPortInitialiseStack( StackType_t *pxTopOfStack, TaskFunction_t pxCode, void *pvParameters )
+{
+	/* Simulate the stack frame as it would be created by a context switch
+	interrupt. */
+
+	/* Offset added to account for the way the MCU uses the stack on entry/exit
+	of interrupts, and to ensure alignment. */
+	pxTopOfStack--;
+
+	*pxTopOfStack = portINITIAL_XPSR;	/* xPSR */
+	pxTopOfStack--;
+	*pxTopOfStack = ( ( StackType_t ) pxCode ) & portSTART_ADDRESS_MASK;	/* PC */
+	pxTopOfStack--;
+	*pxTopOfStack = ( StackType_t ) portTASK_RETURN_ADDRESS;	/* LR */
+
+	/* Save code space by skipping register initialisation. */
+	pxTopOfStack -= 5;	/* R12, R3, R2 and R1. */
+	*pxTopOfStack = ( StackType_t ) pvParameters;	/* R0 */
+
+	/* A save method is being used that requires each task to maintain its
+	own exec return value. */
+	pxTopOfStack--;
+	*pxTopOfStack = portINITIAL_EXC_RETURN;
+
+	pxTopOfStack -= 8;	/* R11, R10, R9, R8, R7, R6, R5 and R4. */
+
+	return pxTopOfStack;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvTaskExitError( void )
+{
+volatile uint32_t ulDummy = 0;
+
+	/* A function that implements a task must not exit or attempt to return to
+	its caller as there is nothing to return to.  If a task wants to exit it
+	should instead call vTaskDelete( NULL ).
+
+	Artificially force an assert() to be triggered if configASSERT() is
+	defined, then stop here so application writers can catch the error. */
+	configASSERT( uxCriticalNesting == ~0UL );
+	portDISABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+	while( ulDummy == 0 )
+	{
+		/* This file calls prvTaskExitError() after the scheduler has been
+		started to remove a compiler warning about the function being defined
+		but never called.  ulDummy is used purely to quieten other warnings
+		about code appearing after this function is called - making ulDummy
+		volatile makes the compiler think the function could return and
+		therefore not output an 'unreachable code' warning for code that appears
+		after it. */
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vPortSVCHandler( void )
+{
+	__asm volatile (
+					"	ldr	r3, pxCurrentTCBConst2		\n" /* Restore the context. */
+					"	ldr r1, [r3]					\n" /* Use pxCurrentTCBConst to get the pxCurrentTCB address. */
+					"	ldr r0, [r1]					\n" /* The first item in pxCurrentTCB is the task top of stack. */
+					"	ldmia r0!, {r4-r11, r14}		\n" /* Pop the registers that are not automatically saved on exception entry and the critical nesting count. */
+					"	msr psp, r0						\n" /* Restore the task stack pointer. */
+					"	isb								\n"
+					"	mov r0, #0 						\n"
+					"	msr	basepri, r0					\n"
+					"	bx r14							\n"
+					"									\n"
+					"	.align 4						\n"
+					"pxCurrentTCBConst2: .word pxCurrentTCB				\n"
+				);
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvPortStartFirstTask( void )
+{
+	/* Start the first task.  This also clears the bit that indicates the FPU is
+	in use in case the FPU was used before the scheduler was started - which
+	would otherwise result in the unnecessary leaving of space in the SVC stack
+	for lazy saving of FPU registers. */
+	__asm volatile(
+					" ldr r0, =0xE000ED08 	\n" /* Use the NVIC offset register to locate the stack. */
+					" ldr r0, [r0] 			\n"
+					" ldr r0, [r0] 			\n"
+					" msr msp, r0			\n" /* Set the msp back to the start of the stack. */
+					" mov r0, #0			\n" /* Clear the bit that indicates the FPU is in use, see comment above. */
+					" msr control, r0		\n"
+					" cpsie i				\n" /* Globally enable interrupts. */
+					" cpsie f				\n"
+					" dsb					\n"
+					" isb					\n"
+					" svc 0					\n" /* System call to start first task. */
+					" nop					\n"
+				);
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/*
+ * See header file for description.
+ */
+BaseType_t xPortStartScheduler( void )
+{
+	/* configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY must not be set to 0.
+	See http://www.FreeRTOS.org/RTOS-Cortex-M3-M4.html */
+	configASSERT( configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY );
+
+	/* This port can be used on all revisions of the Cortex-M7 core other than
+	the r0p1 parts.  r0p1 parts should use the port from the
+	/source/portable/GCC/ARM_CM7/r0p1 directory. */
+	configASSERT( portCPUID != portCORTEX_M7_r0p1_ID );
+	configASSERT( portCPUID != portCORTEX_M7_r0p0_ID );
+
+	#if( configASSERT_DEFINED == 1 )
+	{
+		volatile uint32_t ulOriginalPriority;
+		volatile uint8_t * const pucFirstUserPriorityRegister = ( volatile uint8_t * const ) ( portNVIC_IP_REGISTERS_OFFSET_16 + portFIRST_USER_INTERRUPT_NUMBER );
+		volatile uint8_t ucMaxPriorityValue;
+
+		/* Determine the maximum priority from which ISR safe FreeRTOS API
+		functions can be called.  ISR safe functions are those that end in
+		"FromISR".  FreeRTOS maintains separate thread and ISR API functions to
+		ensure interrupt entry is as fast and simple as possible.
+
+		Save the interrupt priority value that is about to be clobbered. */
+		ulOriginalPriority = *pucFirstUserPriorityRegister;
+
+		/* Determine the number of priority bits available.  First write to all
+		possible bits. */
+		*pucFirstUserPriorityRegister = portMAX_8_BIT_VALUE;
+
+		/* Read the value back to see how many bits stuck. */
+		ucMaxPriorityValue = *pucFirstUserPriorityRegister;
+
+		/* Use the same mask on the maximum system call priority. */
+		ucMaxSysCallPriority = configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY & ucMaxPriorityValue;
+
+		/* Calculate the maximum acceptable priority group value for the number
+		of bits read back. */
+		ulMaxPRIGROUPValue = portMAX_PRIGROUP_BITS;
+		while( ( ucMaxPriorityValue & portTOP_BIT_OF_BYTE ) == portTOP_BIT_OF_BYTE )
+		{
+			ulMaxPRIGROUPValue--;
+			ucMaxPriorityValue <<= ( uint8_t ) 0x01;
+		}
+
+		#ifdef __NVIC_PRIO_BITS
+		{
+			/* Check the CMSIS configuration that defines the number of
+			priority bits matches the number of priority bits actually queried
+			from the hardware. */
+			configASSERT( ( portMAX_PRIGROUP_BITS - ulMaxPRIGROUPValue ) == __NVIC_PRIO_BITS );
+		}
+		#endif
+
+		#ifdef configPRIO_BITS
+		{
+			/* Check the FreeRTOS configuration that defines the number of
+			priority bits matches the number of priority bits actually queried
+			from the hardware. */
+			configASSERT( ( portMAX_PRIGROUP_BITS - ulMaxPRIGROUPValue ) == configPRIO_BITS );
+		}
+		#endif
+
+		/* Shift the priority group value back to its position within the AIRCR
+		register. */
+		ulMaxPRIGROUPValue <<= portPRIGROUP_SHIFT;
+		ulMaxPRIGROUPValue &= portPRIORITY_GROUP_MASK;
+
+		/* Restore the clobbered interrupt priority register to its original
+		value. */
+		*pucFirstUserPriorityRegister = ulOriginalPriority;
+	}
+	#endif /* conifgASSERT_DEFINED */
+
+	/* Make PendSV and SysTick the lowest priority interrupts. */
+	portNVIC_SYSPRI2_REG |= portNVIC_PENDSV_PRI;
+	portNVIC_SYSPRI2_REG |= portNVIC_SYSTICK_PRI;
+
+	/* Start the timer that generates the tick ISR.  Interrupts are disabled
+	here already. */
+	vPortSetupTimerInterrupt();
+
+	/* Initialise the critical nesting count ready for the first task. */
+	uxCriticalNesting = 0;
+
+	/* Ensure the VFP is enabled - it should be anyway. */
+	vPortEnableVFP();
+
+	/* Lazy save always. */
+	*( portFPCCR ) |= portASPEN_AND_LSPEN_BITS;
+
+	/* Start the first task. */
+	prvPortStartFirstTask();
+
+	/* Should never get here as the tasks will now be executing!  Call the task
+	exit error function to prevent compiler warnings about a static function
+	not being called in the case that the application writer overrides this
+	functionality by defining configTASK_RETURN_ADDRESS.  Call
+	vTaskSwitchContext() so link time optimisation does not remove the
+	symbol. */
+	vTaskSwitchContext();
+	prvTaskExitError();
+
+	/* Should not get here! */
+	return 0;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vPortEndScheduler( void )
+{
+	/* Not implemented in ports where there is nothing to return to.
+	Artificially force an assert. */
+	configASSERT( uxCriticalNesting == 1000UL );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vPortEnterCritical( void )
+{
+	portDISABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+	uxCriticalNesting++;
+
+	/* This is not the interrupt safe version of the enter critical function so
+	assert() if it is being called from an interrupt context.  Only API
+	functions that end in "FromISR" can be used in an interrupt.  Only assert if
+	the critical nesting count is 1 to protect against recursive calls if the
+	assert function also uses a critical section. */
+	if( uxCriticalNesting == 1 )
+	{
+		configASSERT( ( portNVIC_INT_CTRL_REG & portVECTACTIVE_MASK ) == 0 );
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vPortExitCritical( void )
+{
+	configASSERT( uxCriticalNesting );
+	uxCriticalNesting--;
+	if( uxCriticalNesting == 0 )
+	{
+		portENABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void xPortPendSVHandler( void )
+{
+	/* This is a naked function. */
+
+	__asm volatile
+	(
+	"	mrs r0, psp							\n"
+	"	isb									\n"
+	"										\n"
+	"	ldr	r3, pxCurrentTCBConst			\n" /* Get the location of the current TCB. */
+	"	ldr	r2, [r3]						\n"
+	"										\n"
+	"	tst r14, #0x10						\n" /* Is the task using the FPU context?  If so, push high vfp registers. */
+	"	it eq								\n"
+	"	vstmdbeq r0!, {s16-s31}				\n"
+	"										\n"
+	"	stmdb r0!, {r4-r11, r14}			\n" /* Save the core registers. */
+	"	str r0, [r2]						\n" /* Save the new top of stack into the first member of the TCB. */
+	"										\n"
+	"	stmdb sp!, {r0, r3}					\n"
+	"	mov r0, %0 							\n"
+	"	msr basepri, r0						\n"
+	"	dsb									\n"
+	"	isb									\n"
+	"	bl vTaskSwitchContext				\n"
+	"	mov r0, #0							\n"
+	"	msr basepri, r0						\n"
+	"	ldmia sp!, {r0, r3}					\n"
+	"										\n"
+	"	ldr r1, [r3]						\n" /* The first item in pxCurrentTCB is the task top of stack. */
+	"	ldr r0, [r1]						\n"
+	"										\n"
+	"	ldmia r0!, {r4-r11, r14}			\n" /* Pop the core registers. */
+	"										\n"
+	"	tst r14, #0x10						\n" /* Is the task using the FPU context?  If so, pop the high vfp registers too. */
+	"	it eq								\n"
+	"	vldmiaeq r0!, {s16-s31}				\n"
+	"										\n"
+	"	msr psp, r0							\n"
+	"	isb									\n"
+	"										\n"
+	#ifdef WORKAROUND_PMU_CM001 /* XMC4000 specific errata workaround. */
+		#if WORKAROUND_PMU_CM001 == 1
+	"			push { r14 }				\n"
+	"			pop { pc }					\n"
+		#endif
+	#endif
+	"										\n"
+	"	bx r14								\n"
+	"										\n"
+	"	.align 4							\n"
+	"pxCurrentTCBConst: .word pxCurrentTCB	\n"
+	::"i"(configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY)
+	);
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void xPortSysTickHandler( void )
+{
+	/* The SysTick runs at the lowest interrupt priority, so when this interrupt
+	executes all interrupts must be unmasked.  There is therefore no need to
+	save and then restore the interrupt mask value as its value is already
+	known. */
+	portDISABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+	{
+		/* Increment the RTOS tick. */
+		if( xTaskIncrementTick() != pdFALSE )
+		{
+			/* A context switch is required.  Context switching is performed in
+			the PendSV interrupt.  Pend the PendSV interrupt. */
+			portNVIC_INT_CTRL_REG = portNVIC_PENDSVSET_BIT;
+		}
+	}
+	portENABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE == 1 )
+
+	__attribute__((weak)) void vPortSuppressTicksAndSleep( TickType_t xExpectedIdleTime )
+	{
+	uint32_t ulReloadValue, ulCompleteTickPeriods, ulCompletedSysTickDecrements;
+	TickType_t xModifiableIdleTime;
+
+		/* Make sure the SysTick reload value does not overflow the counter. */
+		if( xExpectedIdleTime > xMaximumPossibleSuppressedTicks )
+		{
+			xExpectedIdleTime = xMaximumPossibleSuppressedTicks;
+		}
+
+		/* Stop the SysTick momentarily.  The time the SysTick is stopped for
+		is accounted for as best it can be, but using the tickless mode will
+		inevitably result in some tiny drift of the time maintained by the
+		kernel with respect to calendar time. */
+		portNVIC_SYSTICK_CTRL_REG &= ~portNVIC_SYSTICK_ENABLE_BIT;
+
+		/* Calculate the reload value required to wait xExpectedIdleTime
+		tick periods.  -1 is used because this code will execute part way
+		through one of the tick periods. */
+		ulReloadValue = portNVIC_SYSTICK_CURRENT_VALUE_REG + ( ulTimerCountsForOneTick * ( xExpectedIdleTime - 1UL ) );
+		if( ulReloadValue > ulStoppedTimerCompensation )
+		{
+			ulReloadValue -= ulStoppedTimerCompensation;
+		}
+
+		/* Enter a critical section but don't use the taskENTER_CRITICAL()
+		method as that will mask interrupts that should exit sleep mode. */
+		__asm volatile( "cpsid i" ::: "memory" );
+		__asm volatile( "dsb" );
+		__asm volatile( "isb" );
+
+		/* If a context switch is pending or a task is waiting for the scheduler
+		to be unsuspended then abandon the low power entry. */
+		if( eTaskConfirmSleepModeStatus() == eAbortSleep )
+		{
+			/* Restart from whatever is left in the count register to complete
+			this tick period. */
+			portNVIC_SYSTICK_LOAD_REG = portNVIC_SYSTICK_CURRENT_VALUE_REG;
+
+			/* Restart SysTick. */
+			portNVIC_SYSTICK_CTRL_REG |= portNVIC_SYSTICK_ENABLE_BIT;
+
+			/* Reset the reload register to the value required for normal tick
+			periods. */
+			portNVIC_SYSTICK_LOAD_REG = ulTimerCountsForOneTick - 1UL;
+
+			/* Re-enable interrupts - see comments above the cpsid instruction()
+			above. */
+			__asm volatile( "cpsie i" ::: "memory" );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			/* Set the new reload value. */
+			portNVIC_SYSTICK_LOAD_REG = ulReloadValue;
+
+			/* Clear the SysTick count flag and set the count value back to
+			zero. */
+			portNVIC_SYSTICK_CURRENT_VALUE_REG = 0UL;
+
+			/* Restart SysTick. */
+			portNVIC_SYSTICK_CTRL_REG |= portNVIC_SYSTICK_ENABLE_BIT;
+
+			/* Sleep until something happens.  configPRE_SLEEP_PROCESSING() can
+			set its parameter to 0 to indicate that its implementation contains
+			its own wait for interrupt or wait for event instruction, and so wfi
+			should not be executed again.  However, the original expected idle
+			time variable must remain unmodified, so a copy is taken. */
+			xModifiableIdleTime = xExpectedIdleTime;
+			configPRE_SLEEP_PROCESSING( xModifiableIdleTime );
+			if( xModifiableIdleTime > 0 )
+			{
+				__asm volatile( "dsb" ::: "memory" );
+				__asm volatile( "wfi" );
+				__asm volatile( "isb" );
+			}
+			configPOST_SLEEP_PROCESSING( xExpectedIdleTime );
+
+			/* Re-enable interrupts to allow the interrupt that brought the MCU
+			out of sleep mode to execute immediately.  see comments above
+			__disable_interrupt() call above. */
+			__asm volatile( "cpsie i" ::: "memory" );
+			__asm volatile( "dsb" );
+			__asm volatile( "isb" );
+
+			/* Disable interrupts again because the clock is about to be stopped
+			and interrupts that execute while the clock is stopped will increase
+			any slippage between the time maintained by the RTOS and calendar
+			time. */
+			__asm volatile( "cpsid i" ::: "memory" );
+			__asm volatile( "dsb" );
+			__asm volatile( "isb" );
+
+			/* Disable the SysTick clock without reading the
+			portNVIC_SYSTICK_CTRL_REG register to ensure the
+			portNVIC_SYSTICK_COUNT_FLAG_BIT is not cleared if it is set.  Again,
+			the time the SysTick is stopped for is accounted for as best it can
+			be, but using the tickless mode will inevitably result in some tiny
+			drift of the time maintained by the kernel with respect to calendar
+			time*/
+			portNVIC_SYSTICK_CTRL_REG = ( portNVIC_SYSTICK_CLK_BIT | portNVIC_SYSTICK_INT_BIT );
+
+			/* Determine if the SysTick clock has already counted to zero and
+			been set back to the current reload value (the reload back being
+			correct for the entire expected idle time) or if the SysTick is yet
+			to count to zero (in which case an interrupt other than the SysTick
+			must have brought the system out of sleep mode). */
+			if( ( portNVIC_SYSTICK_CTRL_REG & portNVIC_SYSTICK_COUNT_FLAG_BIT ) != 0 )
+			{
+				uint32_t ulCalculatedLoadValue;
+
+				/* The tick interrupt is already pending, and the SysTick count
+				reloaded with ulReloadValue.  Reset the
+				portNVIC_SYSTICK_LOAD_REG with whatever remains of this tick
+				period. */
+				ulCalculatedLoadValue = ( ulTimerCountsForOneTick - 1UL ) - ( ulReloadValue - portNVIC_SYSTICK_CURRENT_VALUE_REG );
+
+				/* Don't allow a tiny value, or values that have somehow
+				underflowed because the post sleep hook did something
+				that took too long. */
+				if( ( ulCalculatedLoadValue < ulStoppedTimerCompensation ) || ( ulCalculatedLoadValue > ulTimerCountsForOneTick ) )
+				{
+					ulCalculatedLoadValue = ( ulTimerCountsForOneTick - 1UL );
+				}
+
+				portNVIC_SYSTICK_LOAD_REG = ulCalculatedLoadValue;
+
+				/* As the pending tick will be processed as soon as this
+				function exits, the tick value maintained by the tick is stepped
+				forward by one less than the time spent waiting. */
+				ulCompleteTickPeriods = xExpectedIdleTime - 1UL;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				/* Something other than the tick interrupt ended the sleep.
+				Work out how long the sleep lasted rounded to complete tick
+				periods (not the ulReload value which accounted for part
+				ticks). */
+				ulCompletedSysTickDecrements = ( xExpectedIdleTime * ulTimerCountsForOneTick ) - portNVIC_SYSTICK_CURRENT_VALUE_REG;
+
+				/* How many complete tick periods passed while the processor
+				was waiting? */
+				ulCompleteTickPeriods = ulCompletedSysTickDecrements / ulTimerCountsForOneTick;
+
+				/* The reload value is set to whatever fraction of a single tick
+				period remains. */
+				portNVIC_SYSTICK_LOAD_REG = ( ( ulCompleteTickPeriods + 1UL ) * ulTimerCountsForOneTick ) - ulCompletedSysTickDecrements;
+			}
+
+			/* Restart SysTick so it runs from portNVIC_SYSTICK_LOAD_REG
+			again, then set portNVIC_SYSTICK_LOAD_REG back to its standard
+			value. */
+			portNVIC_SYSTICK_CURRENT_VALUE_REG = 0UL;
+			portNVIC_SYSTICK_CTRL_REG |= portNVIC_SYSTICK_ENABLE_BIT;
+			vTaskStepTick( ulCompleteTickPeriods );
+			portNVIC_SYSTICK_LOAD_REG = ulTimerCountsForOneTick - 1UL;
+
+			/* Exit with interrupts enabled. */
+			__asm volatile( "cpsie i" ::: "memory" );
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* #if configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/*
+ * Setup the systick timer to generate the tick interrupts at the required
+ * frequency.
+ */
+__attribute__(( weak )) void vPortSetupTimerInterrupt( void )
+{
+	/* Calculate the constants required to configure the tick interrupt. */
+	#if( configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE == 1 )
+	{
+		ulTimerCountsForOneTick = ( configSYSTICK_CLOCK_HZ / configTICK_RATE_HZ );
+		xMaximumPossibleSuppressedTicks = portMAX_24_BIT_NUMBER / ulTimerCountsForOneTick;
+		ulStoppedTimerCompensation = portMISSED_COUNTS_FACTOR / ( configCPU_CLOCK_HZ / configSYSTICK_CLOCK_HZ );
+	}
+	#endif /* configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE */
+
+	/* Stop and clear the SysTick. */
+	portNVIC_SYSTICK_CTRL_REG = 0UL;
+	portNVIC_SYSTICK_CURRENT_VALUE_REG = 0UL;
+
+	/* Configure SysTick to interrupt at the requested rate. */
+	portNVIC_SYSTICK_LOAD_REG = ( configSYSTICK_CLOCK_HZ / configTICK_RATE_HZ ) - 1UL;
+	portNVIC_SYSTICK_CTRL_REG = ( portNVIC_SYSTICK_CLK_BIT | portNVIC_SYSTICK_INT_BIT | portNVIC_SYSTICK_ENABLE_BIT );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* This is a naked function. */
+static void vPortEnableVFP( void )
+{
+	__asm volatile
+	(
+		"	ldr.w r0, =0xE000ED88		\n" /* The FPU enable bits are in the CPACR. */
+		"	ldr r1, [r0]				\n"
+		"								\n"
+		"	orr r1, r1, #( 0xf << 20 )	\n" /* Enable CP10 and CP11 coprocessors, then save back. */
+		"	str r1, [r0]				\n"
+		"	bx r14						"
+	);
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configASSERT_DEFINED == 1 )
+
+	void vPortValidateInterruptPriority( void )
+	{
+	uint32_t ulCurrentInterrupt;
+	uint8_t ucCurrentPriority;
+
+		/* Obtain the number of the currently executing interrupt. */
+		__asm volatile( "mrs %0, ipsr" : "=r"( ulCurrentInterrupt ) :: "memory" );
+
+		/* Is the interrupt number a user defined interrupt? */
+		if( ulCurrentInterrupt >= portFIRST_USER_INTERRUPT_NUMBER )
+		{
+			/* Look up the interrupt's priority. */
+			ucCurrentPriority = pcInterruptPriorityRegisters[ ulCurrentInterrupt ];
+
+			/* The following assertion will fail if a service routine (ISR) for
+			an interrupt that has been assigned a priority above
+			configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY calls an ISR safe FreeRTOS API
+			function.  ISR safe FreeRTOS API functions must *only* be called
+			from interrupts that have been assigned a priority at or below
+			configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY.
+
+			Numerically low interrupt priority numbers represent logically high
+			interrupt priorities, therefore the priority of the interrupt must
+			be set to a value equal to or numerically *higher* than
+			configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY.
+
+			Interrupts that	use the FreeRTOS API must not be left at their
+			default priority of	zero as that is the highest possible priority,
+			which is guaranteed to be above configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY,
+			and	therefore also guaranteed to be invalid.
+
+			FreeRTOS maintains separate thread and ISR API functions to ensure
+			interrupt entry is as fast and simple as possible.
+
+			The following links provide detailed information:
+			http://www.freertos.org/RTOS-Cortex-M3-M4.html
+			http://www.freertos.org/FAQHelp.html */
+			configASSERT( ucCurrentPriority >= ucMaxSysCallPriority );
+		}
+
+		/* Priority grouping:  The interrupt controller (NVIC) allows the bits
+		that define each interrupt's priority to be split between bits that
+		define the interrupt's pre-emption priority bits and bits that define
+		the interrupt's sub-priority.  For simplicity all bits must be defined
+		to be pre-emption priority bits.  The following assertion will fail if
+		this is not the case (if some bits represent a sub-priority).
+
+		If the application only uses CMSIS libraries for interrupt
+		configuration then the correct setting can be achieved on all Cortex-M
+		devices by calling NVIC_SetPriorityGrouping( 0 ); before starting the
+		scheduler.  Note however that some vendor specific peripheral libraries
+		assume a non-zero priority group setting, in which cases using a value
+		of zero will result in unpredictable behaviour. */
+		configASSERT( ( portAIRCR_REG & portPRIORITY_GROUP_MASK ) <= ulMaxPRIGROUPValue );
+	}
+
+#endif /* configASSERT_DEFINED */
+
+
Index: ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/portable/GCC/ARM_CM4F/portmacro.h
===================================================================
--- ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/portable/GCC/ARM_CM4F/portmacro.h	(revision 73)
+++ ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/portable/GCC/ARM_CM4F/portmacro.h	(revision 73)
@@ -0,0 +1,243 @@
+/*
+ * FreeRTOS Kernel V10.3.1
+ * Copyright (C) 2020 Amazon.com, Inc. or its affiliates.  All Rights Reserved.
+ *
+ * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of
+ * this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in
+ * the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to
+ * use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of
+ * the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so,
+ * subject to the following conditions:
+ *
+ * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all
+ * copies or substantial portions of the Software.
+ *
+ * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
+ * IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS
+ * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR
+ * COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
+ * IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
+ * CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
+ *
+ * http://www.FreeRTOS.org
+ * http://aws.amazon.com/freertos
+ *
+ * 1 tab == 4 spaces!
+ */
+
+
+#ifndef PORTMACRO_H
+#define PORTMACRO_H
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------
+ * Port specific definitions.
+ *
+ * The settings in this file configure FreeRTOS correctly for the
+ * given hardware and compiler.
+ *
+ * These settings should not be altered.
+ *-----------------------------------------------------------
+ */
+
+/* Type definitions. */
+#define portCHAR		char
+#define portFLOAT		float
+#define portDOUBLE		double
+#define portLONG		long
+#define portSHORT		short
+#define portSTACK_TYPE	uint32_t
+#define portBASE_TYPE	long
+
+typedef portSTACK_TYPE StackType_t;
+typedef long BaseType_t;
+typedef unsigned long UBaseType_t;
+
+#if( configUSE_16_BIT_TICKS == 1 )
+	typedef uint16_t TickType_t;
+	#define portMAX_DELAY ( TickType_t ) 0xffff
+#else
+	typedef uint32_t TickType_t;
+	#define portMAX_DELAY ( TickType_t ) 0xffffffffUL
+
+	/* 32-bit tick type on a 32-bit architecture, so reads of the tick count do
+	not need to be guarded with a critical section. */
+	#define portTICK_TYPE_IS_ATOMIC 1
+#endif
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* Architecture specifics. */
+#define portSTACK_GROWTH			( -1 )
+#define portTICK_PERIOD_MS			( ( TickType_t ) 1000 / configTICK_RATE_HZ )
+#define portBYTE_ALIGNMENT			8
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* Scheduler utilities. */
+#define portYIELD() 															\
+{																				\
+	/* Set a PendSV to request a context switch. */								\
+	portNVIC_INT_CTRL_REG = portNVIC_PENDSVSET_BIT;								\
+																				\
+	/* Barriers are normally not required but do ensure the code is completely	\
+	within the specified behaviour for the architecture. */						\
+	__asm volatile( "dsb" ::: "memory" );										\
+	__asm volatile( "isb" );													\
+}
+
+#define portNVIC_INT_CTRL_REG		( * ( ( volatile uint32_t * ) 0xe000ed04 ) )
+#define portNVIC_PENDSVSET_BIT		( 1UL << 28UL )
+#define portEND_SWITCHING_ISR( xSwitchRequired ) if( xSwitchRequired != pdFALSE ) portYIELD()
+#define portYIELD_FROM_ISR( x ) portEND_SWITCHING_ISR( x )
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* Critical section management. */
+extern void vPortEnterCritical( void );
+extern void vPortExitCritical( void );
+#define portSET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR()		ulPortRaiseBASEPRI()
+#define portCLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR(x)	vPortSetBASEPRI(x)
+#define portDISABLE_INTERRUPTS()				vPortRaiseBASEPRI()
+#define portENABLE_INTERRUPTS()					vPortSetBASEPRI(0)
+#define portENTER_CRITICAL()					vPortEnterCritical()
+#define portEXIT_CRITICAL()						vPortExitCritical()
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* Task function macros as described on the FreeRTOS.org WEB site.  These are
+not necessary for to use this port.  They are defined so the common demo files
+(which build with all the ports) will build. */
+#define portTASK_FUNCTION_PROTO( vFunction, pvParameters ) void vFunction( void *pvParameters )
+#define portTASK_FUNCTION( vFunction, pvParameters ) void vFunction( void *pvParameters )
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* Tickless idle/low power functionality. */
+#ifndef portSUPPRESS_TICKS_AND_SLEEP
+	extern void vPortSuppressTicksAndSleep( TickType_t xExpectedIdleTime );
+	#define portSUPPRESS_TICKS_AND_SLEEP( xExpectedIdleTime ) vPortSuppressTicksAndSleep( xExpectedIdleTime )
+#endif
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* Architecture specific optimisations. */
+#ifndef configUSE_PORT_OPTIMISED_TASK_SELECTION
+	#define configUSE_PORT_OPTIMISED_TASK_SELECTION 1
+#endif
+
+#if configUSE_PORT_OPTIMISED_TASK_SELECTION == 1
+
+	/* Generic helper function. */
+	__attribute__( ( always_inline ) ) static inline uint8_t ucPortCountLeadingZeros( uint32_t ulBitmap )
+	{
+	uint8_t ucReturn;
+
+		__asm volatile ( "clz %0, %1" : "=r" ( ucReturn ) : "r" ( ulBitmap ) : "memory" );
+		return ucReturn;
+	}
+
+	/* Check the configuration. */
+	#if( configMAX_PRIORITIES > 32 )
+		#error configUSE_PORT_OPTIMISED_TASK_SELECTION can only be set to 1 when configMAX_PRIORITIES is less than or equal to 32.  It is very rare that a system requires more than 10 to 15 difference priorities as tasks that share a priority will time slice.
+	#endif
+
+	/* Store/clear the ready priorities in a bit map. */
+	#define portRECORD_READY_PRIORITY( uxPriority, uxReadyPriorities ) ( uxReadyPriorities ) |= ( 1UL << ( uxPriority ) )
+	#define portRESET_READY_PRIORITY( uxPriority, uxReadyPriorities ) ( uxReadyPriorities ) &= ~( 1UL << ( uxPriority ) )
+
+	/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+	#define portGET_HIGHEST_PRIORITY( uxTopPriority, uxReadyPriorities ) uxTopPriority = ( 31UL - ( uint32_t ) ucPortCountLeadingZeros( ( uxReadyPriorities ) ) )
+
+#endif /* configUSE_PORT_OPTIMISED_TASK_SELECTION */
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#ifdef configASSERT
+	void vPortValidateInterruptPriority( void );
+	#define portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID() 	vPortValidateInterruptPriority()
+#endif
+
+/* portNOP() is not required by this port. */
+#define portNOP()
+
+#define portINLINE	__inline
+
+#ifndef portFORCE_INLINE
+	#define portFORCE_INLINE inline __attribute__(( always_inline))
+#endif
+
+portFORCE_INLINE static BaseType_t xPortIsInsideInterrupt( void )
+{
+uint32_t ulCurrentInterrupt;
+BaseType_t xReturn;
+
+	/* Obtain the number of the currently executing interrupt. */
+	__asm volatile( "mrs %0, ipsr" : "=r"( ulCurrentInterrupt ) :: "memory" );
+
+	if( ulCurrentInterrupt == 0 )
+	{
+		xReturn = pdFALSE;
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		xReturn = pdTRUE;
+	}
+
+	return xReturn;
+}
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+portFORCE_INLINE static void vPortRaiseBASEPRI( void )
+{
+uint32_t ulNewBASEPRI;
+
+	__asm volatile
+	(
+		"	mov %0, %1												\n"	\
+		"	msr basepri, %0											\n" \
+		"	isb														\n" \
+		"	dsb														\n" \
+		:"=r" (ulNewBASEPRI) : "i" ( configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY ) : "memory"
+	);
+}
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+portFORCE_INLINE static uint32_t ulPortRaiseBASEPRI( void )
+{
+uint32_t ulOriginalBASEPRI, ulNewBASEPRI;
+
+	__asm volatile
+	(
+		"	mrs %0, basepri											\n" \
+		"	mov %1, %2												\n"	\
+		"	msr basepri, %1											\n" \
+		"	isb														\n" \
+		"	dsb														\n" \
+		:"=r" (ulOriginalBASEPRI), "=r" (ulNewBASEPRI) : "i" ( configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY ) : "memory"
+	);
+
+	/* This return will not be reached but is necessary to prevent compiler
+	warnings. */
+	return ulOriginalBASEPRI;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+portFORCE_INLINE static void vPortSetBASEPRI( uint32_t ulNewMaskValue )
+{
+	__asm volatile
+	(
+		"	msr basepri, %0	" :: "r" ( ulNewMaskValue ) : "memory"
+	);
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#define portMEMORY_BARRIER() __asm volatile( "" ::: "memory" )
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif /* PORTMACRO_H */
+
Index: ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/portable/MemMang/heap_4.c
===================================================================
--- ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/portable/MemMang/heap_4.c	(revision 73)
+++ ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/portable/MemMang/heap_4.c	(revision 73)
@@ -0,0 +1,492 @@
+/*
+ * FreeRTOS Kernel V10.3.1
+ * Copyright (C) 2020 Amazon.com, Inc. or its affiliates.  All Rights Reserved.
+ *
+ * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of
+ * this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in
+ * the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to
+ * use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of
+ * the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so,
+ * subject to the following conditions:
+ *
+ * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all
+ * copies or substantial portions of the Software.
+ *
+ * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
+ * IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS
+ * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR
+ * COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
+ * IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
+ * CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
+ *
+ * http://www.FreeRTOS.org
+ * http://aws.amazon.com/freertos
+ *
+ * 1 tab == 4 spaces!
+ */
+
+/*
+ * A sample implementation of pvPortMalloc() and vPortFree() that combines
+ * (coalescences) adjacent memory blocks as they are freed, and in so doing
+ * limits memory fragmentation.
+ *
+ * See heap_1.c, heap_2.c and heap_3.c for alternative implementations, and the
+ * memory management pages of http://www.FreeRTOS.org for more information.
+ */
+#include <stdlib.h>
+
+/* Defining MPU_WRAPPERS_INCLUDED_FROM_API_FILE prevents task.h from redefining
+all the API functions to use the MPU wrappers.  That should only be done when
+task.h is included from an application file. */
+#define MPU_WRAPPERS_INCLUDED_FROM_API_FILE
+
+#include "FreeRTOS.h"
+#include "task.h"
+
+#undef MPU_WRAPPERS_INCLUDED_FROM_API_FILE
+
+#if( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 0 )
+	#error This file must not be used if configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION is 0
+#endif
+
+/* Block sizes must not get too small. */
+#define heapMINIMUM_BLOCK_SIZE	( ( size_t ) ( xHeapStructSize << 1 ) )
+
+/* Assumes 8bit bytes! */
+#define heapBITS_PER_BYTE		( ( size_t ) 8 )
+
+/* Allocate the memory for the heap. */
+#if( configAPPLICATION_ALLOCATED_HEAP == 1 )
+	/* The application writer has already defined the array used for the RTOS
+	heap - probably so it can be placed in a special segment or address. */
+	extern uint8_t ucHeap[ configTOTAL_HEAP_SIZE ];
+#else
+	static uint8_t ucHeap[ configTOTAL_HEAP_SIZE ];
+#endif /* configAPPLICATION_ALLOCATED_HEAP */
+
+/* Define the linked list structure.  This is used to link free blocks in order
+of their memory address. */
+typedef struct A_BLOCK_LINK
+{
+	struct A_BLOCK_LINK *pxNextFreeBlock;	/*<< The next free block in the list. */
+	size_t xBlockSize;						/*<< The size of the free block. */
+} BlockLink_t;
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/*
+ * Inserts a block of memory that is being freed into the correct position in
+ * the list of free memory blocks.  The block being freed will be merged with
+ * the block in front it and/or the block behind it if the memory blocks are
+ * adjacent to each other.
+ */
+static void prvInsertBlockIntoFreeList( BlockLink_t *pxBlockToInsert );
+
+/*
+ * Called automatically to setup the required heap structures the first time
+ * pvPortMalloc() is called.
+ */
+static void prvHeapInit( void );
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* The size of the structure placed at the beginning of each allocated memory
+block must by correctly byte aligned. */
+static const size_t xHeapStructSize	= ( sizeof( BlockLink_t ) + ( ( size_t ) ( portBYTE_ALIGNMENT - 1 ) ) ) & ~( ( size_t ) portBYTE_ALIGNMENT_MASK );
+
+/* Create a couple of list links to mark the start and end of the list. */
+static BlockLink_t xStart, *pxEnd = NULL;
+
+/* Keeps track of the number of calls to allocate and free memory as well as the
+number of free bytes remaining, but says nothing about fragmentation. */
+static size_t xFreeBytesRemaining = 0U;
+static size_t xMinimumEverFreeBytesRemaining = 0U;
+static size_t xNumberOfSuccessfulAllocations = 0;
+static size_t xNumberOfSuccessfulFrees = 0;
+
+/* Gets set to the top bit of an size_t type.  When this bit in the xBlockSize
+member of an BlockLink_t structure is set then the block belongs to the
+application.  When the bit is free the block is still part of the free heap
+space. */
+static size_t xBlockAllocatedBit = 0;
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void *pvPortMalloc( size_t xWantedSize )
+{
+BlockLink_t *pxBlock, *pxPreviousBlock, *pxNewBlockLink;
+void *pvReturn = NULL;
+
+	vTaskSuspendAll();
+	{
+		/* If this is the first call to malloc then the heap will require
+		initialisation to setup the list of free blocks. */
+		if( pxEnd == NULL )
+		{
+			prvHeapInit();
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		/* Check the requested block size is not so large that the top bit is
+		set.  The top bit of the block size member of the BlockLink_t structure
+		is used to determine who owns the block - the application or the
+		kernel, so it must be free. */
+		if( ( xWantedSize & xBlockAllocatedBit ) == 0 )
+		{
+			/* The wanted size is increased so it can contain a BlockLink_t
+			structure in addition to the requested amount of bytes. */
+			if( xWantedSize > 0 )
+			{
+				xWantedSize += xHeapStructSize;
+
+				/* Ensure that blocks are always aligned to the required number
+				of bytes. */
+				if( ( xWantedSize & portBYTE_ALIGNMENT_MASK ) != 0x00 )
+				{
+					/* Byte alignment required. */
+					xWantedSize += ( portBYTE_ALIGNMENT - ( xWantedSize & portBYTE_ALIGNMENT_MASK ) );
+					configASSERT( ( xWantedSize & portBYTE_ALIGNMENT_MASK ) == 0 );
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+
+			if( ( xWantedSize > 0 ) && ( xWantedSize <= xFreeBytesRemaining ) )
+			{
+				/* Traverse the list from the start	(lowest address) block until
+				one	of adequate size is found. */
+				pxPreviousBlock = &xStart;
+				pxBlock = xStart.pxNextFreeBlock;
+				while( ( pxBlock->xBlockSize < xWantedSize ) && ( pxBlock->pxNextFreeBlock != NULL ) )
+				{
+					pxPreviousBlock = pxBlock;
+					pxBlock = pxBlock->pxNextFreeBlock;
+				}
+
+				/* If the end marker was reached then a block of adequate size
+				was	not found. */
+				if( pxBlock != pxEnd )
+				{
+					/* Return the memory space pointed to - jumping over the
+					BlockLink_t structure at its start. */
+					pvReturn = ( void * ) ( ( ( uint8_t * ) pxPreviousBlock->pxNextFreeBlock ) + xHeapStructSize );
+
+					/* This block is being returned for use so must be taken out
+					of the list of free blocks. */
+					pxPreviousBlock->pxNextFreeBlock = pxBlock->pxNextFreeBlock;
+
+					/* If the block is larger than required it can be split into
+					two. */
+					if( ( pxBlock->xBlockSize - xWantedSize ) > heapMINIMUM_BLOCK_SIZE )
+					{
+						/* This block is to be split into two.  Create a new
+						block following the number of bytes requested. The void
+						cast is used to prevent byte alignment warnings from the
+						compiler. */
+						pxNewBlockLink = ( void * ) ( ( ( uint8_t * ) pxBlock ) + xWantedSize );
+						configASSERT( ( ( ( size_t ) pxNewBlockLink ) & portBYTE_ALIGNMENT_MASK ) == 0 );
+
+						/* Calculate the sizes of two blocks split from the
+						single block. */
+						pxNewBlockLink->xBlockSize = pxBlock->xBlockSize - xWantedSize;
+						pxBlock->xBlockSize = xWantedSize;
+
+						/* Insert the new block into the list of free blocks. */
+						prvInsertBlockIntoFreeList( pxNewBlockLink );
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+
+					xFreeBytesRemaining -= pxBlock->xBlockSize;
+
+					if( xFreeBytesRemaining < xMinimumEverFreeBytesRemaining )
+					{
+						xMinimumEverFreeBytesRemaining = xFreeBytesRemaining;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+
+					/* The block is being returned - it is allocated and owned
+					by the application and has no "next" block. */
+					pxBlock->xBlockSize |= xBlockAllocatedBit;
+					pxBlock->pxNextFreeBlock = NULL;
+					xNumberOfSuccessfulAllocations++;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		traceMALLOC( pvReturn, xWantedSize );
+	}
+	( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+
+	#if( configUSE_MALLOC_FAILED_HOOK == 1 )
+	{
+		if( pvReturn == NULL )
+		{
+			extern void vApplicationMallocFailedHook( void );
+			vApplicationMallocFailedHook();
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+	#endif
+
+	configASSERT( ( ( ( size_t ) pvReturn ) & ( size_t ) portBYTE_ALIGNMENT_MASK ) == 0 );
+	return pvReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vPortFree( void *pv )
+{
+uint8_t *puc = ( uint8_t * ) pv;
+BlockLink_t *pxLink;
+
+	if( pv != NULL )
+	{
+		/* The memory being freed will have an BlockLink_t structure immediately
+		before it. */
+		puc -= xHeapStructSize;
+
+		/* This casting is to keep the compiler from issuing warnings. */
+		pxLink = ( void * ) puc;
+
+		/* Check the block is actually allocated. */
+		configASSERT( ( pxLink->xBlockSize & xBlockAllocatedBit ) != 0 );
+		configASSERT( pxLink->pxNextFreeBlock == NULL );
+
+		if( ( pxLink->xBlockSize & xBlockAllocatedBit ) != 0 )
+		{
+			if( pxLink->pxNextFreeBlock == NULL )
+			{
+				/* The block is being returned to the heap - it is no longer
+				allocated. */
+				pxLink->xBlockSize &= ~xBlockAllocatedBit;
+
+				vTaskSuspendAll();
+				{
+					/* Add this block to the list of free blocks. */
+					xFreeBytesRemaining += pxLink->xBlockSize;
+					traceFREE( pv, pxLink->xBlockSize );
+					prvInsertBlockIntoFreeList( ( ( BlockLink_t * ) pxLink ) );
+					xNumberOfSuccessfulFrees++;
+				}
+				( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+size_t xPortGetFreeHeapSize( void )
+{
+	return xFreeBytesRemaining;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+size_t xPortGetMinimumEverFreeHeapSize( void )
+{
+	return xMinimumEverFreeBytesRemaining;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vPortInitialiseBlocks( void )
+{
+	/* This just exists to keep the linker quiet. */
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvHeapInit( void )
+{
+BlockLink_t *pxFirstFreeBlock;
+uint8_t *pucAlignedHeap;
+size_t uxAddress;
+size_t xTotalHeapSize = configTOTAL_HEAP_SIZE;
+
+	/* Ensure the heap starts on a correctly aligned boundary. */
+	uxAddress = ( size_t ) ucHeap;
+
+	if( ( uxAddress & portBYTE_ALIGNMENT_MASK ) != 0 )
+	{
+		uxAddress += ( portBYTE_ALIGNMENT - 1 );
+		uxAddress &= ~( ( size_t ) portBYTE_ALIGNMENT_MASK );
+		xTotalHeapSize -= uxAddress - ( size_t ) ucHeap;
+	}
+
+	pucAlignedHeap = ( uint8_t * ) uxAddress;
+
+	/* xStart is used to hold a pointer to the first item in the list of free
+	blocks.  The void cast is used to prevent compiler warnings. */
+	xStart.pxNextFreeBlock = ( void * ) pucAlignedHeap;
+	xStart.xBlockSize = ( size_t ) 0;
+
+	/* pxEnd is used to mark the end of the list of free blocks and is inserted
+	at the end of the heap space. */
+	uxAddress = ( ( size_t ) pucAlignedHeap ) + xTotalHeapSize;
+	uxAddress -= xHeapStructSize;
+	uxAddress &= ~( ( size_t ) portBYTE_ALIGNMENT_MASK );
+	pxEnd = ( void * ) uxAddress;
+	pxEnd->xBlockSize = 0;
+	pxEnd->pxNextFreeBlock = NULL;
+
+	/* To start with there is a single free block that is sized to take up the
+	entire heap space, minus the space taken by pxEnd. */
+	pxFirstFreeBlock = ( void * ) pucAlignedHeap;
+	pxFirstFreeBlock->xBlockSize = uxAddress - ( size_t ) pxFirstFreeBlock;
+	pxFirstFreeBlock->pxNextFreeBlock = pxEnd;
+
+	/* Only one block exists - and it covers the entire usable heap space. */
+	xMinimumEverFreeBytesRemaining = pxFirstFreeBlock->xBlockSize;
+	xFreeBytesRemaining = pxFirstFreeBlock->xBlockSize;
+
+	/* Work out the position of the top bit in a size_t variable. */
+	xBlockAllocatedBit = ( ( size_t ) 1 ) << ( ( sizeof( size_t ) * heapBITS_PER_BYTE ) - 1 );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvInsertBlockIntoFreeList( BlockLink_t *pxBlockToInsert )
+{
+BlockLink_t *pxIterator;
+uint8_t *puc;
+
+	/* Iterate through the list until a block is found that has a higher address
+	than the block being inserted. */
+	for( pxIterator = &xStart; pxIterator->pxNextFreeBlock < pxBlockToInsert; pxIterator = pxIterator->pxNextFreeBlock )
+	{
+		/* Nothing to do here, just iterate to the right position. */
+	}
+
+	/* Do the block being inserted, and the block it is being inserted after
+	make a contiguous block of memory? */
+	puc = ( uint8_t * ) pxIterator;
+	if( ( puc + pxIterator->xBlockSize ) == ( uint8_t * ) pxBlockToInsert )
+	{
+		pxIterator->xBlockSize += pxBlockToInsert->xBlockSize;
+		pxBlockToInsert = pxIterator;
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+	}
+
+	/* Do the block being inserted, and the block it is being inserted before
+	make a contiguous block of memory? */
+	puc = ( uint8_t * ) pxBlockToInsert;
+	if( ( puc + pxBlockToInsert->xBlockSize ) == ( uint8_t * ) pxIterator->pxNextFreeBlock )
+	{
+		if( pxIterator->pxNextFreeBlock != pxEnd )
+		{
+			/* Form one big block from the two blocks. */
+			pxBlockToInsert->xBlockSize += pxIterator->pxNextFreeBlock->xBlockSize;
+			pxBlockToInsert->pxNextFreeBlock = pxIterator->pxNextFreeBlock->pxNextFreeBlock;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			pxBlockToInsert->pxNextFreeBlock = pxEnd;
+		}
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		pxBlockToInsert->pxNextFreeBlock = pxIterator->pxNextFreeBlock;
+	}
+
+	/* If the block being inserted plugged a gab, so was merged with the block
+	before and the block after, then it's pxNextFreeBlock pointer will have
+	already been set, and should not be set here as that would make it point
+	to itself. */
+	if( pxIterator != pxBlockToInsert )
+	{
+		pxIterator->pxNextFreeBlock = pxBlockToInsert;
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vPortGetHeapStats( HeapStats_t *pxHeapStats )
+{
+BlockLink_t *pxBlock;
+size_t xBlocks = 0, xMaxSize = 0, xMinSize = portMAX_DELAY; /* portMAX_DELAY used as a portable way of getting the maximum value. */
+
+	vTaskSuspendAll();
+	{
+		pxBlock = xStart.pxNextFreeBlock;
+
+		/* pxBlock will be NULL if the heap has not been initialised.  The heap
+		is initialised automatically when the first allocation is made. */
+		if( pxBlock != NULL )
+		{
+			do
+			{
+				/* Increment the number of blocks and record the largest block seen
+				so far. */
+				xBlocks++;
+
+				if( pxBlock->xBlockSize > xMaxSize )
+				{
+					xMaxSize = pxBlock->xBlockSize;
+				}
+
+				if( pxBlock->xBlockSize < xMinSize )
+				{
+					xMinSize = pxBlock->xBlockSize;
+				}
+
+				/* Move to the next block in the chain until the last block is
+				reached. */
+				pxBlock = pxBlock->pxNextFreeBlock;
+			} while( pxBlock != pxEnd );
+		}
+	}
+	xTaskResumeAll();
+
+	pxHeapStats->xSizeOfLargestFreeBlockInBytes = xMaxSize;
+	pxHeapStats->xSizeOfSmallestFreeBlockInBytes = xMinSize;
+	pxHeapStats->xNumberOfFreeBlocks = xBlocks;
+
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		pxHeapStats->xAvailableHeapSpaceInBytes = xFreeBytesRemaining;
+		pxHeapStats->xNumberOfSuccessfulAllocations = xNumberOfSuccessfulAllocations;
+		pxHeapStats->xNumberOfSuccessfulFrees = xNumberOfSuccessfulFrees;
+		pxHeapStats->xMinimumEverFreeBytesRemaining = xMinimumEverFreeBytesRemaining;
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+}
+
Index: ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/queue.c
===================================================================
--- ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/queue.c	(revision 73)
+++ ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/queue.c	(revision 73)
@@ -0,0 +1,2945 @@
+/*
+ * FreeRTOS Kernel V10.3.1
+ * Copyright (C) 2020 Amazon.com, Inc. or its affiliates.  All Rights Reserved.
+ *
+ * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of
+ * this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in
+ * the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to
+ * use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of
+ * the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so,
+ * subject to the following conditions:
+ *
+ * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all
+ * copies or substantial portions of the Software.
+ *
+ * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
+ * IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS
+ * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR
+ * COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
+ * IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
+ * CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
+ *
+ * http://www.FreeRTOS.org
+ * http://aws.amazon.com/freertos
+ *
+ * 1 tab == 4 spaces!
+ */
+
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+/* Defining MPU_WRAPPERS_INCLUDED_FROM_API_FILE prevents task.h from redefining
+all the API functions to use the MPU wrappers.  That should only be done when
+task.h is included from an application file. */
+#define MPU_WRAPPERS_INCLUDED_FROM_API_FILE
+
+#include "FreeRTOS.h"
+#include "task.h"
+#include "queue.h"
+
+#if ( configUSE_CO_ROUTINES == 1 )
+	#include "croutine.h"
+#endif
+
+/* Lint e9021, e961 and e750 are suppressed as a MISRA exception justified
+because the MPU ports require MPU_WRAPPERS_INCLUDED_FROM_API_FILE to be defined
+for the header files above, but not in this file, in order to generate the
+correct privileged Vs unprivileged linkage and placement. */
+#undef MPU_WRAPPERS_INCLUDED_FROM_API_FILE /*lint !e961 !e750 !e9021. */
+
+
+/* Constants used with the cRxLock and cTxLock structure members. */
+#define queueUNLOCKED					( ( int8_t ) -1 )
+#define queueLOCKED_UNMODIFIED			( ( int8_t ) 0 )
+
+/* When the Queue_t structure is used to represent a base queue its pcHead and
+pcTail members are used as pointers into the queue storage area.  When the
+Queue_t structure is used to represent a mutex pcHead and pcTail pointers are
+not necessary, and the pcHead pointer is set to NULL to indicate that the
+structure instead holds a pointer to the mutex holder (if any).  Map alternative
+names to the pcHead and structure member to ensure the readability of the code
+is maintained.  The QueuePointers_t and SemaphoreData_t types are used to form
+a union as their usage is mutually exclusive dependent on what the queue is
+being used for. */
+#define uxQueueType						pcHead
+#define queueQUEUE_IS_MUTEX				NULL
+
+typedef struct QueuePointers
+{
+	int8_t *pcTail;					/*< Points to the byte at the end of the queue storage area.  Once more byte is allocated than necessary to store the queue items, this is used as a marker. */
+	int8_t *pcReadFrom;				/*< Points to the last place that a queued item was read from when the structure is used as a queue. */
+} QueuePointers_t;
+
+typedef struct SemaphoreData
+{
+	TaskHandle_t xMutexHolder;		 /*< The handle of the task that holds the mutex. */
+	UBaseType_t uxRecursiveCallCount;/*< Maintains a count of the number of times a recursive mutex has been recursively 'taken' when the structure is used as a mutex. */
+} SemaphoreData_t;
+
+/* Semaphores do not actually store or copy data, so have an item size of
+zero. */
+#define queueSEMAPHORE_QUEUE_ITEM_LENGTH ( ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+#define queueMUTEX_GIVE_BLOCK_TIME		 ( ( TickType_t ) 0U )
+
+#if( configUSE_PREEMPTION == 0 )
+	/* If the cooperative scheduler is being used then a yield should not be
+	performed just because a higher priority task has been woken. */
+	#define queueYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION()
+#else
+	#define queueYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION() portYIELD_WITHIN_API()
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Definition of the queue used by the scheduler.
+ * Items are queued by copy, not reference.  See the following link for the
+ * rationale: https://www.freertos.org/Embedded-RTOS-Queues.html
+ */
+typedef struct QueueDefinition 		/* The old naming convention is used to prevent breaking kernel aware debuggers. */
+{
+	int8_t *pcHead;					/*< Points to the beginning of the queue storage area. */
+	int8_t *pcWriteTo;				/*< Points to the free next place in the storage area. */
+
+	union
+	{
+		QueuePointers_t xQueue;		/*< Data required exclusively when this structure is used as a queue. */
+		SemaphoreData_t xSemaphore; /*< Data required exclusively when this structure is used as a semaphore. */
+	} u;
+
+	List_t xTasksWaitingToSend;		/*< List of tasks that are blocked waiting to post onto this queue.  Stored in priority order. */
+	List_t xTasksWaitingToReceive;	/*< List of tasks that are blocked waiting to read from this queue.  Stored in priority order. */
+
+	volatile UBaseType_t uxMessagesWaiting;/*< The number of items currently in the queue. */
+	UBaseType_t uxLength;			/*< The length of the queue defined as the number of items it will hold, not the number of bytes. */
+	UBaseType_t uxItemSize;			/*< The size of each items that the queue will hold. */
+
+	volatile int8_t cRxLock;		/*< Stores the number of items received from the queue (removed from the queue) while the queue was locked.  Set to queueUNLOCKED when the queue is not locked. */
+	volatile int8_t cTxLock;		/*< Stores the number of items transmitted to the queue (added to the queue) while the queue was locked.  Set to queueUNLOCKED when the queue is not locked. */
+
+	#if( ( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) )
+		uint8_t ucStaticallyAllocated;	/*< Set to pdTRUE if the memory used by the queue was statically allocated to ensure no attempt is made to free the memory. */
+	#endif
+
+	#if ( configUSE_QUEUE_SETS == 1 )
+		struct QueueDefinition *pxQueueSetContainer;
+	#endif
+
+	#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+		UBaseType_t uxQueueNumber;
+		uint8_t ucQueueType;
+	#endif
+
+} xQUEUE;
+
+/* The old xQUEUE name is maintained above then typedefed to the new Queue_t
+name below to enable the use of older kernel aware debuggers. */
+typedef xQUEUE Queue_t;
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/*
+ * The queue registry is just a means for kernel aware debuggers to locate
+ * queue structures.  It has no other purpose so is an optional component.
+ */
+#if ( configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE > 0 )
+
+	/* The type stored within the queue registry array.  This allows a name
+	to be assigned to each queue making kernel aware debugging a little
+	more user friendly. */
+	typedef struct QUEUE_REGISTRY_ITEM
+	{
+		const char *pcQueueName; /*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+		QueueHandle_t xHandle;
+	} xQueueRegistryItem;
+
+	/* The old xQueueRegistryItem name is maintained above then typedefed to the
+	new xQueueRegistryItem name below to enable the use of older kernel aware
+	debuggers. */
+	typedef xQueueRegistryItem QueueRegistryItem_t;
+
+	/* The queue registry is simply an array of QueueRegistryItem_t structures.
+	The pcQueueName member of a structure being NULL is indicative of the
+	array position being vacant. */
+	PRIVILEGED_DATA QueueRegistryItem_t xQueueRegistry[ configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE ];
+
+#endif /* configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE */
+
+/*
+ * Unlocks a queue locked by a call to prvLockQueue.  Locking a queue does not
+ * prevent an ISR from adding or removing items to the queue, but does prevent
+ * an ISR from removing tasks from the queue event lists.  If an ISR finds a
+ * queue is locked it will instead increment the appropriate queue lock count
+ * to indicate that a task may require unblocking.  When the queue in unlocked
+ * these lock counts are inspected, and the appropriate action taken.
+ */
+static void prvUnlockQueue( Queue_t * const pxQueue ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * Uses a critical section to determine if there is any data in a queue.
+ *
+ * @return pdTRUE if the queue contains no items, otherwise pdFALSE.
+ */
+static BaseType_t prvIsQueueEmpty( const Queue_t *pxQueue ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * Uses a critical section to determine if there is any space in a queue.
+ *
+ * @return pdTRUE if there is no space, otherwise pdFALSE;
+ */
+static BaseType_t prvIsQueueFull( const Queue_t *pxQueue ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * Copies an item into the queue, either at the front of the queue or the
+ * back of the queue.
+ */
+static BaseType_t prvCopyDataToQueue( Queue_t * const pxQueue, const void *pvItemToQueue, const BaseType_t xPosition ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * Copies an item out of a queue.
+ */
+static void prvCopyDataFromQueue( Queue_t * const pxQueue, void * const pvBuffer ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+#if ( configUSE_QUEUE_SETS == 1 )
+	/*
+	 * Checks to see if a queue is a member of a queue set, and if so, notifies
+	 * the queue set that the queue contains data.
+	 */
+	static BaseType_t prvNotifyQueueSetContainer( const Queue_t * const pxQueue ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Called after a Queue_t structure has been allocated either statically or
+ * dynamically to fill in the structure's members.
+ */
+static void prvInitialiseNewQueue( const UBaseType_t uxQueueLength, const UBaseType_t uxItemSize, uint8_t *pucQueueStorage, const uint8_t ucQueueType, Queue_t *pxNewQueue ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * Mutexes are a special type of queue.  When a mutex is created, first the
+ * queue is created, then prvInitialiseMutex() is called to configure the queue
+ * as a mutex.
+ */
+#if( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+	static void prvInitialiseMutex( Queue_t *pxNewQueue ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+#endif
+
+#if( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+	/*
+	 * If a task waiting for a mutex causes the mutex holder to inherit a
+	 * priority, but the waiting task times out, then the holder should
+	 * disinherit the priority - but only down to the highest priority of any
+	 * other tasks that are waiting for the same mutex.  This function returns
+	 * that priority.
+	 */
+	static UBaseType_t prvGetDisinheritPriorityAfterTimeout( const Queue_t * const pxQueue ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+#endif
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/*
+ * Macro to mark a queue as locked.  Locking a queue prevents an ISR from
+ * accessing the queue event lists.
+ */
+#define prvLockQueue( pxQueue )								\
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();									\
+	{														\
+		if( ( pxQueue )->cRxLock == queueUNLOCKED )			\
+		{													\
+			( pxQueue )->cRxLock = queueLOCKED_UNMODIFIED;	\
+		}													\
+		if( ( pxQueue )->cTxLock == queueUNLOCKED )			\
+		{													\
+			( pxQueue )->cTxLock = queueLOCKED_UNMODIFIED;	\
+		}													\
+	}														\
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL()
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xQueueGenericReset( QueueHandle_t xQueue, BaseType_t xNewQueue )
+{
+Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+	configASSERT( pxQueue );
+
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcTail = pxQueue->pcHead + ( pxQueue->uxLength * pxQueue->uxItemSize ); /*lint !e9016 Pointer arithmetic allowed on char types, especially when it assists conveying intent. */
+		pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting = ( UBaseType_t ) 0U;
+		pxQueue->pcWriteTo = pxQueue->pcHead;
+		pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom = pxQueue->pcHead + ( ( pxQueue->uxLength - 1U ) * pxQueue->uxItemSize ); /*lint !e9016 Pointer arithmetic allowed on char types, especially when it assists conveying intent. */
+		pxQueue->cRxLock = queueUNLOCKED;
+		pxQueue->cTxLock = queueUNLOCKED;
+
+		if( xNewQueue == pdFALSE )
+		{
+			/* If there are tasks blocked waiting to read from the queue, then
+			the tasks will remain blocked as after this function exits the queue
+			will still be empty.  If there are tasks blocked waiting to write to
+			the queue, then one should be unblocked as after this function exits
+			it will be possible to write to it. */
+			if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) ) == pdFALSE )
+			{
+				if( xTaskRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) ) != pdFALSE )
+				{
+					queueYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION();
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			/* Ensure the event queues start in the correct state. */
+			vListInitialise( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) );
+			vListInitialise( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) );
+		}
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+	/* A value is returned for calling semantic consistency with previous
+	versions. */
+	return pdPASS;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 )
+
+	QueueHandle_t xQueueGenericCreateStatic( const UBaseType_t uxQueueLength, const UBaseType_t uxItemSize, uint8_t *pucQueueStorage, StaticQueue_t *pxStaticQueue, const uint8_t ucQueueType )
+	{
+	Queue_t *pxNewQueue;
+
+		configASSERT( uxQueueLength > ( UBaseType_t ) 0 );
+
+		/* The StaticQueue_t structure and the queue storage area must be
+		supplied. */
+		configASSERT( pxStaticQueue != NULL );
+
+		/* A queue storage area should be provided if the item size is not 0, and
+		should not be provided if the item size is 0. */
+		configASSERT( !( ( pucQueueStorage != NULL ) && ( uxItemSize == 0 ) ) );
+		configASSERT( !( ( pucQueueStorage == NULL ) && ( uxItemSize != 0 ) ) );
+
+		#if( configASSERT_DEFINED == 1 )
+		{
+			/* Sanity check that the size of the structure used to declare a
+			variable of type StaticQueue_t or StaticSemaphore_t equals the size of
+			the real queue and semaphore structures. */
+			volatile size_t xSize = sizeof( StaticQueue_t );
+			configASSERT( xSize == sizeof( Queue_t ) );
+			( void ) xSize; /* Keeps lint quiet when configASSERT() is not defined. */
+		}
+		#endif /* configASSERT_DEFINED */
+
+		/* The address of a statically allocated queue was passed in, use it.
+		The address of a statically allocated storage area was also passed in
+		but is already set. */
+		pxNewQueue = ( Queue_t * ) pxStaticQueue; /*lint !e740 !e9087 Unusual cast is ok as the structures are designed to have the same alignment, and the size is checked by an assert. */
+
+		if( pxNewQueue != NULL )
+		{
+			#if( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 )
+			{
+				/* Queues can be allocated wither statically or dynamically, so
+				note this queue was allocated statically in case the queue is
+				later deleted. */
+				pxNewQueue->ucStaticallyAllocated = pdTRUE;
+			}
+			#endif /* configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION */
+
+			prvInitialiseNewQueue( uxQueueLength, uxItemSize, pucQueueStorage, ucQueueType, pxNewQueue );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			traceQUEUE_CREATE_FAILED( ucQueueType );
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		return pxNewQueue;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 )
+
+	QueueHandle_t xQueueGenericCreate( const UBaseType_t uxQueueLength, const UBaseType_t uxItemSize, const uint8_t ucQueueType )
+	{
+	Queue_t *pxNewQueue;
+	size_t xQueueSizeInBytes;
+	uint8_t *pucQueueStorage;
+
+		configASSERT( uxQueueLength > ( UBaseType_t ) 0 );
+
+		/* Allocate enough space to hold the maximum number of items that
+		can be in the queue at any time.  It is valid for uxItemSize to be
+		zero in the case the queue is used as a semaphore. */
+		xQueueSizeInBytes = ( size_t ) ( uxQueueLength * uxItemSize ); /*lint !e961 MISRA exception as the casts are only redundant for some ports. */
+
+		/* Allocate the queue and storage area.  Justification for MISRA
+		deviation as follows:  pvPortMalloc() always ensures returned memory
+		blocks are aligned per the requirements of the MCU stack.  In this case
+		pvPortMalloc() must return a pointer that is guaranteed to meet the
+		alignment requirements of the Queue_t structure - which in this case
+		is an int8_t *.  Therefore, whenever the stack alignment requirements
+		are greater than or equal to the pointer to char requirements the cast
+		is safe.  In other cases alignment requirements are not strict (one or
+		two bytes). */
+		pxNewQueue = ( Queue_t * ) pvPortMalloc( sizeof( Queue_t ) + xQueueSizeInBytes ); /*lint !e9087 !e9079 see comment above. */
+
+		if( pxNewQueue != NULL )
+		{
+			/* Jump past the queue structure to find the location of the queue
+			storage area. */
+			pucQueueStorage = ( uint8_t * ) pxNewQueue;
+			pucQueueStorage += sizeof( Queue_t ); /*lint !e9016 Pointer arithmetic allowed on char types, especially when it assists conveying intent. */
+
+			#if( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 )
+			{
+				/* Queues can be created either statically or dynamically, so
+				note this task was created dynamically in case it is later
+				deleted. */
+				pxNewQueue->ucStaticallyAllocated = pdFALSE;
+			}
+			#endif /* configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION */
+
+			prvInitialiseNewQueue( uxQueueLength, uxItemSize, pucQueueStorage, ucQueueType, pxNewQueue );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			traceQUEUE_CREATE_FAILED( ucQueueType );
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		return pxNewQueue;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvInitialiseNewQueue( const UBaseType_t uxQueueLength, const UBaseType_t uxItemSize, uint8_t *pucQueueStorage, const uint8_t ucQueueType, Queue_t *pxNewQueue )
+{
+	/* Remove compiler warnings about unused parameters should
+	configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY not be set to 1. */
+	( void ) ucQueueType;
+
+	if( uxItemSize == ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+	{
+		/* No RAM was allocated for the queue storage area, but PC head cannot
+		be set to NULL because NULL is used as a key to say the queue is used as
+		a mutex.  Therefore just set pcHead to point to the queue as a benign
+		value that is known to be within the memory map. */
+		pxNewQueue->pcHead = ( int8_t * ) pxNewQueue;
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		/* Set the head to the start of the queue storage area. */
+		pxNewQueue->pcHead = ( int8_t * ) pucQueueStorage;
+	}
+
+	/* Initialise the queue members as described where the queue type is
+	defined. */
+	pxNewQueue->uxLength = uxQueueLength;
+	pxNewQueue->uxItemSize = uxItemSize;
+	( void ) xQueueGenericReset( pxNewQueue, pdTRUE );
+
+	#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+	{
+		pxNewQueue->ucQueueType = ucQueueType;
+	}
+	#endif /* configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY */
+
+	#if( configUSE_QUEUE_SETS == 1 )
+	{
+		pxNewQueue->pxQueueSetContainer = NULL;
+	}
+	#endif /* configUSE_QUEUE_SETS */
+
+	traceQUEUE_CREATE( pxNewQueue );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+
+	static void prvInitialiseMutex( Queue_t *pxNewQueue )
+	{
+		if( pxNewQueue != NULL )
+		{
+			/* The queue create function will set all the queue structure members
+			correctly for a generic queue, but this function is creating a
+			mutex.  Overwrite those members that need to be set differently -
+			in particular the information required for priority inheritance. */
+			pxNewQueue->u.xSemaphore.xMutexHolder = NULL;
+			pxNewQueue->uxQueueType = queueQUEUE_IS_MUTEX;
+
+			/* In case this is a recursive mutex. */
+			pxNewQueue->u.xSemaphore.uxRecursiveCallCount = 0;
+
+			traceCREATE_MUTEX( pxNewQueue );
+
+			/* Start with the semaphore in the expected state. */
+			( void ) xQueueGenericSend( pxNewQueue, NULL, ( TickType_t ) 0U, queueSEND_TO_BACK );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			traceCREATE_MUTEX_FAILED();
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_MUTEXES */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) )
+
+	QueueHandle_t xQueueCreateMutex( const uint8_t ucQueueType )
+	{
+	QueueHandle_t xNewQueue;
+	const UBaseType_t uxMutexLength = ( UBaseType_t ) 1, uxMutexSize = ( UBaseType_t ) 0;
+
+		xNewQueue = xQueueGenericCreate( uxMutexLength, uxMutexSize, ucQueueType );
+		prvInitialiseMutex( ( Queue_t * ) xNewQueue );
+
+		return xNewQueue;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_MUTEXES */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) )
+
+	QueueHandle_t xQueueCreateMutexStatic( const uint8_t ucQueueType, StaticQueue_t *pxStaticQueue )
+	{
+	QueueHandle_t xNewQueue;
+	const UBaseType_t uxMutexLength = ( UBaseType_t ) 1, uxMutexSize = ( UBaseType_t ) 0;
+
+		/* Prevent compiler warnings about unused parameters if
+		configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY does not equal 1. */
+		( void ) ucQueueType;
+
+		xNewQueue = xQueueGenericCreateStatic( uxMutexLength, uxMutexSize, NULL, pxStaticQueue, ucQueueType );
+		prvInitialiseMutex( ( Queue_t * ) xNewQueue );
+
+		return xNewQueue;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_MUTEXES */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 ) && ( INCLUDE_xSemaphoreGetMutexHolder == 1 ) )
+
+	TaskHandle_t xQueueGetMutexHolder( QueueHandle_t xSemaphore )
+	{
+	TaskHandle_t pxReturn;
+	Queue_t * const pxSemaphore = ( Queue_t * ) xSemaphore;
+
+		/* This function is called by xSemaphoreGetMutexHolder(), and should not
+		be called directly.  Note:  This is a good way of determining if the
+		calling task is the mutex holder, but not a good way of determining the
+		identity of the mutex holder, as the holder may change between the
+		following critical section exiting and the function returning. */
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			if( pxSemaphore->uxQueueType == queueQUEUE_IS_MUTEX )
+			{
+				pxReturn = pxSemaphore->u.xSemaphore.xMutexHolder;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				pxReturn = NULL;
+			}
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		return pxReturn;
+	} /*lint !e818 xSemaphore cannot be a pointer to const because it is a typedef. */
+
+#endif
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 ) && ( INCLUDE_xSemaphoreGetMutexHolder == 1 ) )
+
+	TaskHandle_t xQueueGetMutexHolderFromISR( QueueHandle_t xSemaphore )
+	{
+	TaskHandle_t pxReturn;
+
+		configASSERT( xSemaphore );
+
+		/* Mutexes cannot be used in interrupt service routines, so the mutex
+		holder should not change in an ISR, and therefore a critical section is
+		not required here. */
+		if( ( ( Queue_t * ) xSemaphore )->uxQueueType == queueQUEUE_IS_MUTEX )
+		{
+			pxReturn = ( ( Queue_t * ) xSemaphore )->u.xSemaphore.xMutexHolder;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			pxReturn = NULL;
+		}
+
+		return pxReturn;
+	} /*lint !e818 xSemaphore cannot be a pointer to const because it is a typedef. */
+
+#endif
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_RECURSIVE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xQueueGiveMutexRecursive( QueueHandle_t xMutex )
+	{
+	BaseType_t xReturn;
+	Queue_t * const pxMutex = ( Queue_t * ) xMutex;
+
+		configASSERT( pxMutex );
+
+		/* If this is the task that holds the mutex then xMutexHolder will not
+		change outside of this task.  If this task does not hold the mutex then
+		pxMutexHolder can never coincidentally equal the tasks handle, and as
+		this is the only condition we are interested in it does not matter if
+		pxMutexHolder is accessed simultaneously by another task.  Therefore no
+		mutual exclusion is required to test the pxMutexHolder variable. */
+		if( pxMutex->u.xSemaphore.xMutexHolder == xTaskGetCurrentTaskHandle() )
+		{
+			traceGIVE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE( pxMutex );
+
+			/* uxRecursiveCallCount cannot be zero if xMutexHolder is equal to
+			the task handle, therefore no underflow check is required.  Also,
+			uxRecursiveCallCount is only modified by the mutex holder, and as
+			there can only be one, no mutual exclusion is required to modify the
+			uxRecursiveCallCount member. */
+			( pxMutex->u.xSemaphore.uxRecursiveCallCount )--;
+
+			/* Has the recursive call count unwound to 0? */
+			if( pxMutex->u.xSemaphore.uxRecursiveCallCount == ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+			{
+				/* Return the mutex.  This will automatically unblock any other
+				task that might be waiting to access the mutex. */
+				( void ) xQueueGenericSend( pxMutex, NULL, queueMUTEX_GIVE_BLOCK_TIME, queueSEND_TO_BACK );
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+
+			xReturn = pdPASS;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			/* The mutex cannot be given because the calling task is not the
+			holder. */
+			xReturn = pdFAIL;
+
+			traceGIVE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE_FAILED( pxMutex );
+		}
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_RECURSIVE_MUTEXES */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_RECURSIVE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xQueueTakeMutexRecursive( QueueHandle_t xMutex, TickType_t xTicksToWait )
+	{
+	BaseType_t xReturn;
+	Queue_t * const pxMutex = ( Queue_t * ) xMutex;
+
+		configASSERT( pxMutex );
+
+		/* Comments regarding mutual exclusion as per those within
+		xQueueGiveMutexRecursive(). */
+
+		traceTAKE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE( pxMutex );
+
+		if( pxMutex->u.xSemaphore.xMutexHolder == xTaskGetCurrentTaskHandle() )
+		{
+			( pxMutex->u.xSemaphore.uxRecursiveCallCount )++;
+			xReturn = pdPASS;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xReturn = xQueueSemaphoreTake( pxMutex, xTicksToWait );
+
+			/* pdPASS will only be returned if the mutex was successfully
+			obtained.  The calling task may have entered the Blocked state
+			before reaching here. */
+			if( xReturn != pdFAIL )
+			{
+				( pxMutex->u.xSemaphore.uxRecursiveCallCount )++;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				traceTAKE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE_FAILED( pxMutex );
+			}
+		}
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_RECURSIVE_MUTEXES */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( ( configUSE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORES == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) )
+
+	QueueHandle_t xQueueCreateCountingSemaphoreStatic( const UBaseType_t uxMaxCount, const UBaseType_t uxInitialCount, StaticQueue_t *pxStaticQueue )
+	{
+	QueueHandle_t xHandle;
+
+		configASSERT( uxMaxCount != 0 );
+		configASSERT( uxInitialCount <= uxMaxCount );
+
+		xHandle = xQueueGenericCreateStatic( uxMaxCount, queueSEMAPHORE_QUEUE_ITEM_LENGTH, NULL, pxStaticQueue, queueQUEUE_TYPE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORE );
+
+		if( xHandle != NULL )
+		{
+			( ( Queue_t * ) xHandle )->uxMessagesWaiting = uxInitialCount;
+
+			traceCREATE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORE();
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			traceCREATE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORE_FAILED();
+		}
+
+		return xHandle;
+	}
+
+#endif /* ( ( configUSE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORES == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) ) */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( ( configUSE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORES == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) )
+
+	QueueHandle_t xQueueCreateCountingSemaphore( const UBaseType_t uxMaxCount, const UBaseType_t uxInitialCount )
+	{
+	QueueHandle_t xHandle;
+
+		configASSERT( uxMaxCount != 0 );
+		configASSERT( uxInitialCount <= uxMaxCount );
+
+		xHandle = xQueueGenericCreate( uxMaxCount, queueSEMAPHORE_QUEUE_ITEM_LENGTH, queueQUEUE_TYPE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORE );
+
+		if( xHandle != NULL )
+		{
+			( ( Queue_t * ) xHandle )->uxMessagesWaiting = uxInitialCount;
+
+			traceCREATE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORE();
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			traceCREATE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORE_FAILED();
+		}
+
+		return xHandle;
+	}
+
+#endif /* ( ( configUSE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORES == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) ) */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xQueueGenericSend( QueueHandle_t xQueue, const void * const pvItemToQueue, TickType_t xTicksToWait, const BaseType_t xCopyPosition )
+{
+BaseType_t xEntryTimeSet = pdFALSE, xYieldRequired;
+TimeOut_t xTimeOut;
+Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+	configASSERT( pxQueue );
+	configASSERT( !( ( pvItemToQueue == NULL ) && ( pxQueue->uxItemSize != ( UBaseType_t ) 0U ) ) );
+	configASSERT( !( ( xCopyPosition == queueOVERWRITE ) && ( pxQueue->uxLength != 1 ) ) );
+	#if ( ( INCLUDE_xTaskGetSchedulerState == 1 ) || ( configUSE_TIMERS == 1 ) )
+	{
+		configASSERT( !( ( xTaskGetSchedulerState() == taskSCHEDULER_SUSPENDED ) && ( xTicksToWait != 0 ) ) );
+	}
+	#endif
+
+
+	/*lint -save -e904 This function relaxes the coding standard somewhat to
+	allow return statements within the function itself.  This is done in the
+	interest of execution time efficiency. */
+	for( ;; )
+	{
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			/* Is there room on the queue now?  The running task must be the
+			highest priority task wanting to access the queue.  If the head item
+			in the queue is to be overwritten then it does not matter if the
+			queue is full. */
+			if( ( pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting < pxQueue->uxLength ) || ( xCopyPosition == queueOVERWRITE ) )
+			{
+				traceQUEUE_SEND( pxQueue );
+
+				#if ( configUSE_QUEUE_SETS == 1 )
+				{
+				const UBaseType_t uxPreviousMessagesWaiting = pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting;
+
+					xYieldRequired = prvCopyDataToQueue( pxQueue, pvItemToQueue, xCopyPosition );
+
+					if( pxQueue->pxQueueSetContainer != NULL )
+					{
+						if( ( xCopyPosition == queueOVERWRITE ) && ( uxPreviousMessagesWaiting != ( UBaseType_t ) 0 ) )
+						{
+							/* Do not notify the queue set as an existing item
+							was overwritten in the queue so the number of items
+							in the queue has not changed. */
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+						else if( prvNotifyQueueSetContainer( pxQueue ) != pdFALSE )
+						{
+							/* The queue is a member of a queue set, and posting
+							to the queue set caused a higher priority task to
+							unblock. A context switch is required. */
+							queueYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION();
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						/* If there was a task waiting for data to arrive on the
+						queue then unblock it now. */
+						if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) == pdFALSE )
+						{
+							if( xTaskRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) != pdFALSE )
+							{
+								/* The unblocked task has a priority higher than
+								our own so yield immediately.  Yes it is ok to
+								do this from within the critical section - the
+								kernel takes care of that. */
+								queueYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION();
+							}
+							else
+							{
+								mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+							}
+						}
+						else if( xYieldRequired != pdFALSE )
+						{
+							/* This path is a special case that will only get
+							executed if the task was holding multiple mutexes
+							and the mutexes were given back in an order that is
+							different to that in which they were taken. */
+							queueYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION();
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+					}
+				}
+				#else /* configUSE_QUEUE_SETS */
+				{
+					xYieldRequired = prvCopyDataToQueue( pxQueue, pvItemToQueue, xCopyPosition );
+
+					/* If there was a task waiting for data to arrive on the
+					queue then unblock it now. */
+					if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) == pdFALSE )
+					{
+						if( xTaskRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) != pdFALSE )
+						{
+							/* The unblocked task has a priority higher than
+							our own so yield immediately.  Yes it is ok to do
+							this from within the critical section - the kernel
+							takes care of that. */
+							queueYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION();
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+					}
+					else if( xYieldRequired != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						/* This path is a special case that will only get
+						executed if the task was holding multiple mutexes and
+						the mutexes were given back in an order that is
+						different to that in which they were taken. */
+						queueYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION();
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				#endif /* configUSE_QUEUE_SETS */
+
+				taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+				return pdPASS;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				if( xTicksToWait == ( TickType_t ) 0 )
+				{
+					/* The queue was full and no block time is specified (or
+					the block time has expired) so leave now. */
+					taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+					/* Return to the original privilege level before exiting
+					the function. */
+					traceQUEUE_SEND_FAILED( pxQueue );
+					return errQUEUE_FULL;
+				}
+				else if( xEntryTimeSet == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					/* The queue was full and a block time was specified so
+					configure the timeout structure. */
+					vTaskInternalSetTimeOutState( &xTimeOut );
+					xEntryTimeSet = pdTRUE;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* Entry time was already set. */
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		/* Interrupts and other tasks can send to and receive from the queue
+		now the critical section has been exited. */
+
+		vTaskSuspendAll();
+		prvLockQueue( pxQueue );
+
+		/* Update the timeout state to see if it has expired yet. */
+		if( xTaskCheckForTimeOut( &xTimeOut, &xTicksToWait ) == pdFALSE )
+		{
+			if( prvIsQueueFull( pxQueue ) != pdFALSE )
+			{
+				traceBLOCKING_ON_QUEUE_SEND( pxQueue );
+				vTaskPlaceOnEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ), xTicksToWait );
+
+				/* Unlocking the queue means queue events can effect the
+				event list.  It is possible that interrupts occurring now
+				remove this task from the event list again - but as the
+				scheduler is suspended the task will go onto the pending
+				ready last instead of the actual ready list. */
+				prvUnlockQueue( pxQueue );
+
+				/* Resuming the scheduler will move tasks from the pending
+				ready list into the ready list - so it is feasible that this
+				task is already in a ready list before it yields - in which
+				case the yield will not cause a context switch unless there
+				is also a higher priority task in the pending ready list. */
+				if( xTaskResumeAll() == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					portYIELD_WITHIN_API();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				/* Try again. */
+				prvUnlockQueue( pxQueue );
+				( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			/* The timeout has expired. */
+			prvUnlockQueue( pxQueue );
+			( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+
+			traceQUEUE_SEND_FAILED( pxQueue );
+			return errQUEUE_FULL;
+		}
+	} /*lint -restore */
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xQueueGenericSendFromISR( QueueHandle_t xQueue, const void * const pvItemToQueue, BaseType_t * const pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken, const BaseType_t xCopyPosition )
+{
+BaseType_t xReturn;
+UBaseType_t uxSavedInterruptStatus;
+Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+	configASSERT( pxQueue );
+	configASSERT( !( ( pvItemToQueue == NULL ) && ( pxQueue->uxItemSize != ( UBaseType_t ) 0U ) ) );
+	configASSERT( !( ( xCopyPosition == queueOVERWRITE ) && ( pxQueue->uxLength != 1 ) ) );
+
+	/* RTOS ports that support interrupt nesting have the concept of a maximum
+	system call (or maximum API call) interrupt priority.  Interrupts that are
+	above the maximum system call priority are kept permanently enabled, even
+	when the RTOS kernel is in a critical section, but cannot make any calls to
+	FreeRTOS API functions.  If configASSERT() is defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h
+	then portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID() will result in an assertion
+	failure if a FreeRTOS API function is called from an interrupt that has been
+	assigned a priority above the configured maximum system call priority.
+	Only FreeRTOS functions that end in FromISR can be called from interrupts
+	that have been assigned a priority at or (logically) below the maximum
+	system call	interrupt priority.  FreeRTOS maintains a separate interrupt
+	safe API to ensure interrupt entry is as fast and as simple as possible.
+	More information (albeit Cortex-M specific) is provided on the following
+	link: http://www.freertos.org/RTOS-Cortex-M3-M4.html */
+	portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID();
+
+	/* Similar to xQueueGenericSend, except without blocking if there is no room
+	in the queue.  Also don't directly wake a task that was blocked on a queue
+	read, instead return a flag to say whether a context switch is required or
+	not (i.e. has a task with a higher priority than us been woken by this
+	post). */
+	uxSavedInterruptStatus = portSET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR();
+	{
+		if( ( pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting < pxQueue->uxLength ) || ( xCopyPosition == queueOVERWRITE ) )
+		{
+			const int8_t cTxLock = pxQueue->cTxLock;
+			const UBaseType_t uxPreviousMessagesWaiting = pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting;
+
+			traceQUEUE_SEND_FROM_ISR( pxQueue );
+
+			/* Semaphores use xQueueGiveFromISR(), so pxQueue will not be a
+			semaphore or mutex.  That means prvCopyDataToQueue() cannot result
+			in a task disinheriting a priority and prvCopyDataToQueue() can be
+			called here even though the disinherit function does not check if
+			the scheduler is suspended before accessing the ready lists. */
+			( void ) prvCopyDataToQueue( pxQueue, pvItemToQueue, xCopyPosition );
+
+			/* The event list is not altered if the queue is locked.  This will
+			be done when the queue is unlocked later. */
+			if( cTxLock == queueUNLOCKED )
+			{
+				#if ( configUSE_QUEUE_SETS == 1 )
+				{
+					if( pxQueue->pxQueueSetContainer != NULL )
+					{
+						if( ( xCopyPosition == queueOVERWRITE ) && ( uxPreviousMessagesWaiting != ( UBaseType_t ) 0 ) )
+						{
+							/* Do not notify the queue set as an existing item
+							was overwritten in the queue so the number of items
+							in the queue has not changed. */
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+						else if( prvNotifyQueueSetContainer( pxQueue ) != pdFALSE )
+						{
+							/* The queue is a member of a queue set, and posting
+							to the queue set caused a higher priority task to
+							unblock.  A context switch is required. */
+							if( pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken != NULL )
+							{
+								*pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken = pdTRUE;
+							}
+							else
+							{
+								mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+							}
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) == pdFALSE )
+						{
+							if( xTaskRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) != pdFALSE )
+							{
+								/* The task waiting has a higher priority so
+								record that a context switch is required. */
+								if( pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken != NULL )
+								{
+									*pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken = pdTRUE;
+								}
+								else
+								{
+									mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+								}
+							}
+							else
+							{
+								mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+							}
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+					}
+				}
+				#else /* configUSE_QUEUE_SETS */
+				{
+					if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) == pdFALSE )
+					{
+						if( xTaskRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) != pdFALSE )
+						{
+							/* The task waiting has a higher priority so record that a
+							context	switch is required. */
+							if( pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken != NULL )
+							{
+								*pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken = pdTRUE;
+							}
+							else
+							{
+								mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+							}
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+					
+					/* Not used in this path. */
+					( void ) uxPreviousMessagesWaiting;
+				}
+				#endif /* configUSE_QUEUE_SETS */
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				/* Increment the lock count so the task that unlocks the queue
+				knows that data was posted while it was locked. */
+				pxQueue->cTxLock = ( int8_t ) ( cTxLock + 1 );
+			}
+
+			xReturn = pdPASS;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			traceQUEUE_SEND_FROM_ISR_FAILED( pxQueue );
+			xReturn = errQUEUE_FULL;
+		}
+	}
+	portCLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR( uxSavedInterruptStatus );
+
+	return xReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xQueueGiveFromISR( QueueHandle_t xQueue, BaseType_t * const pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken )
+{
+BaseType_t xReturn;
+UBaseType_t uxSavedInterruptStatus;
+Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+	/* Similar to xQueueGenericSendFromISR() but used with semaphores where the
+	item size is 0.  Don't directly wake a task that was blocked on a queue
+	read, instead return a flag to say whether a context switch is required or
+	not (i.e. has a task with a higher priority than us been woken by this
+	post). */
+
+	configASSERT( pxQueue );
+
+	/* xQueueGenericSendFromISR() should be used instead of xQueueGiveFromISR()
+	if the item size is not 0. */
+	configASSERT( pxQueue->uxItemSize == 0 );
+
+	/* Normally a mutex would not be given from an interrupt, especially if
+	there is a mutex holder, as priority inheritance makes no sense for an
+	interrupts, only tasks. */
+	configASSERT( !( ( pxQueue->uxQueueType == queueQUEUE_IS_MUTEX ) && ( pxQueue->u.xSemaphore.xMutexHolder != NULL ) ) );
+
+	/* RTOS ports that support interrupt nesting have the concept of a maximum
+	system call (or maximum API call) interrupt priority.  Interrupts that are
+	above the maximum system call priority are kept permanently enabled, even
+	when the RTOS kernel is in a critical section, but cannot make any calls to
+	FreeRTOS API functions.  If configASSERT() is defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h
+	then portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID() will result in an assertion
+	failure if a FreeRTOS API function is called from an interrupt that has been
+	assigned a priority above the configured maximum system call priority.
+	Only FreeRTOS functions that end in FromISR can be called from interrupts
+	that have been assigned a priority at or (logically) below the maximum
+	system call	interrupt priority.  FreeRTOS maintains a separate interrupt
+	safe API to ensure interrupt entry is as fast and as simple as possible.
+	More information (albeit Cortex-M specific) is provided on the following
+	link: http://www.freertos.org/RTOS-Cortex-M3-M4.html */
+	portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID();
+
+	uxSavedInterruptStatus = portSET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR();
+	{
+		const UBaseType_t uxMessagesWaiting = pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting;
+
+		/* When the queue is used to implement a semaphore no data is ever
+		moved through the queue but it is still valid to see if the queue 'has
+		space'. */
+		if( uxMessagesWaiting < pxQueue->uxLength )
+		{
+			const int8_t cTxLock = pxQueue->cTxLock;
+
+			traceQUEUE_SEND_FROM_ISR( pxQueue );
+
+			/* A task can only have an inherited priority if it is a mutex
+			holder - and if there is a mutex holder then the mutex cannot be
+			given from an ISR.  As this is the ISR version of the function it
+			can be assumed there is no mutex holder and no need to determine if
+			priority disinheritance is needed.  Simply increase the count of
+			messages (semaphores) available. */
+			pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting = uxMessagesWaiting + ( UBaseType_t ) 1;
+
+			/* The event list is not altered if the queue is locked.  This will
+			be done when the queue is unlocked later. */
+			if( cTxLock == queueUNLOCKED )
+			{
+				#if ( configUSE_QUEUE_SETS == 1 )
+				{
+					if( pxQueue->pxQueueSetContainer != NULL )
+					{
+						if( prvNotifyQueueSetContainer( pxQueue ) != pdFALSE )
+						{
+							/* The semaphore is a member of a queue set, and
+							posting	to the queue set caused a higher priority
+							task to	unblock.  A context switch is required. */
+							if( pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken != NULL )
+							{
+								*pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken = pdTRUE;
+							}
+							else
+							{
+								mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+							}
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) == pdFALSE )
+						{
+							if( xTaskRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) != pdFALSE )
+							{
+								/* The task waiting has a higher priority so
+								record that a context switch is required. */
+								if( pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken != NULL )
+								{
+									*pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken = pdTRUE;
+								}
+								else
+								{
+									mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+								}
+							}
+							else
+							{
+								mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+							}
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+					}
+				}
+				#else /* configUSE_QUEUE_SETS */
+				{
+					if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) == pdFALSE )
+					{
+						if( xTaskRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) != pdFALSE )
+						{
+							/* The task waiting has a higher priority so record that a
+							context	switch is required. */
+							if( pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken != NULL )
+							{
+								*pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken = pdTRUE;
+							}
+							else
+							{
+								mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+							}
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				#endif /* configUSE_QUEUE_SETS */
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				/* Increment the lock count so the task that unlocks the queue
+				knows that data was posted while it was locked. */
+				pxQueue->cTxLock = ( int8_t ) ( cTxLock + 1 );
+			}
+
+			xReturn = pdPASS;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			traceQUEUE_SEND_FROM_ISR_FAILED( pxQueue );
+			xReturn = errQUEUE_FULL;
+		}
+	}
+	portCLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR( uxSavedInterruptStatus );
+
+	return xReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xQueueReceive( QueueHandle_t xQueue, void * const pvBuffer, TickType_t xTicksToWait )
+{
+BaseType_t xEntryTimeSet = pdFALSE;
+TimeOut_t xTimeOut;
+Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+	/* Check the pointer is not NULL. */
+	configASSERT( ( pxQueue ) );
+
+	/* The buffer into which data is received can only be NULL if the data size
+	is zero (so no data is copied into the buffer. */
+	configASSERT( !( ( ( pvBuffer ) == NULL ) && ( ( pxQueue )->uxItemSize != ( UBaseType_t ) 0U ) ) );
+
+	/* Cannot block if the scheduler is suspended. */
+	#if ( ( INCLUDE_xTaskGetSchedulerState == 1 ) || ( configUSE_TIMERS == 1 ) )
+	{
+		configASSERT( !( ( xTaskGetSchedulerState() == taskSCHEDULER_SUSPENDED ) && ( xTicksToWait != 0 ) ) );
+	}
+	#endif
+
+
+	/*lint -save -e904  This function relaxes the coding standard somewhat to
+	allow return statements within the function itself.  This is done in the
+	interest of execution time efficiency. */
+	for( ;; )
+	{
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			const UBaseType_t uxMessagesWaiting = pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting;
+
+			/* Is there data in the queue now?  To be running the calling task
+			must be the highest priority task wanting to access the queue. */
+			if( uxMessagesWaiting > ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+			{
+				/* Data available, remove one item. */
+				prvCopyDataFromQueue( pxQueue, pvBuffer );
+				traceQUEUE_RECEIVE( pxQueue );
+				pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting = uxMessagesWaiting - ( UBaseType_t ) 1;
+
+				/* There is now space in the queue, were any tasks waiting to
+				post to the queue?  If so, unblock the highest priority waiting
+				task. */
+				if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) ) == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					if( xTaskRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) ) != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						queueYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION();
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+
+				taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+				return pdPASS;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				if( xTicksToWait == ( TickType_t ) 0 )
+				{
+					/* The queue was empty and no block time is specified (or
+					the block time has expired) so leave now. */
+					taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+					traceQUEUE_RECEIVE_FAILED( pxQueue );
+					return errQUEUE_EMPTY;
+				}
+				else if( xEntryTimeSet == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					/* The queue was empty and a block time was specified so
+					configure the timeout structure. */
+					vTaskInternalSetTimeOutState( &xTimeOut );
+					xEntryTimeSet = pdTRUE;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* Entry time was already set. */
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		/* Interrupts and other tasks can send to and receive from the queue
+		now the critical section has been exited. */
+
+		vTaskSuspendAll();
+		prvLockQueue( pxQueue );
+
+		/* Update the timeout state to see if it has expired yet. */
+		if( xTaskCheckForTimeOut( &xTimeOut, &xTicksToWait ) == pdFALSE )
+		{
+			/* The timeout has not expired.  If the queue is still empty place
+			the task on the list of tasks waiting to receive from the queue. */
+			if( prvIsQueueEmpty( pxQueue ) != pdFALSE )
+			{
+				traceBLOCKING_ON_QUEUE_RECEIVE( pxQueue );
+				vTaskPlaceOnEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ), xTicksToWait );
+				prvUnlockQueue( pxQueue );
+				if( xTaskResumeAll() == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					portYIELD_WITHIN_API();
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				/* The queue contains data again.  Loop back to try and read the
+				data. */
+				prvUnlockQueue( pxQueue );
+				( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			/* Timed out.  If there is no data in the queue exit, otherwise loop
+			back and attempt to read the data. */
+			prvUnlockQueue( pxQueue );
+			( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+
+			if( prvIsQueueEmpty( pxQueue ) != pdFALSE )
+			{
+				traceQUEUE_RECEIVE_FAILED( pxQueue );
+				return errQUEUE_EMPTY;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+	} /*lint -restore */
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xQueueSemaphoreTake( QueueHandle_t xQueue, TickType_t xTicksToWait )
+{
+BaseType_t xEntryTimeSet = pdFALSE;
+TimeOut_t xTimeOut;
+Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+#if( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+	BaseType_t xInheritanceOccurred = pdFALSE;
+#endif
+
+	/* Check the queue pointer is not NULL. */
+	configASSERT( ( pxQueue ) );
+
+	/* Check this really is a semaphore, in which case the item size will be
+	0. */
+	configASSERT( pxQueue->uxItemSize == 0 );
+
+	/* Cannot block if the scheduler is suspended. */
+	#if ( ( INCLUDE_xTaskGetSchedulerState == 1 ) || ( configUSE_TIMERS == 1 ) )
+	{
+		configASSERT( !( ( xTaskGetSchedulerState() == taskSCHEDULER_SUSPENDED ) && ( xTicksToWait != 0 ) ) );
+	}
+	#endif
+
+
+	/*lint -save -e904 This function relaxes the coding standard somewhat to allow return
+	statements within the function itself.  This is done in the interest
+	of execution time efficiency. */
+	for( ;; )
+	{
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			/* Semaphores are queues with an item size of 0, and where the
+			number of messages in the queue is the semaphore's count value. */
+			const UBaseType_t uxSemaphoreCount = pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting;
+
+			/* Is there data in the queue now?  To be running the calling task
+			must be the highest priority task wanting to access the queue. */
+			if( uxSemaphoreCount > ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+			{
+				traceQUEUE_RECEIVE( pxQueue );
+
+				/* Semaphores are queues with a data size of zero and where the
+				messages waiting is the semaphore's count.  Reduce the count. */
+				pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting = uxSemaphoreCount - ( UBaseType_t ) 1;
+
+				#if ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+				{
+					if( pxQueue->uxQueueType == queueQUEUE_IS_MUTEX )
+					{
+						/* Record the information required to implement
+						priority inheritance should it become necessary. */
+						pxQueue->u.xSemaphore.xMutexHolder = pvTaskIncrementMutexHeldCount();
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				#endif /* configUSE_MUTEXES */
+
+				/* Check to see if other tasks are blocked waiting to give the
+				semaphore, and if so, unblock the highest priority such task. */
+				if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) ) == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					if( xTaskRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) ) != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						queueYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION();
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+
+				taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+				return pdPASS;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				if( xTicksToWait == ( TickType_t ) 0 )
+				{
+					/* For inheritance to have occurred there must have been an
+					initial timeout, and an adjusted timeout cannot become 0, as
+					if it were 0 the function would have exited. */
+					#if( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+					{
+						configASSERT( xInheritanceOccurred == pdFALSE );
+					}
+					#endif /* configUSE_MUTEXES */
+
+					/* The semaphore count was 0 and no block time is specified
+					(or the block time has expired) so exit now. */
+					taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+					traceQUEUE_RECEIVE_FAILED( pxQueue );
+					return errQUEUE_EMPTY;
+				}
+				else if( xEntryTimeSet == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					/* The semaphore count was 0 and a block time was specified
+					so configure the timeout structure ready to block. */
+					vTaskInternalSetTimeOutState( &xTimeOut );
+					xEntryTimeSet = pdTRUE;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* Entry time was already set. */
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		/* Interrupts and other tasks can give to and take from the semaphore
+		now the critical section has been exited. */
+
+		vTaskSuspendAll();
+		prvLockQueue( pxQueue );
+
+		/* Update the timeout state to see if it has expired yet. */
+		if( xTaskCheckForTimeOut( &xTimeOut, &xTicksToWait ) == pdFALSE )
+		{
+			/* A block time is specified and not expired.  If the semaphore
+			count is 0 then enter the Blocked state to wait for a semaphore to
+			become available.  As semaphores are implemented with queues the
+			queue being empty is equivalent to the semaphore count being 0. */
+			if( prvIsQueueEmpty( pxQueue ) != pdFALSE )
+			{
+				traceBLOCKING_ON_QUEUE_RECEIVE( pxQueue );
+
+				#if ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+				{
+					if( pxQueue->uxQueueType == queueQUEUE_IS_MUTEX )
+					{
+						taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+						{
+							xInheritanceOccurred = xTaskPriorityInherit( pxQueue->u.xSemaphore.xMutexHolder );
+						}
+						taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				#endif
+
+				vTaskPlaceOnEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ), xTicksToWait );
+				prvUnlockQueue( pxQueue );
+				if( xTaskResumeAll() == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					portYIELD_WITHIN_API();
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				/* There was no timeout and the semaphore count was not 0, so
+				attempt to take the semaphore again. */
+				prvUnlockQueue( pxQueue );
+				( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			/* Timed out. */
+			prvUnlockQueue( pxQueue );
+			( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+
+			/* If the semaphore count is 0 exit now as the timeout has
+			expired.  Otherwise return to attempt to take the semaphore that is
+			known to be available.  As semaphores are implemented by queues the
+			queue being empty is equivalent to the semaphore count being 0. */
+			if( prvIsQueueEmpty( pxQueue ) != pdFALSE )
+			{
+				#if ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+				{
+					/* xInheritanceOccurred could only have be set if
+					pxQueue->uxQueueType == queueQUEUE_IS_MUTEX so no need to
+					test the mutex type again to check it is actually a mutex. */
+					if( xInheritanceOccurred != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+						{
+							UBaseType_t uxHighestWaitingPriority;
+
+							/* This task blocking on the mutex caused another
+							task to inherit this task's priority.  Now this task
+							has timed out the priority should be disinherited
+							again, but only as low as the next highest priority
+							task that is waiting for the same mutex. */
+							uxHighestWaitingPriority = prvGetDisinheritPriorityAfterTimeout( pxQueue );
+							vTaskPriorityDisinheritAfterTimeout( pxQueue->u.xSemaphore.xMutexHolder, uxHighestWaitingPriority );
+						}
+						taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+					}
+				}
+				#endif /* configUSE_MUTEXES */
+
+				traceQUEUE_RECEIVE_FAILED( pxQueue );
+				return errQUEUE_EMPTY;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+	} /*lint -restore */
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xQueuePeek( QueueHandle_t xQueue, void * const pvBuffer, TickType_t xTicksToWait )
+{
+BaseType_t xEntryTimeSet = pdFALSE;
+TimeOut_t xTimeOut;
+int8_t *pcOriginalReadPosition;
+Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+	/* Check the pointer is not NULL. */
+	configASSERT( ( pxQueue ) );
+
+	/* The buffer into which data is received can only be NULL if the data size
+	is zero (so no data is copied into the buffer. */
+	configASSERT( !( ( ( pvBuffer ) == NULL ) && ( ( pxQueue )->uxItemSize != ( UBaseType_t ) 0U ) ) );
+
+	/* Cannot block if the scheduler is suspended. */
+	#if ( ( INCLUDE_xTaskGetSchedulerState == 1 ) || ( configUSE_TIMERS == 1 ) )
+	{
+		configASSERT( !( ( xTaskGetSchedulerState() == taskSCHEDULER_SUSPENDED ) && ( xTicksToWait != 0 ) ) );
+	}
+	#endif
+
+
+	/*lint -save -e904  This function relaxes the coding standard somewhat to
+	allow return statements within the function itself.  This is done in the
+	interest of execution time efficiency. */
+	for( ;; )
+	{
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			const UBaseType_t uxMessagesWaiting = pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting;
+
+			/* Is there data in the queue now?  To be running the calling task
+			must be the highest priority task wanting to access the queue. */
+			if( uxMessagesWaiting > ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+			{
+				/* Remember the read position so it can be reset after the data
+				is read from the queue as this function is only peeking the
+				data, not removing it. */
+				pcOriginalReadPosition = pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom;
+
+				prvCopyDataFromQueue( pxQueue, pvBuffer );
+				traceQUEUE_PEEK( pxQueue );
+
+				/* The data is not being removed, so reset the read pointer. */
+				pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom = pcOriginalReadPosition;
+
+				/* The data is being left in the queue, so see if there are
+				any other tasks waiting for the data. */
+				if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					if( xTaskRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						/* The task waiting has a higher priority than this task. */
+						queueYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION();
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+
+				taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+				return pdPASS;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				if( xTicksToWait == ( TickType_t ) 0 )
+				{
+					/* The queue was empty and no block time is specified (or
+					the block time has expired) so leave now. */
+					taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+					traceQUEUE_PEEK_FAILED( pxQueue );
+					return errQUEUE_EMPTY;
+				}
+				else if( xEntryTimeSet == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					/* The queue was empty and a block time was specified so
+					configure the timeout structure ready to enter the blocked
+					state. */
+					vTaskInternalSetTimeOutState( &xTimeOut );
+					xEntryTimeSet = pdTRUE;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* Entry time was already set. */
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		/* Interrupts and other tasks can send to and receive from the queue
+		now the critical section has been exited. */
+
+		vTaskSuspendAll();
+		prvLockQueue( pxQueue );
+
+		/* Update the timeout state to see if it has expired yet. */
+		if( xTaskCheckForTimeOut( &xTimeOut, &xTicksToWait ) == pdFALSE )
+		{
+			/* Timeout has not expired yet, check to see if there is data in the
+			queue now, and if not enter the Blocked state to wait for data. */
+			if( prvIsQueueEmpty( pxQueue ) != pdFALSE )
+			{
+				traceBLOCKING_ON_QUEUE_PEEK( pxQueue );
+				vTaskPlaceOnEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ), xTicksToWait );
+				prvUnlockQueue( pxQueue );
+				if( xTaskResumeAll() == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					portYIELD_WITHIN_API();
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				/* There is data in the queue now, so don't enter the blocked
+				state, instead return to try and obtain the data. */
+				prvUnlockQueue( pxQueue );
+				( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			/* The timeout has expired.  If there is still no data in the queue
+			exit, otherwise go back and try to read the data again. */
+			prvUnlockQueue( pxQueue );
+			( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+
+			if( prvIsQueueEmpty( pxQueue ) != pdFALSE )
+			{
+				traceQUEUE_PEEK_FAILED( pxQueue );
+				return errQUEUE_EMPTY;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+	} /*lint -restore */
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xQueueReceiveFromISR( QueueHandle_t xQueue, void * const pvBuffer, BaseType_t * const pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken )
+{
+BaseType_t xReturn;
+UBaseType_t uxSavedInterruptStatus;
+Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+	configASSERT( pxQueue );
+	configASSERT( !( ( pvBuffer == NULL ) && ( pxQueue->uxItemSize != ( UBaseType_t ) 0U ) ) );
+
+	/* RTOS ports that support interrupt nesting have the concept of a maximum
+	system call (or maximum API call) interrupt priority.  Interrupts that are
+	above the maximum system call priority are kept permanently enabled, even
+	when the RTOS kernel is in a critical section, but cannot make any calls to
+	FreeRTOS API functions.  If configASSERT() is defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h
+	then portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID() will result in an assertion
+	failure if a FreeRTOS API function is called from an interrupt that has been
+	assigned a priority above the configured maximum system call priority.
+	Only FreeRTOS functions that end in FromISR can be called from interrupts
+	that have been assigned a priority at or (logically) below the maximum
+	system call	interrupt priority.  FreeRTOS maintains a separate interrupt
+	safe API to ensure interrupt entry is as fast and as simple as possible.
+	More information (albeit Cortex-M specific) is provided on the following
+	link: http://www.freertos.org/RTOS-Cortex-M3-M4.html */
+	portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID();
+
+	uxSavedInterruptStatus = portSET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR();
+	{
+		const UBaseType_t uxMessagesWaiting = pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting;
+
+		/* Cannot block in an ISR, so check there is data available. */
+		if( uxMessagesWaiting > ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+		{
+			const int8_t cRxLock = pxQueue->cRxLock;
+
+			traceQUEUE_RECEIVE_FROM_ISR( pxQueue );
+
+			prvCopyDataFromQueue( pxQueue, pvBuffer );
+			pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting = uxMessagesWaiting - ( UBaseType_t ) 1;
+
+			/* If the queue is locked the event list will not be modified.
+			Instead update the lock count so the task that unlocks the queue
+			will know that an ISR has removed data while the queue was
+			locked. */
+			if( cRxLock == queueUNLOCKED )
+			{
+				if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) ) == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					if( xTaskRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) ) != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						/* The task waiting has a higher priority than us so
+						force a context switch. */
+						if( pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken != NULL )
+						{
+							*pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken = pdTRUE;
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				/* Increment the lock count so the task that unlocks the queue
+				knows that data was removed while it was locked. */
+				pxQueue->cRxLock = ( int8_t ) ( cRxLock + 1 );
+			}
+
+			xReturn = pdPASS;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xReturn = pdFAIL;
+			traceQUEUE_RECEIVE_FROM_ISR_FAILED( pxQueue );
+		}
+	}
+	portCLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR( uxSavedInterruptStatus );
+
+	return xReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xQueuePeekFromISR( QueueHandle_t xQueue,  void * const pvBuffer )
+{
+BaseType_t xReturn;
+UBaseType_t uxSavedInterruptStatus;
+int8_t *pcOriginalReadPosition;
+Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+	configASSERT( pxQueue );
+	configASSERT( !( ( pvBuffer == NULL ) && ( pxQueue->uxItemSize != ( UBaseType_t ) 0U ) ) );
+	configASSERT( pxQueue->uxItemSize != 0 ); /* Can't peek a semaphore. */
+
+	/* RTOS ports that support interrupt nesting have the concept of a maximum
+	system call (or maximum API call) interrupt priority.  Interrupts that are
+	above the maximum system call priority are kept permanently enabled, even
+	when the RTOS kernel is in a critical section, but cannot make any calls to
+	FreeRTOS API functions.  If configASSERT() is defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h
+	then portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID() will result in an assertion
+	failure if a FreeRTOS API function is called from an interrupt that has been
+	assigned a priority above the configured maximum system call priority.
+	Only FreeRTOS functions that end in FromISR can be called from interrupts
+	that have been assigned a priority at or (logically) below the maximum
+	system call	interrupt priority.  FreeRTOS maintains a separate interrupt
+	safe API to ensure interrupt entry is as fast and as simple as possible.
+	More information (albeit Cortex-M specific) is provided on the following
+	link: http://www.freertos.org/RTOS-Cortex-M3-M4.html */
+	portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID();
+
+	uxSavedInterruptStatus = portSET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR();
+	{
+		/* Cannot block in an ISR, so check there is data available. */
+		if( pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting > ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+		{
+			traceQUEUE_PEEK_FROM_ISR( pxQueue );
+
+			/* Remember the read position so it can be reset as nothing is
+			actually being removed from the queue. */
+			pcOriginalReadPosition = pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom;
+			prvCopyDataFromQueue( pxQueue, pvBuffer );
+			pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom = pcOriginalReadPosition;
+
+			xReturn = pdPASS;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xReturn = pdFAIL;
+			traceQUEUE_PEEK_FROM_ISR_FAILED( pxQueue );
+		}
+	}
+	portCLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR( uxSavedInterruptStatus );
+
+	return xReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+UBaseType_t uxQueueMessagesWaiting( const QueueHandle_t xQueue )
+{
+UBaseType_t uxReturn;
+
+	configASSERT( xQueue );
+
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		uxReturn = ( ( Queue_t * ) xQueue )->uxMessagesWaiting;
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+	return uxReturn;
+} /*lint !e818 Pointer cannot be declared const as xQueue is a typedef not pointer. */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+UBaseType_t uxQueueSpacesAvailable( const QueueHandle_t xQueue )
+{
+UBaseType_t uxReturn;
+Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+	configASSERT( pxQueue );
+
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		uxReturn = pxQueue->uxLength - pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting;
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+	return uxReturn;
+} /*lint !e818 Pointer cannot be declared const as xQueue is a typedef not pointer. */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+UBaseType_t uxQueueMessagesWaitingFromISR( const QueueHandle_t xQueue )
+{
+UBaseType_t uxReturn;
+Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+	configASSERT( pxQueue );
+	uxReturn = pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting;
+
+	return uxReturn;
+} /*lint !e818 Pointer cannot be declared const as xQueue is a typedef not pointer. */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vQueueDelete( QueueHandle_t xQueue )
+{
+Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+	configASSERT( pxQueue );
+	traceQUEUE_DELETE( pxQueue );
+
+	#if ( configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE > 0 )
+	{
+		vQueueUnregisterQueue( pxQueue );
+	}
+	#endif
+
+	#if( ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 0 ) )
+	{
+		/* The queue can only have been allocated dynamically - free it
+		again. */
+		vPortFree( pxQueue );
+	}
+	#elif( ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) )
+	{
+		/* The queue could have been allocated statically or dynamically, so
+		check before attempting to free the memory. */
+		if( pxQueue->ucStaticallyAllocated == ( uint8_t ) pdFALSE )
+		{
+			vPortFree( pxQueue );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+	#else
+	{
+		/* The queue must have been statically allocated, so is not going to be
+		deleted.  Avoid compiler warnings about the unused parameter. */
+		( void ) pxQueue;
+	}
+	#endif /* configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION */
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+
+	UBaseType_t uxQueueGetQueueNumber( QueueHandle_t xQueue )
+	{
+		return ( ( Queue_t * ) xQueue )->uxQueueNumber;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+
+	void vQueueSetQueueNumber( QueueHandle_t xQueue, UBaseType_t uxQueueNumber )
+	{
+		( ( Queue_t * ) xQueue )->uxQueueNumber = uxQueueNumber;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+
+	uint8_t ucQueueGetQueueType( QueueHandle_t xQueue )
+	{
+		return ( ( Queue_t * ) xQueue )->ucQueueType;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+
+	static UBaseType_t prvGetDisinheritPriorityAfterTimeout( const Queue_t * const pxQueue )
+	{
+	UBaseType_t uxHighestPriorityOfWaitingTasks;
+
+		/* If a task waiting for a mutex causes the mutex holder to inherit a
+		priority, but the waiting task times out, then the holder should
+		disinherit the priority - but only down to the highest priority of any
+		other tasks that are waiting for the same mutex.  For this purpose,
+		return the priority of the highest priority task that is waiting for the
+		mutex. */
+		if( listCURRENT_LIST_LENGTH( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) > 0U )
+		{
+			uxHighestPriorityOfWaitingTasks = ( UBaseType_t ) configMAX_PRIORITIES - ( UBaseType_t ) listGET_ITEM_VALUE_OF_HEAD_ENTRY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			uxHighestPriorityOfWaitingTasks = tskIDLE_PRIORITY;
+		}
+
+		return uxHighestPriorityOfWaitingTasks;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_MUTEXES */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static BaseType_t prvCopyDataToQueue( Queue_t * const pxQueue, const void *pvItemToQueue, const BaseType_t xPosition )
+{
+BaseType_t xReturn = pdFALSE;
+UBaseType_t uxMessagesWaiting;
+
+	/* This function is called from a critical section. */
+
+	uxMessagesWaiting = pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting;
+
+	if( pxQueue->uxItemSize == ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+	{
+		#if ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+		{
+			if( pxQueue->uxQueueType == queueQUEUE_IS_MUTEX )
+			{
+				/* The mutex is no longer being held. */
+				xReturn = xTaskPriorityDisinherit( pxQueue->u.xSemaphore.xMutexHolder );
+				pxQueue->u.xSemaphore.xMutexHolder = NULL;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		#endif /* configUSE_MUTEXES */
+	}
+	else if( xPosition == queueSEND_TO_BACK )
+	{
+		( void ) memcpy( ( void * ) pxQueue->pcWriteTo, pvItemToQueue, ( size_t ) pxQueue->uxItemSize ); /*lint !e961 !e418 !e9087 MISRA exception as the casts are only redundant for some ports, plus previous logic ensures a null pointer can only be passed to memcpy() if the copy size is 0.  Cast to void required by function signature and safe as no alignment requirement and copy length specified in bytes. */
+		pxQueue->pcWriteTo += pxQueue->uxItemSize; /*lint !e9016 Pointer arithmetic on char types ok, especially in this use case where it is the clearest way of conveying intent. */
+		if( pxQueue->pcWriteTo >= pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcTail ) /*lint !e946 MISRA exception justified as comparison of pointers is the cleanest solution. */
+		{
+			pxQueue->pcWriteTo = pxQueue->pcHead;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		( void ) memcpy( ( void * ) pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom, pvItemToQueue, ( size_t ) pxQueue->uxItemSize ); /*lint !e961 !e9087 !e418 MISRA exception as the casts are only redundant for some ports.  Cast to void required by function signature and safe as no alignment requirement and copy length specified in bytes.  Assert checks null pointer only used when length is 0. */
+		pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom -= pxQueue->uxItemSize;
+		if( pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom < pxQueue->pcHead ) /*lint !e946 MISRA exception justified as comparison of pointers is the cleanest solution. */
+		{
+			pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom = ( pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcTail - pxQueue->uxItemSize );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		if( xPosition == queueOVERWRITE )
+		{
+			if( uxMessagesWaiting > ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+			{
+				/* An item is not being added but overwritten, so subtract
+				one from the recorded number of items in the queue so when
+				one is added again below the number of recorded items remains
+				correct. */
+				--uxMessagesWaiting;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+
+	pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting = uxMessagesWaiting + ( UBaseType_t ) 1;
+
+	return xReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvCopyDataFromQueue( Queue_t * const pxQueue, void * const pvBuffer )
+{
+	if( pxQueue->uxItemSize != ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+	{
+		pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom += pxQueue->uxItemSize; /*lint !e9016 Pointer arithmetic on char types ok, especially in this use case where it is the clearest way of conveying intent. */
+		if( pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom >= pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcTail ) /*lint !e946 MISRA exception justified as use of the relational operator is the cleanest solutions. */
+		{
+			pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom = pxQueue->pcHead;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+		( void ) memcpy( ( void * ) pvBuffer, ( void * ) pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom, ( size_t ) pxQueue->uxItemSize ); /*lint !e961 !e418 !e9087 MISRA exception as the casts are only redundant for some ports.  Also previous logic ensures a null pointer can only be passed to memcpy() when the count is 0.  Cast to void required by function signature and safe as no alignment requirement and copy length specified in bytes. */
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvUnlockQueue( Queue_t * const pxQueue )
+{
+	/* THIS FUNCTION MUST BE CALLED WITH THE SCHEDULER SUSPENDED. */
+
+	/* The lock counts contains the number of extra data items placed or
+	removed from the queue while the queue was locked.  When a queue is
+	locked items can be added or removed, but the event lists cannot be
+	updated. */
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		int8_t cTxLock = pxQueue->cTxLock;
+
+		/* See if data was added to the queue while it was locked. */
+		while( cTxLock > queueLOCKED_UNMODIFIED )
+		{
+			/* Data was posted while the queue was locked.  Are any tasks
+			blocked waiting for data to become available? */
+			#if ( configUSE_QUEUE_SETS == 1 )
+			{
+				if( pxQueue->pxQueueSetContainer != NULL )
+				{
+					if( prvNotifyQueueSetContainer( pxQueue ) != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						/* The queue is a member of a queue set, and posting to
+						the queue set caused a higher priority task to unblock.
+						A context switch is required. */
+						vTaskMissedYield();
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* Tasks that are removed from the event list will get
+					added to the pending ready list as the scheduler is still
+					suspended. */
+					if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) == pdFALSE )
+					{
+						if( xTaskRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) != pdFALSE )
+						{
+							/* The task waiting has a higher priority so record that a
+							context	switch is required. */
+							vTaskMissedYield();
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						break;
+					}
+				}
+			}
+			#else /* configUSE_QUEUE_SETS */
+			{
+				/* Tasks that are removed from the event list will get added to
+				the pending ready list as the scheduler is still suspended. */
+				if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					if( xTaskRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						/* The task waiting has a higher priority so record that
+						a context switch is required. */
+						vTaskMissedYield();
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					break;
+				}
+			}
+			#endif /* configUSE_QUEUE_SETS */
+
+			--cTxLock;
+		}
+
+		pxQueue->cTxLock = queueUNLOCKED;
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+	/* Do the same for the Rx lock. */
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		int8_t cRxLock = pxQueue->cRxLock;
+
+		while( cRxLock > queueLOCKED_UNMODIFIED )
+		{
+			if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) ) == pdFALSE )
+			{
+				if( xTaskRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) ) != pdFALSE )
+				{
+					vTaskMissedYield();
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+
+				--cRxLock;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				break;
+			}
+		}
+
+		pxQueue->cRxLock = queueUNLOCKED;
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static BaseType_t prvIsQueueEmpty( const Queue_t *pxQueue )
+{
+BaseType_t xReturn;
+
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		if( pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting == ( UBaseType_t )  0 )
+		{
+			xReturn = pdTRUE;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xReturn = pdFALSE;
+		}
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+	return xReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xQueueIsQueueEmptyFromISR( const QueueHandle_t xQueue )
+{
+BaseType_t xReturn;
+Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+	configASSERT( pxQueue );
+	if( pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting == ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+	{
+		xReturn = pdTRUE;
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		xReturn = pdFALSE;
+	}
+
+	return xReturn;
+} /*lint !e818 xQueue could not be pointer to const because it is a typedef. */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static BaseType_t prvIsQueueFull( const Queue_t *pxQueue )
+{
+BaseType_t xReturn;
+
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		if( pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting == pxQueue->uxLength )
+		{
+			xReturn = pdTRUE;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xReturn = pdFALSE;
+		}
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+	return xReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xQueueIsQueueFullFromISR( const QueueHandle_t xQueue )
+{
+BaseType_t xReturn;
+Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+	configASSERT( pxQueue );
+	if( pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting == pxQueue->uxLength )
+	{
+		xReturn = pdTRUE;
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		xReturn = pdFALSE;
+	}
+
+	return xReturn;
+} /*lint !e818 xQueue could not be pointer to const because it is a typedef. */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_CO_ROUTINES == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xQueueCRSend( QueueHandle_t xQueue, const void *pvItemToQueue, TickType_t xTicksToWait )
+	{
+	BaseType_t xReturn;
+	Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+		/* If the queue is already full we may have to block.  A critical section
+		is required to prevent an interrupt removing something from the queue
+		between the check to see if the queue is full and blocking on the queue. */
+		portDISABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+		{
+			if( prvIsQueueFull( pxQueue ) != pdFALSE )
+			{
+				/* The queue is full - do we want to block or just leave without
+				posting? */
+				if( xTicksToWait > ( TickType_t ) 0 )
+				{
+					/* As this is called from a coroutine we cannot block directly, but
+					return indicating that we need to block. */
+					vCoRoutineAddToDelayedList( xTicksToWait, &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) );
+					portENABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+					return errQUEUE_BLOCKED;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					portENABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+					return errQUEUE_FULL;
+				}
+			}
+		}
+		portENABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+
+		portDISABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+		{
+			if( pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting < pxQueue->uxLength )
+			{
+				/* There is room in the queue, copy the data into the queue. */
+				prvCopyDataToQueue( pxQueue, pvItemToQueue, queueSEND_TO_BACK );
+				xReturn = pdPASS;
+
+				/* Were any co-routines waiting for data to become available? */
+				if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					/* In this instance the co-routine could be placed directly
+					into the ready list as we are within a critical section.
+					Instead the same pending ready list mechanism is used as if
+					the event were caused from within an interrupt. */
+					if( xCoRoutineRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						/* The co-routine waiting has a higher priority so record
+						that a yield might be appropriate. */
+						xReturn = errQUEUE_YIELD;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				xReturn = errQUEUE_FULL;
+			}
+		}
+		portENABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_CO_ROUTINES */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_CO_ROUTINES == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xQueueCRReceive( QueueHandle_t xQueue, void *pvBuffer, TickType_t xTicksToWait )
+	{
+	BaseType_t xReturn;
+	Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+		/* If the queue is already empty we may have to block.  A critical section
+		is required to prevent an interrupt adding something to the queue
+		between the check to see if the queue is empty and blocking on the queue. */
+		portDISABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+		{
+			if( pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting == ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+			{
+				/* There are no messages in the queue, do we want to block or just
+				leave with nothing? */
+				if( xTicksToWait > ( TickType_t ) 0 )
+				{
+					/* As this is a co-routine we cannot block directly, but return
+					indicating that we need to block. */
+					vCoRoutineAddToDelayedList( xTicksToWait, &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) );
+					portENABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+					return errQUEUE_BLOCKED;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					portENABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+					return errQUEUE_FULL;
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		portENABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+
+		portDISABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+		{
+			if( pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting > ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+			{
+				/* Data is available from the queue. */
+				pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom += pxQueue->uxItemSize;
+				if( pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom >= pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcTail )
+				{
+					pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom = pxQueue->pcHead;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+				--( pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting );
+				( void ) memcpy( ( void * ) pvBuffer, ( void * ) pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom, ( unsigned ) pxQueue->uxItemSize );
+
+				xReturn = pdPASS;
+
+				/* Were any co-routines waiting for space to become available? */
+				if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) ) == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					/* In this instance the co-routine could be placed directly
+					into the ready list as we are within a critical section.
+					Instead the same pending ready list mechanism is used as if
+					the event were caused from within an interrupt. */
+					if( xCoRoutineRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) ) != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						xReturn = errQUEUE_YIELD;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				xReturn = pdFAIL;
+			}
+		}
+		portENABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_CO_ROUTINES */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_CO_ROUTINES == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xQueueCRSendFromISR( QueueHandle_t xQueue, const void *pvItemToQueue, BaseType_t xCoRoutinePreviouslyWoken )
+	{
+	Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+		/* Cannot block within an ISR so if there is no space on the queue then
+		exit without doing anything. */
+		if( pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting < pxQueue->uxLength )
+		{
+			prvCopyDataToQueue( pxQueue, pvItemToQueue, queueSEND_TO_BACK );
+
+			/* We only want to wake one co-routine per ISR, so check that a
+			co-routine has not already been woken. */
+			if( xCoRoutinePreviouslyWoken == pdFALSE )
+			{
+				if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					if( xCoRoutineRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						return pdTRUE;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		return xCoRoutinePreviouslyWoken;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_CO_ROUTINES */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_CO_ROUTINES == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xQueueCRReceiveFromISR( QueueHandle_t xQueue, void *pvBuffer, BaseType_t *pxCoRoutineWoken )
+	{
+	BaseType_t xReturn;
+	Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+		/* We cannot block from an ISR, so check there is data available. If
+		not then just leave without doing anything. */
+		if( pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting > ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+		{
+			/* Copy the data from the queue. */
+			pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom += pxQueue->uxItemSize;
+			if( pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom >= pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcTail )
+			{
+				pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom = pxQueue->pcHead;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+			--( pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting );
+			( void ) memcpy( ( void * ) pvBuffer, ( void * ) pxQueue->u.xQueue.pcReadFrom, ( unsigned ) pxQueue->uxItemSize );
+
+			if( ( *pxCoRoutineWoken ) == pdFALSE )
+			{
+				if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) ) == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					if( xCoRoutineRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToSend ) ) != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						*pxCoRoutineWoken = pdTRUE;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+
+			xReturn = pdPASS;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xReturn = pdFAIL;
+		}
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_CO_ROUTINES */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE > 0 )
+
+	void vQueueAddToRegistry( QueueHandle_t xQueue, const char *pcQueueName ) /*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+	{
+	UBaseType_t ux;
+
+		/* See if there is an empty space in the registry.  A NULL name denotes
+		a free slot. */
+		for( ux = ( UBaseType_t ) 0U; ux < ( UBaseType_t ) configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE; ux++ )
+		{
+			if( xQueueRegistry[ ux ].pcQueueName == NULL )
+			{
+				/* Store the information on this queue. */
+				xQueueRegistry[ ux ].pcQueueName = pcQueueName;
+				xQueueRegistry[ ux ].xHandle = xQueue;
+
+				traceQUEUE_REGISTRY_ADD( xQueue, pcQueueName );
+				break;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE > 0 )
+
+	const char *pcQueueGetName( QueueHandle_t xQueue ) /*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+	{
+	UBaseType_t ux;
+	const char *pcReturn = NULL; /*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+
+		/* Note there is nothing here to protect against another task adding or
+		removing entries from the registry while it is being searched. */
+		for( ux = ( UBaseType_t ) 0U; ux < ( UBaseType_t ) configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE; ux++ )
+		{
+			if( xQueueRegistry[ ux ].xHandle == xQueue )
+			{
+				pcReturn = xQueueRegistry[ ux ].pcQueueName;
+				break;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+
+		return pcReturn;
+	} /*lint !e818 xQueue cannot be a pointer to const because it is a typedef. */
+
+#endif /* configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE > 0 )
+
+	void vQueueUnregisterQueue( QueueHandle_t xQueue )
+	{
+	UBaseType_t ux;
+
+		/* See if the handle of the queue being unregistered in actually in the
+		registry. */
+		for( ux = ( UBaseType_t ) 0U; ux < ( UBaseType_t ) configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE; ux++ )
+		{
+			if( xQueueRegistry[ ux ].xHandle == xQueue )
+			{
+				/* Set the name to NULL to show that this slot if free again. */
+				xQueueRegistry[ ux ].pcQueueName = NULL;
+
+				/* Set the handle to NULL to ensure the same queue handle cannot
+				appear in the registry twice if it is added, removed, then
+				added again. */
+				xQueueRegistry[ ux ].xHandle = ( QueueHandle_t ) 0;
+				break;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+
+	} /*lint !e818 xQueue could not be pointer to const because it is a typedef. */
+
+#endif /* configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_TIMERS == 1 )
+
+	void vQueueWaitForMessageRestricted( QueueHandle_t xQueue, TickType_t xTicksToWait, const BaseType_t xWaitIndefinitely )
+	{
+	Queue_t * const pxQueue = xQueue;
+
+		/* This function should not be called by application code hence the
+		'Restricted' in its name.  It is not part of the public API.  It is
+		designed for use by kernel code, and has special calling requirements.
+		It can result in vListInsert() being called on a list that can only
+		possibly ever have one item in it, so the list will be fast, but even
+		so it should be called with the scheduler locked and not from a critical
+		section. */
+
+		/* Only do anything if there are no messages in the queue.  This function
+		will not actually cause the task to block, just place it on a blocked
+		list.  It will not block until the scheduler is unlocked - at which
+		time a yield will be performed.  If an item is added to the queue while
+		the queue is locked, and the calling task blocks on the queue, then the
+		calling task will be immediately unblocked when the queue is unlocked. */
+		prvLockQueue( pxQueue );
+		if( pxQueue->uxMessagesWaiting == ( UBaseType_t ) 0U )
+		{
+			/* There is nothing in the queue, block for the specified period. */
+			vTaskPlaceOnEventListRestricted( &( pxQueue->xTasksWaitingToReceive ), xTicksToWait, xWaitIndefinitely );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+		prvUnlockQueue( pxQueue );
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TIMERS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( ( configUSE_QUEUE_SETS == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) )
+
+	QueueSetHandle_t xQueueCreateSet( const UBaseType_t uxEventQueueLength )
+	{
+	QueueSetHandle_t pxQueue;
+
+		pxQueue = xQueueGenericCreate( uxEventQueueLength, ( UBaseType_t ) sizeof( Queue_t * ), queueQUEUE_TYPE_SET );
+
+		return pxQueue;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_QUEUE_SETS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_QUEUE_SETS == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xQueueAddToSet( QueueSetMemberHandle_t xQueueOrSemaphore, QueueSetHandle_t xQueueSet )
+	{
+	BaseType_t xReturn;
+
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			if( ( ( Queue_t * ) xQueueOrSemaphore )->pxQueueSetContainer != NULL )
+			{
+				/* Cannot add a queue/semaphore to more than one queue set. */
+				xReturn = pdFAIL;
+			}
+			else if( ( ( Queue_t * ) xQueueOrSemaphore )->uxMessagesWaiting != ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+			{
+				/* Cannot add a queue/semaphore to a queue set if there are already
+				items in the queue/semaphore. */
+				xReturn = pdFAIL;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				( ( Queue_t * ) xQueueOrSemaphore )->pxQueueSetContainer = xQueueSet;
+				xReturn = pdPASS;
+			}
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_QUEUE_SETS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_QUEUE_SETS == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xQueueRemoveFromSet( QueueSetMemberHandle_t xQueueOrSemaphore, QueueSetHandle_t xQueueSet )
+	{
+	BaseType_t xReturn;
+	Queue_t * const pxQueueOrSemaphore = ( Queue_t * ) xQueueOrSemaphore;
+
+		if( pxQueueOrSemaphore->pxQueueSetContainer != xQueueSet )
+		{
+			/* The queue was not a member of the set. */
+			xReturn = pdFAIL;
+		}
+		else if( pxQueueOrSemaphore->uxMessagesWaiting != ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+		{
+			/* It is dangerous to remove a queue from a set when the queue is
+			not empty because the queue set will still hold pending events for
+			the queue. */
+			xReturn = pdFAIL;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+			{
+				/* The queue is no longer contained in the set. */
+				pxQueueOrSemaphore->pxQueueSetContainer = NULL;
+			}
+			taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+			xReturn = pdPASS;
+		}
+
+		return xReturn;
+	} /*lint !e818 xQueueSet could not be declared as pointing to const as it is a typedef. */
+
+#endif /* configUSE_QUEUE_SETS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_QUEUE_SETS == 1 )
+
+	QueueSetMemberHandle_t xQueueSelectFromSet( QueueSetHandle_t xQueueSet, TickType_t const xTicksToWait )
+	{
+	QueueSetMemberHandle_t xReturn = NULL;
+
+		( void ) xQueueReceive( ( QueueHandle_t ) xQueueSet, &xReturn, xTicksToWait ); /*lint !e961 Casting from one typedef to another is not redundant. */
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_QUEUE_SETS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_QUEUE_SETS == 1 )
+
+	QueueSetMemberHandle_t xQueueSelectFromSetFromISR( QueueSetHandle_t xQueueSet )
+	{
+	QueueSetMemberHandle_t xReturn = NULL;
+
+		( void ) xQueueReceiveFromISR( ( QueueHandle_t ) xQueueSet, &xReturn, NULL ); /*lint !e961 Casting from one typedef to another is not redundant. */
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_QUEUE_SETS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_QUEUE_SETS == 1 )
+
+	static BaseType_t prvNotifyQueueSetContainer( const Queue_t * const pxQueue )
+	{
+	Queue_t *pxQueueSetContainer = pxQueue->pxQueueSetContainer;
+	BaseType_t xReturn = pdFALSE;
+
+		/* This function must be called form a critical section. */
+
+		configASSERT( pxQueueSetContainer );
+		configASSERT( pxQueueSetContainer->uxMessagesWaiting < pxQueueSetContainer->uxLength );
+
+		if( pxQueueSetContainer->uxMessagesWaiting < pxQueueSetContainer->uxLength )
+		{
+			const int8_t cTxLock = pxQueueSetContainer->cTxLock;
+
+			traceQUEUE_SEND( pxQueueSetContainer );
+
+			/* The data copied is the handle of the queue that contains data. */
+			xReturn = prvCopyDataToQueue( pxQueueSetContainer, &pxQueue, queueSEND_TO_BACK );
+
+			if( cTxLock == queueUNLOCKED )
+			{
+				if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxQueueSetContainer->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					if( xTaskRemoveFromEventList( &( pxQueueSetContainer->xTasksWaitingToReceive ) ) != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						/* The task waiting has a higher priority. */
+						xReturn = pdTRUE;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				pxQueueSetContainer->cTxLock = ( int8_t ) ( cTxLock + 1 );
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_QUEUE_SETS */
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
Index: ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/tasks.c
===================================================================
--- ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/tasks.c	(revision 73)
+++ ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/tasks.c	(revision 73)
@@ -0,0 +1,5310 @@
+/*
+ * FreeRTOS Kernel V10.3.1
+ * Copyright (C) 2020 Amazon.com, Inc. or its affiliates.  All Rights Reserved.
+ *
+ * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of
+ * this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in
+ * the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to
+ * use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of
+ * the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so,
+ * subject to the following conditions:
+ *
+ * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all
+ * copies or substantial portions of the Software.
+ *
+ * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
+ * IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS
+ * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR
+ * COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
+ * IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
+ * CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
+ *
+ * http://www.FreeRTOS.org
+ * http://aws.amazon.com/freertos
+ *
+ * 1 tab == 4 spaces!
+ */
+
+/* Standard includes. */
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+/* Defining MPU_WRAPPERS_INCLUDED_FROM_API_FILE prevents task.h from redefining
+all the API functions to use the MPU wrappers.  That should only be done when
+task.h is included from an application file. */
+#define MPU_WRAPPERS_INCLUDED_FROM_API_FILE
+
+/* FreeRTOS includes. */
+#include "FreeRTOS.h"
+#include "task.h"
+#include "timers.h"
+#include "stack_macros.h"
+
+/* Lint e9021, e961 and e750 are suppressed as a MISRA exception justified
+because the MPU ports require MPU_WRAPPERS_INCLUDED_FROM_API_FILE to be defined
+for the header files above, but not in this file, in order to generate the
+correct privileged Vs unprivileged linkage and placement. */
+#undef MPU_WRAPPERS_INCLUDED_FROM_API_FILE /*lint !e961 !e750 !e9021. */
+
+/* Set configUSE_STATS_FORMATTING_FUNCTIONS to 2 to include the stats formatting
+functions but without including stdio.h here. */
+#if ( configUSE_STATS_FORMATTING_FUNCTIONS == 1 )
+	/* At the bottom of this file are two optional functions that can be used
+	to generate human readable text from the raw data generated by the
+	uxTaskGetSystemState() function.  Note the formatting functions are provided
+	for convenience only, and are NOT considered part of the kernel. */
+	#include <stdio.h>
+#endif /* configUSE_STATS_FORMATTING_FUNCTIONS == 1 ) */
+
+#if( configUSE_PREEMPTION == 0 )
+	/* If the cooperative scheduler is being used then a yield should not be
+	performed just because a higher priority task has been woken. */
+	#define taskYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION()
+#else
+	#define taskYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION() portYIELD_WITHIN_API()
+#endif
+
+/* Values that can be assigned to the ucNotifyState member of the TCB. */
+#define taskNOT_WAITING_NOTIFICATION	( ( uint8_t ) 0 )
+#define taskWAITING_NOTIFICATION		( ( uint8_t ) 1 )
+#define taskNOTIFICATION_RECEIVED		( ( uint8_t ) 2 )
+
+/*
+ * The value used to fill the stack of a task when the task is created.  This
+ * is used purely for checking the high water mark for tasks.
+ */
+#define tskSTACK_FILL_BYTE	( 0xa5U )
+
+/* Bits used to recored how a task's stack and TCB were allocated. */
+#define tskDYNAMICALLY_ALLOCATED_STACK_AND_TCB 		( ( uint8_t ) 0 )
+#define tskSTATICALLY_ALLOCATED_STACK_ONLY 			( ( uint8_t ) 1 )
+#define tskSTATICALLY_ALLOCATED_STACK_AND_TCB		( ( uint8_t ) 2 )
+
+/* If any of the following are set then task stacks are filled with a known
+value so the high water mark can be determined.  If none of the following are
+set then don't fill the stack so there is no unnecessary dependency on memset. */
+#if( ( configCHECK_FOR_STACK_OVERFLOW > 1 ) || ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 ) || ( INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark == 1 ) || ( INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark2 == 1 ) )
+	#define tskSET_NEW_STACKS_TO_KNOWN_VALUE	1
+#else
+	#define tskSET_NEW_STACKS_TO_KNOWN_VALUE	0
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Macros used by vListTask to indicate which state a task is in.
+ */
+#define tskRUNNING_CHAR		( 'X' )
+#define tskBLOCKED_CHAR		( 'B' )
+#define tskREADY_CHAR		( 'R' )
+#define tskDELETED_CHAR		( 'D' )
+#define tskSUSPENDED_CHAR	( 'S' )
+
+/*
+ * Some kernel aware debuggers require the data the debugger needs access to be
+ * global, rather than file scope.
+ */
+#ifdef portREMOVE_STATIC_QUALIFIER
+	#define static
+#endif
+
+/* The name allocated to the Idle task.  This can be overridden by defining
+configIDLE_TASK_NAME in FreeRTOSConfig.h. */
+#ifndef configIDLE_TASK_NAME
+	#define configIDLE_TASK_NAME "IDLE"
+#endif
+
+#if ( configUSE_PORT_OPTIMISED_TASK_SELECTION == 0 )
+
+	/* If configUSE_PORT_OPTIMISED_TASK_SELECTION is 0 then task selection is
+	performed in a generic way that is not optimised to any particular
+	microcontroller architecture. */
+
+	/* uxTopReadyPriority holds the priority of the highest priority ready
+	state task. */
+	#define taskRECORD_READY_PRIORITY( uxPriority )														\
+	{																									\
+		if( ( uxPriority ) > uxTopReadyPriority )														\
+		{																								\
+			uxTopReadyPriority = ( uxPriority );														\
+		}																								\
+	} /* taskRECORD_READY_PRIORITY */
+
+	/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+	#define taskSELECT_HIGHEST_PRIORITY_TASK()															\
+	{																									\
+	UBaseType_t uxTopPriority = uxTopReadyPriority;														\
+																										\
+		/* Find the highest priority queue that contains ready tasks. */								\
+		while( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &( pxReadyTasksLists[ uxTopPriority ] ) ) )							\
+		{																								\
+			configASSERT( uxTopPriority );																\
+			--uxTopPriority;																			\
+		}																								\
+																										\
+		/* listGET_OWNER_OF_NEXT_ENTRY indexes through the list, so the tasks of						\
+		the	same priority get an equal share of the processor time. */									\
+		listGET_OWNER_OF_NEXT_ENTRY( pxCurrentTCB, &( pxReadyTasksLists[ uxTopPriority ] ) );			\
+		uxTopReadyPriority = uxTopPriority;																\
+	} /* taskSELECT_HIGHEST_PRIORITY_TASK */
+
+	/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+	/* Define away taskRESET_READY_PRIORITY() and portRESET_READY_PRIORITY() as
+	they are only required when a port optimised method of task selection is
+	being used. */
+	#define taskRESET_READY_PRIORITY( uxPriority )
+	#define portRESET_READY_PRIORITY( uxPriority, uxTopReadyPriority )
+
+#else /* configUSE_PORT_OPTIMISED_TASK_SELECTION */
+
+	/* If configUSE_PORT_OPTIMISED_TASK_SELECTION is 1 then task selection is
+	performed in a way that is tailored to the particular microcontroller
+	architecture being used. */
+
+	/* A port optimised version is provided.  Call the port defined macros. */
+	#define taskRECORD_READY_PRIORITY( uxPriority )	portRECORD_READY_PRIORITY( uxPriority, uxTopReadyPriority )
+
+	/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+	#define taskSELECT_HIGHEST_PRIORITY_TASK()														\
+	{																								\
+	UBaseType_t uxTopPriority;																		\
+																									\
+		/* Find the highest priority list that contains ready tasks. */								\
+		portGET_HIGHEST_PRIORITY( uxTopPriority, uxTopReadyPriority );								\
+		configASSERT( listCURRENT_LIST_LENGTH( &( pxReadyTasksLists[ uxTopPriority ] ) ) > 0 );		\
+		listGET_OWNER_OF_NEXT_ENTRY( pxCurrentTCB, &( pxReadyTasksLists[ uxTopPriority ] ) );		\
+	} /* taskSELECT_HIGHEST_PRIORITY_TASK() */
+
+	/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+	/* A port optimised version is provided, call it only if the TCB being reset
+	is being referenced from a ready list.  If it is referenced from a delayed
+	or suspended list then it won't be in a ready list. */
+	#define taskRESET_READY_PRIORITY( uxPriority )														\
+	{																									\
+		if( listCURRENT_LIST_LENGTH( &( pxReadyTasksLists[ ( uxPriority ) ] ) ) == ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )	\
+		{																								\
+			portRESET_READY_PRIORITY( ( uxPriority ), ( uxTopReadyPriority ) );							\
+		}																								\
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_PORT_OPTIMISED_TASK_SELECTION */
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* pxDelayedTaskList and pxOverflowDelayedTaskList are switched when the tick
+count overflows. */
+#define taskSWITCH_DELAYED_LISTS()																	\
+{																									\
+	List_t *pxTemp;																					\
+																									\
+	/* The delayed tasks list should be empty when the lists are switched. */						\
+	configASSERT( ( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( pxDelayedTaskList ) ) );										\
+																									\
+	pxTemp = pxDelayedTaskList;																		\
+	pxDelayedTaskList = pxOverflowDelayedTaskList;													\
+	pxOverflowDelayedTaskList = pxTemp;																\
+	xNumOfOverflows++;																				\
+	prvResetNextTaskUnblockTime();																	\
+}
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/*
+ * Place the task represented by pxTCB into the appropriate ready list for
+ * the task.  It is inserted at the end of the list.
+ */
+#define prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxTCB )																\
+	traceMOVED_TASK_TO_READY_STATE( pxTCB );														\
+	taskRECORD_READY_PRIORITY( ( pxTCB )->uxPriority );												\
+	vListInsertEnd( &( pxReadyTasksLists[ ( pxTCB )->uxPriority ] ), &( ( pxTCB )->xStateListItem ) ); \
+	tracePOST_MOVED_TASK_TO_READY_STATE( pxTCB )
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/*
+ * Several functions take an TaskHandle_t parameter that can optionally be NULL,
+ * where NULL is used to indicate that the handle of the currently executing
+ * task should be used in place of the parameter.  This macro simply checks to
+ * see if the parameter is NULL and returns a pointer to the appropriate TCB.
+ */
+#define prvGetTCBFromHandle( pxHandle ) ( ( ( pxHandle ) == NULL ) ? pxCurrentTCB : ( pxHandle ) )
+
+/* The item value of the event list item is normally used to hold the priority
+of the task to which it belongs (coded to allow it to be held in reverse
+priority order).  However, it is occasionally borrowed for other purposes.  It
+is important its value is not updated due to a task priority change while it is
+being used for another purpose.  The following bit definition is used to inform
+the scheduler that the value should not be changed - in which case it is the
+responsibility of whichever module is using the value to ensure it gets set back
+to its original value when it is released. */
+#if( configUSE_16_BIT_TICKS == 1 )
+	#define taskEVENT_LIST_ITEM_VALUE_IN_USE	0x8000U
+#else
+	#define taskEVENT_LIST_ITEM_VALUE_IN_USE	0x80000000UL
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Task control block.  A task control block (TCB) is allocated for each task,
+ * and stores task state information, including a pointer to the task's context
+ * (the task's run time environment, including register values)
+ */
+typedef struct tskTaskControlBlock 			/* The old naming convention is used to prevent breaking kernel aware debuggers. */
+{
+	volatile StackType_t	*pxTopOfStack;	/*< Points to the location of the last item placed on the tasks stack.  THIS MUST BE THE FIRST MEMBER OF THE TCB STRUCT. */
+
+	#if ( portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS == 1 )
+		xMPU_SETTINGS	xMPUSettings;		/*< The MPU settings are defined as part of the port layer.  THIS MUST BE THE SECOND MEMBER OF THE TCB STRUCT. */
+	#endif
+
+	ListItem_t			xStateListItem;	/*< The list that the state list item of a task is reference from denotes the state of that task (Ready, Blocked, Suspended ). */
+	ListItem_t			xEventListItem;		/*< Used to reference a task from an event list. */
+	UBaseType_t			uxPriority;			/*< The priority of the task.  0 is the lowest priority. */
+	StackType_t			*pxStack;			/*< Points to the start of the stack. */
+	char				pcTaskName[ configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN ];/*< Descriptive name given to the task when created.  Facilitates debugging only. */ /*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+
+	#if ( ( portSTACK_GROWTH > 0 ) || ( configRECORD_STACK_HIGH_ADDRESS == 1 ) )
+		StackType_t		*pxEndOfStack;		/*< Points to the highest valid address for the stack. */
+	#endif
+
+	#if ( portCRITICAL_NESTING_IN_TCB == 1 )
+		UBaseType_t		uxCriticalNesting;	/*< Holds the critical section nesting depth for ports that do not maintain their own count in the port layer. */
+	#endif
+
+	#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+		UBaseType_t		uxTCBNumber;		/*< Stores a number that increments each time a TCB is created.  It allows debuggers to determine when a task has been deleted and then recreated. */
+		UBaseType_t		uxTaskNumber;		/*< Stores a number specifically for use by third party trace code. */
+	#endif
+
+	#if ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+		UBaseType_t		uxBasePriority;		/*< The priority last assigned to the task - used by the priority inheritance mechanism. */
+		UBaseType_t		uxMutexesHeld;
+	#endif
+
+	#if ( configUSE_APPLICATION_TASK_TAG == 1 )
+		TaskHookFunction_t pxTaskTag;
+	#endif
+
+	#if( configNUM_THREAD_LOCAL_STORAGE_POINTERS > 0 )
+		void			*pvThreadLocalStoragePointers[ configNUM_THREAD_LOCAL_STORAGE_POINTERS ];
+	#endif
+
+	#if( configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS == 1 )
+		uint32_t		ulRunTimeCounter;	/*< Stores the amount of time the task has spent in the Running state. */
+	#endif
+
+	#if ( configUSE_NEWLIB_REENTRANT == 1 )
+		/* Allocate a Newlib reent structure that is specific to this task.
+		Note Newlib support has been included by popular demand, but is not
+		used by the FreeRTOS maintainers themselves.  FreeRTOS is not
+		responsible for resulting newlib operation.  User must be familiar with
+		newlib and must provide system-wide implementations of the necessary
+		stubs. Be warned that (at the time of writing) the current newlib design
+		implements a system-wide malloc() that must be provided with locks.
+
+		See the third party link http://www.nadler.com/embedded/newlibAndFreeRTOS.html
+		for additional information. */
+		struct	_reent xNewLib_reent;
+	#endif
+
+	#if( configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS == 1 )
+		volatile uint32_t ulNotifiedValue;
+		volatile uint8_t ucNotifyState;
+	#endif
+
+	/* See the comments in FreeRTOS.h with the definition of
+	tskSTATIC_AND_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION_POSSIBLE. */
+	#if( tskSTATIC_AND_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION_POSSIBLE != 0 ) /*lint !e731 !e9029 Macro has been consolidated for readability reasons. */
+		uint8_t	ucStaticallyAllocated; 		/*< Set to pdTRUE if the task is a statically allocated to ensure no attempt is made to free the memory. */
+	#endif
+
+	#if( INCLUDE_xTaskAbortDelay == 1 )
+		uint8_t ucDelayAborted;
+	#endif
+
+	#if( configUSE_POSIX_ERRNO == 1 )
+		int iTaskErrno;
+	#endif
+
+} tskTCB;
+
+/* The old tskTCB name is maintained above then typedefed to the new TCB_t name
+below to enable the use of older kernel aware debuggers. */
+typedef tskTCB TCB_t;
+
+/*lint -save -e956 A manual analysis and inspection has been used to determine
+which static variables must be declared volatile. */
+PRIVILEGED_DATA TCB_t * volatile pxCurrentTCB = NULL;
+
+/* Lists for ready and blocked tasks. --------------------
+xDelayedTaskList1 and xDelayedTaskList2 could be move to function scople but
+doing so breaks some kernel aware debuggers and debuggers that rely on removing
+the static qualifier. */
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static List_t pxReadyTasksLists[ configMAX_PRIORITIES ];/*< Prioritised ready tasks. */
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static List_t xDelayedTaskList1;						/*< Delayed tasks. */
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static List_t xDelayedTaskList2;						/*< Delayed tasks (two lists are used - one for delays that have overflowed the current tick count. */
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static List_t * volatile pxDelayedTaskList;				/*< Points to the delayed task list currently being used. */
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static List_t * volatile pxOverflowDelayedTaskList;		/*< Points to the delayed task list currently being used to hold tasks that have overflowed the current tick count. */
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static List_t xPendingReadyList;						/*< Tasks that have been readied while the scheduler was suspended.  They will be moved to the ready list when the scheduler is resumed. */
+
+#if( INCLUDE_vTaskDelete == 1 )
+
+	PRIVILEGED_DATA static List_t xTasksWaitingTermination;				/*< Tasks that have been deleted - but their memory not yet freed. */
+	PRIVILEGED_DATA static volatile UBaseType_t uxDeletedTasksWaitingCleanUp = ( UBaseType_t ) 0U;
+
+#endif
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend == 1 )
+
+	PRIVILEGED_DATA static List_t xSuspendedTaskList;					/*< Tasks that are currently suspended. */
+
+#endif
+
+/* Global POSIX errno. Its value is changed upon context switching to match
+the errno of the currently running task. */
+#if ( configUSE_POSIX_ERRNO == 1 )
+	int FreeRTOS_errno = 0;
+#endif
+
+/* Other file private variables. --------------------------------*/
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static volatile UBaseType_t uxCurrentNumberOfTasks 	= ( UBaseType_t ) 0U;
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static volatile TickType_t xTickCount 				= ( TickType_t ) configINITIAL_TICK_COUNT;
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static volatile UBaseType_t uxTopReadyPriority 		= tskIDLE_PRIORITY;
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static volatile BaseType_t xSchedulerRunning 		= pdFALSE;
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static volatile TickType_t xPendedTicks 			= ( TickType_t ) 0U;
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static volatile BaseType_t xYieldPending 			= pdFALSE;
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static volatile BaseType_t xNumOfOverflows 			= ( BaseType_t ) 0;
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static UBaseType_t uxTaskNumber 					= ( UBaseType_t ) 0U;
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static volatile TickType_t xNextTaskUnblockTime		= ( TickType_t ) 0U; /* Initialised to portMAX_DELAY before the scheduler starts. */
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static TaskHandle_t xIdleTaskHandle					= NULL;			/*< Holds the handle of the idle task.  The idle task is created automatically when the scheduler is started. */
+
+/* Context switches are held pending while the scheduler is suspended.  Also,
+interrupts must not manipulate the xStateListItem of a TCB, or any of the
+lists the xStateListItem can be referenced from, if the scheduler is suspended.
+If an interrupt needs to unblock a task while the scheduler is suspended then it
+moves the task's event list item into the xPendingReadyList, ready for the
+kernel to move the task from the pending ready list into the real ready list
+when the scheduler is unsuspended.  The pending ready list itself can only be
+accessed from a critical section. */
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static volatile UBaseType_t uxSchedulerSuspended	= ( UBaseType_t ) pdFALSE;
+
+#if ( configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS == 1 )
+
+	/* Do not move these variables to function scope as doing so prevents the
+	code working with debuggers that need to remove the static qualifier. */
+	PRIVILEGED_DATA static uint32_t ulTaskSwitchedInTime = 0UL;	/*< Holds the value of a timer/counter the last time a task was switched in. */
+	PRIVILEGED_DATA static uint32_t ulTotalRunTime = 0UL;		/*< Holds the total amount of execution time as defined by the run time counter clock. */
+
+#endif
+
+/*lint -restore */
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* Callback function prototypes. --------------------------*/
+#if(  configCHECK_FOR_STACK_OVERFLOW > 0 )
+
+	extern void vApplicationStackOverflowHook( TaskHandle_t xTask, char *pcTaskName );
+
+#endif
+
+#if( configUSE_TICK_HOOK > 0 )
+
+	extern void vApplicationTickHook( void ); /*lint !e526 Symbol not defined as it is an application callback. */
+
+#endif
+
+#if( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 )
+
+	extern void vApplicationGetIdleTaskMemory( StaticTask_t **ppxIdleTaskTCBBuffer, StackType_t **ppxIdleTaskStackBuffer, uint32_t *pulIdleTaskStackSize ); /*lint !e526 Symbol not defined as it is an application callback. */
+
+#endif
+
+/* File private functions. --------------------------------*/
+
+/**
+ * Utility task that simply returns pdTRUE if the task referenced by xTask is
+ * currently in the Suspended state, or pdFALSE if the task referenced by xTask
+ * is in any other state.
+ */
+#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend == 1 )
+
+	static BaseType_t prvTaskIsTaskSuspended( const TaskHandle_t xTask ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend */
+
+/*
+ * Utility to ready all the lists used by the scheduler.  This is called
+ * automatically upon the creation of the first task.
+ */
+static void prvInitialiseTaskLists( void ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * The idle task, which as all tasks is implemented as a never ending loop.
+ * The idle task is automatically created and added to the ready lists upon
+ * creation of the first user task.
+ *
+ * The portTASK_FUNCTION_PROTO() macro is used to allow port/compiler specific
+ * language extensions.  The equivalent prototype for this function is:
+ *
+ * void prvIdleTask( void *pvParameters );
+ *
+ */
+static portTASK_FUNCTION_PROTO( prvIdleTask, pvParameters );
+
+/*
+ * Utility to free all memory allocated by the scheduler to hold a TCB,
+ * including the stack pointed to by the TCB.
+ *
+ * This does not free memory allocated by the task itself (i.e. memory
+ * allocated by calls to pvPortMalloc from within the tasks application code).
+ */
+#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskDelete == 1 )
+
+	static void prvDeleteTCB( TCB_t *pxTCB ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Used only by the idle task.  This checks to see if anything has been placed
+ * in the list of tasks waiting to be deleted.  If so the task is cleaned up
+ * and its TCB deleted.
+ */
+static void prvCheckTasksWaitingTermination( void ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * The currently executing task is entering the Blocked state.  Add the task to
+ * either the current or the overflow delayed task list.
+ */
+static void prvAddCurrentTaskToDelayedList( TickType_t xTicksToWait, const BaseType_t xCanBlockIndefinitely ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * Fills an TaskStatus_t structure with information on each task that is
+ * referenced from the pxList list (which may be a ready list, a delayed list,
+ * a suspended list, etc.).
+ *
+ * THIS FUNCTION IS INTENDED FOR DEBUGGING ONLY, AND SHOULD NOT BE CALLED FROM
+ * NORMAL APPLICATION CODE.
+ */
+#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+
+	static UBaseType_t prvListTasksWithinSingleList( TaskStatus_t *pxTaskStatusArray, List_t *pxList, eTaskState eState ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Searches pxList for a task with name pcNameToQuery - returning a handle to
+ * the task if it is found, or NULL if the task is not found.
+ */
+#if ( INCLUDE_xTaskGetHandle == 1 )
+
+	static TCB_t *prvSearchForNameWithinSingleList( List_t *pxList, const char pcNameToQuery[] ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * When a task is created, the stack of the task is filled with a known value.
+ * This function determines the 'high water mark' of the task stack by
+ * determining how much of the stack remains at the original preset value.
+ */
+#if ( ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 ) || ( INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark == 1 ) || ( INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark2 == 1 ) )
+
+	static configSTACK_DEPTH_TYPE prvTaskCheckFreeStackSpace( const uint8_t * pucStackByte ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Return the amount of time, in ticks, that will pass before the kernel will
+ * next move a task from the Blocked state to the Running state.
+ *
+ * This conditional compilation should use inequality to 0, not equality to 1.
+ * This is to ensure portSUPPRESS_TICKS_AND_SLEEP() can be called when user
+ * defined low power mode implementations require configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE to be
+ * set to a value other than 1.
+ */
+#if ( configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE != 0 )
+
+	static TickType_t prvGetExpectedIdleTime( void ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Set xNextTaskUnblockTime to the time at which the next Blocked state task
+ * will exit the Blocked state.
+ */
+static void prvResetNextTaskUnblockTime( void );
+
+#if ( ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 ) && ( configUSE_STATS_FORMATTING_FUNCTIONS > 0 ) )
+
+	/*
+	 * Helper function used to pad task names with spaces when printing out
+	 * human readable tables of task information.
+	 */
+	static char *prvWriteNameToBuffer( char *pcBuffer, const char *pcTaskName ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Called after a Task_t structure has been allocated either statically or
+ * dynamically to fill in the structure's members.
+ */
+static void prvInitialiseNewTask( 	TaskFunction_t pxTaskCode,
+									const char * const pcName, 		/*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+									const uint32_t ulStackDepth,
+									void * const pvParameters,
+									UBaseType_t uxPriority,
+									TaskHandle_t * const pxCreatedTask,
+									TCB_t *pxNewTCB,
+									const MemoryRegion_t * const xRegions ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * Called after a new task has been created and initialised to place the task
+ * under the control of the scheduler.
+ */
+static void prvAddNewTaskToReadyList( TCB_t *pxNewTCB ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * freertos_tasks_c_additions_init() should only be called if the user definable
+ * macro FREERTOS_TASKS_C_ADDITIONS_INIT() is defined, as that is the only macro
+ * called by the function.
+ */
+#ifdef FREERTOS_TASKS_C_ADDITIONS_INIT
+
+	static void freertos_tasks_c_additions_init( void ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+#endif
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 )
+
+	TaskHandle_t xTaskCreateStatic(	TaskFunction_t pxTaskCode,
+									const char * const pcName,		/*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+									const uint32_t ulStackDepth,
+									void * const pvParameters,
+									UBaseType_t uxPriority,
+									StackType_t * const puxStackBuffer,
+									StaticTask_t * const pxTaskBuffer )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxNewTCB;
+	TaskHandle_t xReturn;
+
+		configASSERT( puxStackBuffer != NULL );
+		configASSERT( pxTaskBuffer != NULL );
+
+		#if( configASSERT_DEFINED == 1 )
+		{
+			/* Sanity check that the size of the structure used to declare a
+			variable of type StaticTask_t equals the size of the real task
+			structure. */
+			volatile size_t xSize = sizeof( StaticTask_t );
+			configASSERT( xSize == sizeof( TCB_t ) );
+			( void ) xSize; /* Prevent lint warning when configASSERT() is not used. */
+		}
+		#endif /* configASSERT_DEFINED */
+
+
+		if( ( pxTaskBuffer != NULL ) && ( puxStackBuffer != NULL ) )
+		{
+			/* The memory used for the task's TCB and stack are passed into this
+			function - use them. */
+			pxNewTCB = ( TCB_t * ) pxTaskBuffer; /*lint !e740 !e9087 Unusual cast is ok as the structures are designed to have the same alignment, and the size is checked by an assert. */
+			pxNewTCB->pxStack = ( StackType_t * ) puxStackBuffer;
+
+			#if( tskSTATIC_AND_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION_POSSIBLE != 0 ) /*lint !e731 !e9029 Macro has been consolidated for readability reasons. */
+			{
+				/* Tasks can be created statically or dynamically, so note this
+				task was created statically in case the task is later deleted. */
+				pxNewTCB->ucStaticallyAllocated = tskSTATICALLY_ALLOCATED_STACK_AND_TCB;
+			}
+			#endif /* tskSTATIC_AND_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION_POSSIBLE */
+
+			prvInitialiseNewTask( pxTaskCode, pcName, ulStackDepth, pvParameters, uxPriority, &xReturn, pxNewTCB, NULL );
+			prvAddNewTaskToReadyList( pxNewTCB );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xReturn = NULL;
+		}
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* SUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( ( portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) )
+
+	BaseType_t xTaskCreateRestrictedStatic( const TaskParameters_t * const pxTaskDefinition, TaskHandle_t *pxCreatedTask )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxNewTCB;
+	BaseType_t xReturn = errCOULD_NOT_ALLOCATE_REQUIRED_MEMORY;
+
+		configASSERT( pxTaskDefinition->puxStackBuffer != NULL );
+		configASSERT( pxTaskDefinition->pxTaskBuffer != NULL );
+
+		if( ( pxTaskDefinition->puxStackBuffer != NULL ) && ( pxTaskDefinition->pxTaskBuffer != NULL ) )
+		{
+			/* Allocate space for the TCB.  Where the memory comes from depends
+			on the implementation of the port malloc function and whether or
+			not static allocation is being used. */
+			pxNewTCB = ( TCB_t * ) pxTaskDefinition->pxTaskBuffer;
+
+			/* Store the stack location in the TCB. */
+			pxNewTCB->pxStack = pxTaskDefinition->puxStackBuffer;
+
+			#if( tskSTATIC_AND_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION_POSSIBLE != 0 )
+			{
+				/* Tasks can be created statically or dynamically, so note this
+				task was created statically in case the task is later deleted. */
+				pxNewTCB->ucStaticallyAllocated = tskSTATICALLY_ALLOCATED_STACK_AND_TCB;
+			}
+			#endif /* tskSTATIC_AND_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION_POSSIBLE */
+
+			prvInitialiseNewTask(	pxTaskDefinition->pvTaskCode,
+									pxTaskDefinition->pcName,
+									( uint32_t ) pxTaskDefinition->usStackDepth,
+									pxTaskDefinition->pvParameters,
+									pxTaskDefinition->uxPriority,
+									pxCreatedTask, pxNewTCB,
+									pxTaskDefinition->xRegions );
+
+			prvAddNewTaskToReadyList( pxNewTCB );
+			xReturn = pdPASS;
+		}
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* ( portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( ( portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) )
+
+	BaseType_t xTaskCreateRestricted( const TaskParameters_t * const pxTaskDefinition, TaskHandle_t *pxCreatedTask )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxNewTCB;
+	BaseType_t xReturn = errCOULD_NOT_ALLOCATE_REQUIRED_MEMORY;
+
+		configASSERT( pxTaskDefinition->puxStackBuffer );
+
+		if( pxTaskDefinition->puxStackBuffer != NULL )
+		{
+			/* Allocate space for the TCB.  Where the memory comes from depends
+			on the implementation of the port malloc function and whether or
+			not static allocation is being used. */
+			pxNewTCB = ( TCB_t * ) pvPortMalloc( sizeof( TCB_t ) );
+
+			if( pxNewTCB != NULL )
+			{
+				/* Store the stack location in the TCB. */
+				pxNewTCB->pxStack = pxTaskDefinition->puxStackBuffer;
+
+				#if( tskSTATIC_AND_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION_POSSIBLE != 0 )
+				{
+					/* Tasks can be created statically or dynamically, so note
+					this task had a statically allocated stack in case it is
+					later deleted.  The TCB was allocated dynamically. */
+					pxNewTCB->ucStaticallyAllocated = tskSTATICALLY_ALLOCATED_STACK_ONLY;
+				}
+				#endif /* tskSTATIC_AND_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION_POSSIBLE */
+
+				prvInitialiseNewTask(	pxTaskDefinition->pvTaskCode,
+										pxTaskDefinition->pcName,
+										( uint32_t ) pxTaskDefinition->usStackDepth,
+										pxTaskDefinition->pvParameters,
+										pxTaskDefinition->uxPriority,
+										pxCreatedTask, pxNewTCB,
+										pxTaskDefinition->xRegions );
+
+				prvAddNewTaskToReadyList( pxNewTCB );
+				xReturn = pdPASS;
+			}
+		}
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xTaskCreate(	TaskFunction_t pxTaskCode,
+							const char * const pcName,		/*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+							const configSTACK_DEPTH_TYPE usStackDepth,
+							void * const pvParameters,
+							UBaseType_t uxPriority,
+							TaskHandle_t * const pxCreatedTask )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxNewTCB;
+	BaseType_t xReturn;
+
+		/* If the stack grows down then allocate the stack then the TCB so the stack
+		does not grow into the TCB.  Likewise if the stack grows up then allocate
+		the TCB then the stack. */
+		#if( portSTACK_GROWTH > 0 )
+		{
+			/* Allocate space for the TCB.  Where the memory comes from depends on
+			the implementation of the port malloc function and whether or not static
+			allocation is being used. */
+			pxNewTCB = ( TCB_t * ) pvPortMalloc( sizeof( TCB_t ) );
+
+			if( pxNewTCB != NULL )
+			{
+				/* Allocate space for the stack used by the task being created.
+				The base of the stack memory stored in the TCB so the task can
+				be deleted later if required. */
+				pxNewTCB->pxStack = ( StackType_t * ) pvPortMalloc( ( ( ( size_t ) usStackDepth ) * sizeof( StackType_t ) ) ); /*lint !e961 MISRA exception as the casts are only redundant for some ports. */
+
+				if( pxNewTCB->pxStack == NULL )
+				{
+					/* Could not allocate the stack.  Delete the allocated TCB. */
+					vPortFree( pxNewTCB );
+					pxNewTCB = NULL;
+				}
+			}
+		}
+		#else /* portSTACK_GROWTH */
+		{
+		StackType_t *pxStack;
+
+			/* Allocate space for the stack used by the task being created. */
+			pxStack = pvPortMalloc( ( ( ( size_t ) usStackDepth ) * sizeof( StackType_t ) ) ); /*lint !e9079 All values returned by pvPortMalloc() have at least the alignment required by the MCU's stack and this allocation is the stack. */
+
+			if( pxStack != NULL )
+			{
+				/* Allocate space for the TCB. */
+				pxNewTCB = ( TCB_t * ) pvPortMalloc( sizeof( TCB_t ) ); /*lint !e9087 !e9079 All values returned by pvPortMalloc() have at least the alignment required by the MCU's stack, and the first member of TCB_t is always a pointer to the task's stack. */
+
+				if( pxNewTCB != NULL )
+				{
+					/* Store the stack location in the TCB. */
+					pxNewTCB->pxStack = pxStack;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* The stack cannot be used as the TCB was not created.  Free
+					it again. */
+					vPortFree( pxStack );
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				pxNewTCB = NULL;
+			}
+		}
+		#endif /* portSTACK_GROWTH */
+
+		if( pxNewTCB != NULL )
+		{
+			#if( tskSTATIC_AND_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION_POSSIBLE != 0 ) /*lint !e9029 !e731 Macro has been consolidated for readability reasons. */
+			{
+				/* Tasks can be created statically or dynamically, so note this
+				task was created dynamically in case it is later deleted. */
+				pxNewTCB->ucStaticallyAllocated = tskDYNAMICALLY_ALLOCATED_STACK_AND_TCB;
+			}
+			#endif /* tskSTATIC_AND_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION_POSSIBLE */
+
+			prvInitialiseNewTask( pxTaskCode, pcName, ( uint32_t ) usStackDepth, pvParameters, uxPriority, pxCreatedTask, pxNewTCB, NULL );
+			prvAddNewTaskToReadyList( pxNewTCB );
+			xReturn = pdPASS;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xReturn = errCOULD_NOT_ALLOCATE_REQUIRED_MEMORY;
+		}
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvInitialiseNewTask( 	TaskFunction_t pxTaskCode,
+									const char * const pcName,		/*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+									const uint32_t ulStackDepth,
+									void * const pvParameters,
+									UBaseType_t uxPriority,
+									TaskHandle_t * const pxCreatedTask,
+									TCB_t *pxNewTCB,
+									const MemoryRegion_t * const xRegions )
+{
+StackType_t *pxTopOfStack;
+UBaseType_t x;
+
+	#if( portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS == 1 )
+		/* Should the task be created in privileged mode? */
+		BaseType_t xRunPrivileged;
+		if( ( uxPriority & portPRIVILEGE_BIT ) != 0U )
+		{
+			xRunPrivileged = pdTRUE;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xRunPrivileged = pdFALSE;
+		}
+		uxPriority &= ~portPRIVILEGE_BIT;
+	#endif /* portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS == 1 */
+
+	/* Avoid dependency on memset() if it is not required. */
+	#if( tskSET_NEW_STACKS_TO_KNOWN_VALUE == 1 )
+	{
+		/* Fill the stack with a known value to assist debugging. */
+		( void ) memset( pxNewTCB->pxStack, ( int ) tskSTACK_FILL_BYTE, ( size_t ) ulStackDepth * sizeof( StackType_t ) );
+	}
+	#endif /* tskSET_NEW_STACKS_TO_KNOWN_VALUE */
+
+	/* Calculate the top of stack address.  This depends on whether the stack
+	grows from high memory to low (as per the 80x86) or vice versa.
+	portSTACK_GROWTH is used to make the result positive or negative as required
+	by the port. */
+	#if( portSTACK_GROWTH < 0 )
+	{
+		pxTopOfStack = &( pxNewTCB->pxStack[ ulStackDepth - ( uint32_t ) 1 ] );
+		pxTopOfStack = ( StackType_t * ) ( ( ( portPOINTER_SIZE_TYPE ) pxTopOfStack ) & ( ~( ( portPOINTER_SIZE_TYPE ) portBYTE_ALIGNMENT_MASK ) ) ); /*lint !e923 !e9033 !e9078 MISRA exception.  Avoiding casts between pointers and integers is not practical.  Size differences accounted for using portPOINTER_SIZE_TYPE type.  Checked by assert(). */
+
+		/* Check the alignment of the calculated top of stack is correct. */
+		configASSERT( ( ( ( portPOINTER_SIZE_TYPE ) pxTopOfStack & ( portPOINTER_SIZE_TYPE ) portBYTE_ALIGNMENT_MASK ) == 0UL ) );
+
+		#if( configRECORD_STACK_HIGH_ADDRESS == 1 )
+		{
+			/* Also record the stack's high address, which may assist
+			debugging. */
+			pxNewTCB->pxEndOfStack = pxTopOfStack;
+		}
+		#endif /* configRECORD_STACK_HIGH_ADDRESS */
+	}
+	#else /* portSTACK_GROWTH */
+	{
+		pxTopOfStack = pxNewTCB->pxStack;
+
+		/* Check the alignment of the stack buffer is correct. */
+		configASSERT( ( ( ( portPOINTER_SIZE_TYPE ) pxNewTCB->pxStack & ( portPOINTER_SIZE_TYPE ) portBYTE_ALIGNMENT_MASK ) == 0UL ) );
+
+		/* The other extreme of the stack space is required if stack checking is
+		performed. */
+		pxNewTCB->pxEndOfStack = pxNewTCB->pxStack + ( ulStackDepth - ( uint32_t ) 1 );
+	}
+	#endif /* portSTACK_GROWTH */
+
+	/* Store the task name in the TCB. */
+	if( pcName != NULL )
+	{
+		for( x = ( UBaseType_t ) 0; x < ( UBaseType_t ) configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN; x++ )
+		{
+			pxNewTCB->pcTaskName[ x ] = pcName[ x ];
+
+			/* Don't copy all configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN if the string is shorter than
+			configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN characters just in case the memory after the
+			string is not accessible (extremely unlikely). */
+			if( pcName[ x ] == ( char ) 0x00 )
+			{
+				break;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+
+		/* Ensure the name string is terminated in the case that the string length
+		was greater or equal to configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN. */
+		pxNewTCB->pcTaskName[ configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN - 1 ] = '\0';
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		/* The task has not been given a name, so just ensure there is a NULL
+		terminator when it is read out. */
+		pxNewTCB->pcTaskName[ 0 ] = 0x00;
+	}
+
+	/* This is used as an array index so must ensure it's not too large.  First
+	remove the privilege bit if one is present. */
+	if( uxPriority >= ( UBaseType_t ) configMAX_PRIORITIES )
+	{
+		uxPriority = ( UBaseType_t ) configMAX_PRIORITIES - ( UBaseType_t ) 1U;
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+	}
+
+	pxNewTCB->uxPriority = uxPriority;
+	#if ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+	{
+		pxNewTCB->uxBasePriority = uxPriority;
+		pxNewTCB->uxMutexesHeld = 0;
+	}
+	#endif /* configUSE_MUTEXES */
+
+	vListInitialiseItem( &( pxNewTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+	vListInitialiseItem( &( pxNewTCB->xEventListItem ) );
+
+	/* Set the pxNewTCB as a link back from the ListItem_t.  This is so we can get
+	back to	the containing TCB from a generic item in a list. */
+	listSET_LIST_ITEM_OWNER( &( pxNewTCB->xStateListItem ), pxNewTCB );
+
+	/* Event lists are always in priority order. */
+	listSET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxNewTCB->xEventListItem ), ( TickType_t ) configMAX_PRIORITIES - ( TickType_t ) uxPriority ); /*lint !e961 MISRA exception as the casts are only redundant for some ports. */
+	listSET_LIST_ITEM_OWNER( &( pxNewTCB->xEventListItem ), pxNewTCB );
+
+	#if ( portCRITICAL_NESTING_IN_TCB == 1 )
+	{
+		pxNewTCB->uxCriticalNesting = ( UBaseType_t ) 0U;
+	}
+	#endif /* portCRITICAL_NESTING_IN_TCB */
+
+	#if ( configUSE_APPLICATION_TASK_TAG == 1 )
+	{
+		pxNewTCB->pxTaskTag = NULL;
+	}
+	#endif /* configUSE_APPLICATION_TASK_TAG */
+
+	#if ( configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS == 1 )
+	{
+		pxNewTCB->ulRunTimeCounter = 0UL;
+	}
+	#endif /* configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS */
+
+	#if ( portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS == 1 )
+	{
+		vPortStoreTaskMPUSettings( &( pxNewTCB->xMPUSettings ), xRegions, pxNewTCB->pxStack, ulStackDepth );
+	}
+	#else
+	{
+		/* Avoid compiler warning about unreferenced parameter. */
+		( void ) xRegions;
+	}
+	#endif
+
+	#if( configNUM_THREAD_LOCAL_STORAGE_POINTERS != 0 )
+	{
+		for( x = 0; x < ( UBaseType_t ) configNUM_THREAD_LOCAL_STORAGE_POINTERS; x++ )
+		{
+			pxNewTCB->pvThreadLocalStoragePointers[ x ] = NULL;
+		}
+	}
+	#endif
+
+	#if ( configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS == 1 )
+	{
+		pxNewTCB->ulNotifiedValue = 0;
+		pxNewTCB->ucNotifyState = taskNOT_WAITING_NOTIFICATION;
+	}
+	#endif
+
+	#if ( configUSE_NEWLIB_REENTRANT == 1 )
+	{
+		/* Initialise this task's Newlib reent structure.
+		See the third party link http://www.nadler.com/embedded/newlibAndFreeRTOS.html
+		for additional information. */
+		_REENT_INIT_PTR( ( &( pxNewTCB->xNewLib_reent ) ) );
+	}
+	#endif
+
+	#if( INCLUDE_xTaskAbortDelay == 1 )
+	{
+		pxNewTCB->ucDelayAborted = pdFALSE;
+	}
+	#endif
+
+	/* Initialize the TCB stack to look as if the task was already running,
+	but had been interrupted by the scheduler.  The return address is set
+	to the start of the task function. Once the stack has been initialised
+	the top of stack variable is updated. */
+	#if( portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS == 1 )
+	{
+		/* If the port has capability to detect stack overflow,
+		pass the stack end address to the stack initialization
+		function as well. */
+		#if( portHAS_STACK_OVERFLOW_CHECKING == 1 )
+		{
+			#if( portSTACK_GROWTH < 0 )
+			{
+				pxNewTCB->pxTopOfStack = pxPortInitialiseStack( pxTopOfStack, pxNewTCB->pxStack, pxTaskCode, pvParameters, xRunPrivileged );
+			}
+			#else /* portSTACK_GROWTH */
+			{
+				pxNewTCB->pxTopOfStack = pxPortInitialiseStack( pxTopOfStack, pxNewTCB->pxEndOfStack, pxTaskCode, pvParameters, xRunPrivileged );
+			}
+			#endif /* portSTACK_GROWTH */
+		}
+		#else /* portHAS_STACK_OVERFLOW_CHECKING */
+		{
+			pxNewTCB->pxTopOfStack = pxPortInitialiseStack( pxTopOfStack, pxTaskCode, pvParameters, xRunPrivileged );
+		}
+		#endif /* portHAS_STACK_OVERFLOW_CHECKING */
+	}
+	#else /* portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS */
+	{
+		/* If the port has capability to detect stack overflow,
+		pass the stack end address to the stack initialization
+		function as well. */
+		#if( portHAS_STACK_OVERFLOW_CHECKING == 1 )
+		{
+			#if( portSTACK_GROWTH < 0 )
+			{
+				pxNewTCB->pxTopOfStack = pxPortInitialiseStack( pxTopOfStack, pxNewTCB->pxStack, pxTaskCode, pvParameters );
+			}
+			#else /* portSTACK_GROWTH */
+			{
+				pxNewTCB->pxTopOfStack = pxPortInitialiseStack( pxTopOfStack, pxNewTCB->pxEndOfStack, pxTaskCode, pvParameters );
+			}
+			#endif /* portSTACK_GROWTH */
+		}
+		#else /* portHAS_STACK_OVERFLOW_CHECKING */
+		{
+			pxNewTCB->pxTopOfStack = pxPortInitialiseStack( pxTopOfStack, pxTaskCode, pvParameters );
+		}
+		#endif /* portHAS_STACK_OVERFLOW_CHECKING */
+	}
+	#endif /* portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS */
+
+	if( pxCreatedTask != NULL )
+	{
+		/* Pass the handle out in an anonymous way.  The handle can be used to
+		change the created task's priority, delete the created task, etc.*/
+		*pxCreatedTask = ( TaskHandle_t ) pxNewTCB;
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvAddNewTaskToReadyList( TCB_t *pxNewTCB )
+{
+	/* Ensure interrupts don't access the task lists while the lists are being
+	updated. */
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		uxCurrentNumberOfTasks++;
+		if( pxCurrentTCB == NULL )
+		{
+			/* There are no other tasks, or all the other tasks are in
+			the suspended state - make this the current task. */
+			pxCurrentTCB = pxNewTCB;
+
+			if( uxCurrentNumberOfTasks == ( UBaseType_t ) 1 )
+			{
+				/* This is the first task to be created so do the preliminary
+				initialisation required.  We will not recover if this call
+				fails, but we will report the failure. */
+				prvInitialiseTaskLists();
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			/* If the scheduler is not already running, make this task the
+			current task if it is the highest priority task to be created
+			so far. */
+			if( xSchedulerRunning == pdFALSE )
+			{
+				if( pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority <= pxNewTCB->uxPriority )
+				{
+					pxCurrentTCB = pxNewTCB;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+
+		uxTaskNumber++;
+
+		#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+		{
+			/* Add a counter into the TCB for tracing only. */
+			pxNewTCB->uxTCBNumber = uxTaskNumber;
+		}
+		#endif /* configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY */
+		traceTASK_CREATE( pxNewTCB );
+
+		prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxNewTCB );
+
+		portSETUP_TCB( pxNewTCB );
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+	if( xSchedulerRunning != pdFALSE )
+	{
+		/* If the created task is of a higher priority than the current task
+		then it should run now. */
+		if( pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority < pxNewTCB->uxPriority )
+		{
+			taskYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION();
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskDelete == 1 )
+
+	void vTaskDelete( TaskHandle_t xTaskToDelete )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxTCB;
+
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			/* If null is passed in here then it is the calling task that is
+			being deleted. */
+			pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTaskToDelete );
+
+			/* Remove task from the ready/delayed list. */
+			if( uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) ) == ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+			{
+				taskRESET_READY_PRIORITY( pxTCB->uxPriority );
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+
+			/* Is the task waiting on an event also? */
+			if( listLIST_ITEM_CONTAINER( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) ) != NULL )
+			{
+				( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) );
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+
+			/* Increment the uxTaskNumber also so kernel aware debuggers can
+			detect that the task lists need re-generating.  This is done before
+			portPRE_TASK_DELETE_HOOK() as in the Windows port that macro will
+			not return. */
+			uxTaskNumber++;
+
+			if( pxTCB == pxCurrentTCB )
+			{
+				/* A task is deleting itself.  This cannot complete within the
+				task itself, as a context switch to another task is required.
+				Place the task in the termination list.  The idle task will
+				check the termination list and free up any memory allocated by
+				the scheduler for the TCB and stack of the deleted task. */
+				vListInsertEnd( &xTasksWaitingTermination, &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+
+				/* Increment the ucTasksDeleted variable so the idle task knows
+				there is a task that has been deleted and that it should therefore
+				check the xTasksWaitingTermination list. */
+				++uxDeletedTasksWaitingCleanUp;
+
+				/* Call the delete hook before portPRE_TASK_DELETE_HOOK() as
+				portPRE_TASK_DELETE_HOOK() does not return in the Win32 port. */
+				traceTASK_DELETE( pxTCB );
+
+				/* The pre-delete hook is primarily for the Windows simulator,
+				in which Windows specific clean up operations are performed,
+				after which it is not possible to yield away from this task -
+				hence xYieldPending is used to latch that a context switch is
+				required. */
+				portPRE_TASK_DELETE_HOOK( pxTCB, &xYieldPending );
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				--uxCurrentNumberOfTasks;
+				traceTASK_DELETE( pxTCB );
+				prvDeleteTCB( pxTCB );
+
+				/* Reset the next expected unblock time in case it referred to
+				the task that has just been deleted. */
+				prvResetNextTaskUnblockTime();
+			}
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		/* Force a reschedule if it is the currently running task that has just
+		been deleted. */
+		if( xSchedulerRunning != pdFALSE )
+		{
+			if( pxTCB == pxCurrentTCB )
+			{
+				configASSERT( uxSchedulerSuspended == 0 );
+				portYIELD_WITHIN_API();
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_vTaskDelete */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskDelayUntil == 1 )
+
+	void vTaskDelayUntil( TickType_t * const pxPreviousWakeTime, const TickType_t xTimeIncrement )
+	{
+	TickType_t xTimeToWake;
+	BaseType_t xAlreadyYielded, xShouldDelay = pdFALSE;
+
+		configASSERT( pxPreviousWakeTime );
+		configASSERT( ( xTimeIncrement > 0U ) );
+		configASSERT( uxSchedulerSuspended == 0 );
+
+		vTaskSuspendAll();
+		{
+			/* Minor optimisation.  The tick count cannot change in this
+			block. */
+			const TickType_t xConstTickCount = xTickCount;
+
+			/* Generate the tick time at which the task wants to wake. */
+			xTimeToWake = *pxPreviousWakeTime + xTimeIncrement;
+
+			if( xConstTickCount < *pxPreviousWakeTime )
+			{
+				/* The tick count has overflowed since this function was
+				lasted called.  In this case the only time we should ever
+				actually delay is if the wake time has also	overflowed,
+				and the wake time is greater than the tick time.  When this
+				is the case it is as if neither time had overflowed. */
+				if( ( xTimeToWake < *pxPreviousWakeTime ) && ( xTimeToWake > xConstTickCount ) )
+				{
+					xShouldDelay = pdTRUE;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				/* The tick time has not overflowed.  In this case we will
+				delay if either the wake time has overflowed, and/or the
+				tick time is less than the wake time. */
+				if( ( xTimeToWake < *pxPreviousWakeTime ) || ( xTimeToWake > xConstTickCount ) )
+				{
+					xShouldDelay = pdTRUE;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+
+			/* Update the wake time ready for the next call. */
+			*pxPreviousWakeTime = xTimeToWake;
+
+			if( xShouldDelay != pdFALSE )
+			{
+				traceTASK_DELAY_UNTIL( xTimeToWake );
+
+				/* prvAddCurrentTaskToDelayedList() needs the block time, not
+				the time to wake, so subtract the current tick count. */
+				prvAddCurrentTaskToDelayedList( xTimeToWake - xConstTickCount, pdFALSE );
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		xAlreadyYielded = xTaskResumeAll();
+
+		/* Force a reschedule if xTaskResumeAll has not already done so, we may
+		have put ourselves to sleep. */
+		if( xAlreadyYielded == pdFALSE )
+		{
+			portYIELD_WITHIN_API();
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_vTaskDelayUntil */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskDelay == 1 )
+
+	void vTaskDelay( const TickType_t xTicksToDelay )
+	{
+	BaseType_t xAlreadyYielded = pdFALSE;
+
+		/* A delay time of zero just forces a reschedule. */
+		if( xTicksToDelay > ( TickType_t ) 0U )
+		{
+			configASSERT( uxSchedulerSuspended == 0 );
+			vTaskSuspendAll();
+			{
+				traceTASK_DELAY();
+
+				/* A task that is removed from the event list while the
+				scheduler is suspended will not get placed in the ready
+				list or removed from the blocked list until the scheduler
+				is resumed.
+
+				This task cannot be in an event list as it is the currently
+				executing task. */
+				prvAddCurrentTaskToDelayedList( xTicksToDelay, pdFALSE );
+			}
+			xAlreadyYielded = xTaskResumeAll();
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		/* Force a reschedule if xTaskResumeAll has not already done so, we may
+		have put ourselves to sleep. */
+		if( xAlreadyYielded == pdFALSE )
+		{
+			portYIELD_WITHIN_API();
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_vTaskDelay */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( ( INCLUDE_eTaskGetState == 1 ) || ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 ) || ( INCLUDE_xTaskAbortDelay == 1 ) )
+
+	eTaskState eTaskGetState( TaskHandle_t xTask )
+	{
+	eTaskState eReturn;
+	List_t const * pxStateList, *pxDelayedList, *pxOverflowedDelayedList;
+	const TCB_t * const pxTCB = xTask;
+
+		configASSERT( pxTCB );
+
+		if( pxTCB == pxCurrentTCB )
+		{
+			/* The task calling this function is querying its own state. */
+			eReturn = eRunning;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+			{
+				pxStateList = listLIST_ITEM_CONTAINER( &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+				pxDelayedList = pxDelayedTaskList;
+				pxOverflowedDelayedList = pxOverflowDelayedTaskList;
+			}
+			taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+			if( ( pxStateList == pxDelayedList ) || ( pxStateList == pxOverflowedDelayedList ) )
+			{
+				/* The task being queried is referenced from one of the Blocked
+				lists. */
+				eReturn = eBlocked;
+			}
+
+			#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend == 1 )
+				else if( pxStateList == &xSuspendedTaskList )
+				{
+					/* The task being queried is referenced from the suspended
+					list.  Is it genuinely suspended or is it blocked
+					indefinitely? */
+					if( listLIST_ITEM_CONTAINER( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) ) == NULL )
+					{
+						#if( configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS == 1 )
+						{
+							/* The task does not appear on the event list item of
+							and of the RTOS objects, but could still be in the
+							blocked state if it is waiting on its notification
+							rather than waiting on an object. */
+							if( pxTCB->ucNotifyState == taskWAITING_NOTIFICATION )
+							{
+								eReturn = eBlocked;
+							}
+							else
+							{
+								eReturn = eSuspended;
+							}
+						}
+						#else
+						{
+							eReturn = eSuspended;
+						}
+						#endif
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						eReturn = eBlocked;
+					}
+				}
+			#endif
+
+			#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskDelete == 1 )
+				else if( ( pxStateList == &xTasksWaitingTermination ) || ( pxStateList == NULL ) )
+				{
+					/* The task being queried is referenced from the deleted
+					tasks list, or it is not referenced from any lists at
+					all. */
+					eReturn = eDeleted;
+				}
+			#endif
+
+			else /*lint !e525 Negative indentation is intended to make use of pre-processor clearer. */
+			{
+				/* If the task is not in any other state, it must be in the
+				Ready (including pending ready) state. */
+				eReturn = eReady;
+			}
+		}
+
+		return eReturn;
+	} /*lint !e818 xTask cannot be a pointer to const because it is a typedef. */
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_eTaskGetState */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_uxTaskPriorityGet == 1 )
+
+	UBaseType_t uxTaskPriorityGet( const TaskHandle_t xTask )
+	{
+	TCB_t const *pxTCB;
+	UBaseType_t uxReturn;
+
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			/* If null is passed in here then it is the priority of the task
+			that called uxTaskPriorityGet() that is being queried. */
+			pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTask );
+			uxReturn = pxTCB->uxPriority;
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		return uxReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_uxTaskPriorityGet */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_uxTaskPriorityGet == 1 )
+
+	UBaseType_t uxTaskPriorityGetFromISR( const TaskHandle_t xTask )
+	{
+	TCB_t const *pxTCB;
+	UBaseType_t uxReturn, uxSavedInterruptState;
+
+		/* RTOS ports that support interrupt nesting have the concept of a
+		maximum	system call (or maximum API call) interrupt priority.
+		Interrupts that are	above the maximum system call priority are keep
+		permanently enabled, even when the RTOS kernel is in a critical section,
+		but cannot make any calls to FreeRTOS API functions.  If configASSERT()
+		is defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h then
+		portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID() will result in an assertion
+		failure if a FreeRTOS API function is called from an interrupt that has
+		been assigned a priority above the configured maximum system call
+		priority.  Only FreeRTOS functions that end in FromISR can be called
+		from interrupts	that have been assigned a priority at or (logically)
+		below the maximum system call interrupt priority.  FreeRTOS maintains a
+		separate interrupt safe API to ensure interrupt entry is as fast and as
+		simple as possible.  More information (albeit Cortex-M specific) is
+		provided on the following link:
+		https://www.freertos.org/RTOS-Cortex-M3-M4.html */
+		portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID();
+
+		uxSavedInterruptState = portSET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR();
+		{
+			/* If null is passed in here then it is the priority of the calling
+			task that is being queried. */
+			pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTask );
+			uxReturn = pxTCB->uxPriority;
+		}
+		portCLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR( uxSavedInterruptState );
+
+		return uxReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_uxTaskPriorityGet */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskPrioritySet == 1 )
+
+	void vTaskPrioritySet( TaskHandle_t xTask, UBaseType_t uxNewPriority )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxTCB;
+	UBaseType_t uxCurrentBasePriority, uxPriorityUsedOnEntry;
+	BaseType_t xYieldRequired = pdFALSE;
+
+		configASSERT( ( uxNewPriority < configMAX_PRIORITIES ) );
+
+		/* Ensure the new priority is valid. */
+		if( uxNewPriority >= ( UBaseType_t ) configMAX_PRIORITIES )
+		{
+			uxNewPriority = ( UBaseType_t ) configMAX_PRIORITIES - ( UBaseType_t ) 1U;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			/* If null is passed in here then it is the priority of the calling
+			task that is being changed. */
+			pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTask );
+
+			traceTASK_PRIORITY_SET( pxTCB, uxNewPriority );
+
+			#if ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+			{
+				uxCurrentBasePriority = pxTCB->uxBasePriority;
+			}
+			#else
+			{
+				uxCurrentBasePriority = pxTCB->uxPriority;
+			}
+			#endif
+
+			if( uxCurrentBasePriority != uxNewPriority )
+			{
+				/* The priority change may have readied a task of higher
+				priority than the calling task. */
+				if( uxNewPriority > uxCurrentBasePriority )
+				{
+					if( pxTCB != pxCurrentTCB )
+					{
+						/* The priority of a task other than the currently
+						running task is being raised.  Is the priority being
+						raised above that of the running task? */
+						if( uxNewPriority >= pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority )
+						{
+							xYieldRequired = pdTRUE;
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						/* The priority of the running task is being raised,
+						but the running task must already be the highest
+						priority task able to run so no yield is required. */
+					}
+				}
+				else if( pxTCB == pxCurrentTCB )
+				{
+					/* Setting the priority of the running task down means
+					there may now be another task of higher priority that
+					is ready to execute. */
+					xYieldRequired = pdTRUE;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* Setting the priority of any other task down does not
+					require a yield as the running task must be above the
+					new priority of the task being modified. */
+				}
+
+				/* Remember the ready list the task might be referenced from
+				before its uxPriority member is changed so the
+				taskRESET_READY_PRIORITY() macro can function correctly. */
+				uxPriorityUsedOnEntry = pxTCB->uxPriority;
+
+				#if ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+				{
+					/* Only change the priority being used if the task is not
+					currently using an inherited priority. */
+					if( pxTCB->uxBasePriority == pxTCB->uxPriority )
+					{
+						pxTCB->uxPriority = uxNewPriority;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+
+					/* The base priority gets set whatever. */
+					pxTCB->uxBasePriority = uxNewPriority;
+				}
+				#else
+				{
+					pxTCB->uxPriority = uxNewPriority;
+				}
+				#endif
+
+				/* Only reset the event list item value if the value is not
+				being used for anything else. */
+				if( ( listGET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) ) & taskEVENT_LIST_ITEM_VALUE_IN_USE ) == 0UL )
+				{
+					listSET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ), ( ( TickType_t ) configMAX_PRIORITIES - ( TickType_t ) uxNewPriority ) ); /*lint !e961 MISRA exception as the casts are only redundant for some ports. */
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+
+				/* If the task is in the blocked or suspended list we need do
+				nothing more than change its priority variable. However, if
+				the task is in a ready list it needs to be removed and placed
+				in the list appropriate to its new priority. */
+				if( listIS_CONTAINED_WITHIN( &( pxReadyTasksLists[ uxPriorityUsedOnEntry ] ), &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) ) != pdFALSE )
+				{
+					/* The task is currently in its ready list - remove before
+					adding it to it's new ready list.  As we are in a critical
+					section we can do this even if the scheduler is suspended. */
+					if( uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) ) == ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+					{
+						/* It is known that the task is in its ready list so
+						there is no need to check again and the port level
+						reset macro can be called directly. */
+						portRESET_READY_PRIORITY( uxPriorityUsedOnEntry, uxTopReadyPriority );
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+					prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxTCB );
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+
+				if( xYieldRequired != pdFALSE )
+				{
+					taskYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION();
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+
+				/* Remove compiler warning about unused variables when the port
+				optimised task selection is not being used. */
+				( void ) uxPriorityUsedOnEntry;
+			}
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_vTaskPrioritySet */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend == 1 )
+
+	void vTaskSuspend( TaskHandle_t xTaskToSuspend )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxTCB;
+
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			/* If null is passed in here then it is the running task that is
+			being suspended. */
+			pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTaskToSuspend );
+
+			traceTASK_SUSPEND( pxTCB );
+
+			/* Remove task from the ready/delayed list and place in the
+			suspended list. */
+			if( uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) ) == ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+			{
+				taskRESET_READY_PRIORITY( pxTCB->uxPriority );
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+
+			/* Is the task waiting on an event also? */
+			if( listLIST_ITEM_CONTAINER( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) ) != NULL )
+			{
+				( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) );
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+
+			vListInsertEnd( &xSuspendedTaskList, &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+
+			#if( configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS == 1 )
+			{
+				if( pxTCB->ucNotifyState == taskWAITING_NOTIFICATION )
+				{
+					/* The task was blocked to wait for a notification, but is
+					now suspended, so no notification was received. */
+					pxTCB->ucNotifyState = taskNOT_WAITING_NOTIFICATION;
+				}
+			}
+			#endif
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		if( xSchedulerRunning != pdFALSE )
+		{
+			/* Reset the next expected unblock time in case it referred to the
+			task that is now in the Suspended state. */
+			taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+			{
+				prvResetNextTaskUnblockTime();
+			}
+			taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		if( pxTCB == pxCurrentTCB )
+		{
+			if( xSchedulerRunning != pdFALSE )
+			{
+				/* The current task has just been suspended. */
+				configASSERT( uxSchedulerSuspended == 0 );
+				portYIELD_WITHIN_API();
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				/* The scheduler is not running, but the task that was pointed
+				to by pxCurrentTCB has just been suspended and pxCurrentTCB
+				must be adjusted to point to a different task. */
+				if( listCURRENT_LIST_LENGTH( &xSuspendedTaskList ) == uxCurrentNumberOfTasks ) /*lint !e931 Right has no side effect, just volatile. */
+				{
+					/* No other tasks are ready, so set pxCurrentTCB back to
+					NULL so when the next task is created pxCurrentTCB will
+					be set to point to it no matter what its relative priority
+					is. */
+					pxCurrentTCB = NULL;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					vTaskSwitchContext();
+				}
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend == 1 )
+
+	static BaseType_t prvTaskIsTaskSuspended( const TaskHandle_t xTask )
+	{
+	BaseType_t xReturn = pdFALSE;
+	const TCB_t * const pxTCB = xTask;
+
+		/* Accesses xPendingReadyList so must be called from a critical
+		section. */
+
+		/* It does not make sense to check if the calling task is suspended. */
+		configASSERT( xTask );
+
+		/* Is the task being resumed actually in the suspended list? */
+		if( listIS_CONTAINED_WITHIN( &xSuspendedTaskList, &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) ) != pdFALSE )
+		{
+			/* Has the task already been resumed from within an ISR? */
+			if( listIS_CONTAINED_WITHIN( &xPendingReadyList, &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) ) == pdFALSE )
+			{
+				/* Is it in the suspended list because it is in the	Suspended
+				state, or because is is blocked with no timeout? */
+				if( listIS_CONTAINED_WITHIN( NULL, &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) ) != pdFALSE ) /*lint !e961.  The cast is only redundant when NULL is used. */
+				{
+					xReturn = pdTRUE;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		return xReturn;
+	} /*lint !e818 xTask cannot be a pointer to const because it is a typedef. */
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend == 1 )
+
+	void vTaskResume( TaskHandle_t xTaskToResume )
+	{
+	TCB_t * const pxTCB = xTaskToResume;
+
+		/* It does not make sense to resume the calling task. */
+		configASSERT( xTaskToResume );
+
+		/* The parameter cannot be NULL as it is impossible to resume the
+		currently executing task. */
+		if( ( pxTCB != pxCurrentTCB ) && ( pxTCB != NULL ) )
+		{
+			taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+			{
+				if( prvTaskIsTaskSuspended( pxTCB ) != pdFALSE )
+				{
+					traceTASK_RESUME( pxTCB );
+
+					/* The ready list can be accessed even if the scheduler is
+					suspended because this is inside a critical section. */
+					( void ) uxListRemove(  &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+					prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxTCB );
+
+					/* A higher priority task may have just been resumed. */
+					if( pxTCB->uxPriority >= pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority )
+					{
+						/* This yield may not cause the task just resumed to run,
+						but will leave the lists in the correct state for the
+						next yield. */
+						taskYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION();
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend */
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( ( INCLUDE_xTaskResumeFromISR == 1 ) && ( INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend == 1 ) )
+
+	BaseType_t xTaskResumeFromISR( TaskHandle_t xTaskToResume )
+	{
+	BaseType_t xYieldRequired = pdFALSE;
+	TCB_t * const pxTCB = xTaskToResume;
+	UBaseType_t uxSavedInterruptStatus;
+
+		configASSERT( xTaskToResume );
+
+		/* RTOS ports that support interrupt nesting have the concept of a
+		maximum	system call (or maximum API call) interrupt priority.
+		Interrupts that are	above the maximum system call priority are keep
+		permanently enabled, even when the RTOS kernel is in a critical section,
+		but cannot make any calls to FreeRTOS API functions.  If configASSERT()
+		is defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h then
+		portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID() will result in an assertion
+		failure if a FreeRTOS API function is called from an interrupt that has
+		been assigned a priority above the configured maximum system call
+		priority.  Only FreeRTOS functions that end in FromISR can be called
+		from interrupts	that have been assigned a priority at or (logically)
+		below the maximum system call interrupt priority.  FreeRTOS maintains a
+		separate interrupt safe API to ensure interrupt entry is as fast and as
+		simple as possible.  More information (albeit Cortex-M specific) is
+		provided on the following link:
+		https://www.freertos.org/RTOS-Cortex-M3-M4.html */
+		portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID();
+
+		uxSavedInterruptStatus = portSET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR();
+		{
+			if( prvTaskIsTaskSuspended( pxTCB ) != pdFALSE )
+			{
+				traceTASK_RESUME_FROM_ISR( pxTCB );
+
+				/* Check the ready lists can be accessed. */
+				if( uxSchedulerSuspended == ( UBaseType_t ) pdFALSE )
+				{
+					/* Ready lists can be accessed so move the task from the
+					suspended list to the ready list directly. */
+					if( pxTCB->uxPriority >= pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority )
+					{
+						xYieldRequired = pdTRUE;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+
+					( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+					prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxTCB );
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* The delayed or ready lists cannot be accessed so the task
+					is held in the pending ready list until the scheduler is
+					unsuspended. */
+					vListInsertEnd( &( xPendingReadyList ), &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) );
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		portCLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR( uxSavedInterruptStatus );
+
+		return xYieldRequired;
+	}
+
+#endif /* ( ( INCLUDE_xTaskResumeFromISR == 1 ) && ( INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend == 1 ) ) */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vTaskStartScheduler( void )
+{
+BaseType_t xReturn;
+
+	/* Add the idle task at the lowest priority. */
+	#if( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 )
+	{
+		StaticTask_t *pxIdleTaskTCBBuffer = NULL;
+		StackType_t *pxIdleTaskStackBuffer = NULL;
+		uint32_t ulIdleTaskStackSize;
+
+		/* The Idle task is created using user provided RAM - obtain the
+		address of the RAM then create the idle task. */
+		vApplicationGetIdleTaskMemory( &pxIdleTaskTCBBuffer, &pxIdleTaskStackBuffer, &ulIdleTaskStackSize );
+		xIdleTaskHandle = xTaskCreateStatic(	prvIdleTask,
+												configIDLE_TASK_NAME,
+												ulIdleTaskStackSize,
+												( void * ) NULL, /*lint !e961.  The cast is not redundant for all compilers. */
+												portPRIVILEGE_BIT, /* In effect ( tskIDLE_PRIORITY | portPRIVILEGE_BIT ), but tskIDLE_PRIORITY is zero. */
+												pxIdleTaskStackBuffer,
+												pxIdleTaskTCBBuffer ); /*lint !e961 MISRA exception, justified as it is not a redundant explicit cast to all supported compilers. */
+
+		if( xIdleTaskHandle != NULL )
+		{
+			xReturn = pdPASS;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xReturn = pdFAIL;
+		}
+	}
+	#else
+	{
+		/* The Idle task is being created using dynamically allocated RAM. */
+		xReturn = xTaskCreate(	prvIdleTask,
+								configIDLE_TASK_NAME,
+								configMINIMAL_STACK_SIZE,
+								( void * ) NULL,
+								portPRIVILEGE_BIT, /* In effect ( tskIDLE_PRIORITY | portPRIVILEGE_BIT ), but tskIDLE_PRIORITY is zero. */
+								&xIdleTaskHandle ); /*lint !e961 MISRA exception, justified as it is not a redundant explicit cast to all supported compilers. */
+	}
+	#endif /* configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION */
+
+	#if ( configUSE_TIMERS == 1 )
+	{
+		if( xReturn == pdPASS )
+		{
+			xReturn = xTimerCreateTimerTask();
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+	#endif /* configUSE_TIMERS */
+
+	if( xReturn == pdPASS )
+	{
+		/* freertos_tasks_c_additions_init() should only be called if the user
+		definable macro FREERTOS_TASKS_C_ADDITIONS_INIT() is defined, as that is
+		the only macro called by the function. */
+		#ifdef FREERTOS_TASKS_C_ADDITIONS_INIT
+		{
+			freertos_tasks_c_additions_init();
+		}
+		#endif
+
+		/* Interrupts are turned off here, to ensure a tick does not occur
+		before or during the call to xPortStartScheduler().  The stacks of
+		the created tasks contain a status word with interrupts switched on
+		so interrupts will automatically get re-enabled when the first task
+		starts to run. */
+		portDISABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+
+		#if ( configUSE_NEWLIB_REENTRANT == 1 )
+		{
+			/* Switch Newlib's _impure_ptr variable to point to the _reent
+			structure specific to the task that will run first.
+			See the third party link http://www.nadler.com/embedded/newlibAndFreeRTOS.html
+			for additional information. */
+			_impure_ptr = &( pxCurrentTCB->xNewLib_reent );
+		}
+		#endif /* configUSE_NEWLIB_REENTRANT */
+
+		xNextTaskUnblockTime = portMAX_DELAY;
+		xSchedulerRunning = pdTRUE;
+		xTickCount = ( TickType_t ) configINITIAL_TICK_COUNT;
+
+		/* If configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS is defined then the following
+		macro must be defined to configure the timer/counter used to generate
+		the run time counter time base.   NOTE:  If configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS
+		is set to 0 and the following line fails to build then ensure you do not
+		have portCONFIGURE_TIMER_FOR_RUN_TIME_STATS() defined in your
+		FreeRTOSConfig.h file. */
+		portCONFIGURE_TIMER_FOR_RUN_TIME_STATS();
+
+		traceTASK_SWITCHED_IN();
+
+		/* Setting up the timer tick is hardware specific and thus in the
+		portable interface. */
+		if( xPortStartScheduler() != pdFALSE )
+		{
+			/* Should not reach here as if the scheduler is running the
+			function will not return. */
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			/* Should only reach here if a task calls xTaskEndScheduler(). */
+		}
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		/* This line will only be reached if the kernel could not be started,
+		because there was not enough FreeRTOS heap to create the idle task
+		or the timer task. */
+		configASSERT( xReturn != errCOULD_NOT_ALLOCATE_REQUIRED_MEMORY );
+	}
+
+	/* Prevent compiler warnings if INCLUDE_xTaskGetIdleTaskHandle is set to 0,
+	meaning xIdleTaskHandle is not used anywhere else. */
+	( void ) xIdleTaskHandle;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vTaskEndScheduler( void )
+{
+	/* Stop the scheduler interrupts and call the portable scheduler end
+	routine so the original ISRs can be restored if necessary.  The port
+	layer must ensure interrupts enable	bit is left in the correct state. */
+	portDISABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+	xSchedulerRunning = pdFALSE;
+	vPortEndScheduler();
+}
+/*----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vTaskSuspendAll( void )
+{
+	/* A critical section is not required as the variable is of type
+	BaseType_t.  Please read Richard Barry's reply in the following link to a
+	post in the FreeRTOS support forum before reporting this as a bug! -
+	http://goo.gl/wu4acr */
+
+	/* portSOFRWARE_BARRIER() is only implemented for emulated/simulated ports that
+	do not otherwise exhibit real time behaviour. */
+	portSOFTWARE_BARRIER();
+
+	/* The scheduler is suspended if uxSchedulerSuspended is non-zero.  An increment
+	is used to allow calls to vTaskSuspendAll() to nest. */
+	++uxSchedulerSuspended;
+
+	/* Enforces ordering for ports and optimised compilers that may otherwise place
+	the above increment elsewhere. */
+	portMEMORY_BARRIER();
+}
+/*----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE != 0 )
+
+	static TickType_t prvGetExpectedIdleTime( void )
+	{
+	TickType_t xReturn;
+	UBaseType_t uxHigherPriorityReadyTasks = pdFALSE;
+
+		/* uxHigherPriorityReadyTasks takes care of the case where
+		configUSE_PREEMPTION is 0, so there may be tasks above the idle priority
+		task that are in the Ready state, even though the idle task is
+		running. */
+		#if( configUSE_PORT_OPTIMISED_TASK_SELECTION == 0 )
+		{
+			if( uxTopReadyPriority > tskIDLE_PRIORITY )
+			{
+				uxHigherPriorityReadyTasks = pdTRUE;
+			}
+		}
+		#else
+		{
+			const UBaseType_t uxLeastSignificantBit = ( UBaseType_t ) 0x01;
+
+			/* When port optimised task selection is used the uxTopReadyPriority
+			variable is used as a bit map.  If bits other than the least
+			significant bit are set then there are tasks that have a priority
+			above the idle priority that are in the Ready state.  This takes
+			care of the case where the co-operative scheduler is in use. */
+			if( uxTopReadyPriority > uxLeastSignificantBit )
+			{
+				uxHigherPriorityReadyTasks = pdTRUE;
+			}
+		}
+		#endif
+
+		if( pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority > tskIDLE_PRIORITY )
+		{
+			xReturn = 0;
+		}
+		else if( listCURRENT_LIST_LENGTH( &( pxReadyTasksLists[ tskIDLE_PRIORITY ] ) ) > 1 )
+		{
+			/* There are other idle priority tasks in the ready state.  If
+			time slicing is used then the very next tick interrupt must be
+			processed. */
+			xReturn = 0;
+		}
+		else if( uxHigherPriorityReadyTasks != pdFALSE )
+		{
+			/* There are tasks in the Ready state that have a priority above the
+			idle priority.  This path can only be reached if
+			configUSE_PREEMPTION is 0. */
+			xReturn = 0;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xReturn = xNextTaskUnblockTime - xTickCount;
+		}
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE */
+/*----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xTaskResumeAll( void )
+{
+TCB_t *pxTCB = NULL;
+BaseType_t xAlreadyYielded = pdFALSE;
+
+	/* If uxSchedulerSuspended is zero then this function does not match a
+	previous call to vTaskSuspendAll(). */
+	configASSERT( uxSchedulerSuspended );
+
+	/* It is possible that an ISR caused a task to be removed from an event
+	list while the scheduler was suspended.  If this was the case then the
+	removed task will have been added to the xPendingReadyList.  Once the
+	scheduler has been resumed it is safe to move all the pending ready
+	tasks from this list into their appropriate ready list. */
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		--uxSchedulerSuspended;
+
+		if( uxSchedulerSuspended == ( UBaseType_t ) pdFALSE )
+		{
+			if( uxCurrentNumberOfTasks > ( UBaseType_t ) 0U )
+			{
+				/* Move any readied tasks from the pending list into the
+				appropriate ready list. */
+				while( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( &xPendingReadyList ) == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					pxTCB = listGET_OWNER_OF_HEAD_ENTRY( ( &xPendingReadyList ) ); /*lint !e9079 void * is used as this macro is used with timers and co-routines too.  Alignment is known to be fine as the type of the pointer stored and retrieved is the same. */
+					( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) );
+					( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+					prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxTCB );
+
+					/* If the moved task has a priority higher than the current
+					task then a yield must be performed. */
+					if( pxTCB->uxPriority >= pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority )
+					{
+						xYieldPending = pdTRUE;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+
+				if( pxTCB != NULL )
+				{
+					/* A task was unblocked while the scheduler was suspended,
+					which may have prevented the next unblock time from being
+					re-calculated, in which case re-calculate it now.  Mainly
+					important for low power tickless implementations, where
+					this can prevent an unnecessary exit from low power
+					state. */
+					prvResetNextTaskUnblockTime();
+				}
+
+				/* If any ticks occurred while the scheduler was suspended then
+				they should be processed now.  This ensures the tick count does
+				not	slip, and that any delayed tasks are resumed at the correct
+				time. */
+				{
+					TickType_t xPendedCounts = xPendedTicks; /* Non-volatile copy. */
+
+					if( xPendedCounts > ( TickType_t ) 0U )
+					{
+						do
+						{
+							if( xTaskIncrementTick() != pdFALSE )
+							{
+								xYieldPending = pdTRUE;
+							}
+							else
+							{
+								mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+							}
+							--xPendedCounts;
+						} while( xPendedCounts > ( TickType_t ) 0U );
+
+						xPendedTicks = 0;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+
+				if( xYieldPending != pdFALSE )
+				{
+					#if( configUSE_PREEMPTION != 0 )
+					{
+						xAlreadyYielded = pdTRUE;
+					}
+					#endif
+					taskYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION();
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+	return xAlreadyYielded;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+TickType_t xTaskGetTickCount( void )
+{
+TickType_t xTicks;
+
+	/* Critical section required if running on a 16 bit processor. */
+	portTICK_TYPE_ENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		xTicks = xTickCount;
+	}
+	portTICK_TYPE_EXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+	return xTicks;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+TickType_t xTaskGetTickCountFromISR( void )
+{
+TickType_t xReturn;
+UBaseType_t uxSavedInterruptStatus;
+
+	/* RTOS ports that support interrupt nesting have the concept of a maximum
+	system call (or maximum API call) interrupt priority.  Interrupts that are
+	above the maximum system call priority are kept permanently enabled, even
+	when the RTOS kernel is in a critical section, but cannot make any calls to
+	FreeRTOS API functions.  If configASSERT() is defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h
+	then portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID() will result in an assertion
+	failure if a FreeRTOS API function is called from an interrupt that has been
+	assigned a priority above the configured maximum system call priority.
+	Only FreeRTOS functions that end in FromISR can be called from interrupts
+	that have been assigned a priority at or (logically) below the maximum
+	system call	interrupt priority.  FreeRTOS maintains a separate interrupt
+	safe API to ensure interrupt entry is as fast and as simple as possible.
+	More information (albeit Cortex-M specific) is provided on the following
+	link: https://www.freertos.org/RTOS-Cortex-M3-M4.html */
+	portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID();
+
+	uxSavedInterruptStatus = portTICK_TYPE_SET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR();
+	{
+		xReturn = xTickCount;
+	}
+	portTICK_TYPE_CLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR( uxSavedInterruptStatus );
+
+	return xReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+UBaseType_t uxTaskGetNumberOfTasks( void )
+{
+	/* A critical section is not required because the variables are of type
+	BaseType_t. */
+	return uxCurrentNumberOfTasks;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+char *pcTaskGetName( TaskHandle_t xTaskToQuery ) /*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+{
+TCB_t *pxTCB;
+
+	/* If null is passed in here then the name of the calling task is being
+	queried. */
+	pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTaskToQuery );
+	configASSERT( pxTCB );
+	return &( pxTCB->pcTaskName[ 0 ] );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_xTaskGetHandle == 1 )
+
+	static TCB_t *prvSearchForNameWithinSingleList( List_t *pxList, const char pcNameToQuery[] )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxNextTCB, *pxFirstTCB, *pxReturn = NULL;
+	UBaseType_t x;
+	char cNextChar;
+	BaseType_t xBreakLoop;
+
+		/* This function is called with the scheduler suspended. */
+
+		if( listCURRENT_LIST_LENGTH( pxList ) > ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+		{
+			listGET_OWNER_OF_NEXT_ENTRY( pxFirstTCB, pxList );  /*lint !e9079 void * is used as this macro is used with timers and co-routines too.  Alignment is known to be fine as the type of the pointer stored and retrieved is the same. */
+
+			do
+			{
+				listGET_OWNER_OF_NEXT_ENTRY( pxNextTCB, pxList ); /*lint !e9079 void * is used as this macro is used with timers and co-routines too.  Alignment is known to be fine as the type of the pointer stored and retrieved is the same. */
+
+				/* Check each character in the name looking for a match or
+				mismatch. */
+				xBreakLoop = pdFALSE;
+				for( x = ( UBaseType_t ) 0; x < ( UBaseType_t ) configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN; x++ )
+				{
+					cNextChar = pxNextTCB->pcTaskName[ x ];
+
+					if( cNextChar != pcNameToQuery[ x ] )
+					{
+						/* Characters didn't match. */
+						xBreakLoop = pdTRUE;
+					}
+					else if( cNextChar == ( char ) 0x00 )
+					{
+						/* Both strings terminated, a match must have been
+						found. */
+						pxReturn = pxNextTCB;
+						xBreakLoop = pdTRUE;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+
+					if( xBreakLoop != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						break;
+					}
+				}
+
+				if( pxReturn != NULL )
+				{
+					/* The handle has been found. */
+					break;
+				}
+
+			} while( pxNextTCB != pxFirstTCB );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		return pxReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_xTaskGetHandle */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_xTaskGetHandle == 1 )
+
+	TaskHandle_t xTaskGetHandle( const char *pcNameToQuery ) /*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+	{
+	UBaseType_t uxQueue = configMAX_PRIORITIES;
+	TCB_t* pxTCB;
+
+		/* Task names will be truncated to configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN - 1 bytes. */
+		configASSERT( strlen( pcNameToQuery ) < configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN );
+
+		vTaskSuspendAll();
+		{
+			/* Search the ready lists. */
+			do
+			{
+				uxQueue--;
+				pxTCB = prvSearchForNameWithinSingleList( ( List_t * ) &( pxReadyTasksLists[ uxQueue ] ), pcNameToQuery );
+
+				if( pxTCB != NULL )
+				{
+					/* Found the handle. */
+					break;
+				}
+
+			} while( uxQueue > ( UBaseType_t ) tskIDLE_PRIORITY ); /*lint !e961 MISRA exception as the casts are only redundant for some ports. */
+
+			/* Search the delayed lists. */
+			if( pxTCB == NULL )
+			{
+				pxTCB = prvSearchForNameWithinSingleList( ( List_t * ) pxDelayedTaskList, pcNameToQuery );
+			}
+
+			if( pxTCB == NULL )
+			{
+				pxTCB = prvSearchForNameWithinSingleList( ( List_t * ) pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, pcNameToQuery );
+			}
+
+			#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend == 1 )
+			{
+				if( pxTCB == NULL )
+				{
+					/* Search the suspended list. */
+					pxTCB = prvSearchForNameWithinSingleList( &xSuspendedTaskList, pcNameToQuery );
+				}
+			}
+			#endif
+
+			#if( INCLUDE_vTaskDelete == 1 )
+			{
+				if( pxTCB == NULL )
+				{
+					/* Search the deleted list. */
+					pxTCB = prvSearchForNameWithinSingleList( &xTasksWaitingTermination, pcNameToQuery );
+				}
+			}
+			#endif
+		}
+		( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+
+		return pxTCB;
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_xTaskGetHandle */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+
+	UBaseType_t uxTaskGetSystemState( TaskStatus_t * const pxTaskStatusArray, const UBaseType_t uxArraySize, uint32_t * const pulTotalRunTime )
+	{
+	UBaseType_t uxTask = 0, uxQueue = configMAX_PRIORITIES;
+
+		vTaskSuspendAll();
+		{
+			/* Is there a space in the array for each task in the system? */
+			if( uxArraySize >= uxCurrentNumberOfTasks )
+			{
+				/* Fill in an TaskStatus_t structure with information on each
+				task in the Ready state. */
+				do
+				{
+					uxQueue--;
+					uxTask += prvListTasksWithinSingleList( &( pxTaskStatusArray[ uxTask ] ), &( pxReadyTasksLists[ uxQueue ] ), eReady );
+
+				} while( uxQueue > ( UBaseType_t ) tskIDLE_PRIORITY ); /*lint !e961 MISRA exception as the casts are only redundant for some ports. */
+
+				/* Fill in an TaskStatus_t structure with information on each
+				task in the Blocked state. */
+				uxTask += prvListTasksWithinSingleList( &( pxTaskStatusArray[ uxTask ] ), ( List_t * ) pxDelayedTaskList, eBlocked );
+				uxTask += prvListTasksWithinSingleList( &( pxTaskStatusArray[ uxTask ] ), ( List_t * ) pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, eBlocked );
+
+				#if( INCLUDE_vTaskDelete == 1 )
+				{
+					/* Fill in an TaskStatus_t structure with information on
+					each task that has been deleted but not yet cleaned up. */
+					uxTask += prvListTasksWithinSingleList( &( pxTaskStatusArray[ uxTask ] ), &xTasksWaitingTermination, eDeleted );
+				}
+				#endif
+
+				#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend == 1 )
+				{
+					/* Fill in an TaskStatus_t structure with information on
+					each task in the Suspended state. */
+					uxTask += prvListTasksWithinSingleList( &( pxTaskStatusArray[ uxTask ] ), &xSuspendedTaskList, eSuspended );
+				}
+				#endif
+
+				#if ( configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS == 1)
+				{
+					if( pulTotalRunTime != NULL )
+					{
+						#ifdef portALT_GET_RUN_TIME_COUNTER_VALUE
+							portALT_GET_RUN_TIME_COUNTER_VALUE( ( *pulTotalRunTime ) );
+						#else
+							*pulTotalRunTime = portGET_RUN_TIME_COUNTER_VALUE();
+						#endif
+					}
+				}
+				#else
+				{
+					if( pulTotalRunTime != NULL )
+					{
+						*pulTotalRunTime = 0;
+					}
+				}
+				#endif
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+
+		return uxTask;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY */
+/*----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_xTaskGetIdleTaskHandle == 1 )
+
+	TaskHandle_t xTaskGetIdleTaskHandle( void )
+	{
+		/* If xTaskGetIdleTaskHandle() is called before the scheduler has been
+		started, then xIdleTaskHandle will be NULL. */
+		configASSERT( ( xIdleTaskHandle != NULL ) );
+		return xIdleTaskHandle;
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_xTaskGetIdleTaskHandle */
+/*----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* This conditional compilation should use inequality to 0, not equality to 1.
+This is to ensure vTaskStepTick() is available when user defined low power mode
+implementations require configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE to be set to a value other than
+1. */
+#if ( configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE != 0 )
+
+	void vTaskStepTick( const TickType_t xTicksToJump )
+	{
+		/* Correct the tick count value after a period during which the tick
+		was suppressed.  Note this does *not* call the tick hook function for
+		each stepped tick. */
+		configASSERT( ( xTickCount + xTicksToJump ) <= xNextTaskUnblockTime );
+		xTickCount += xTicksToJump;
+		traceINCREASE_TICK_COUNT( xTicksToJump );
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE */
+/*----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xTaskCatchUpTicks( TickType_t xTicksToCatchUp )
+{
+BaseType_t xYieldRequired = pdFALSE;
+
+	/* Must not be called with the scheduler suspended as the implementation
+	relies on xPendedTicks being wound down to 0 in xTaskResumeAll(). */
+	configASSERT( uxSchedulerSuspended == 0 );
+
+	/* Use xPendedTicks to mimic xTicksToCatchUp number of ticks occurring when
+	the scheduler is suspended so the ticks are executed in xTaskResumeAll(). */
+	vTaskSuspendAll();
+	xPendedTicks += xTicksToCatchUp;
+	xYieldRequired = xTaskResumeAll();
+
+	return xYieldRequired;
+}
+/*----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_xTaskAbortDelay == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xTaskAbortDelay( TaskHandle_t xTask )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxTCB = xTask;
+	BaseType_t xReturn;
+
+		configASSERT( pxTCB );
+
+		vTaskSuspendAll();
+		{
+			/* A task can only be prematurely removed from the Blocked state if
+			it is actually in the Blocked state. */
+			if( eTaskGetState( xTask ) == eBlocked )
+			{
+				xReturn = pdPASS;
+
+				/* Remove the reference to the task from the blocked list.  An
+				interrupt won't touch the xStateListItem because the
+				scheduler is suspended. */
+				( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+
+				/* Is the task waiting on an event also?  If so remove it from
+				the event list too.  Interrupts can touch the event list item,
+				even though the scheduler is suspended, so a critical section
+				is used. */
+				taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+				{
+					if( listLIST_ITEM_CONTAINER( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) ) != NULL )
+					{
+						( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) );
+
+						/* This lets the task know it was forcibly removed from the
+						blocked state so it should not re-evaluate its block time and
+						then block again. */
+						pxTCB->ucDelayAborted = pdTRUE;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+				/* Place the unblocked task into the appropriate ready list. */
+				prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxTCB );
+
+				/* A task being unblocked cannot cause an immediate context
+				switch if preemption is turned off. */
+				#if (  configUSE_PREEMPTION == 1 )
+				{
+					/* Preemption is on, but a context switch should only be
+					performed if the unblocked task has a priority that is
+					equal to or higher than the currently executing task. */
+					if( pxTCB->uxPriority > pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority )
+					{
+						/* Pend the yield to be performed when the scheduler
+						is unsuspended. */
+						xYieldPending = pdTRUE;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				#endif /* configUSE_PREEMPTION */
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				xReturn = pdFAIL;
+			}
+		}
+		( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_xTaskAbortDelay */
+/*----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xTaskIncrementTick( void )
+{
+TCB_t * pxTCB;
+TickType_t xItemValue;
+BaseType_t xSwitchRequired = pdFALSE;
+
+	/* Called by the portable layer each time a tick interrupt occurs.
+	Increments the tick then checks to see if the new tick value will cause any
+	tasks to be unblocked. */
+	traceTASK_INCREMENT_TICK( xTickCount );
+	if( uxSchedulerSuspended == ( UBaseType_t ) pdFALSE )
+	{
+		/* Minor optimisation.  The tick count cannot change in this
+		block. */
+		const TickType_t xConstTickCount = xTickCount + ( TickType_t ) 1;
+
+		/* Increment the RTOS tick, switching the delayed and overflowed
+		delayed lists if it wraps to 0. */
+		xTickCount = xConstTickCount;
+
+		if( xConstTickCount == ( TickType_t ) 0U ) /*lint !e774 'if' does not always evaluate to false as it is looking for an overflow. */
+		{
+			taskSWITCH_DELAYED_LISTS();
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		/* See if this tick has made a timeout expire.  Tasks are stored in
+		the	queue in the order of their wake time - meaning once one task
+		has been found whose block time has not expired there is no need to
+		look any further down the list. */
+		if( xConstTickCount >= xNextTaskUnblockTime )
+		{
+			for( ;; )
+			{
+				if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( pxDelayedTaskList ) != pdFALSE )
+				{
+					/* The delayed list is empty.  Set xNextTaskUnblockTime
+					to the maximum possible value so it is extremely
+					unlikely that the
+					if( xTickCount >= xNextTaskUnblockTime ) test will pass
+					next time through. */
+					xNextTaskUnblockTime = portMAX_DELAY; /*lint !e961 MISRA exception as the casts are only redundant for some ports. */
+					break;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* The delayed list is not empty, get the value of the
+					item at the head of the delayed list.  This is the time
+					at which the task at the head of the delayed list must
+					be removed from the Blocked state. */
+					pxTCB = listGET_OWNER_OF_HEAD_ENTRY( pxDelayedTaskList ); /*lint !e9079 void * is used as this macro is used with timers and co-routines too.  Alignment is known to be fine as the type of the pointer stored and retrieved is the same. */
+					xItemValue = listGET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+
+					if( xConstTickCount < xItemValue )
+					{
+						/* It is not time to unblock this item yet, but the
+						item value is the time at which the task at the head
+						of the blocked list must be removed from the Blocked
+						state -	so record the item value in
+						xNextTaskUnblockTime. */
+						xNextTaskUnblockTime = xItemValue;
+						break; /*lint !e9011 Code structure here is deedmed easier to understand with multiple breaks. */
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+
+					/* It is time to remove the item from the Blocked state. */
+					( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+
+					/* Is the task waiting on an event also?  If so remove
+					it from the event list. */
+					if( listLIST_ITEM_CONTAINER( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) ) != NULL )
+					{
+						( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) );
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+
+					/* Place the unblocked task into the appropriate ready
+					list. */
+					prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxTCB );
+
+					/* A task being unblocked cannot cause an immediate
+					context switch if preemption is turned off. */
+					#if (  configUSE_PREEMPTION == 1 )
+					{
+						/* Preemption is on, but a context switch should
+						only be performed if the unblocked task has a
+						priority that is equal to or higher than the
+						currently executing task. */
+						if( pxTCB->uxPriority >= pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority )
+						{
+							xSwitchRequired = pdTRUE;
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+					}
+					#endif /* configUSE_PREEMPTION */
+				}
+			}
+		}
+
+		/* Tasks of equal priority to the currently running task will share
+		processing time (time slice) if preemption is on, and the application
+		writer has not explicitly turned time slicing off. */
+		#if ( ( configUSE_PREEMPTION == 1 ) && ( configUSE_TIME_SLICING == 1 ) )
+		{
+			if( listCURRENT_LIST_LENGTH( &( pxReadyTasksLists[ pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority ] ) ) > ( UBaseType_t ) 1 )
+			{
+				xSwitchRequired = pdTRUE;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		#endif /* ( ( configUSE_PREEMPTION == 1 ) && ( configUSE_TIME_SLICING == 1 ) ) */
+
+		#if ( configUSE_TICK_HOOK == 1 )
+		{
+			/* Guard against the tick hook being called when the pended tick
+			count is being unwound (when the scheduler is being unlocked). */
+			if( xPendedTicks == ( TickType_t ) 0 )
+			{
+				vApplicationTickHook();
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		#endif /* configUSE_TICK_HOOK */
+
+		#if ( configUSE_PREEMPTION == 1 )
+		{
+			if( xYieldPending != pdFALSE )
+			{
+				xSwitchRequired = pdTRUE;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		#endif /* configUSE_PREEMPTION */
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		++xPendedTicks;
+
+		/* The tick hook gets called at regular intervals, even if the
+		scheduler is locked. */
+		#if ( configUSE_TICK_HOOK == 1 )
+		{
+			vApplicationTickHook();
+		}
+		#endif
+	}
+
+	return xSwitchRequired;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_APPLICATION_TASK_TAG == 1 )
+
+	void vTaskSetApplicationTaskTag( TaskHandle_t xTask, TaskHookFunction_t pxHookFunction )
+	{
+	TCB_t *xTCB;
+
+		/* If xTask is NULL then it is the task hook of the calling task that is
+		getting set. */
+		if( xTask == NULL )
+		{
+			xTCB = ( TCB_t * ) pxCurrentTCB;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xTCB = xTask;
+		}
+
+		/* Save the hook function in the TCB.  A critical section is required as
+		the value can be accessed from an interrupt. */
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			xTCB->pxTaskTag = pxHookFunction;
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_APPLICATION_TASK_TAG */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_APPLICATION_TASK_TAG == 1 )
+
+	TaskHookFunction_t xTaskGetApplicationTaskTag( TaskHandle_t xTask )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxTCB;
+	TaskHookFunction_t xReturn;
+
+		/* If xTask is NULL then set the calling task's hook. */
+		pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTask );
+
+		/* Save the hook function in the TCB.  A critical section is required as
+		the value can be accessed from an interrupt. */
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			xReturn = pxTCB->pxTaskTag;
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_APPLICATION_TASK_TAG */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_APPLICATION_TASK_TAG == 1 )
+
+	TaskHookFunction_t xTaskGetApplicationTaskTagFromISR( TaskHandle_t xTask )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxTCB;
+	TaskHookFunction_t xReturn;
+	UBaseType_t uxSavedInterruptStatus;
+
+		/* If xTask is NULL then set the calling task's hook. */
+		pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTask );
+
+		/* Save the hook function in the TCB.  A critical section is required as
+		the value can be accessed from an interrupt. */
+		uxSavedInterruptStatus = portSET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR();
+		{
+			xReturn = pxTCB->pxTaskTag;
+		}
+		portCLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR( uxSavedInterruptStatus );
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_APPLICATION_TASK_TAG */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_APPLICATION_TASK_TAG == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xTaskCallApplicationTaskHook( TaskHandle_t xTask, void *pvParameter )
+	{
+	TCB_t *xTCB;
+	BaseType_t xReturn;
+
+		/* If xTask is NULL then we are calling our own task hook. */
+		if( xTask == NULL )
+		{
+			xTCB = pxCurrentTCB;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xTCB = xTask;
+		}
+
+		if( xTCB->pxTaskTag != NULL )
+		{
+			xReturn = xTCB->pxTaskTag( pvParameter );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xReturn = pdFAIL;
+		}
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_APPLICATION_TASK_TAG */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vTaskSwitchContext( void )
+{
+	if( uxSchedulerSuspended != ( UBaseType_t ) pdFALSE )
+	{
+		/* The scheduler is currently suspended - do not allow a context
+		switch. */
+		xYieldPending = pdTRUE;
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		xYieldPending = pdFALSE;
+		traceTASK_SWITCHED_OUT();
+
+		#if ( configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS == 1 )
+		{
+			#ifdef portALT_GET_RUN_TIME_COUNTER_VALUE
+				portALT_GET_RUN_TIME_COUNTER_VALUE( ulTotalRunTime );
+			#else
+				ulTotalRunTime = portGET_RUN_TIME_COUNTER_VALUE();
+			#endif
+
+			/* Add the amount of time the task has been running to the
+			accumulated time so far.  The time the task started running was
+			stored in ulTaskSwitchedInTime.  Note that there is no overflow
+			protection here so count values are only valid until the timer
+			overflows.  The guard against negative values is to protect
+			against suspect run time stat counter implementations - which
+			are provided by the application, not the kernel. */
+			if( ulTotalRunTime > ulTaskSwitchedInTime )
+			{
+				pxCurrentTCB->ulRunTimeCounter += ( ulTotalRunTime - ulTaskSwitchedInTime );
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+			ulTaskSwitchedInTime = ulTotalRunTime;
+		}
+		#endif /* configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS */
+
+		/* Check for stack overflow, if configured. */
+		taskCHECK_FOR_STACK_OVERFLOW();
+
+		/* Before the currently running task is switched out, save its errno. */
+		#if( configUSE_POSIX_ERRNO == 1 )
+		{
+			pxCurrentTCB->iTaskErrno = FreeRTOS_errno;
+		}
+		#endif
+
+		/* Select a new task to run using either the generic C or port
+		optimised asm code. */
+		taskSELECT_HIGHEST_PRIORITY_TASK(); /*lint !e9079 void * is used as this macro is used with timers and co-routines too.  Alignment is known to be fine as the type of the pointer stored and retrieved is the same. */
+		traceTASK_SWITCHED_IN();
+
+		/* After the new task is switched in, update the global errno. */
+		#if( configUSE_POSIX_ERRNO == 1 )
+		{
+			FreeRTOS_errno = pxCurrentTCB->iTaskErrno;
+		}
+		#endif
+
+		#if ( configUSE_NEWLIB_REENTRANT == 1 )
+		{
+			/* Switch Newlib's _impure_ptr variable to point to the _reent
+			structure specific to this task.
+			See the third party link http://www.nadler.com/embedded/newlibAndFreeRTOS.html
+			for additional information. */
+			_impure_ptr = &( pxCurrentTCB->xNewLib_reent );
+		}
+		#endif /* configUSE_NEWLIB_REENTRANT */
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vTaskPlaceOnEventList( List_t * const pxEventList, const TickType_t xTicksToWait )
+{
+	configASSERT( pxEventList );
+
+	/* THIS FUNCTION MUST BE CALLED WITH EITHER INTERRUPTS DISABLED OR THE
+	SCHEDULER SUSPENDED AND THE QUEUE BEING ACCESSED LOCKED. */
+
+	/* Place the event list item of the TCB in the appropriate event list.
+	This is placed in the list in priority order so the highest priority task
+	is the first to be woken by the event.  The queue that contains the event
+	list is locked, preventing simultaneous access from interrupts. */
+	vListInsert( pxEventList, &( pxCurrentTCB->xEventListItem ) );
+
+	prvAddCurrentTaskToDelayedList( xTicksToWait, pdTRUE );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vTaskPlaceOnUnorderedEventList( List_t * pxEventList, const TickType_t xItemValue, const TickType_t xTicksToWait )
+{
+	configASSERT( pxEventList );
+
+	/* THIS FUNCTION MUST BE CALLED WITH THE SCHEDULER SUSPENDED.  It is used by
+	the event groups implementation. */
+	configASSERT( uxSchedulerSuspended != 0 );
+
+	/* Store the item value in the event list item.  It is safe to access the
+	event list item here as interrupts won't access the event list item of a
+	task that is not in the Blocked state. */
+	listSET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxCurrentTCB->xEventListItem ), xItemValue | taskEVENT_LIST_ITEM_VALUE_IN_USE );
+
+	/* Place the event list item of the TCB at the end of the appropriate event
+	list.  It is safe to access the event list here because it is part of an
+	event group implementation - and interrupts don't access event groups
+	directly (instead they access them indirectly by pending function calls to
+	the task level). */
+	vListInsertEnd( pxEventList, &( pxCurrentTCB->xEventListItem ) );
+
+	prvAddCurrentTaskToDelayedList( xTicksToWait, pdTRUE );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configUSE_TIMERS == 1 )
+
+	void vTaskPlaceOnEventListRestricted( List_t * const pxEventList, TickType_t xTicksToWait, const BaseType_t xWaitIndefinitely )
+	{
+		configASSERT( pxEventList );
+
+		/* This function should not be called by application code hence the
+		'Restricted' in its name.  It is not part of the public API.  It is
+		designed for use by kernel code, and has special calling requirements -
+		it should be called with the scheduler suspended. */
+
+
+		/* Place the event list item of the TCB in the appropriate event list.
+		In this case it is assume that this is the only task that is going to
+		be waiting on this event list, so the faster vListInsertEnd() function
+		can be used in place of vListInsert. */
+		vListInsertEnd( pxEventList, &( pxCurrentTCB->xEventListItem ) );
+
+		/* If the task should block indefinitely then set the block time to a
+		value that will be recognised as an indefinite delay inside the
+		prvAddCurrentTaskToDelayedList() function. */
+		if( xWaitIndefinitely != pdFALSE )
+		{
+			xTicksToWait = portMAX_DELAY;
+		}
+
+		traceTASK_DELAY_UNTIL( ( xTickCount + xTicksToWait ) );
+		prvAddCurrentTaskToDelayedList( xTicksToWait, xWaitIndefinitely );
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TIMERS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xTaskRemoveFromEventList( const List_t * const pxEventList )
+{
+TCB_t *pxUnblockedTCB;
+BaseType_t xReturn;
+
+	/* THIS FUNCTION MUST BE CALLED FROM A CRITICAL SECTION.  It can also be
+	called from a critical section within an ISR. */
+
+	/* The event list is sorted in priority order, so the first in the list can
+	be removed as it is known to be the highest priority.  Remove the TCB from
+	the delayed list, and add it to the ready list.
+
+	If an event is for a queue that is locked then this function will never
+	get called - the lock count on the queue will get modified instead.  This
+	means exclusive access to the event list is guaranteed here.
+
+	This function assumes that a check has already been made to ensure that
+	pxEventList is not empty. */
+	pxUnblockedTCB = listGET_OWNER_OF_HEAD_ENTRY( pxEventList ); /*lint !e9079 void * is used as this macro is used with timers and co-routines too.  Alignment is known to be fine as the type of the pointer stored and retrieved is the same. */
+	configASSERT( pxUnblockedTCB );
+	( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxUnblockedTCB->xEventListItem ) );
+
+	if( uxSchedulerSuspended == ( UBaseType_t ) pdFALSE )
+	{
+		( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxUnblockedTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+		prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxUnblockedTCB );
+
+		#if( configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE != 0 )
+		{
+			/* If a task is blocked on a kernel object then xNextTaskUnblockTime
+			might be set to the blocked task's time out time.  If the task is
+			unblocked for a reason other than a timeout xNextTaskUnblockTime is
+			normally left unchanged, because it is automatically reset to a new
+			value when the tick count equals xNextTaskUnblockTime.  However if
+			tickless idling is used it might be more important to enter sleep mode
+			at the earliest possible time - so reset xNextTaskUnblockTime here to
+			ensure it is updated at the earliest possible time. */
+			prvResetNextTaskUnblockTime();
+		}
+		#endif
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		/* The delayed and ready lists cannot be accessed, so hold this task
+		pending until the scheduler is resumed. */
+		vListInsertEnd( &( xPendingReadyList ), &( pxUnblockedTCB->xEventListItem ) );
+	}
+
+	if( pxUnblockedTCB->uxPriority > pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority )
+	{
+		/* Return true if the task removed from the event list has a higher
+		priority than the calling task.  This allows the calling task to know if
+		it should force a context switch now. */
+		xReturn = pdTRUE;
+
+		/* Mark that a yield is pending in case the user is not using the
+		"xHigherPriorityTaskWoken" parameter to an ISR safe FreeRTOS function. */
+		xYieldPending = pdTRUE;
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		xReturn = pdFALSE;
+	}
+
+	return xReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vTaskRemoveFromUnorderedEventList( ListItem_t * pxEventListItem, const TickType_t xItemValue )
+{
+TCB_t *pxUnblockedTCB;
+
+	/* THIS FUNCTION MUST BE CALLED WITH THE SCHEDULER SUSPENDED.  It is used by
+	the event flags implementation. */
+	configASSERT( uxSchedulerSuspended != pdFALSE );
+
+	/* Store the new item value in the event list. */
+	listSET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( pxEventListItem, xItemValue | taskEVENT_LIST_ITEM_VALUE_IN_USE );
+
+	/* Remove the event list form the event flag.  Interrupts do not access
+	event flags. */
+	pxUnblockedTCB = listGET_LIST_ITEM_OWNER( pxEventListItem ); /*lint !e9079 void * is used as this macro is used with timers and co-routines too.  Alignment is known to be fine as the type of the pointer stored and retrieved is the same. */
+	configASSERT( pxUnblockedTCB );
+	( void ) uxListRemove( pxEventListItem );
+
+	#if( configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE != 0 )
+	{
+		/* If a task is blocked on a kernel object then xNextTaskUnblockTime
+		might be set to the blocked task's time out time.  If the task is
+		unblocked for a reason other than a timeout xNextTaskUnblockTime is
+		normally left unchanged, because it is automatically reset to a new
+		value when the tick count equals xNextTaskUnblockTime.  However if
+		tickless idling is used it might be more important to enter sleep mode
+		at the earliest possible time - so reset xNextTaskUnblockTime here to
+		ensure it is updated at the earliest possible time. */
+		prvResetNextTaskUnblockTime();
+	}
+	#endif
+
+	/* Remove the task from the delayed list and add it to the ready list.  The
+	scheduler is suspended so interrupts will not be accessing the ready
+	lists. */
+	( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxUnblockedTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+	prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxUnblockedTCB );
+
+	if( pxUnblockedTCB->uxPriority > pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority )
+	{
+		/* The unblocked task has a priority above that of the calling task, so
+		a context switch is required.  This function is called with the
+		scheduler suspended so xYieldPending is set so the context switch
+		occurs immediately that the scheduler is resumed (unsuspended). */
+		xYieldPending = pdTRUE;
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vTaskSetTimeOutState( TimeOut_t * const pxTimeOut )
+{
+	configASSERT( pxTimeOut );
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		pxTimeOut->xOverflowCount = xNumOfOverflows;
+		pxTimeOut->xTimeOnEntering = xTickCount;
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vTaskInternalSetTimeOutState( TimeOut_t * const pxTimeOut )
+{
+	/* For internal use only as it does not use a critical section. */
+	pxTimeOut->xOverflowCount = xNumOfOverflows;
+	pxTimeOut->xTimeOnEntering = xTickCount;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xTaskCheckForTimeOut( TimeOut_t * const pxTimeOut, TickType_t * const pxTicksToWait )
+{
+BaseType_t xReturn;
+
+	configASSERT( pxTimeOut );
+	configASSERT( pxTicksToWait );
+
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		/* Minor optimisation.  The tick count cannot change in this block. */
+		const TickType_t xConstTickCount = xTickCount;
+		const TickType_t xElapsedTime = xConstTickCount - pxTimeOut->xTimeOnEntering;
+
+		#if( INCLUDE_xTaskAbortDelay == 1 )
+			if( pxCurrentTCB->ucDelayAborted != ( uint8_t ) pdFALSE )
+			{
+				/* The delay was aborted, which is not the same as a time out,
+				but has the same result. */
+				pxCurrentTCB->ucDelayAborted = pdFALSE;
+				xReturn = pdTRUE;
+			}
+			else
+		#endif
+
+		#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend == 1 )
+			if( *pxTicksToWait == portMAX_DELAY )
+			{
+				/* If INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend is set to 1 and the block time
+				specified is the maximum block time then the task should block
+				indefinitely, and therefore never time out. */
+				xReturn = pdFALSE;
+			}
+			else
+		#endif
+
+		if( ( xNumOfOverflows != pxTimeOut->xOverflowCount ) && ( xConstTickCount >= pxTimeOut->xTimeOnEntering ) ) /*lint !e525 Indentation preferred as is to make code within pre-processor directives clearer. */
+		{
+			/* The tick count is greater than the time at which
+			vTaskSetTimeout() was called, but has also overflowed since
+			vTaskSetTimeOut() was called.  It must have wrapped all the way
+			around and gone past again. This passed since vTaskSetTimeout()
+			was called. */
+			xReturn = pdTRUE;
+		}
+		else if( xElapsedTime < *pxTicksToWait ) /*lint !e961 Explicit casting is only redundant with some compilers, whereas others require it to prevent integer conversion errors. */
+		{
+			/* Not a genuine timeout. Adjust parameters for time remaining. */
+			*pxTicksToWait -= xElapsedTime;
+			vTaskInternalSetTimeOutState( pxTimeOut );
+			xReturn = pdFALSE;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			*pxTicksToWait = 0;
+			xReturn = pdTRUE;
+		}
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+	return xReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vTaskMissedYield( void )
+{
+	xYieldPending = pdTRUE;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+
+	UBaseType_t uxTaskGetTaskNumber( TaskHandle_t xTask )
+	{
+	UBaseType_t uxReturn;
+	TCB_t const *pxTCB;
+
+		if( xTask != NULL )
+		{
+			pxTCB = xTask;
+			uxReturn = pxTCB->uxTaskNumber;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			uxReturn = 0U;
+		}
+
+		return uxReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+
+	void vTaskSetTaskNumber( TaskHandle_t xTask, const UBaseType_t uxHandle )
+	{
+	TCB_t * pxTCB;
+
+		if( xTask != NULL )
+		{
+			pxTCB = xTask;
+			pxTCB->uxTaskNumber = uxHandle;
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY */
+
+/*
+ * -----------------------------------------------------------
+ * The Idle task.
+ * ----------------------------------------------------------
+ *
+ * The portTASK_FUNCTION() macro is used to allow port/compiler specific
+ * language extensions.  The equivalent prototype for this function is:
+ *
+ * void prvIdleTask( void *pvParameters );
+ *
+ */
+static portTASK_FUNCTION( prvIdleTask, pvParameters )
+{
+	/* Stop warnings. */
+	( void ) pvParameters;
+
+	/** THIS IS THE RTOS IDLE TASK - WHICH IS CREATED AUTOMATICALLY WHEN THE
+	SCHEDULER IS STARTED. **/
+
+	/* In case a task that has a secure context deletes itself, in which case
+	the idle task is responsible for deleting the task's secure context, if
+	any. */
+	portALLOCATE_SECURE_CONTEXT( configMINIMAL_SECURE_STACK_SIZE );
+
+	for( ;; )
+	{
+		/* See if any tasks have deleted themselves - if so then the idle task
+		is responsible for freeing the deleted task's TCB and stack. */
+		prvCheckTasksWaitingTermination();
+
+		#if ( configUSE_PREEMPTION == 0 )
+		{
+			/* If we are not using preemption we keep forcing a task switch to
+			see if any other task has become available.  If we are using
+			preemption we don't need to do this as any task becoming available
+			will automatically get the processor anyway. */
+			taskYIELD();
+		}
+		#endif /* configUSE_PREEMPTION */
+
+		#if ( ( configUSE_PREEMPTION == 1 ) && ( configIDLE_SHOULD_YIELD == 1 ) )
+		{
+			/* When using preemption tasks of equal priority will be
+			timesliced.  If a task that is sharing the idle priority is ready
+			to run then the idle task should yield before the end of the
+			timeslice.
+
+			A critical region is not required here as we are just reading from
+			the list, and an occasional incorrect value will not matter.  If
+			the ready list at the idle priority contains more than one task
+			then a task other than the idle task is ready to execute. */
+			if( listCURRENT_LIST_LENGTH( &( pxReadyTasksLists[ tskIDLE_PRIORITY ] ) ) > ( UBaseType_t ) 1 )
+			{
+				taskYIELD();
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		#endif /* ( ( configUSE_PREEMPTION == 1 ) && ( configIDLE_SHOULD_YIELD == 1 ) ) */
+
+		#if ( configUSE_IDLE_HOOK == 1 )
+		{
+			extern void vApplicationIdleHook( void );
+
+			/* Call the user defined function from within the idle task.  This
+			allows the application designer to add background functionality
+			without the overhead of a separate task.
+			NOTE: vApplicationIdleHook() MUST NOT, UNDER ANY CIRCUMSTANCES,
+			CALL A FUNCTION THAT MIGHT BLOCK. */
+			vApplicationIdleHook();
+		}
+		#endif /* configUSE_IDLE_HOOK */
+
+		/* This conditional compilation should use inequality to 0, not equality
+		to 1.  This is to ensure portSUPPRESS_TICKS_AND_SLEEP() is called when
+		user defined low power mode	implementations require
+		configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE to be set to a value other than 1. */
+		#if ( configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE != 0 )
+		{
+		TickType_t xExpectedIdleTime;
+
+			/* It is not desirable to suspend then resume the scheduler on
+			each iteration of the idle task.  Therefore, a preliminary
+			test of the expected idle time is performed without the
+			scheduler suspended.  The result here is not necessarily
+			valid. */
+			xExpectedIdleTime = prvGetExpectedIdleTime();
+
+			if( xExpectedIdleTime >= configEXPECTED_IDLE_TIME_BEFORE_SLEEP )
+			{
+				vTaskSuspendAll();
+				{
+					/* Now the scheduler is suspended, the expected idle
+					time can be sampled again, and this time its value can
+					be used. */
+					configASSERT( xNextTaskUnblockTime >= xTickCount );
+					xExpectedIdleTime = prvGetExpectedIdleTime();
+
+					/* Define the following macro to set xExpectedIdleTime to 0
+					if the application does not want
+					portSUPPRESS_TICKS_AND_SLEEP() to be called. */
+					configPRE_SUPPRESS_TICKS_AND_SLEEP_PROCESSING( xExpectedIdleTime );
+
+					if( xExpectedIdleTime >= configEXPECTED_IDLE_TIME_BEFORE_SLEEP )
+					{
+						traceLOW_POWER_IDLE_BEGIN();
+						portSUPPRESS_TICKS_AND_SLEEP( xExpectedIdleTime );
+						traceLOW_POWER_IDLE_END();
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		#endif /* configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE */
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE != 0 )
+
+	eSleepModeStatus eTaskConfirmSleepModeStatus( void )
+	{
+	/* The idle task exists in addition to the application tasks. */
+	const UBaseType_t uxNonApplicationTasks = 1;
+	eSleepModeStatus eReturn = eStandardSleep;
+
+		/* This function must be called from a critical section. */
+
+		if( listCURRENT_LIST_LENGTH( &xPendingReadyList ) != 0 )
+		{
+			/* A task was made ready while the scheduler was suspended. */
+			eReturn = eAbortSleep;
+		}
+		else if( xYieldPending != pdFALSE )
+		{
+			/* A yield was pended while the scheduler was suspended. */
+			eReturn = eAbortSleep;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			/* If all the tasks are in the suspended list (which might mean they
+			have an infinite block time rather than actually being suspended)
+			then it is safe to turn all clocks off and just wait for external
+			interrupts. */
+			if( listCURRENT_LIST_LENGTH( &xSuspendedTaskList ) == ( uxCurrentNumberOfTasks - uxNonApplicationTasks ) )
+			{
+				eReturn = eNoTasksWaitingTimeout;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+
+		return eReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configNUM_THREAD_LOCAL_STORAGE_POINTERS != 0 )
+
+	void vTaskSetThreadLocalStoragePointer( TaskHandle_t xTaskToSet, BaseType_t xIndex, void *pvValue )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxTCB;
+
+		if( xIndex < configNUM_THREAD_LOCAL_STORAGE_POINTERS )
+		{
+			pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTaskToSet );
+			configASSERT( pxTCB != NULL );
+			pxTCB->pvThreadLocalStoragePointers[ xIndex ] = pvValue;
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* configNUM_THREAD_LOCAL_STORAGE_POINTERS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configNUM_THREAD_LOCAL_STORAGE_POINTERS != 0 )
+
+	void *pvTaskGetThreadLocalStoragePointer( TaskHandle_t xTaskToQuery, BaseType_t xIndex )
+	{
+	void *pvReturn = NULL;
+	TCB_t *pxTCB;
+
+		if( xIndex < configNUM_THREAD_LOCAL_STORAGE_POINTERS )
+		{
+			pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTaskToQuery );
+			pvReturn = pxTCB->pvThreadLocalStoragePointers[ xIndex ];
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			pvReturn = NULL;
+		}
+
+		return pvReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configNUM_THREAD_LOCAL_STORAGE_POINTERS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS == 1 )
+
+	void vTaskAllocateMPURegions( TaskHandle_t xTaskToModify, const MemoryRegion_t * const xRegions )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxTCB;
+
+		/* If null is passed in here then we are modifying the MPU settings of
+		the calling task. */
+		pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTaskToModify );
+
+		vPortStoreTaskMPUSettings( &( pxTCB->xMPUSettings ), xRegions, NULL, 0 );
+	}
+
+#endif /* portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvInitialiseTaskLists( void )
+{
+UBaseType_t uxPriority;
+
+	for( uxPriority = ( UBaseType_t ) 0U; uxPriority < ( UBaseType_t ) configMAX_PRIORITIES; uxPriority++ )
+	{
+		vListInitialise( &( pxReadyTasksLists[ uxPriority ] ) );
+	}
+
+	vListInitialise( &xDelayedTaskList1 );
+	vListInitialise( &xDelayedTaskList2 );
+	vListInitialise( &xPendingReadyList );
+
+	#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskDelete == 1 )
+	{
+		vListInitialise( &xTasksWaitingTermination );
+	}
+	#endif /* INCLUDE_vTaskDelete */
+
+	#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend == 1 )
+	{
+		vListInitialise( &xSuspendedTaskList );
+	}
+	#endif /* INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend */
+
+	/* Start with pxDelayedTaskList using list1 and the pxOverflowDelayedTaskList
+	using list2. */
+	pxDelayedTaskList = &xDelayedTaskList1;
+	pxOverflowDelayedTaskList = &xDelayedTaskList2;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvCheckTasksWaitingTermination( void )
+{
+
+	/** THIS FUNCTION IS CALLED FROM THE RTOS IDLE TASK **/
+
+	#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskDelete == 1 )
+	{
+		TCB_t *pxTCB;
+
+		/* uxDeletedTasksWaitingCleanUp is used to prevent taskENTER_CRITICAL()
+		being called too often in the idle task. */
+		while( uxDeletedTasksWaitingCleanUp > ( UBaseType_t ) 0U )
+		{
+			taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+			{
+				pxTCB = listGET_OWNER_OF_HEAD_ENTRY( ( &xTasksWaitingTermination ) ); /*lint !e9079 void * is used as this macro is used with timers and co-routines too.  Alignment is known to be fine as the type of the pointer stored and retrieved is the same. */
+				( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+				--uxCurrentNumberOfTasks;
+				--uxDeletedTasksWaitingCleanUp;
+			}
+			taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+			prvDeleteTCB( pxTCB );
+		}
+	}
+	#endif /* INCLUDE_vTaskDelete */
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+
+	void vTaskGetInfo( TaskHandle_t xTask, TaskStatus_t *pxTaskStatus, BaseType_t xGetFreeStackSpace, eTaskState eState )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxTCB;
+
+		/* xTask is NULL then get the state of the calling task. */
+		pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTask );
+
+		pxTaskStatus->xHandle = ( TaskHandle_t ) pxTCB;
+		pxTaskStatus->pcTaskName = ( const char * ) &( pxTCB->pcTaskName [ 0 ] );
+		pxTaskStatus->uxCurrentPriority = pxTCB->uxPriority;
+		pxTaskStatus->pxStackBase = pxTCB->pxStack;
+		pxTaskStatus->xTaskNumber = pxTCB->uxTCBNumber;
+
+		#if ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+		{
+			pxTaskStatus->uxBasePriority = pxTCB->uxBasePriority;
+		}
+		#else
+		{
+			pxTaskStatus->uxBasePriority = 0;
+		}
+		#endif
+
+		#if ( configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS == 1 )
+		{
+			pxTaskStatus->ulRunTimeCounter = pxTCB->ulRunTimeCounter;
+		}
+		#else
+		{
+			pxTaskStatus->ulRunTimeCounter = 0;
+		}
+		#endif
+
+		/* Obtaining the task state is a little fiddly, so is only done if the
+		value of eState passed into this function is eInvalid - otherwise the
+		state is just set to whatever is passed in. */
+		if( eState != eInvalid )
+		{
+			if( pxTCB == pxCurrentTCB )
+			{
+				pxTaskStatus->eCurrentState = eRunning;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				pxTaskStatus->eCurrentState = eState;
+
+				#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend == 1 )
+				{
+					/* If the task is in the suspended list then there is a
+					chance it is actually just blocked indefinitely - so really
+					it should be reported as being in the Blocked state. */
+					if( eState == eSuspended )
+					{
+						vTaskSuspendAll();
+						{
+							if( listLIST_ITEM_CONTAINER( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) ) != NULL )
+							{
+								pxTaskStatus->eCurrentState = eBlocked;
+							}
+						}
+						( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+					}
+				}
+				#endif /* INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend */
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			pxTaskStatus->eCurrentState = eTaskGetState( pxTCB );
+		}
+
+		/* Obtaining the stack space takes some time, so the xGetFreeStackSpace
+		parameter is provided to allow it to be skipped. */
+		if( xGetFreeStackSpace != pdFALSE )
+		{
+			#if ( portSTACK_GROWTH > 0 )
+			{
+				pxTaskStatus->usStackHighWaterMark = prvTaskCheckFreeStackSpace( ( uint8_t * ) pxTCB->pxEndOfStack );
+			}
+			#else
+			{
+				pxTaskStatus->usStackHighWaterMark = prvTaskCheckFreeStackSpace( ( uint8_t * ) pxTCB->pxStack );
+			}
+			#endif
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			pxTaskStatus->usStackHighWaterMark = 0;
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+
+	static UBaseType_t prvListTasksWithinSingleList( TaskStatus_t *pxTaskStatusArray, List_t *pxList, eTaskState eState )
+	{
+	configLIST_VOLATILE TCB_t *pxNextTCB, *pxFirstTCB;
+	UBaseType_t uxTask = 0;
+
+		if( listCURRENT_LIST_LENGTH( pxList ) > ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+		{
+			listGET_OWNER_OF_NEXT_ENTRY( pxFirstTCB, pxList ); /*lint !e9079 void * is used as this macro is used with timers and co-routines too.  Alignment is known to be fine as the type of the pointer stored and retrieved is the same. */
+
+			/* Populate an TaskStatus_t structure within the
+			pxTaskStatusArray array for each task that is referenced from
+			pxList.  See the definition of TaskStatus_t in task.h for the
+			meaning of each TaskStatus_t structure member. */
+			do
+			{
+				listGET_OWNER_OF_NEXT_ENTRY( pxNextTCB, pxList ); /*lint !e9079 void * is used as this macro is used with timers and co-routines too.  Alignment is known to be fine as the type of the pointer stored and retrieved is the same. */
+				vTaskGetInfo( ( TaskHandle_t ) pxNextTCB, &( pxTaskStatusArray[ uxTask ] ), pdTRUE, eState );
+				uxTask++;
+			} while( pxNextTCB != pxFirstTCB );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		return uxTask;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 ) || ( INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark == 1 ) || ( INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark2 == 1 ) )
+
+	static configSTACK_DEPTH_TYPE prvTaskCheckFreeStackSpace( const uint8_t * pucStackByte )
+	{
+	uint32_t ulCount = 0U;
+
+		while( *pucStackByte == ( uint8_t ) tskSTACK_FILL_BYTE )
+		{
+			pucStackByte -= portSTACK_GROWTH;
+			ulCount++;
+		}
+
+		ulCount /= ( uint32_t ) sizeof( StackType_t ); /*lint !e961 Casting is not redundant on smaller architectures. */
+
+		return ( configSTACK_DEPTH_TYPE ) ulCount;
+	}
+
+#endif /* ( ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 ) || ( INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark == 1 ) || ( INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark2 == 1 ) ) */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark2 == 1 )
+
+	/* uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark() and uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark2() are the
+	same except for their return type.  Using configSTACK_DEPTH_TYPE allows the
+	user to determine the return type.  It gets around the problem of the value
+	overflowing on 8-bit types without breaking backward compatibility for
+	applications that expect an 8-bit return type. */
+	configSTACK_DEPTH_TYPE uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark2( TaskHandle_t xTask )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxTCB;
+	uint8_t *pucEndOfStack;
+	configSTACK_DEPTH_TYPE uxReturn;
+
+		/* uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark() and uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark2() are
+		the same except for their return type.  Using configSTACK_DEPTH_TYPE
+		allows the user to determine the return type.  It gets around the
+		problem of the value overflowing on 8-bit types without breaking
+		backward compatibility for applications that expect an 8-bit return
+		type. */
+
+		pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTask );
+
+		#if portSTACK_GROWTH < 0
+		{
+			pucEndOfStack = ( uint8_t * ) pxTCB->pxStack;
+		}
+		#else
+		{
+			pucEndOfStack = ( uint8_t * ) pxTCB->pxEndOfStack;
+		}
+		#endif
+
+		uxReturn = prvTaskCheckFreeStackSpace( pucEndOfStack );
+
+		return uxReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark2 */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark == 1 )
+
+	UBaseType_t uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark( TaskHandle_t xTask )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxTCB;
+	uint8_t *pucEndOfStack;
+	UBaseType_t uxReturn;
+
+		pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTask );
+
+		#if portSTACK_GROWTH < 0
+		{
+			pucEndOfStack = ( uint8_t * ) pxTCB->pxStack;
+		}
+		#else
+		{
+			pucEndOfStack = ( uint8_t * ) pxTCB->pxEndOfStack;
+		}
+		#endif
+
+		uxReturn = ( UBaseType_t ) prvTaskCheckFreeStackSpace( pucEndOfStack );
+
+		return uxReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskDelete == 1 )
+
+	static void prvDeleteTCB( TCB_t *pxTCB )
+	{
+		/* This call is required specifically for the TriCore port.  It must be
+		above the vPortFree() calls.  The call is also used by ports/demos that
+		want to allocate and clean RAM statically. */
+		portCLEAN_UP_TCB( pxTCB );
+
+		/* Free up the memory allocated by the scheduler for the task.  It is up
+		to the task to free any memory allocated at the application level.
+		See the third party link http://www.nadler.com/embedded/newlibAndFreeRTOS.html
+		for additional information. */
+		#if ( configUSE_NEWLIB_REENTRANT == 1 )
+		{
+			_reclaim_reent( &( pxTCB->xNewLib_reent ) );
+		}
+		#endif /* configUSE_NEWLIB_REENTRANT */
+
+		#if( ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) && ( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 0 ) && ( portUSING_MPU_WRAPPERS == 0 ) )
+		{
+			/* The task can only have been allocated dynamically - free both
+			the stack and TCB. */
+			vPortFree( pxTCB->pxStack );
+			vPortFree( pxTCB );
+		}
+		#elif( tskSTATIC_AND_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION_POSSIBLE != 0 ) /*lint !e731 !e9029 Macro has been consolidated for readability reasons. */
+		{
+			/* The task could have been allocated statically or dynamically, so
+			check what was statically allocated before trying to free the
+			memory. */
+			if( pxTCB->ucStaticallyAllocated == tskDYNAMICALLY_ALLOCATED_STACK_AND_TCB )
+			{
+				/* Both the stack and TCB were allocated dynamically, so both
+				must be freed. */
+				vPortFree( pxTCB->pxStack );
+				vPortFree( pxTCB );
+			}
+			else if( pxTCB->ucStaticallyAllocated == tskSTATICALLY_ALLOCATED_STACK_ONLY )
+			{
+				/* Only the stack was statically allocated, so the TCB is the
+				only memory that must be freed. */
+				vPortFree( pxTCB );
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				/* Neither the stack nor the TCB were allocated dynamically, so
+				nothing needs to be freed. */
+				configASSERT( pxTCB->ucStaticallyAllocated == tskSTATICALLY_ALLOCATED_STACK_AND_TCB	);
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		#endif /* configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION */
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_vTaskDelete */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvResetNextTaskUnblockTime( void )
+{
+TCB_t *pxTCB;
+
+	if( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( pxDelayedTaskList ) != pdFALSE )
+	{
+		/* The new current delayed list is empty.  Set xNextTaskUnblockTime to
+		the maximum possible value so it is	extremely unlikely that the
+		if( xTickCount >= xNextTaskUnblockTime ) test will pass until
+		there is an item in the delayed list. */
+		xNextTaskUnblockTime = portMAX_DELAY;
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		/* The new current delayed list is not empty, get the value of
+		the item at the head of the delayed list.  This is the time at
+		which the task at the head of the delayed list should be removed
+		from the Blocked state. */
+		( pxTCB ) = listGET_OWNER_OF_HEAD_ENTRY( pxDelayedTaskList ); /*lint !e9079 void * is used as this macro is used with timers and co-routines too.  Alignment is known to be fine as the type of the pointer stored and retrieved is the same. */
+		xNextTaskUnblockTime = listGET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( ( pxTCB )->xStateListItem ) );
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( ( INCLUDE_xTaskGetCurrentTaskHandle == 1 ) || ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 ) )
+
+	TaskHandle_t xTaskGetCurrentTaskHandle( void )
+	{
+	TaskHandle_t xReturn;
+
+		/* A critical section is not required as this is not called from
+		an interrupt and the current TCB will always be the same for any
+		individual execution thread. */
+		xReturn = pxCurrentTCB;
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* ( ( INCLUDE_xTaskGetCurrentTaskHandle == 1 ) || ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 ) ) */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( ( INCLUDE_xTaskGetSchedulerState == 1 ) || ( configUSE_TIMERS == 1 ) )
+
+	BaseType_t xTaskGetSchedulerState( void )
+	{
+	BaseType_t xReturn;
+
+		if( xSchedulerRunning == pdFALSE )
+		{
+			xReturn = taskSCHEDULER_NOT_STARTED;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			if( uxSchedulerSuspended == ( UBaseType_t ) pdFALSE )
+			{
+				xReturn = taskSCHEDULER_RUNNING;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				xReturn = taskSCHEDULER_SUSPENDED;
+			}
+		}
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* ( ( INCLUDE_xTaskGetSchedulerState == 1 ) || ( configUSE_TIMERS == 1 ) ) */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xTaskPriorityInherit( TaskHandle_t const pxMutexHolder )
+	{
+	TCB_t * const pxMutexHolderTCB = pxMutexHolder;
+	BaseType_t xReturn = pdFALSE;
+
+		/* If the mutex was given back by an interrupt while the queue was
+		locked then the mutex holder might now be NULL.  _RB_ Is this still
+		needed as interrupts can no longer use mutexes? */
+		if( pxMutexHolder != NULL )
+		{
+			/* If the holder of the mutex has a priority below the priority of
+			the task attempting to obtain the mutex then it will temporarily
+			inherit the priority of the task attempting to obtain the mutex. */
+			if( pxMutexHolderTCB->uxPriority < pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority )
+			{
+				/* Adjust the mutex holder state to account for its new
+				priority.  Only reset the event list item value if the value is
+				not being used for anything else. */
+				if( ( listGET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxMutexHolderTCB->xEventListItem ) ) & taskEVENT_LIST_ITEM_VALUE_IN_USE ) == 0UL )
+				{
+					listSET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxMutexHolderTCB->xEventListItem ), ( TickType_t ) configMAX_PRIORITIES - ( TickType_t ) pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority ); /*lint !e961 MISRA exception as the casts are only redundant for some ports. */
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+
+				/* If the task being modified is in the ready state it will need
+				to be moved into a new list. */
+				if( listIS_CONTAINED_WITHIN( &( pxReadyTasksLists[ pxMutexHolderTCB->uxPriority ] ), &( pxMutexHolderTCB->xStateListItem ) ) != pdFALSE )
+				{
+					if( uxListRemove( &( pxMutexHolderTCB->xStateListItem ) ) == ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+					{
+						/* It is known that the task is in its ready list so
+						there is no need to check again and the port level
+						reset macro can be called directly. */
+						portRESET_READY_PRIORITY( pxMutexHolderTCB->uxPriority, uxTopReadyPriority );
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+
+					/* Inherit the priority before being moved into the new list. */
+					pxMutexHolderTCB->uxPriority = pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority;
+					prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxMutexHolderTCB );
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* Just inherit the priority. */
+					pxMutexHolderTCB->uxPriority = pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority;
+				}
+
+				traceTASK_PRIORITY_INHERIT( pxMutexHolderTCB, pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority );
+
+				/* Inheritance occurred. */
+				xReturn = pdTRUE;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				if( pxMutexHolderTCB->uxBasePriority < pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority )
+				{
+					/* The base priority of the mutex holder is lower than the
+					priority of the task attempting to take the mutex, but the
+					current priority of the mutex holder is not lower than the
+					priority of the task attempting to take the mutex.
+					Therefore the mutex holder must have already inherited a
+					priority, but inheritance would have occurred if that had
+					not been the case. */
+					xReturn = pdTRUE;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_MUTEXES */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xTaskPriorityDisinherit( TaskHandle_t const pxMutexHolder )
+	{
+	TCB_t * const pxTCB = pxMutexHolder;
+	BaseType_t xReturn = pdFALSE;
+
+		if( pxMutexHolder != NULL )
+		{
+			/* A task can only have an inherited priority if it holds the mutex.
+			If the mutex is held by a task then it cannot be given from an
+			interrupt, and if a mutex is given by the holding task then it must
+			be the running state task. */
+			configASSERT( pxTCB == pxCurrentTCB );
+			configASSERT( pxTCB->uxMutexesHeld );
+			( pxTCB->uxMutexesHeld )--;
+
+			/* Has the holder of the mutex inherited the priority of another
+			task? */
+			if( pxTCB->uxPriority != pxTCB->uxBasePriority )
+			{
+				/* Only disinherit if no other mutexes are held. */
+				if( pxTCB->uxMutexesHeld == ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+				{
+					/* A task can only have an inherited priority if it holds
+					the mutex.  If the mutex is held by a task then it cannot be
+					given from an interrupt, and if a mutex is given by the
+					holding task then it must be the running state task.  Remove
+					the holding task from the ready/delayed list. */
+					if( uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) ) == ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+					{
+						taskRESET_READY_PRIORITY( pxTCB->uxPriority );
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+
+					/* Disinherit the priority before adding the task into the
+					new	ready list. */
+					traceTASK_PRIORITY_DISINHERIT( pxTCB, pxTCB->uxBasePriority );
+					pxTCB->uxPriority = pxTCB->uxBasePriority;
+
+					/* Reset the event list item value.  It cannot be in use for
+					any other purpose if this task is running, and it must be
+					running to give back the mutex. */
+					listSET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ), ( TickType_t ) configMAX_PRIORITIES - ( TickType_t ) pxTCB->uxPriority ); /*lint !e961 MISRA exception as the casts are only redundant for some ports. */
+					prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxTCB );
+
+					/* Return true to indicate that a context switch is required.
+					This is only actually required in the corner case whereby
+					multiple mutexes were held and the mutexes were given back
+					in an order different to that in which they were taken.
+					If a context switch did not occur when the first mutex was
+					returned, even if a task was waiting on it, then a context
+					switch should occur when the last mutex is returned whether
+					a task is waiting on it or not. */
+					xReturn = pdTRUE;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_MUTEXES */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+
+	void vTaskPriorityDisinheritAfterTimeout( TaskHandle_t const pxMutexHolder, UBaseType_t uxHighestPriorityWaitingTask )
+	{
+	TCB_t * const pxTCB = pxMutexHolder;
+	UBaseType_t uxPriorityUsedOnEntry, uxPriorityToUse;
+	const UBaseType_t uxOnlyOneMutexHeld = ( UBaseType_t ) 1;
+
+		if( pxMutexHolder != NULL )
+		{
+			/* If pxMutexHolder is not NULL then the holder must hold at least
+			one mutex. */
+			configASSERT( pxTCB->uxMutexesHeld );
+
+			/* Determine the priority to which the priority of the task that
+			holds the mutex should be set.  This will be the greater of the
+			holding task's base priority and the priority of the highest
+			priority task that is waiting to obtain the mutex. */
+			if( pxTCB->uxBasePriority < uxHighestPriorityWaitingTask )
+			{
+				uxPriorityToUse = uxHighestPriorityWaitingTask;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				uxPriorityToUse = pxTCB->uxBasePriority;
+			}
+
+			/* Does the priority need to change? */
+			if( pxTCB->uxPriority != uxPriorityToUse )
+			{
+				/* Only disinherit if no other mutexes are held.  This is a
+				simplification in the priority inheritance implementation.  If
+				the task that holds the mutex is also holding other mutexes then
+				the other mutexes may have caused the priority inheritance. */
+				if( pxTCB->uxMutexesHeld == uxOnlyOneMutexHeld )
+				{
+					/* If a task has timed out because it already holds the
+					mutex it was trying to obtain then it cannot of inherited
+					its own priority. */
+					configASSERT( pxTCB != pxCurrentTCB );
+
+					/* Disinherit the priority, remembering the previous
+					priority to facilitate determining the subject task's
+					state. */
+					traceTASK_PRIORITY_DISINHERIT( pxTCB, pxTCB->uxBasePriority );
+					uxPriorityUsedOnEntry = pxTCB->uxPriority;
+					pxTCB->uxPriority = uxPriorityToUse;
+
+					/* Only reset the event list item value if the value is not
+					being used for anything else. */
+					if( ( listGET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) ) & taskEVENT_LIST_ITEM_VALUE_IN_USE ) == 0UL )
+					{
+						listSET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ), ( TickType_t ) configMAX_PRIORITIES - ( TickType_t ) uxPriorityToUse ); /*lint !e961 MISRA exception as the casts are only redundant for some ports. */
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+
+					/* If the running task is not the task that holds the mutex
+					then the task that holds the mutex could be in either the
+					Ready, Blocked or Suspended states.  Only remove the task
+					from its current state list if it is in the Ready state as
+					the task's priority is going to change and there is one
+					Ready list per priority. */
+					if( listIS_CONTAINED_WITHIN( &( pxReadyTasksLists[ uxPriorityUsedOnEntry ] ), &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) ) != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						if( uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) ) == ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+						{
+							/* It is known that the task is in its ready list so
+							there is no need to check again and the port level
+							reset macro can be called directly. */
+							portRESET_READY_PRIORITY( pxTCB->uxPriority, uxTopReadyPriority );
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+
+						prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxTCB );
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_MUTEXES */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( portCRITICAL_NESTING_IN_TCB == 1 )
+
+	void vTaskEnterCritical( void )
+	{
+		portDISABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+
+		if( xSchedulerRunning != pdFALSE )
+		{
+			( pxCurrentTCB->uxCriticalNesting )++;
+
+			/* This is not the interrupt safe version of the enter critical
+			function so	assert() if it is being called from an interrupt
+			context.  Only API functions that end in "FromISR" can be used in an
+			interrupt.  Only assert if the critical nesting count is 1 to
+			protect against recursive calls if the assert function also uses a
+			critical section. */
+			if( pxCurrentTCB->uxCriticalNesting == 1 )
+			{
+				portASSERT_IF_IN_ISR();
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* portCRITICAL_NESTING_IN_TCB */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( portCRITICAL_NESTING_IN_TCB == 1 )
+
+	void vTaskExitCritical( void )
+	{
+		if( xSchedulerRunning != pdFALSE )
+		{
+			if( pxCurrentTCB->uxCriticalNesting > 0U )
+			{
+				( pxCurrentTCB->uxCriticalNesting )--;
+
+				if( pxCurrentTCB->uxCriticalNesting == 0U )
+				{
+					portENABLE_INTERRUPTS();
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* portCRITICAL_NESTING_IN_TCB */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 ) && ( configUSE_STATS_FORMATTING_FUNCTIONS > 0 ) )
+
+	static char *prvWriteNameToBuffer( char *pcBuffer, const char *pcTaskName )
+	{
+	size_t x;
+
+		/* Start by copying the entire string. */
+		strcpy( pcBuffer, pcTaskName );
+
+		/* Pad the end of the string with spaces to ensure columns line up when
+		printed out. */
+		for( x = strlen( pcBuffer ); x < ( size_t ) ( configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN - 1 ); x++ )
+		{
+			pcBuffer[ x ] = ' ';
+		}
+
+		/* Terminate. */
+		pcBuffer[ x ] = ( char ) 0x00;
+
+		/* Return the new end of string. */
+		return &( pcBuffer[ x ] );
+	}
+
+#endif /* ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 ) && ( configUSE_STATS_FORMATTING_FUNCTIONS > 0 ) */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 ) && ( configUSE_STATS_FORMATTING_FUNCTIONS > 0 ) && ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) )
+
+	void vTaskList( char * pcWriteBuffer )
+	{
+	TaskStatus_t *pxTaskStatusArray;
+	UBaseType_t uxArraySize, x;
+	char cStatus;
+
+		/*
+		 * PLEASE NOTE:
+		 *
+		 * This function is provided for convenience only, and is used by many
+		 * of the demo applications.  Do not consider it to be part of the
+		 * scheduler.
+		 *
+		 * vTaskList() calls uxTaskGetSystemState(), then formats part of the
+		 * uxTaskGetSystemState() output into a human readable table that
+		 * displays task names, states and stack usage.
+		 *
+		 * vTaskList() has a dependency on the sprintf() C library function that
+		 * might bloat the code size, use a lot of stack, and provide different
+		 * results on different platforms.  An alternative, tiny, third party,
+		 * and limited functionality implementation of sprintf() is provided in
+		 * many of the FreeRTOS/Demo sub-directories in a file called
+		 * printf-stdarg.c (note printf-stdarg.c does not provide a full
+		 * snprintf() implementation!).
+		 *
+		 * It is recommended that production systems call uxTaskGetSystemState()
+		 * directly to get access to raw stats data, rather than indirectly
+		 * through a call to vTaskList().
+		 */
+
+
+		/* Make sure the write buffer does not contain a string. */
+		*pcWriteBuffer = ( char ) 0x00;
+
+		/* Take a snapshot of the number of tasks in case it changes while this
+		function is executing. */
+		uxArraySize = uxCurrentNumberOfTasks;
+
+		/* Allocate an array index for each task.  NOTE!  if
+		configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION is set to 0 then pvPortMalloc() will
+		equate to NULL. */
+		pxTaskStatusArray = pvPortMalloc( uxCurrentNumberOfTasks * sizeof( TaskStatus_t ) ); /*lint !e9079 All values returned by pvPortMalloc() have at least the alignment required by the MCU's stack and this allocation allocates a struct that has the alignment requirements of a pointer. */
+
+		if( pxTaskStatusArray != NULL )
+		{
+			/* Generate the (binary) data. */
+			uxArraySize = uxTaskGetSystemState( pxTaskStatusArray, uxArraySize, NULL );
+
+			/* Create a human readable table from the binary data. */
+			for( x = 0; x < uxArraySize; x++ )
+			{
+				switch( pxTaskStatusArray[ x ].eCurrentState )
+				{
+					case eRunning:		cStatus = tskRUNNING_CHAR;
+										break;
+
+					case eReady:		cStatus = tskREADY_CHAR;
+										break;
+
+					case eBlocked:		cStatus = tskBLOCKED_CHAR;
+										break;
+
+					case eSuspended:	cStatus = tskSUSPENDED_CHAR;
+										break;
+
+					case eDeleted:		cStatus = tskDELETED_CHAR;
+										break;
+
+					case eInvalid:		/* Fall through. */
+					default:			/* Should not get here, but it is included
+										to prevent static checking errors. */
+										cStatus = ( char ) 0x00;
+										break;
+				}
+
+				/* Write the task name to the string, padding with spaces so it
+				can be printed in tabular form more easily. */
+				pcWriteBuffer = prvWriteNameToBuffer( pcWriteBuffer, pxTaskStatusArray[ x ].pcTaskName );
+
+				/* Write the rest of the string. */
+				sprintf( pcWriteBuffer, "\t%c\t%u\t%u\t%u\r\n", cStatus, ( unsigned int ) pxTaskStatusArray[ x ].uxCurrentPriority, ( unsigned int ) pxTaskStatusArray[ x ].usStackHighWaterMark, ( unsigned int ) pxTaskStatusArray[ x ].xTaskNumber ); /*lint !e586 sprintf() allowed as this is compiled with many compilers and this is a utility function only - not part of the core kernel implementation. */
+				pcWriteBuffer += strlen( pcWriteBuffer ); /*lint !e9016 Pointer arithmetic ok on char pointers especially as in this case where it best denotes the intent of the code. */
+			}
+
+			/* Free the array again.  NOTE!  If configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION
+			is 0 then vPortFree() will be #defined to nothing. */
+			vPortFree( pxTaskStatusArray );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* ( ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 ) && ( configUSE_STATS_FORMATTING_FUNCTIONS > 0 ) && ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) ) */
+/*----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( ( configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS == 1 ) && ( configUSE_STATS_FORMATTING_FUNCTIONS > 0 ) && ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) )
+
+	void vTaskGetRunTimeStats( char *pcWriteBuffer )
+	{
+	TaskStatus_t *pxTaskStatusArray;
+	UBaseType_t uxArraySize, x;
+	uint32_t ulTotalTime, ulStatsAsPercentage;
+
+		#if( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY != 1 )
+		{
+			#error configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY must also be set to 1 in FreeRTOSConfig.h to use vTaskGetRunTimeStats().
+		}
+		#endif
+
+		/*
+		 * PLEASE NOTE:
+		 *
+		 * This function is provided for convenience only, and is used by many
+		 * of the demo applications.  Do not consider it to be part of the
+		 * scheduler.
+		 *
+		 * vTaskGetRunTimeStats() calls uxTaskGetSystemState(), then formats part
+		 * of the uxTaskGetSystemState() output into a human readable table that
+		 * displays the amount of time each task has spent in the Running state
+		 * in both absolute and percentage terms.
+		 *
+		 * vTaskGetRunTimeStats() has a dependency on the sprintf() C library
+		 * function that might bloat the code size, use a lot of stack, and
+		 * provide different results on different platforms.  An alternative,
+		 * tiny, third party, and limited functionality implementation of
+		 * sprintf() is provided in many of the FreeRTOS/Demo sub-directories in
+		 * a file called printf-stdarg.c (note printf-stdarg.c does not provide
+		 * a full snprintf() implementation!).
+		 *
+		 * It is recommended that production systems call uxTaskGetSystemState()
+		 * directly to get access to raw stats data, rather than indirectly
+		 * through a call to vTaskGetRunTimeStats().
+		 */
+
+		/* Make sure the write buffer does not contain a string. */
+		*pcWriteBuffer = ( char ) 0x00;
+
+		/* Take a snapshot of the number of tasks in case it changes while this
+		function is executing. */
+		uxArraySize = uxCurrentNumberOfTasks;
+
+		/* Allocate an array index for each task.  NOTE!  If
+		configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION is set to 0 then pvPortMalloc() will
+		equate to NULL. */
+		pxTaskStatusArray = pvPortMalloc( uxCurrentNumberOfTasks * sizeof( TaskStatus_t ) ); /*lint !e9079 All values returned by pvPortMalloc() have at least the alignment required by the MCU's stack and this allocation allocates a struct that has the alignment requirements of a pointer. */
+
+		if( pxTaskStatusArray != NULL )
+		{
+			/* Generate the (binary) data. */
+			uxArraySize = uxTaskGetSystemState( pxTaskStatusArray, uxArraySize, &ulTotalTime );
+
+			/* For percentage calculations. */
+			ulTotalTime /= 100UL;
+
+			/* Avoid divide by zero errors. */
+			if( ulTotalTime > 0UL )
+			{
+				/* Create a human readable table from the binary data. */
+				for( x = 0; x < uxArraySize; x++ )
+				{
+					/* What percentage of the total run time has the task used?
+					This will always be rounded down to the nearest integer.
+					ulTotalRunTimeDiv100 has already been divided by 100. */
+					ulStatsAsPercentage = pxTaskStatusArray[ x ].ulRunTimeCounter / ulTotalTime;
+
+					/* Write the task name to the string, padding with
+					spaces so it can be printed in tabular form more
+					easily. */
+					pcWriteBuffer = prvWriteNameToBuffer( pcWriteBuffer, pxTaskStatusArray[ x ].pcTaskName );
+
+					if( ulStatsAsPercentage > 0UL )
+					{
+						#ifdef portLU_PRINTF_SPECIFIER_REQUIRED
+						{
+							sprintf( pcWriteBuffer, "\t%lu\t\t%lu%%\r\n", pxTaskStatusArray[ x ].ulRunTimeCounter, ulStatsAsPercentage );
+						}
+						#else
+						{
+							/* sizeof( int ) == sizeof( long ) so a smaller
+							printf() library can be used. */
+							sprintf( pcWriteBuffer, "\t%u\t\t%u%%\r\n", ( unsigned int ) pxTaskStatusArray[ x ].ulRunTimeCounter, ( unsigned int ) ulStatsAsPercentage ); /*lint !e586 sprintf() allowed as this is compiled with many compilers and this is a utility function only - not part of the core kernel implementation. */
+						}
+						#endif
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						/* If the percentage is zero here then the task has
+						consumed less than 1% of the total run time. */
+						#ifdef portLU_PRINTF_SPECIFIER_REQUIRED
+						{
+							sprintf( pcWriteBuffer, "\t%lu\t\t<1%%\r\n", pxTaskStatusArray[ x ].ulRunTimeCounter );
+						}
+						#else
+						{
+							/* sizeof( int ) == sizeof( long ) so a smaller
+							printf() library can be used. */
+							sprintf( pcWriteBuffer, "\t%u\t\t<1%%\r\n", ( unsigned int ) pxTaskStatusArray[ x ].ulRunTimeCounter ); /*lint !e586 sprintf() allowed as this is compiled with many compilers and this is a utility function only - not part of the core kernel implementation. */
+						}
+						#endif
+					}
+
+					pcWriteBuffer += strlen( pcWriteBuffer ); /*lint !e9016 Pointer arithmetic ok on char pointers especially as in this case where it best denotes the intent of the code. */
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+
+			/* Free the array again.  NOTE!  If configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION
+			is 0 then vPortFree() will be #defined to nothing. */
+			vPortFree( pxTaskStatusArray );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+
+#endif /* ( ( configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS == 1 ) && ( configUSE_STATS_FORMATTING_FUNCTIONS > 0 ) && ( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 ) ) */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+TickType_t uxTaskResetEventItemValue( void )
+{
+TickType_t uxReturn;
+
+	uxReturn = listGET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxCurrentTCB->xEventListItem ) );
+
+	/* Reset the event list item to its normal value - so it can be used with
+	queues and semaphores. */
+	listSET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxCurrentTCB->xEventListItem ), ( ( TickType_t ) configMAX_PRIORITIES - ( TickType_t ) pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority ) ); /*lint !e961 MISRA exception as the casts are only redundant for some ports. */
+
+	return uxReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_MUTEXES == 1 )
+
+	TaskHandle_t pvTaskIncrementMutexHeldCount( void )
+	{
+		/* If xSemaphoreCreateMutex() is called before any tasks have been created
+		then pxCurrentTCB will be NULL. */
+		if( pxCurrentTCB != NULL )
+		{
+			( pxCurrentTCB->uxMutexesHeld )++;
+		}
+
+		return pxCurrentTCB;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_MUTEXES */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS == 1 )
+
+	uint32_t ulTaskNotifyTake( BaseType_t xClearCountOnExit, TickType_t xTicksToWait )
+	{
+	uint32_t ulReturn;
+
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			/* Only block if the notification count is not already non-zero. */
+			if( pxCurrentTCB->ulNotifiedValue == 0UL )
+			{
+				/* Mark this task as waiting for a notification. */
+				pxCurrentTCB->ucNotifyState = taskWAITING_NOTIFICATION;
+
+				if( xTicksToWait > ( TickType_t ) 0 )
+				{
+					prvAddCurrentTaskToDelayedList( xTicksToWait, pdTRUE );
+					traceTASK_NOTIFY_TAKE_BLOCK();
+
+					/* All ports are written to allow a yield in a critical
+					section (some will yield immediately, others wait until the
+					critical section exits) - but it is not something that
+					application code should ever do. */
+					portYIELD_WITHIN_API();
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			traceTASK_NOTIFY_TAKE();
+			ulReturn = pxCurrentTCB->ulNotifiedValue;
+
+			if( ulReturn != 0UL )
+			{
+				if( xClearCountOnExit != pdFALSE )
+				{
+					pxCurrentTCB->ulNotifiedValue = 0UL;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					pxCurrentTCB->ulNotifiedValue = ulReturn - ( uint32_t ) 1;
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+
+			pxCurrentTCB->ucNotifyState = taskNOT_WAITING_NOTIFICATION;
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		return ulReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xTaskNotifyWait( uint32_t ulBitsToClearOnEntry, uint32_t ulBitsToClearOnExit, uint32_t *pulNotificationValue, TickType_t xTicksToWait )
+	{
+	BaseType_t xReturn;
+
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			/* Only block if a notification is not already pending. */
+			if( pxCurrentTCB->ucNotifyState != taskNOTIFICATION_RECEIVED )
+			{
+				/* Clear bits in the task's notification value as bits may get
+				set	by the notifying task or interrupt.  This can be used to
+				clear the value to zero. */
+				pxCurrentTCB->ulNotifiedValue &= ~ulBitsToClearOnEntry;
+
+				/* Mark this task as waiting for a notification. */
+				pxCurrentTCB->ucNotifyState = taskWAITING_NOTIFICATION;
+
+				if( xTicksToWait > ( TickType_t ) 0 )
+				{
+					prvAddCurrentTaskToDelayedList( xTicksToWait, pdTRUE );
+					traceTASK_NOTIFY_WAIT_BLOCK();
+
+					/* All ports are written to allow a yield in a critical
+					section (some will yield immediately, others wait until the
+					critical section exits) - but it is not something that
+					application code should ever do. */
+					portYIELD_WITHIN_API();
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			traceTASK_NOTIFY_WAIT();
+
+			if( pulNotificationValue != NULL )
+			{
+				/* Output the current notification value, which may or may not
+				have changed. */
+				*pulNotificationValue = pxCurrentTCB->ulNotifiedValue;
+			}
+
+			/* If ucNotifyValue is set then either the task never entered the
+			blocked state (because a notification was already pending) or the
+			task unblocked because of a notification.  Otherwise the task
+			unblocked because of a timeout. */
+			if( pxCurrentTCB->ucNotifyState != taskNOTIFICATION_RECEIVED )
+			{
+				/* A notification was not received. */
+				xReturn = pdFALSE;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				/* A notification was already pending or a notification was
+				received while the task was waiting. */
+				pxCurrentTCB->ulNotifiedValue &= ~ulBitsToClearOnExit;
+				xReturn = pdTRUE;
+			}
+
+			pxCurrentTCB->ucNotifyState = taskNOT_WAITING_NOTIFICATION;
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xTaskGenericNotify( TaskHandle_t xTaskToNotify, uint32_t ulValue, eNotifyAction eAction, uint32_t *pulPreviousNotificationValue )
+	{
+	TCB_t * pxTCB;
+	BaseType_t xReturn = pdPASS;
+	uint8_t ucOriginalNotifyState;
+
+		configASSERT( xTaskToNotify );
+		pxTCB = xTaskToNotify;
+
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			if( pulPreviousNotificationValue != NULL )
+			{
+				*pulPreviousNotificationValue = pxTCB->ulNotifiedValue;
+			}
+
+			ucOriginalNotifyState = pxTCB->ucNotifyState;
+
+			pxTCB->ucNotifyState = taskNOTIFICATION_RECEIVED;
+
+			switch( eAction )
+			{
+				case eSetBits	:
+					pxTCB->ulNotifiedValue |= ulValue;
+					break;
+
+				case eIncrement	:
+					( pxTCB->ulNotifiedValue )++;
+					break;
+
+				case eSetValueWithOverwrite	:
+					pxTCB->ulNotifiedValue = ulValue;
+					break;
+
+				case eSetValueWithoutOverwrite :
+					if( ucOriginalNotifyState != taskNOTIFICATION_RECEIVED )
+					{
+						pxTCB->ulNotifiedValue = ulValue;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						/* The value could not be written to the task. */
+						xReturn = pdFAIL;
+					}
+					break;
+
+				case eNoAction:
+					/* The task is being notified without its notify value being
+					updated. */
+					break;
+
+				default:
+					/* Should not get here if all enums are handled.
+					Artificially force an assert by testing a value the
+					compiler can't assume is const. */
+					configASSERT( pxTCB->ulNotifiedValue == ~0UL );
+
+					break;
+			}
+
+			traceTASK_NOTIFY();
+
+			/* If the task is in the blocked state specifically to wait for a
+			notification then unblock it now. */
+			if( ucOriginalNotifyState == taskWAITING_NOTIFICATION )
+			{
+				( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+				prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxTCB );
+
+				/* The task should not have been on an event list. */
+				configASSERT( listLIST_ITEM_CONTAINER( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) ) == NULL );
+
+				#if( configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE != 0 )
+				{
+					/* If a task is blocked waiting for a notification then
+					xNextTaskUnblockTime might be set to the blocked task's time
+					out time.  If the task is unblocked for a reason other than
+					a timeout xNextTaskUnblockTime is normally left unchanged,
+					because it will automatically get reset to a new value when
+					the tick count equals xNextTaskUnblockTime.  However if
+					tickless idling is used it might be more important to enter
+					sleep mode at the earliest possible time - so reset
+					xNextTaskUnblockTime here to ensure it is updated at the
+					earliest possible time. */
+					prvResetNextTaskUnblockTime();
+				}
+				#endif
+
+				if( pxTCB->uxPriority > pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority )
+				{
+					/* The notified task has a priority above the currently
+					executing task so a yield is required. */
+					taskYIELD_IF_USING_PREEMPTION();
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xTaskGenericNotifyFromISR( TaskHandle_t xTaskToNotify, uint32_t ulValue, eNotifyAction eAction, uint32_t *pulPreviousNotificationValue, BaseType_t *pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken )
+	{
+	TCB_t * pxTCB;
+	uint8_t ucOriginalNotifyState;
+	BaseType_t xReturn = pdPASS;
+	UBaseType_t uxSavedInterruptStatus;
+
+		configASSERT( xTaskToNotify );
+
+		/* RTOS ports that support interrupt nesting have the concept of a
+		maximum	system call (or maximum API call) interrupt priority.
+		Interrupts that are	above the maximum system call priority are keep
+		permanently enabled, even when the RTOS kernel is in a critical section,
+		but cannot make any calls to FreeRTOS API functions.  If configASSERT()
+		is defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h then
+		portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID() will result in an assertion
+		failure if a FreeRTOS API function is called from an interrupt that has
+		been assigned a priority above the configured maximum system call
+		priority.  Only FreeRTOS functions that end in FromISR can be called
+		from interrupts	that have been assigned a priority at or (logically)
+		below the maximum system call interrupt priority.  FreeRTOS maintains a
+		separate interrupt safe API to ensure interrupt entry is as fast and as
+		simple as possible.  More information (albeit Cortex-M specific) is
+		provided on the following link:
+		http://www.freertos.org/RTOS-Cortex-M3-M4.html */
+		portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID();
+
+		pxTCB = xTaskToNotify;
+
+		uxSavedInterruptStatus = portSET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR();
+		{
+			if( pulPreviousNotificationValue != NULL )
+			{
+				*pulPreviousNotificationValue = pxTCB->ulNotifiedValue;
+			}
+
+			ucOriginalNotifyState = pxTCB->ucNotifyState;
+			pxTCB->ucNotifyState = taskNOTIFICATION_RECEIVED;
+
+			switch( eAction )
+			{
+				case eSetBits	:
+					pxTCB->ulNotifiedValue |= ulValue;
+					break;
+
+				case eIncrement	:
+					( pxTCB->ulNotifiedValue )++;
+					break;
+
+				case eSetValueWithOverwrite	:
+					pxTCB->ulNotifiedValue = ulValue;
+					break;
+
+				case eSetValueWithoutOverwrite :
+					if( ucOriginalNotifyState != taskNOTIFICATION_RECEIVED )
+					{
+						pxTCB->ulNotifiedValue = ulValue;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						/* The value could not be written to the task. */
+						xReturn = pdFAIL;
+					}
+					break;
+
+				case eNoAction :
+					/* The task is being notified without its notify value being
+					updated. */
+					break;
+
+				default:
+					/* Should not get here if all enums are handled.
+					Artificially force an assert by testing a value the
+					compiler can't assume is const. */
+					configASSERT( pxTCB->ulNotifiedValue == ~0UL );
+					break;
+			}
+
+			traceTASK_NOTIFY_FROM_ISR();
+
+			/* If the task is in the blocked state specifically to wait for a
+			notification then unblock it now. */
+			if( ucOriginalNotifyState == taskWAITING_NOTIFICATION )
+			{
+				/* The task should not have been on an event list. */
+				configASSERT( listLIST_ITEM_CONTAINER( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) ) == NULL );
+
+				if( uxSchedulerSuspended == ( UBaseType_t ) pdFALSE )
+				{
+					( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+					prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxTCB );
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* The delayed and ready lists cannot be accessed, so hold
+					this task pending until the scheduler is resumed. */
+					vListInsertEnd( &( xPendingReadyList ), &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) );
+				}
+
+				if( pxTCB->uxPriority > pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority )
+				{
+					/* The notified task has a priority above the currently
+					executing task so a yield is required. */
+					if( pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken != NULL )
+					{
+						*pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken = pdTRUE;
+					}
+
+					/* Mark that a yield is pending in case the user is not
+					using the "xHigherPriorityTaskWoken" parameter to an ISR
+					safe FreeRTOS function. */
+					xYieldPending = pdTRUE;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+		}
+		portCLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR( uxSavedInterruptStatus );
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS == 1 )
+
+	void vTaskNotifyGiveFromISR( TaskHandle_t xTaskToNotify, BaseType_t *pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken )
+	{
+	TCB_t * pxTCB;
+	uint8_t ucOriginalNotifyState;
+	UBaseType_t uxSavedInterruptStatus;
+
+		configASSERT( xTaskToNotify );
+
+		/* RTOS ports that support interrupt nesting have the concept of a
+		maximum	system call (or maximum API call) interrupt priority.
+		Interrupts that are	above the maximum system call priority are keep
+		permanently enabled, even when the RTOS kernel is in a critical section,
+		but cannot make any calls to FreeRTOS API functions.  If configASSERT()
+		is defined in FreeRTOSConfig.h then
+		portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID() will result in an assertion
+		failure if a FreeRTOS API function is called from an interrupt that has
+		been assigned a priority above the configured maximum system call
+		priority.  Only FreeRTOS functions that end in FromISR can be called
+		from interrupts	that have been assigned a priority at or (logically)
+		below the maximum system call interrupt priority.  FreeRTOS maintains a
+		separate interrupt safe API to ensure interrupt entry is as fast and as
+		simple as possible.  More information (albeit Cortex-M specific) is
+		provided on the following link:
+		http://www.freertos.org/RTOS-Cortex-M3-M4.html */
+		portASSERT_IF_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY_INVALID();
+
+		pxTCB = xTaskToNotify;
+
+		uxSavedInterruptStatus = portSET_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR();
+		{
+			ucOriginalNotifyState = pxTCB->ucNotifyState;
+			pxTCB->ucNotifyState = taskNOTIFICATION_RECEIVED;
+
+			/* 'Giving' is equivalent to incrementing a count in a counting
+			semaphore. */
+			( pxTCB->ulNotifiedValue )++;
+
+			traceTASK_NOTIFY_GIVE_FROM_ISR();
+
+			/* If the task is in the blocked state specifically to wait for a
+			notification then unblock it now. */
+			if( ucOriginalNotifyState == taskWAITING_NOTIFICATION )
+			{
+				/* The task should not have been on an event list. */
+				configASSERT( listLIST_ITEM_CONTAINER( &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) ) == NULL );
+
+				if( uxSchedulerSuspended == ( UBaseType_t ) pdFALSE )
+				{
+					( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+					prvAddTaskToReadyList( pxTCB );
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* The delayed and ready lists cannot be accessed, so hold
+					this task pending until the scheduler is resumed. */
+					vListInsertEnd( &( xPendingReadyList ), &( pxTCB->xEventListItem ) );
+				}
+
+				if( pxTCB->uxPriority > pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority )
+				{
+					/* The notified task has a priority above the currently
+					executing task so a yield is required. */
+					if( pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken != NULL )
+					{
+						*pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken = pdTRUE;
+					}
+
+					/* Mark that a yield is pending in case the user is not
+					using the "xHigherPriorityTaskWoken" parameter in an ISR
+					safe FreeRTOS function. */
+					xYieldPending = pdTRUE;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+		}
+		portCLEAR_INTERRUPT_MASK_FROM_ISR( uxSavedInterruptStatus );
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xTaskNotifyStateClear( TaskHandle_t xTask )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxTCB;
+	BaseType_t xReturn;
+
+		/* If null is passed in here then it is the calling task that is having
+		its notification state cleared. */
+		pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTask );
+
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			if( pxTCB->ucNotifyState == taskNOTIFICATION_RECEIVED )
+			{
+				pxTCB->ucNotifyState = taskNOT_WAITING_NOTIFICATION;
+				xReturn = pdPASS;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				xReturn = pdFAIL;
+			}
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS == 1 )
+
+	uint32_t ulTaskNotifyValueClear( TaskHandle_t xTask, uint32_t ulBitsToClear )
+	{
+	TCB_t *pxTCB;
+	uint32_t ulReturn;
+
+		/* If null is passed in here then it is the calling task that is having
+		its notification state cleared. */
+		pxTCB = prvGetTCBFromHandle( xTask );
+
+		taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+		{
+			/* Return the notification as it was before the bits were cleared,
+			then clear the bit mask. */
+			ulReturn = pxCurrentTCB->ulNotifiedValue;
+			pxTCB->ulNotifiedValue &= ~ulBitsToClear;
+		}
+		taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+		return ulReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TASK_NOTIFICATIONS */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( ( configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS == 1 ) && ( INCLUDE_xTaskGetIdleTaskHandle == 1 ) )
+
+	uint32_t ulTaskGetIdleRunTimeCounter( void )
+	{
+		return xIdleTaskHandle->ulRunTimeCounter;
+	}
+
+#endif
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvAddCurrentTaskToDelayedList( TickType_t xTicksToWait, const BaseType_t xCanBlockIndefinitely )
+{
+TickType_t xTimeToWake;
+const TickType_t xConstTickCount = xTickCount;
+
+	#if( INCLUDE_xTaskAbortDelay == 1 )
+	{
+		/* About to enter a delayed list, so ensure the ucDelayAborted flag is
+		reset to pdFALSE so it can be detected as having been set to pdTRUE
+		when the task leaves the Blocked state. */
+		pxCurrentTCB->ucDelayAborted = pdFALSE;
+	}
+	#endif
+
+	/* Remove the task from the ready list before adding it to the blocked list
+	as the same list item is used for both lists. */
+	if( uxListRemove( &( pxCurrentTCB->xStateListItem ) ) == ( UBaseType_t ) 0 )
+	{
+		/* The current task must be in a ready list, so there is no need to
+		check, and the port reset macro can be called directly. */
+		portRESET_READY_PRIORITY( pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority, uxTopReadyPriority ); /*lint !e931 pxCurrentTCB cannot change as it is the calling task.  pxCurrentTCB->uxPriority and uxTopReadyPriority cannot change as called with scheduler suspended or in a critical section. */
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+	}
+
+	#if ( INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend == 1 )
+	{
+		if( ( xTicksToWait == portMAX_DELAY ) && ( xCanBlockIndefinitely != pdFALSE ) )
+		{
+			/* Add the task to the suspended task list instead of a delayed task
+			list to ensure it is not woken by a timing event.  It will block
+			indefinitely. */
+			vListInsertEnd( &xSuspendedTaskList, &( pxCurrentTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			/* Calculate the time at which the task should be woken if the event
+			does not occur.  This may overflow but this doesn't matter, the
+			kernel will manage it correctly. */
+			xTimeToWake = xConstTickCount + xTicksToWait;
+
+			/* The list item will be inserted in wake time order. */
+			listSET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxCurrentTCB->xStateListItem ), xTimeToWake );
+
+			if( xTimeToWake < xConstTickCount )
+			{
+				/* Wake time has overflowed.  Place this item in the overflow
+				list. */
+				vListInsert( pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, &( pxCurrentTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				/* The wake time has not overflowed, so the current block list
+				is used. */
+				vListInsert( pxDelayedTaskList, &( pxCurrentTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+
+				/* If the task entering the blocked state was placed at the
+				head of the list of blocked tasks then xNextTaskUnblockTime
+				needs to be updated too. */
+				if( xTimeToWake < xNextTaskUnblockTime )
+				{
+					xNextTaskUnblockTime = xTimeToWake;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+		}
+	}
+	#else /* INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend */
+	{
+		/* Calculate the time at which the task should be woken if the event
+		does not occur.  This may overflow but this doesn't matter, the kernel
+		will manage it correctly. */
+		xTimeToWake = xConstTickCount + xTicksToWait;
+
+		/* The list item will be inserted in wake time order. */
+		listSET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxCurrentTCB->xStateListItem ), xTimeToWake );
+
+		if( xTimeToWake < xConstTickCount )
+		{
+			/* Wake time has overflowed.  Place this item in the overflow list. */
+			vListInsert( pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, &( pxCurrentTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			/* The wake time has not overflowed, so the current block list is used. */
+			vListInsert( pxDelayedTaskList, &( pxCurrentTCB->xStateListItem ) );
+
+			/* If the task entering the blocked state was placed at the head of the
+			list of blocked tasks then xNextTaskUnblockTime needs to be updated
+			too. */
+			if( xTimeToWake < xNextTaskUnblockTime )
+			{
+				xNextTaskUnblockTime = xTimeToWake;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+
+		/* Avoid compiler warning when INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend is not 1. */
+		( void ) xCanBlockIndefinitely;
+	}
+	#endif /* INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend */
+}
+
+/* Code below here allows additional code to be inserted into this source file,
+especially where access to file scope functions and data is needed (for example
+when performing module tests). */
+
+#ifdef FREERTOS_MODULE_TEST
+	#include "tasks_test_access_functions.h"
+#endif
+
+
+#if( configINCLUDE_FREERTOS_TASK_C_ADDITIONS_H == 1 )
+
+	#include "freertos_tasks_c_additions.h"
+
+	#ifdef FREERTOS_TASKS_C_ADDITIONS_INIT
+		static void freertos_tasks_c_additions_init( void )
+		{
+			FREERTOS_TASKS_C_ADDITIONS_INIT();
+		}
+	#endif
+
+#endif
+
+
Index: ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/timers.c
===================================================================
--- ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/timers.c	(revision 73)
+++ ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/Middlewares/Third_Party/FreeRTOS/Source/timers.c	(revision 73)
@@ -0,0 +1,1127 @@
+/*
+ * FreeRTOS Kernel V10.3.1
+ * Copyright (C) 2020 Amazon.com, Inc. or its affiliates.  All Rights Reserved.
+ *
+ * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of
+ * this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in
+ * the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to
+ * use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of
+ * the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so,
+ * subject to the following conditions:
+ *
+ * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all
+ * copies or substantial portions of the Software.
+ *
+ * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
+ * IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS
+ * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR
+ * COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
+ * IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
+ * CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
+ *
+ * http://www.FreeRTOS.org
+ * http://aws.amazon.com/freertos
+ *
+ * 1 tab == 4 spaces!
+ */
+
+/* Standard includes. */
+#include <stdlib.h>
+
+/* Defining MPU_WRAPPERS_INCLUDED_FROM_API_FILE prevents task.h from redefining
+all the API functions to use the MPU wrappers.  That should only be done when
+task.h is included from an application file. */
+#define MPU_WRAPPERS_INCLUDED_FROM_API_FILE
+
+#include "FreeRTOS.h"
+#include "task.h"
+#include "queue.h"
+#include "timers.h"
+
+#if ( INCLUDE_xTimerPendFunctionCall == 1 ) && ( configUSE_TIMERS == 0 )
+	#error configUSE_TIMERS must be set to 1 to make the xTimerPendFunctionCall() function available.
+#endif
+
+/* Lint e9021, e961 and e750 are suppressed as a MISRA exception justified
+because the MPU ports require MPU_WRAPPERS_INCLUDED_FROM_API_FILE to be defined
+for the header files above, but not in this file, in order to generate the
+correct privileged Vs unprivileged linkage and placement. */
+#undef MPU_WRAPPERS_INCLUDED_FROM_API_FILE /*lint !e9021 !e961 !e750. */
+
+
+/* This entire source file will be skipped if the application is not configured
+to include software timer functionality.  This #if is closed at the very bottom
+of this file.  If you want to include software timer functionality then ensure
+configUSE_TIMERS is set to 1 in FreeRTOSConfig.h. */
+#if ( configUSE_TIMERS == 1 )
+
+/* Misc definitions. */
+#define tmrNO_DELAY		( TickType_t ) 0U
+
+/* The name assigned to the timer service task.  This can be overridden by
+defining trmTIMER_SERVICE_TASK_NAME in FreeRTOSConfig.h. */
+#ifndef configTIMER_SERVICE_TASK_NAME
+	#define configTIMER_SERVICE_TASK_NAME "Tmr Svc"
+#endif
+
+/* Bit definitions used in the ucStatus member of a timer structure. */
+#define tmrSTATUS_IS_ACTIVE					( ( uint8_t ) 0x01 )
+#define tmrSTATUS_IS_STATICALLY_ALLOCATED	( ( uint8_t ) 0x02 )
+#define tmrSTATUS_IS_AUTORELOAD				( ( uint8_t ) 0x04 )
+
+/* The definition of the timers themselves. */
+typedef struct tmrTimerControl /* The old naming convention is used to prevent breaking kernel aware debuggers. */
+{
+	const char				*pcTimerName;		/*<< Text name.  This is not used by the kernel, it is included simply to make debugging easier. */ /*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+	ListItem_t				xTimerListItem;		/*<< Standard linked list item as used by all kernel features for event management. */
+	TickType_t				xTimerPeriodInTicks;/*<< How quickly and often the timer expires. */
+	void 					*pvTimerID;			/*<< An ID to identify the timer.  This allows the timer to be identified when the same callback is used for multiple timers. */
+	TimerCallbackFunction_t	pxCallbackFunction;	/*<< The function that will be called when the timer expires. */
+	#if( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+		UBaseType_t			uxTimerNumber;		/*<< An ID assigned by trace tools such as FreeRTOS+Trace */
+	#endif
+	uint8_t 				ucStatus;			/*<< Holds bits to say if the timer was statically allocated or not, and if it is active or not. */
+} xTIMER;
+
+/* The old xTIMER name is maintained above then typedefed to the new Timer_t
+name below to enable the use of older kernel aware debuggers. */
+typedef xTIMER Timer_t;
+
+/* The definition of messages that can be sent and received on the timer queue.
+Two types of message can be queued - messages that manipulate a software timer,
+and messages that request the execution of a non-timer related callback.  The
+two message types are defined in two separate structures, xTimerParametersType
+and xCallbackParametersType respectively. */
+typedef struct tmrTimerParameters
+{
+	TickType_t			xMessageValue;		/*<< An optional value used by a subset of commands, for example, when changing the period of a timer. */
+	Timer_t *			pxTimer;			/*<< The timer to which the command will be applied. */
+} TimerParameter_t;
+
+
+typedef struct tmrCallbackParameters
+{
+	PendedFunction_t	pxCallbackFunction;	/* << The callback function to execute. */
+	void *pvParameter1;						/* << The value that will be used as the callback functions first parameter. */
+	uint32_t ulParameter2;					/* << The value that will be used as the callback functions second parameter. */
+} CallbackParameters_t;
+
+/* The structure that contains the two message types, along with an identifier
+that is used to determine which message type is valid. */
+typedef struct tmrTimerQueueMessage
+{
+	BaseType_t			xMessageID;			/*<< The command being sent to the timer service task. */
+	union
+	{
+		TimerParameter_t xTimerParameters;
+
+		/* Don't include xCallbackParameters if it is not going to be used as
+		it makes the structure (and therefore the timer queue) larger. */
+		#if ( INCLUDE_xTimerPendFunctionCall == 1 )
+			CallbackParameters_t xCallbackParameters;
+		#endif /* INCLUDE_xTimerPendFunctionCall */
+	} u;
+} DaemonTaskMessage_t;
+
+/*lint -save -e956 A manual analysis and inspection has been used to determine
+which static variables must be declared volatile. */
+
+/* The list in which active timers are stored.  Timers are referenced in expire
+time order, with the nearest expiry time at the front of the list.  Only the
+timer service task is allowed to access these lists.
+xActiveTimerList1 and xActiveTimerList2 could be at function scope but that
+breaks some kernel aware debuggers, and debuggers that reply on removing the
+static qualifier. */
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static List_t xActiveTimerList1;
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static List_t xActiveTimerList2;
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static List_t *pxCurrentTimerList;
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static List_t *pxOverflowTimerList;
+
+/* A queue that is used to send commands to the timer service task. */
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static QueueHandle_t xTimerQueue = NULL;
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static TaskHandle_t xTimerTaskHandle = NULL;
+
+/*lint -restore */
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 )
+
+	/* If static allocation is supported then the application must provide the
+	following callback function - which enables the application to optionally
+	provide the memory that will be used by the timer task as the task's stack
+	and TCB. */
+	extern void vApplicationGetTimerTaskMemory( StaticTask_t **ppxTimerTaskTCBBuffer, StackType_t **ppxTimerTaskStackBuffer, uint32_t *pulTimerTaskStackSize );
+
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Initialise the infrastructure used by the timer service task if it has not
+ * been initialised already.
+ */
+static void prvCheckForValidListAndQueue( void ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * The timer service task (daemon).  Timer functionality is controlled by this
+ * task.  Other tasks communicate with the timer service task using the
+ * xTimerQueue queue.
+ */
+static portTASK_FUNCTION_PROTO( prvTimerTask, pvParameters ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * Called by the timer service task to interpret and process a command it
+ * received on the timer queue.
+ */
+static void prvProcessReceivedCommands( void ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * Insert the timer into either xActiveTimerList1, or xActiveTimerList2,
+ * depending on if the expire time causes a timer counter overflow.
+ */
+static BaseType_t prvInsertTimerInActiveList( Timer_t * const pxTimer, const TickType_t xNextExpiryTime, const TickType_t xTimeNow, const TickType_t xCommandTime ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * An active timer has reached its expire time.  Reload the timer if it is an
+ * auto-reload timer, then call its callback.
+ */
+static void prvProcessExpiredTimer( const TickType_t xNextExpireTime, const TickType_t xTimeNow ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * The tick count has overflowed.  Switch the timer lists after ensuring the
+ * current timer list does not still reference some timers.
+ */
+static void prvSwitchTimerLists( void ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * Obtain the current tick count, setting *pxTimerListsWereSwitched to pdTRUE
+ * if a tick count overflow occurred since prvSampleTimeNow() was last called.
+ */
+static TickType_t prvSampleTimeNow( BaseType_t * const pxTimerListsWereSwitched ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * If the timer list contains any active timers then return the expire time of
+ * the timer that will expire first and set *pxListWasEmpty to false.  If the
+ * timer list does not contain any timers then return 0 and set *pxListWasEmpty
+ * to pdTRUE.
+ */
+static TickType_t prvGetNextExpireTime( BaseType_t * const pxListWasEmpty ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * If a timer has expired, process it.  Otherwise, block the timer service task
+ * until either a timer does expire or a command is received.
+ */
+static void prvProcessTimerOrBlockTask( const TickType_t xNextExpireTime, BaseType_t xListWasEmpty ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+
+/*
+ * Called after a Timer_t structure has been allocated either statically or
+ * dynamically to fill in the structure's members.
+ */
+static void prvInitialiseNewTimer(	const char * const pcTimerName,			/*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+									const TickType_t xTimerPeriodInTicks,
+									const UBaseType_t uxAutoReload,
+									void * const pvTimerID,
+									TimerCallbackFunction_t pxCallbackFunction,
+									Timer_t *pxNewTimer ) PRIVILEGED_FUNCTION;
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xTimerCreateTimerTask( void )
+{
+BaseType_t xReturn = pdFAIL;
+
+	/* This function is called when the scheduler is started if
+	configUSE_TIMERS is set to 1.  Check that the infrastructure used by the
+	timer service task has been created/initialised.  If timers have already
+	been created then the initialisation will already have been performed. */
+	prvCheckForValidListAndQueue();
+
+	if( xTimerQueue != NULL )
+	{
+		#if( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 )
+		{
+			StaticTask_t *pxTimerTaskTCBBuffer = NULL;
+			StackType_t *pxTimerTaskStackBuffer = NULL;
+			uint32_t ulTimerTaskStackSize;
+
+			vApplicationGetTimerTaskMemory( &pxTimerTaskTCBBuffer, &pxTimerTaskStackBuffer, &ulTimerTaskStackSize );
+			xTimerTaskHandle = xTaskCreateStatic(	prvTimerTask,
+													configTIMER_SERVICE_TASK_NAME,
+													ulTimerTaskStackSize,
+													NULL,
+													( ( UBaseType_t ) configTIMER_TASK_PRIORITY ) | portPRIVILEGE_BIT,
+													pxTimerTaskStackBuffer,
+													pxTimerTaskTCBBuffer );
+
+			if( xTimerTaskHandle != NULL )
+			{
+				xReturn = pdPASS;
+			}
+		}
+		#else
+		{
+			xReturn = xTaskCreate(	prvTimerTask,
+									configTIMER_SERVICE_TASK_NAME,
+									configTIMER_TASK_STACK_DEPTH,
+									NULL,
+									( ( UBaseType_t ) configTIMER_TASK_PRIORITY ) | portPRIVILEGE_BIT,
+									&xTimerTaskHandle );
+		}
+		#endif /* configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION */
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+	}
+
+	configASSERT( xReturn );
+	return xReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 )
+
+	TimerHandle_t xTimerCreate(	const char * const pcTimerName,			/*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+								const TickType_t xTimerPeriodInTicks,
+								const UBaseType_t uxAutoReload,
+								void * const pvTimerID,
+								TimerCallbackFunction_t pxCallbackFunction )
+	{
+	Timer_t *pxNewTimer;
+
+		pxNewTimer = ( Timer_t * ) pvPortMalloc( sizeof( Timer_t ) ); /*lint !e9087 !e9079 All values returned by pvPortMalloc() have at least the alignment required by the MCU's stack, and the first member of Timer_t is always a pointer to the timer's mame. */
+
+		if( pxNewTimer != NULL )
+		{
+			/* Status is thus far zero as the timer is not created statically
+			and has not been started.  The auto-reload bit may get set in
+			prvInitialiseNewTimer. */
+			pxNewTimer->ucStatus = 0x00;
+			prvInitialiseNewTimer( pcTimerName, xTimerPeriodInTicks, uxAutoReload, pvTimerID, pxCallbackFunction, pxNewTimer );
+		}
+
+		return pxNewTimer;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 )
+
+	TimerHandle_t xTimerCreateStatic(	const char * const pcTimerName,		/*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+										const TickType_t xTimerPeriodInTicks,
+										const UBaseType_t uxAutoReload,
+										void * const pvTimerID,
+										TimerCallbackFunction_t pxCallbackFunction,
+										StaticTimer_t *pxTimerBuffer )
+	{
+	Timer_t *pxNewTimer;
+
+		#if( configASSERT_DEFINED == 1 )
+		{
+			/* Sanity check that the size of the structure used to declare a
+			variable of type StaticTimer_t equals the size of the real timer
+			structure. */
+			volatile size_t xSize = sizeof( StaticTimer_t );
+			configASSERT( xSize == sizeof( Timer_t ) );
+			( void ) xSize; /* Keeps lint quiet when configASSERT() is not defined. */
+		}
+		#endif /* configASSERT_DEFINED */
+
+		/* A pointer to a StaticTimer_t structure MUST be provided, use it. */
+		configASSERT( pxTimerBuffer );
+		pxNewTimer = ( Timer_t * ) pxTimerBuffer; /*lint !e740 !e9087 StaticTimer_t is a pointer to a Timer_t, so guaranteed to be aligned and sized correctly (checked by an assert()), so this is safe. */
+
+		if( pxNewTimer != NULL )
+		{
+			/* Timers can be created statically or dynamically so note this
+			timer was created statically in case it is later deleted.  The
+			auto-reload bit may get set in prvInitialiseNewTimer(). */
+			pxNewTimer->ucStatus = tmrSTATUS_IS_STATICALLY_ALLOCATED;
+
+			prvInitialiseNewTimer( pcTimerName, xTimerPeriodInTicks, uxAutoReload, pvTimerID, pxCallbackFunction, pxNewTimer );
+		}
+
+		return pxNewTimer;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvInitialiseNewTimer(	const char * const pcTimerName,			/*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+									const TickType_t xTimerPeriodInTicks,
+									const UBaseType_t uxAutoReload,
+									void * const pvTimerID,
+									TimerCallbackFunction_t pxCallbackFunction,
+									Timer_t *pxNewTimer )
+{
+	/* 0 is not a valid value for xTimerPeriodInTicks. */
+	configASSERT( ( xTimerPeriodInTicks > 0 ) );
+
+	if( pxNewTimer != NULL )
+	{
+		/* Ensure the infrastructure used by the timer service task has been
+		created/initialised. */
+		prvCheckForValidListAndQueue();
+
+		/* Initialise the timer structure members using the function
+		parameters. */
+		pxNewTimer->pcTimerName = pcTimerName;
+		pxNewTimer->xTimerPeriodInTicks = xTimerPeriodInTicks;
+		pxNewTimer->pvTimerID = pvTimerID;
+		pxNewTimer->pxCallbackFunction = pxCallbackFunction;
+		vListInitialiseItem( &( pxNewTimer->xTimerListItem ) );
+		if( uxAutoReload != pdFALSE )
+		{
+			pxNewTimer->ucStatus |= tmrSTATUS_IS_AUTORELOAD;
+		}
+		traceTIMER_CREATE( pxNewTimer );
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xTimerGenericCommand( TimerHandle_t xTimer, const BaseType_t xCommandID, const TickType_t xOptionalValue, BaseType_t * const pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken, const TickType_t xTicksToWait )
+{
+BaseType_t xReturn = pdFAIL;
+DaemonTaskMessage_t xMessage;
+
+	configASSERT( xTimer );
+
+	/* Send a message to the timer service task to perform a particular action
+	on a particular timer definition. */
+	if( xTimerQueue != NULL )
+	{
+		/* Send a command to the timer service task to start the xTimer timer. */
+		xMessage.xMessageID = xCommandID;
+		xMessage.u.xTimerParameters.xMessageValue = xOptionalValue;
+		xMessage.u.xTimerParameters.pxTimer = xTimer;
+
+		if( xCommandID < tmrFIRST_FROM_ISR_COMMAND )
+		{
+			if( xTaskGetSchedulerState() == taskSCHEDULER_RUNNING )
+			{
+				xReturn = xQueueSendToBack( xTimerQueue, &xMessage, xTicksToWait );
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				xReturn = xQueueSendToBack( xTimerQueue, &xMessage, tmrNO_DELAY );
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xReturn = xQueueSendToBackFromISR( xTimerQueue, &xMessage, pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken );
+		}
+
+		traceTIMER_COMMAND_SEND( xTimer, xCommandID, xOptionalValue, xReturn );
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+	}
+
+	return xReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+TaskHandle_t xTimerGetTimerDaemonTaskHandle( void )
+{
+	/* If xTimerGetTimerDaemonTaskHandle() is called before the scheduler has been
+	started, then xTimerTaskHandle will be NULL. */
+	configASSERT( ( xTimerTaskHandle != NULL ) );
+	return xTimerTaskHandle;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+TickType_t xTimerGetPeriod( TimerHandle_t xTimer )
+{
+Timer_t *pxTimer = xTimer;
+
+	configASSERT( xTimer );
+	return pxTimer->xTimerPeriodInTicks;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vTimerSetReloadMode( TimerHandle_t xTimer, const UBaseType_t uxAutoReload )
+{
+Timer_t * pxTimer =  xTimer;
+
+	configASSERT( xTimer );
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		if( uxAutoReload != pdFALSE )
+		{
+			pxTimer->ucStatus |= tmrSTATUS_IS_AUTORELOAD;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			pxTimer->ucStatus &= ~tmrSTATUS_IS_AUTORELOAD;
+		}
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+UBaseType_t uxTimerGetReloadMode( TimerHandle_t xTimer )
+{
+Timer_t * pxTimer =  xTimer;
+UBaseType_t uxReturn;
+
+	configASSERT( xTimer );
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		if( ( pxTimer->ucStatus & tmrSTATUS_IS_AUTORELOAD ) == 0 )
+		{
+			/* Not an auto-reload timer. */
+			uxReturn = ( UBaseType_t ) pdFALSE;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			/* Is an auto-reload timer. */
+			uxReturn = ( UBaseType_t ) pdTRUE;
+		}
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+	return uxReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+TickType_t xTimerGetExpiryTime( TimerHandle_t xTimer )
+{
+Timer_t * pxTimer =  xTimer;
+TickType_t xReturn;
+
+	configASSERT( xTimer );
+	xReturn = listGET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxTimer->xTimerListItem ) );
+	return xReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+const char * pcTimerGetName( TimerHandle_t xTimer ) /*lint !e971 Unqualified char types are allowed for strings and single characters only. */
+{
+Timer_t *pxTimer = xTimer;
+
+	configASSERT( xTimer );
+	return pxTimer->pcTimerName;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvProcessExpiredTimer( const TickType_t xNextExpireTime, const TickType_t xTimeNow )
+{
+BaseType_t xResult;
+Timer_t * const pxTimer = ( Timer_t * ) listGET_OWNER_OF_HEAD_ENTRY( pxCurrentTimerList ); /*lint !e9087 !e9079 void * is used as this macro is used with tasks and co-routines too.  Alignment is known to be fine as the type of the pointer stored and retrieved is the same. */
+
+	/* Remove the timer from the list of active timers.  A check has already
+	been performed to ensure the list is not empty. */
+	( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTimer->xTimerListItem ) );
+	traceTIMER_EXPIRED( pxTimer );
+
+	/* If the timer is an auto-reload timer then calculate the next
+	expiry time and re-insert the timer in the list of active timers. */
+	if( ( pxTimer->ucStatus & tmrSTATUS_IS_AUTORELOAD ) != 0 )
+	{
+		/* The timer is inserted into a list using a time relative to anything
+		other than the current time.  It will therefore be inserted into the
+		correct list relative to the time this task thinks it is now. */
+		if( prvInsertTimerInActiveList( pxTimer, ( xNextExpireTime + pxTimer->xTimerPeriodInTicks ), xTimeNow, xNextExpireTime ) != pdFALSE )
+		{
+			/* The timer expired before it was added to the active timer
+			list.  Reload it now.  */
+			xResult = xTimerGenericCommand( pxTimer, tmrCOMMAND_START_DONT_TRACE, xNextExpireTime, NULL, tmrNO_DELAY );
+			configASSERT( xResult );
+			( void ) xResult;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		pxTimer->ucStatus &= ~tmrSTATUS_IS_ACTIVE;
+		mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+	}
+
+	/* Call the timer callback. */
+	pxTimer->pxCallbackFunction( ( TimerHandle_t ) pxTimer );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static portTASK_FUNCTION( prvTimerTask, pvParameters )
+{
+TickType_t xNextExpireTime;
+BaseType_t xListWasEmpty;
+
+	/* Just to avoid compiler warnings. */
+	( void ) pvParameters;
+
+	#if( configUSE_DAEMON_TASK_STARTUP_HOOK == 1 )
+	{
+		extern void vApplicationDaemonTaskStartupHook( void );
+
+		/* Allow the application writer to execute some code in the context of
+		this task at the point the task starts executing.  This is useful if the
+		application includes initialisation code that would benefit from
+		executing after the scheduler has been started. */
+		vApplicationDaemonTaskStartupHook();
+	}
+	#endif /* configUSE_DAEMON_TASK_STARTUP_HOOK */
+
+	for( ;; )
+	{
+		/* Query the timers list to see if it contains any timers, and if so,
+		obtain the time at which the next timer will expire. */
+		xNextExpireTime = prvGetNextExpireTime( &xListWasEmpty );
+
+		/* If a timer has expired, process it.  Otherwise, block this task
+		until either a timer does expire, or a command is received. */
+		prvProcessTimerOrBlockTask( xNextExpireTime, xListWasEmpty );
+
+		/* Empty the command queue. */
+		prvProcessReceivedCommands();
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvProcessTimerOrBlockTask( const TickType_t xNextExpireTime, BaseType_t xListWasEmpty )
+{
+TickType_t xTimeNow;
+BaseType_t xTimerListsWereSwitched;
+
+	vTaskSuspendAll();
+	{
+		/* Obtain the time now to make an assessment as to whether the timer
+		has expired or not.  If obtaining the time causes the lists to switch
+		then don't process this timer as any timers that remained in the list
+		when the lists were switched will have been processed within the
+		prvSampleTimeNow() function. */
+		xTimeNow = prvSampleTimeNow( &xTimerListsWereSwitched );
+		if( xTimerListsWereSwitched == pdFALSE )
+		{
+			/* The tick count has not overflowed, has the timer expired? */
+			if( ( xListWasEmpty == pdFALSE ) && ( xNextExpireTime <= xTimeNow ) )
+			{
+				( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+				prvProcessExpiredTimer( xNextExpireTime, xTimeNow );
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				/* The tick count has not overflowed, and the next expire
+				time has not been reached yet.  This task should therefore
+				block to wait for the next expire time or a command to be
+				received - whichever comes first.  The following line cannot
+				be reached unless xNextExpireTime > xTimeNow, except in the
+				case when the current timer list is empty. */
+				if( xListWasEmpty != pdFALSE )
+				{
+					/* The current timer list is empty - is the overflow list
+					also empty? */
+					xListWasEmpty = listLIST_IS_EMPTY( pxOverflowTimerList );
+				}
+
+				vQueueWaitForMessageRestricted( xTimerQueue, ( xNextExpireTime - xTimeNow ), xListWasEmpty );
+
+				if( xTaskResumeAll() == pdFALSE )
+				{
+					/* Yield to wait for either a command to arrive, or the
+					block time to expire.  If a command arrived between the
+					critical section being exited and this yield then the yield
+					will not cause the task to block. */
+					portYIELD_WITHIN_API();
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			( void ) xTaskResumeAll();
+		}
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static TickType_t prvGetNextExpireTime( BaseType_t * const pxListWasEmpty )
+{
+TickType_t xNextExpireTime;
+
+	/* Timers are listed in expiry time order, with the head of the list
+	referencing the task that will expire first.  Obtain the time at which
+	the timer with the nearest expiry time will expire.  If there are no
+	active timers then just set the next expire time to 0.  That will cause
+	this task to unblock when the tick count overflows, at which point the
+	timer lists will be switched and the next expiry time can be
+	re-assessed.  */
+	*pxListWasEmpty = listLIST_IS_EMPTY( pxCurrentTimerList );
+	if( *pxListWasEmpty == pdFALSE )
+	{
+		xNextExpireTime = listGET_ITEM_VALUE_OF_HEAD_ENTRY( pxCurrentTimerList );
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		/* Ensure the task unblocks when the tick count rolls over. */
+		xNextExpireTime = ( TickType_t ) 0U;
+	}
+
+	return xNextExpireTime;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static TickType_t prvSampleTimeNow( BaseType_t * const pxTimerListsWereSwitched )
+{
+TickType_t xTimeNow;
+PRIVILEGED_DATA static TickType_t xLastTime = ( TickType_t ) 0U; /*lint !e956 Variable is only accessible to one task. */
+
+	xTimeNow = xTaskGetTickCount();
+
+	if( xTimeNow < xLastTime )
+	{
+		prvSwitchTimerLists();
+		*pxTimerListsWereSwitched = pdTRUE;
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		*pxTimerListsWereSwitched = pdFALSE;
+	}
+
+	xLastTime = xTimeNow;
+
+	return xTimeNow;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static BaseType_t prvInsertTimerInActiveList( Timer_t * const pxTimer, const TickType_t xNextExpiryTime, const TickType_t xTimeNow, const TickType_t xCommandTime )
+{
+BaseType_t xProcessTimerNow = pdFALSE;
+
+	listSET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxTimer->xTimerListItem ), xNextExpiryTime );
+	listSET_LIST_ITEM_OWNER( &( pxTimer->xTimerListItem ), pxTimer );
+
+	if( xNextExpiryTime <= xTimeNow )
+	{
+		/* Has the expiry time elapsed between the command to start/reset a
+		timer was issued, and the time the command was processed? */
+		if( ( ( TickType_t ) ( xTimeNow - xCommandTime ) ) >= pxTimer->xTimerPeriodInTicks ) /*lint !e961 MISRA exception as the casts are only redundant for some ports. */
+		{
+			/* The time between a command being issued and the command being
+			processed actually exceeds the timers period.  */
+			xProcessTimerNow = pdTRUE;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			vListInsert( pxOverflowTimerList, &( pxTimer->xTimerListItem ) );
+		}
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		if( ( xTimeNow < xCommandTime ) && ( xNextExpiryTime >= xCommandTime ) )
+		{
+			/* If, since the command was issued, the tick count has overflowed
+			but the expiry time has not, then the timer must have already passed
+			its expiry time and should be processed immediately. */
+			xProcessTimerNow = pdTRUE;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			vListInsert( pxCurrentTimerList, &( pxTimer->xTimerListItem ) );
+		}
+	}
+
+	return xProcessTimerNow;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void	prvProcessReceivedCommands( void )
+{
+DaemonTaskMessage_t xMessage;
+Timer_t *pxTimer;
+BaseType_t xTimerListsWereSwitched, xResult;
+TickType_t xTimeNow;
+
+	while( xQueueReceive( xTimerQueue, &xMessage, tmrNO_DELAY ) != pdFAIL ) /*lint !e603 xMessage does not have to be initialised as it is passed out, not in, and it is not used unless xQueueReceive() returns pdTRUE. */
+	{
+		#if ( INCLUDE_xTimerPendFunctionCall == 1 )
+		{
+			/* Negative commands are pended function calls rather than timer
+			commands. */
+			if( xMessage.xMessageID < ( BaseType_t ) 0 )
+			{
+				const CallbackParameters_t * const pxCallback = &( xMessage.u.xCallbackParameters );
+
+				/* The timer uses the xCallbackParameters member to request a
+				callback be executed.  Check the callback is not NULL. */
+				configASSERT( pxCallback );
+
+				/* Call the function. */
+				pxCallback->pxCallbackFunction( pxCallback->pvParameter1, pxCallback->ulParameter2 );
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+		}
+		#endif /* INCLUDE_xTimerPendFunctionCall */
+
+		/* Commands that are positive are timer commands rather than pended
+		function calls. */
+		if( xMessage.xMessageID >= ( BaseType_t ) 0 )
+		{
+			/* The messages uses the xTimerParameters member to work on a
+			software timer. */
+			pxTimer = xMessage.u.xTimerParameters.pxTimer;
+
+			if( listIS_CONTAINED_WITHIN( NULL, &( pxTimer->xTimerListItem ) ) == pdFALSE ) /*lint !e961. The cast is only redundant when NULL is passed into the macro. */
+			{
+				/* The timer is in a list, remove it. */
+				( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTimer->xTimerListItem ) );
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+			}
+
+			traceTIMER_COMMAND_RECEIVED( pxTimer, xMessage.xMessageID, xMessage.u.xTimerParameters.xMessageValue );
+
+			/* In this case the xTimerListsWereSwitched parameter is not used, but
+			it must be present in the function call.  prvSampleTimeNow() must be
+			called after the message is received from xTimerQueue so there is no
+			possibility of a higher priority task adding a message to the message
+			queue with a time that is ahead of the timer daemon task (because it
+			pre-empted the timer daemon task after the xTimeNow value was set). */
+			xTimeNow = prvSampleTimeNow( &xTimerListsWereSwitched );
+
+			switch( xMessage.xMessageID )
+			{
+				case tmrCOMMAND_START :
+				case tmrCOMMAND_START_FROM_ISR :
+				case tmrCOMMAND_RESET :
+				case tmrCOMMAND_RESET_FROM_ISR :
+				case tmrCOMMAND_START_DONT_TRACE :
+					/* Start or restart a timer. */
+					pxTimer->ucStatus |= tmrSTATUS_IS_ACTIVE;
+					if( prvInsertTimerInActiveList( pxTimer,  xMessage.u.xTimerParameters.xMessageValue + pxTimer->xTimerPeriodInTicks, xTimeNow, xMessage.u.xTimerParameters.xMessageValue ) != pdFALSE )
+					{
+						/* The timer expired before it was added to the active
+						timer list.  Process it now. */
+						pxTimer->pxCallbackFunction( ( TimerHandle_t ) pxTimer );
+						traceTIMER_EXPIRED( pxTimer );
+
+						if( ( pxTimer->ucStatus & tmrSTATUS_IS_AUTORELOAD ) != 0 )
+						{
+							xResult = xTimerGenericCommand( pxTimer, tmrCOMMAND_START_DONT_TRACE, xMessage.u.xTimerParameters.xMessageValue + pxTimer->xTimerPeriodInTicks, NULL, tmrNO_DELAY );
+							configASSERT( xResult );
+							( void ) xResult;
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+						}
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+					}
+					break;
+
+				case tmrCOMMAND_STOP :
+				case tmrCOMMAND_STOP_FROM_ISR :
+					/* The timer has already been removed from the active list. */
+					pxTimer->ucStatus &= ~tmrSTATUS_IS_ACTIVE;
+					break;
+
+				case tmrCOMMAND_CHANGE_PERIOD :
+				case tmrCOMMAND_CHANGE_PERIOD_FROM_ISR :
+					pxTimer->ucStatus |= tmrSTATUS_IS_ACTIVE;
+					pxTimer->xTimerPeriodInTicks = xMessage.u.xTimerParameters.xMessageValue;
+					configASSERT( ( pxTimer->xTimerPeriodInTicks > 0 ) );
+
+					/* The new period does not really have a reference, and can
+					be longer or shorter than the old one.  The command time is
+					therefore set to the current time, and as the period cannot
+					be zero the next expiry time can only be in the future,
+					meaning (unlike for the xTimerStart() case above) there is
+					no fail case that needs to be handled here. */
+					( void ) prvInsertTimerInActiveList( pxTimer, ( xTimeNow + pxTimer->xTimerPeriodInTicks ), xTimeNow, xTimeNow );
+					break;
+
+				case tmrCOMMAND_DELETE :
+					#if ( configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION == 1 )
+					{
+						/* The timer has already been removed from the active list,
+						just free up the memory if the memory was dynamically
+						allocated. */
+						if( ( pxTimer->ucStatus & tmrSTATUS_IS_STATICALLY_ALLOCATED ) == ( uint8_t ) 0 )
+						{
+							vPortFree( pxTimer );
+						}
+						else
+						{
+							pxTimer->ucStatus &= ~tmrSTATUS_IS_ACTIVE;
+						}
+					}
+					#else
+					{
+						/* If dynamic allocation is not enabled, the memory
+						could not have been dynamically allocated. So there is
+						no need to free the memory - just mark the timer as
+						"not active". */
+						pxTimer->ucStatus &= ~tmrSTATUS_IS_ACTIVE;
+					}
+					#endif /* configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION */
+					break;
+
+				default	:
+					/* Don't expect to get here. */
+					break;
+			}
+		}
+	}
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvSwitchTimerLists( void )
+{
+TickType_t xNextExpireTime, xReloadTime;
+List_t *pxTemp;
+Timer_t *pxTimer;
+BaseType_t xResult;
+
+	/* The tick count has overflowed.  The timer lists must be switched.
+	If there are any timers still referenced from the current timer list
+	then they must have expired and should be processed before the lists
+	are switched. */
+	while( listLIST_IS_EMPTY( pxCurrentTimerList ) == pdFALSE )
+	{
+		xNextExpireTime = listGET_ITEM_VALUE_OF_HEAD_ENTRY( pxCurrentTimerList );
+
+		/* Remove the timer from the list. */
+		pxTimer = ( Timer_t * ) listGET_OWNER_OF_HEAD_ENTRY( pxCurrentTimerList ); /*lint !e9087 !e9079 void * is used as this macro is used with tasks and co-routines too.  Alignment is known to be fine as the type of the pointer stored and retrieved is the same. */
+		( void ) uxListRemove( &( pxTimer->xTimerListItem ) );
+		traceTIMER_EXPIRED( pxTimer );
+
+		/* Execute its callback, then send a command to restart the timer if
+		it is an auto-reload timer.  It cannot be restarted here as the lists
+		have not yet been switched. */
+		pxTimer->pxCallbackFunction( ( TimerHandle_t ) pxTimer );
+
+		if( ( pxTimer->ucStatus & tmrSTATUS_IS_AUTORELOAD ) != 0 )
+		{
+			/* Calculate the reload value, and if the reload value results in
+			the timer going into the same timer list then it has already expired
+			and the timer should be re-inserted into the current list so it is
+			processed again within this loop.  Otherwise a command should be sent
+			to restart the timer to ensure it is only inserted into a list after
+			the lists have been swapped. */
+			xReloadTime = ( xNextExpireTime + pxTimer->xTimerPeriodInTicks );
+			if( xReloadTime > xNextExpireTime )
+			{
+				listSET_LIST_ITEM_VALUE( &( pxTimer->xTimerListItem ), xReloadTime );
+				listSET_LIST_ITEM_OWNER( &( pxTimer->xTimerListItem ), pxTimer );
+				vListInsert( pxCurrentTimerList, &( pxTimer->xTimerListItem ) );
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				xResult = xTimerGenericCommand( pxTimer, tmrCOMMAND_START_DONT_TRACE, xNextExpireTime, NULL, tmrNO_DELAY );
+				configASSERT( xResult );
+				( void ) xResult;
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+
+	pxTemp = pxCurrentTimerList;
+	pxCurrentTimerList = pxOverflowTimerList;
+	pxOverflowTimerList = pxTemp;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvCheckForValidListAndQueue( void )
+{
+	/* Check that the list from which active timers are referenced, and the
+	queue used to communicate with the timer service, have been
+	initialised. */
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		if( xTimerQueue == NULL )
+		{
+			vListInitialise( &xActiveTimerList1 );
+			vListInitialise( &xActiveTimerList2 );
+			pxCurrentTimerList = &xActiveTimerList1;
+			pxOverflowTimerList = &xActiveTimerList2;
+
+			#if( configSUPPORT_STATIC_ALLOCATION == 1 )
+			{
+				/* The timer queue is allocated statically in case
+				configSUPPORT_DYNAMIC_ALLOCATION is 0. */
+				static StaticQueue_t xStaticTimerQueue; /*lint !e956 Ok to declare in this manner to prevent additional conditional compilation guards in other locations. */
+				static uint8_t ucStaticTimerQueueStorage[ ( size_t ) configTIMER_QUEUE_LENGTH * sizeof( DaemonTaskMessage_t ) ]; /*lint !e956 Ok to declare in this manner to prevent additional conditional compilation guards in other locations. */
+
+				xTimerQueue = xQueueCreateStatic( ( UBaseType_t ) configTIMER_QUEUE_LENGTH, ( UBaseType_t ) sizeof( DaemonTaskMessage_t ), &( ucStaticTimerQueueStorage[ 0 ] ), &xStaticTimerQueue );
+			}
+			#else
+			{
+				xTimerQueue = xQueueCreate( ( UBaseType_t ) configTIMER_QUEUE_LENGTH, sizeof( DaemonTaskMessage_t ) );
+			}
+			#endif
+
+			#if ( configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE > 0 )
+			{
+				if( xTimerQueue != NULL )
+				{
+					vQueueAddToRegistry( xTimerQueue, "TmrQ" );
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+				}
+			}
+			#endif /* configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE */
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			mtCOVERAGE_TEST_MARKER();
+		}
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+BaseType_t xTimerIsTimerActive( TimerHandle_t xTimer )
+{
+BaseType_t xReturn;
+Timer_t *pxTimer = xTimer;
+
+	configASSERT( xTimer );
+
+	/* Is the timer in the list of active timers? */
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		if( ( pxTimer->ucStatus & tmrSTATUS_IS_ACTIVE ) == 0 )
+		{
+			xReturn = pdFALSE;
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			xReturn = pdTRUE;
+		}
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+	return xReturn;
+} /*lint !e818 Can't be pointer to const due to the typedef. */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void *pvTimerGetTimerID( const TimerHandle_t xTimer )
+{
+Timer_t * const pxTimer = xTimer;
+void *pvReturn;
+
+	configASSERT( xTimer );
+
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		pvReturn = pxTimer->pvTimerID;
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+
+	return pvReturn;
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vTimerSetTimerID( TimerHandle_t xTimer, void *pvNewID )
+{
+Timer_t * const pxTimer = xTimer;
+
+	configASSERT( xTimer );
+
+	taskENTER_CRITICAL();
+	{
+		pxTimer->pvTimerID = pvNewID;
+	}
+	taskEXIT_CRITICAL();
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( INCLUDE_xTimerPendFunctionCall == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xTimerPendFunctionCallFromISR( PendedFunction_t xFunctionToPend, void *pvParameter1, uint32_t ulParameter2, BaseType_t *pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken )
+	{
+	DaemonTaskMessage_t xMessage;
+	BaseType_t xReturn;
+
+		/* Complete the message with the function parameters and post it to the
+		daemon task. */
+		xMessage.xMessageID = tmrCOMMAND_EXECUTE_CALLBACK_FROM_ISR;
+		xMessage.u.xCallbackParameters.pxCallbackFunction = xFunctionToPend;
+		xMessage.u.xCallbackParameters.pvParameter1 = pvParameter1;
+		xMessage.u.xCallbackParameters.ulParameter2 = ulParameter2;
+
+		xReturn = xQueueSendFromISR( xTimerQueue, &xMessage, pxHigherPriorityTaskWoken );
+
+		tracePEND_FUNC_CALL_FROM_ISR( xFunctionToPend, pvParameter1, ulParameter2, xReturn );
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_xTimerPendFunctionCall */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if( INCLUDE_xTimerPendFunctionCall == 1 )
+
+	BaseType_t xTimerPendFunctionCall( PendedFunction_t xFunctionToPend, void *pvParameter1, uint32_t ulParameter2, TickType_t xTicksToWait )
+	{
+	DaemonTaskMessage_t xMessage;
+	BaseType_t xReturn;
+
+		/* This function can only be called after a timer has been created or
+		after the scheduler has been started because, until then, the timer
+		queue does not exist. */
+		configASSERT( xTimerQueue );
+
+		/* Complete the message with the function parameters and post it to the
+		daemon task. */
+		xMessage.xMessageID = tmrCOMMAND_EXECUTE_CALLBACK;
+		xMessage.u.xCallbackParameters.pxCallbackFunction = xFunctionToPend;
+		xMessage.u.xCallbackParameters.pvParameter1 = pvParameter1;
+		xMessage.u.xCallbackParameters.ulParameter2 = ulParameter2;
+
+		xReturn = xQueueSendToBack( xTimerQueue, &xMessage, xTicksToWait );
+
+		tracePEND_FUNC_CALL( xFunctionToPend, pvParameter1, ulParameter2, xReturn );
+
+		return xReturn;
+	}
+
+#endif /* INCLUDE_xTimerPendFunctionCall */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+
+	UBaseType_t uxTimerGetTimerNumber( TimerHandle_t xTimer )
+	{
+		return ( ( Timer_t * ) xTimer )->uxTimerNumber;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#if ( configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY == 1 )
+
+	void vTimerSetTimerNumber( TimerHandle_t xTimer, UBaseType_t uxTimerNumber )
+	{
+		( ( Timer_t * ) xTimer )->uxTimerNumber = uxTimerNumber;
+	}
+
+#endif /* configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY */
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* This entire source file will be skipped if the application is not configured
+to include software timer functionality.  If you want to include software timer
+functionality then ensure configUSE_TIMERS is set to 1 in FreeRTOSConfig.h. */
+#endif /* configUSE_TIMERS == 1 */
+
+
+
Index: ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/charger.ioc
===================================================================
--- ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/charger.ioc	(revision 72)
+++ ctrl/firmware/Main/CubeMX/charger.ioc	(revision 73)
@@ -66,8 +66,9 @@
 Dma.USART3_TX.2.SyncRequestNumber=1
 Dma.USART3_TX.2.SyncSignalID=NONE
+FREERTOS.FootprintOK=true
 FREERTOS.INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark2=1
 FREERTOS.INCLUDE_xTaskGetHandle=1
-FREERTOS.IPParameters=Tasks01,configENABLE_FPU,configENABLE_BACKWARD_COMPATIBILITY,configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE,configRECORD_STACK_HIGH_ADDRESS,configCHECK_FOR_STACK_OVERFLOW,INCLUDE_xTaskGetHandle,INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark2
-FREERTOS.Tasks01=mainTask,24,128,mainTaskStart,Default,NULL,Static,mainTaskBuffer,mainTaskControlBlock
+FREERTOS.IPParameters=Tasks01,configENABLE_FPU,configENABLE_BACKWARD_COMPATIBILITY,configUSE_TICKLESS_IDLE,configRECORD_STACK_HIGH_ADDRESS,configCHECK_FOR_STACK_OVERFLOW,INCLUDE_xTaskGetHandle,INCLUDE_uxTaskGetStackHighWaterMark2,FootprintOK
+FREERTOS.Tasks01=mainTask,24,128,mainTaskStart,As weak,NULL,Static,mainTaskBuffer,mainTaskControlBlock
 FREERTOS.configCHECK_FOR_STACK_OVERFLOW=2
 FREERTOS.configENABLE_BACKWARD_COMPATIBILITY=0
@@ -488,2 +489,3 @@
 VP_TIM8_VS_ControllerModeReset.Signal=TIM8_VS_ControllerModeReset
 board=custom
+rtos.0.ip=FREERTOS
